2011-11-03 Tristan Gingold <gingold@adacore.com>
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
3 @c 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009,
4 @c 2010, 2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24 @syncodeindex tp cp
25
26 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
27 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
28 @syncodeindex vr cp
29 @syncodeindex fn cp
30
31 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
32 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
33 @set EDITION Tenth
34
35 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
36 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
37
38 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
39
40 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
41 @c manuals to an info tree.
42 @dircategory Software development
43 @direntry
44 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
45 @end direntry
46
47 @copying
48 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
49 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
50 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
51
52 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
53 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
54 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
55 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
56 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
57 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
58
59 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
60 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
61 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
62 @end copying
63
64 @ifnottex
65 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
66
67 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
68 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
69 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
70 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
71 @end ifset
72 Version @value{GDBVN}.
73
74 @insertcopying
75 @end ifnottex
76
77 @titlepage
78 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
79 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
80 @sp 1
81 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
82 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
83 @sp 1
84 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
85 @end ifset
86 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
87 @page
88 @tex
89 {\parskip=0pt
90 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
91 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
92 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
93 }
94 @end tex
95
96 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
97 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
98 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
99 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
100 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
101
102 @insertcopying
103 @end titlepage
104 @page
105
106 @ifnottex
107 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
108
109 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
110
111 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
112
113 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
114 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
115 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
116 @end ifset
117 Version @value{GDBVN}.
118
119 Copyright (C) 1988-2010 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
120
121 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
122 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
123 software in general. We will miss him.
124
125 @menu
126 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
127 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
128
129 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
130 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
131 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
132 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
133 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
134 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
135 * Stack:: Examining the stack
136 * Source:: Examining source files
137 * Data:: Examining data
138 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
139 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
140 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
141 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
142
143 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
144
145 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
146 * Altering:: Altering execution
147 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
148 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
149 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
150 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
151 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
152 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
153 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
154 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
155 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
156 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
157 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
158 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
159
160 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
161
162 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
163 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
164 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
165 @end ifset
166 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
167 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
168 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
169 @end ifclear
170 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
171 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
172 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
173 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
174 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
175 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
176 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
177 @value{GDBN}
178 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
179 the operating system
180 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
181 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
182 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
183 how you can copy and share GDB
184 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
185 * Index:: Index
186 @end menu
187
188 @end ifnottex
189
190 @contents
191
192 @node Summary
193 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
194
195 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
196 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
197 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
198
199 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
200 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
201
202 @itemize @bullet
203 @item
204 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
205
206 @item
207 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
208
209 @item
210 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
211
212 @item
213 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
214 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
215 @end itemize
216
217 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
218 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
219 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
220
221 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
222 @ref{D,,D}.
223
224 @cindex Modula-2
225 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
226 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
227
228 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
229 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
230
231 @cindex Pascal
232 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
233 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
234 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
235 syntax.
236
237 @cindex Fortran
238 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
239 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
240 underscore.
241
242 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
243 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
244
245 @menu
246 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
247 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
248 @end menu
249
250 @node Free Software
251 @unnumberedsec Free Software
252
253 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
254 General Public License
255 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
256 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
257 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
258 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
259 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
260 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
261
262 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
263 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
264 from anyone else.
265
266 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
267
268 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
269 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
270 include with the free software. Many of our most important
271 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
272 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
273 when an important free software package does not come with a free
274 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
275 gaps today.
276
277 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
278 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
279 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
280 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
281 them from the free software world.
282
283 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
284 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
285 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
286 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
287 contract to make it non-free.
288
289 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
290 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
291 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
292 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
293 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
294 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
295 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
296
297 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
298 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
299 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
300 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
301
302 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
303 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
304 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
305 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
306 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
307 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
308 community.
309
310 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
311 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
312 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
313 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
314 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
315 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
316 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
317 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
318 of the manual.
319
320 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
321 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
322 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
323 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
324 manual to replace it.
325
326 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
327 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
328 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
329 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
330 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
331 the free software community.
332
333 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
334 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
335 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
336 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
337 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
338 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
339 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
340 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
341 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
342
343 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
344 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
345 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
346 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
347 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
348 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
349 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
350 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
351
352 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
353 published by other publishers, at
354 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
355
356 @node Contributors
357 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
358
359 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
360 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
361 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
362 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
363 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
364 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
365 blow-by-blow account.
366
367 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
368
369 @quotation
370 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
371 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
372 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
373 @end quotation
374
375 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
376 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
377 releases:
378 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
379 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
380 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
381 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
382 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
383 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
384 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
385 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
386 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
387
388 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
389 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
390
391 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
392 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
393 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
394 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
395 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
396
397 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
398 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
399 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
400
401 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
402 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
403
404 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
405
406 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
407 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
408 support.
409 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
410 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
411 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
412 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
413 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
414 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
415 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
416 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
417 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
418 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
419 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
420 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
421 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
422 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
423 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
424 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
425
426 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
427
428 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
429 libraries.
430
431 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
432 about several machine instruction sets.
433
434 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
435 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
436 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
437 and RDI targets, respectively.
438
439 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
440 command-line editing and command history.
441
442 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
443 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
444
445 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
446 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
447 symbols.
448
449 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
450 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
451
452 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
453
454 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
455 processors.
456
457 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
458
459 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
460
461 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
462
463 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
464 watchpoints.
465
466 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
467
468 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
469
470 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
471 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
472
473 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
474 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
475 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
476 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
477 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
478 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
479 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
480
481 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
482 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
483
484 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
485 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
486 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
487 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
488 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
489 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
490 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
491 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
492 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
493 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
494 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
495 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
496 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
497 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
498 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
499
500 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
501 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
502
503 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
504 Hat.
505
506 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
507 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
508 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
509 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
510 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
511 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
512
513 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
514 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
515 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
516 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
517 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
518 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
519 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
520 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
521 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
522 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
523 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
524 Weigand.
525
526 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
527 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
528 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
529 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
530
531 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
532 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
533
534 @node Sample Session
535 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
536
537 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
538 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
539 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
540
541 @iftex
542 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
543 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
544 @end iftex
545
546 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
547 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
548
549 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
550 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
551 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
552 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
553 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
554 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
555 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
556 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
557 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
558
559 @smallexample
560 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
561 $ @b{./m4}
562 @b{define(foo,0000)}
563
564 @b{foo}
565 0000
566 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
567
568 @b{bar}
569 0000
570 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
571
572 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
573 @b{baz}
574 @b{Ctrl-d}
575 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
576 @end smallexample
577
578 @noindent
579 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
580
581 @smallexample
582 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
583 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
584 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
585 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
586 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
587 the conditions.
588 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
589 for details.
590
591 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
592 (@value{GDBP})
593 @end smallexample
594
595 @noindent
596 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
597 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
598 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
599 that examples fit in this manual.
600
601 @smallexample
602 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
607 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
608 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
609 @code{break} command.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
613 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
614 @end smallexample
615
616 @noindent
617 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
618 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
619 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
623 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
624 @b{define(foo,0000)}
625
626 @b{foo}
627 0000
628 @end smallexample
629
630 @noindent
631 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
632 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
633 context where it stops.
634
635 @smallexample
636 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
637
638 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
639 at builtin.c:879
640 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
641 @end smallexample
642
643 @noindent
644 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
645 the next line of the current function.
646
647 @smallexample
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
649 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
650 : nil,
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
655 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
656 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
657 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
658
659 @smallexample
660 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
661 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
662 at input.c:530
663 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
664 @end smallexample
665
666 @noindent
667 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
668 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
669 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
670 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
671 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
672 stack frame for each active subroutine.
673
674 @smallexample
675 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
676 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
677 at input.c:530
678 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
679 at builtin.c:882
680 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
681 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
682 at macro.c:71
683 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
684 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
685 @end smallexample
686
687 @noindent
688 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
689 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
690 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
691
692 @smallexample
693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
694 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
696 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
697 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
698 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
699 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
700 : xstrdup(rq);
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
702 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
703 @end smallexample
704
705 @noindent
706 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
707 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
708 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
709 (@code{print}) to see their values.
710
711 @smallexample
712 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
713 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
714 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
715 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
716 @end smallexample
717
718 @noindent
719 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
720 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
721 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
722
723 @smallexample
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
725 533 xfree(rquote);
726 534
727 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
728 : xstrdup (lq);
729 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
730 : xstrdup (rq);
731 537
732 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
733 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
734 540 @}
735 541
736 542 void
737 @end smallexample
738
739 @noindent
740 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
741 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
742
743 @smallexample
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
745 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
746 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
747 540 @}
748 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
749 $3 = 9
750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
751 $4 = 7
752 @end smallexample
753
754 @noindent
755 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
756 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
757 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
758 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
759 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
760 assignments.
761
762 @smallexample
763 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
764 $5 = 7
765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
766 $6 = 9
767 @end smallexample
768
769 @noindent
770 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
771 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
772 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
773 example that caused trouble initially:
774
775 @smallexample
776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
777 Continuing.
778
779 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
780
781 baz
782 0000
783 @end smallexample
784
785 @noindent
786 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
787 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
788 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
789
790 @smallexample
791 @b{Ctrl-d}
792 Program exited normally.
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
797 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
798 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
799
800 @smallexample
801 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
802 @end smallexample
803
804 @node Invocation
805 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
806
807 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
808 The essentials are:
809 @itemize @bullet
810 @item
811 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
812 @item
813 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
814 @end itemize
815
816 @menu
817 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
818 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
819 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
820 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
821 @end menu
822
823 @node Invoking GDB
824 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
825
826 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
827 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
828
829 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
830 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
831
832 The command-line options described here are designed
833 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
834 options may effectively be unavailable.
835
836 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
837 specifying an executable program:
838
839 @smallexample
840 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
841 @end smallexample
842
843 @noindent
844 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
845 specified:
846
847 @smallexample
848 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
849 @end smallexample
850
851 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
852 to debug a running process:
853
854 @smallexample
855 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
856 @end smallexample
857
858 @noindent
859 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
860 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
861
862 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
863 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
864 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
865 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
866 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
867
868 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
869 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
870 option processing.
871 @smallexample
872 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
873 @end smallexample
874 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
875 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
876
877 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
878 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} -silent
882 @end smallexample
883
884 @noindent
885 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
886 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
887
888 @noindent
889 Type
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} -help
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
897 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
898
899 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
900 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
901 @samp{-x} option is used.
902
903
904 @menu
905 * File Options:: Choosing files
906 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
907 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
908 @end menu
909
910 @node File Options
911 @subsection Choosing Files
912
913 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
914 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
915 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
916 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
917 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
918 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
919 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
920 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
921 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
922 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
923 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
924 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
925 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
926
927 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
928 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
929 argument and ignore it.
930
931 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
932 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
933 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
934 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
935 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
936
937 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
938 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
939 @c it.
940
941 @table @code
942 @item -symbols @var{file}
943 @itemx -s @var{file}
944 @cindex @code{--symbols}
945 @cindex @code{-s}
946 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
947
948 @item -exec @var{file}
949 @itemx -e @var{file}
950 @cindex @code{--exec}
951 @cindex @code{-e}
952 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
953 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
954
955 @item -se @var{file}
956 @cindex @code{--se}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
958 file.
959
960 @item -core @var{file}
961 @itemx -c @var{file}
962 @cindex @code{--core}
963 @cindex @code{-c}
964 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
965
966 @item -pid @var{number}
967 @itemx -p @var{number}
968 @cindex @code{--pid}
969 @cindex @code{-p}
970 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
971
972 @item -command @var{file}
973 @itemx -x @var{file}
974 @cindex @code{--command}
975 @cindex @code{-x}
976 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
977 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
978 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
979
980 @item -eval-command @var{command}
981 @itemx -ex @var{command}
982 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
983 @cindex @code{-ex}
984 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
985
986 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
987 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
988
989 @smallexample
990 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
991 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
992 @end smallexample
993
994 @item -directory @var{directory}
995 @itemx -d @var{directory}
996 @cindex @code{--directory}
997 @cindex @code{-d}
998 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
999
1000 @item -r
1001 @itemx -readnow
1002 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1003 @cindex @code{-r}
1004 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1005 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1006 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1007
1008 @end table
1009
1010 @node Mode Options
1011 @subsection Choosing Modes
1012
1013 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1014 batch mode or quiet mode.
1015
1016 @table @code
1017 @item -nx
1018 @itemx -n
1019 @cindex @code{--nx}
1020 @cindex @code{-n}
1021 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1022 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1023 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1024 Files}.
1025
1026 @item -quiet
1027 @itemx -silent
1028 @itemx -q
1029 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1030 @cindex @code{--silent}
1031 @cindex @code{-q}
1032 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1033 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1034
1035 @item -batch
1036 @cindex @code{--batch}
1037 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1038 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1039 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1040 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1041 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1042 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1043 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1044
1045 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1046 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1047 make this more useful, the message
1048
1049 @smallexample
1050 Program exited normally.
1051 @end smallexample
1052
1053 @noindent
1054 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1055 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1056 mode.
1057
1058 @item -batch-silent
1059 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1060 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1061 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1062 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1063 for an interactive session.
1064
1065 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1066 messages, for example.
1067
1068 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1069 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1070
1071 @item -return-child-result
1072 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1073 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1074 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1075
1076 @itemize @bullet
1077 @item
1078 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1079 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1080 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1081 @item
1082 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1083 @item
1084 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1085 the exit code will be -1.
1086 @end itemize
1087
1088 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1089 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1090 interface.
1091
1092 @item -nowindows
1093 @itemx -nw
1094 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1095 @cindex @code{-nw}
1096 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1097 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1098 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1099
1100 @item -windows
1101 @itemx -w
1102 @cindex @code{--windows}
1103 @cindex @code{-w}
1104 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1105 used if possible.
1106
1107 @item -cd @var{directory}
1108 @cindex @code{--cd}
1109 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1110 instead of the current directory.
1111
1112 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1113 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1114 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1115 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1116 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1117
1118 @item -fullname
1119 @itemx -f
1120 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1121 @cindex @code{-f}
1122 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1123 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1124 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1125 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1126 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1127 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1128 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1129 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1130 frame.
1131
1132 @item -epoch
1133 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1134 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1135 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1136 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1137 separate window.
1138
1139 @item -annotate @var{level}
1140 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1141 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1142 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1143 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1144 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1145 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1146 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1147 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1148 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1149
1150 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1151 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1152
1153 @item --args
1154 @cindex @code{--args}
1155 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1156 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1157 This option stops option processing.
1158
1159 @item -baud @var{bps}
1160 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1161 @cindex @code{--baud}
1162 @cindex @code{-b}
1163 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1164 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1165
1166 @item -l @var{timeout}
1167 @cindex @code{-l}
1168 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1169 for remote debugging.
1170
1171 @item -tty @var{device}
1172 @itemx -t @var{device}
1173 @cindex @code{--tty}
1174 @cindex @code{-t}
1175 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1176 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1177
1178 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1179 @item -tui
1180 @cindex @code{--tui}
1181 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1182 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1183 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1184 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1185 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1186 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1187 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1188
1189 @c @item -xdb
1190 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1191 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1192 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1193 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1194 @c systems.
1195
1196 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1197 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1198 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1199 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1200 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1201 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1202
1203 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1204 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1205 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1206 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1207 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1208 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1209
1210 @item -write
1211 @cindex @code{--write}
1212 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1213 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1214 (@pxref{Patching}).
1215
1216 @item -statistics
1217 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1218 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1219 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1220
1221 @item -version
1222 @cindex @code{--version}
1223 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1224 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1225
1226 @end table
1227
1228 @node Startup
1229 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1230 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1231
1232 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1233
1234 @enumerate
1235 @item
1236 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1237 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1238
1239 @item
1240 @cindex init file
1241 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1242 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1243 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1244 that file.
1245
1246 @item
1247 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1248 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1249 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1250 that file.
1251
1252 @item
1253 Processes command line options and operands.
1254
1255 @item
1256 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1257 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1258 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1259 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1260 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1261 @value{GDBN}.
1262
1263 @item
1264 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1265 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1266 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1267 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1268
1269 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1270 you must do something like the following:
1271
1272 @smallexample
1273 $ gdb -ex "set auto-load-scripts off" -ex "file myprogram"
1274 @end smallexample
1275
1276 The following does not work because the auto-loading is turned off too late:
1277
1278 @smallexample
1279 $ gdb -ex "set auto-load-scripts off" myprogram
1280 @end smallexample
1281
1282 @item
1283 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1284 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1285
1286 @item
1287 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1288 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1289 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1290 @end enumerate
1291
1292 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1293 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1294 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1295 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1296 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1297 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1298
1299 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1300 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1301
1302 @cindex init file name
1303 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1304 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1305 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1306 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1307 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1308 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1309 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1310 the file to the standard name.
1311
1312
1313 @node Quitting GDB
1314 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1315 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1316 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1317
1318 @table @code
1319 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1320 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1321 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1322 @itemx q
1323 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1324 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1325 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1326 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1327 error code.
1328 @end table
1329
1330 @cindex interrupt
1331 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1332 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1333 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1334 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1335 until a time when it is safe.
1336
1337 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1338 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1339 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1340
1341 @node Shell Commands
1342 @section Shell Commands
1343
1344 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1345 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1346 just use the @code{shell} command.
1347
1348 @table @code
1349 @kindex shell
1350 @cindex shell escape
1351 @item shell @var{command string}
1352 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1353 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1354 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1355 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1356 @end table
1357
1358 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1359 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1360 @value{GDBN}:
1361
1362 @table @code
1363 @kindex make
1364 @cindex calling make
1365 @item make @var{make-args}
1366 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1367 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1368 @end table
1369
1370 @node Logging Output
1371 @section Logging Output
1372 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1373 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1374
1375 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1376 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1377
1378 @table @code
1379 @kindex set logging
1380 @item set logging on
1381 Enable logging.
1382 @item set logging off
1383 Disable logging.
1384 @cindex logging file name
1385 @item set logging file @var{file}
1386 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1387 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1388 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1389 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1390 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1391 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1392 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1393 @kindex show logging
1394 @item show logging
1395 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1396 @end table
1397
1398 @node Commands
1399 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1400
1401 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1402 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1403 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1404 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1405 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1406
1407 @menu
1408 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1409 * Completion:: Command completion
1410 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1411 @end menu
1412
1413 @node Command Syntax
1414 @section Command Syntax
1415
1416 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1417 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1418 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1419 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1420 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1421 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1422
1423 @cindex abbreviation
1424 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1425 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1426 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1427 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1428 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1429 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1430 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1431
1432 @cindex repeating commands
1433 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1434 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1435 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1436 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1437 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1438 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1439 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1440
1441 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1442 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1443 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1444
1445 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1446 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1447 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1448 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1449 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1450
1451 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1452 @cindex comment
1453 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1454 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1455 Files,,Command Files}).
1456
1457 @cindex repeating command sequences
1458 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1459 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1460 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1461 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1462 for editing.
1463
1464 @node Completion
1465 @section Command Completion
1466
1467 @cindex completion
1468 @cindex word completion
1469 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1470 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1471 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1472 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1473
1474 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1475 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1476 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1477 enter it). For example, if you type
1478
1479 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1480 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1481 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1482 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1483 @smallexample
1484 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1485 @end smallexample
1486
1487 @noindent
1488 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1489 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1490
1491 @smallexample
1492 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1493 @end smallexample
1494
1495 @noindent
1496 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1497 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1498 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1499 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1500 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1501 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1502
1503 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1504 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1505 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1506 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1507 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1508 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1509 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1510 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1511 example:
1512
1513 @smallexample
1514 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1515 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1516 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1517 make_abs_section make_function_type
1518 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1519 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1520 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1521 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1522 @end smallexample
1523
1524 @noindent
1525 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1526 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1527 command.
1528
1529 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1530 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1531 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1532 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1533 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1534
1535 @cindex quotes in commands
1536 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1537 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1538 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1539 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1540 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1541 @value{GDBN} commands.
1542
1543 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1544 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1545 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1546 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1547 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1548 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1549 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1550 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1551 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1552 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1553 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1554
1555 @smallexample
1556 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1557 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1558 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1559 @end smallexample
1560
1561 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1562 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1563 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1564 place:
1565
1566 @smallexample
1567 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1568 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1569 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1570 @end smallexample
1571
1572 @noindent
1573 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1574 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1575 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1576
1577 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1578 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1579 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1580 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1581
1582 @cindex completion of structure field names
1583 @cindex structure field name completion
1584 @cindex completion of union field names
1585 @cindex union field name completion
1586 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1587 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1588 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1589 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1590 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1591 left-hand-side:
1592
1593 @smallexample
1594 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1595 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1596 to_data to_isatty to_write
1597 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1598 to_flush to_read
1599 @end smallexample
1600
1601 @noindent
1602 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1603 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1604 follows:
1605
1606 @smallexample
1607 struct ui_file
1608 @{
1609 int *magic;
1610 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1611 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1612 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1613 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1614 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1615 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1616 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1617 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1618 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1619 void *to_data;
1620 @}
1621 @end smallexample
1622
1623
1624 @node Help
1625 @section Getting Help
1626 @cindex online documentation
1627 @kindex help
1628
1629 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1630 using the command @code{help}.
1631
1632 @table @code
1633 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1634 @item help
1635 @itemx h
1636 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1637 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1638
1639 @smallexample
1640 (@value{GDBP}) help
1641 List of classes of commands:
1642
1643 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1644 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1645 data -- Examining data
1646 files -- Specifying and examining files
1647 internals -- Maintenance commands
1648 obscure -- Obscure features
1649 running -- Running the program
1650 stack -- Examining the stack
1651 status -- Status inquiries
1652 support -- Support facilities
1653 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1654 stopping the program
1655 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1656
1657 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1658 commands in that class.
1659 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1660 documentation.
1661 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1662 (@value{GDBP})
1663 @end smallexample
1664 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1665
1666 @item help @var{class}
1667 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1668 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1669 help display for the class @code{status}:
1670
1671 @smallexample
1672 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1673 Status inquiries.
1674
1675 List of commands:
1676
1677 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1678 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1679 info -- Generic command for showing things
1680 about the program being debugged
1681 show -- Generic command for showing things
1682 about the debugger
1683
1684 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1685 documentation.
1686 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1687 (@value{GDBP})
1688 @end smallexample
1689
1690 @item help @var{command}
1691 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1692 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1693
1694 @kindex apropos
1695 @item apropos @var{args}
1696 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1697 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1698 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1699
1700 @smallexample
1701 apropos reload
1702 @end smallexample
1703
1704 @noindent
1705 results in:
1706
1707 @smallexample
1708 @c @group
1709 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1710 multiple times in one run
1711 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1712 multiple times in one run
1713 @c @end group
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716 @kindex complete
1717 @item complete @var{args}
1718 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1719 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1720 command you want completed. For example:
1721
1722 @smallexample
1723 complete i
1724 @end smallexample
1725
1726 @noindent results in:
1727
1728 @smallexample
1729 @group
1730 if
1731 ignore
1732 info
1733 inspect
1734 @end group
1735 @end smallexample
1736
1737 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1738 @end table
1739
1740 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1741 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1742 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1743 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1744 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1745 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1746
1747 @c @group
1748 @table @code
1749 @kindex info
1750 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1751 @item info
1752 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1753 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1754 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1755 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1756 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1757 @w{@code{help info}}.
1758
1759 @kindex set
1760 @item set
1761 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1762 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1763 @code{set prompt $}.
1764
1765 @kindex show
1766 @item show
1767 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1768 @value{GDBN} itself.
1769 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1770 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1771 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1772 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1773
1774 @kindex info set
1775 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1776 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1777 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1778 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1779 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1780 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1781 @end table
1782 @c @end group
1783
1784 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1785 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1786
1787 @table @code
1788 @kindex show version
1789 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1790 @item show version
1791 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1792 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1793 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1794 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1795 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1796 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1797 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1798 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1799 @value{GDBN}.
1800
1801 @kindex show copying
1802 @kindex info copying
1803 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1804 @item show copying
1805 @itemx info copying
1806 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1807
1808 @kindex show warranty
1809 @kindex info warranty
1810 @item show warranty
1811 @itemx info warranty
1812 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1813 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1814
1815 @end table
1816
1817 @node Running
1818 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1819
1820 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1821 debugging information when you compile it.
1822
1823 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1824 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1825 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1826 kill a child process.
1827
1828 @menu
1829 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1830 * Starting:: Starting your program
1831 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1832 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1833
1834 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1835 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1836 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1837 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1838
1839 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1840 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1841 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1842 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1843 @end menu
1844
1845 @node Compilation
1846 @section Compiling for Debugging
1847
1848 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1849 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1850 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1851 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1852 and addresses in the executable code.
1853
1854 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1855 the compiler.
1856
1857 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1858 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1859 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1860 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1861 executables containing debugging information.
1862
1863 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1864 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1865 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1866 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1867 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1868
1869 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1870 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1871 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1872
1873 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1874 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1875 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1876 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1877 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1878 provides macro information if you specify the options
1879 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1880 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1881 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1882 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1883 @option{-g} alone.
1884
1885 @need 2000
1886 @node Starting
1887 @section Starting your Program
1888 @cindex starting
1889 @cindex running
1890
1891 @table @code
1892 @kindex run
1893 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1894 @item run
1895 @itemx r
1896 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1897 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1898 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1899 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1900 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1901
1902 @end table
1903
1904 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1905 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1906 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1907 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1908 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1909 message like this one:
1910
1911 @smallexample
1912 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1913 Try "help target" or "continue".
1914 @end smallexample
1915
1916 @noindent
1917 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1918 first (@pxref{load}).
1919
1920 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1921 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1922 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1923 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1924 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1925 divided into four categories:
1926
1927 @table @asis
1928 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1929 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1930 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1931 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1932 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1933 the arguments.
1934 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1935 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1936 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1937
1938 @item The @emph{environment.}
1939 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1940 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1941 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1942 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1943
1944 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1945 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1946 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1947 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1948
1949 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1950 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1951 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1952 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1953 set a different device for your program.
1954 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1955
1956 @cindex pipes
1957 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1958 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1959 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1960 wrong program.
1961 @end table
1962
1963 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1964 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1965 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1966 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1967 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1968
1969 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1970 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1971 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1972 your current breakpoints.
1973
1974 @table @code
1975 @kindex start
1976 @item start
1977 @cindex run to main procedure
1978 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1979 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1980 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1981 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1982 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1983 procedure, depending on the language used.
1984
1985 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1986 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1987 the @samp{run} command.
1988
1989 @cindex elaboration phase
1990 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1991 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1992 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1993 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1994 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1995 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1996 will remain to halt execution.
1997
1998 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1999 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2000 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2001 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2002 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2003
2004 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2005 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2006 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2007 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2008 elaboration code before running your program.
2009
2010 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2011 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2012 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2013 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2014 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2015 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2016 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2017 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2018 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2019 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2020 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2021
2022 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2023 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2024 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2025 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2026
2027 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2028 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2029 environment:
2030
2031 @smallexample
2032 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2033 (@value{GDBP}) run
2034 @end smallexample
2035
2036 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2037 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2038
2039 @kindex set disable-randomization
2040 @item set disable-randomization
2041 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2042 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2043 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2044 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2045 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2046
2047 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2048 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2049
2050 @smallexample
2051 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2052 @end smallexample
2053
2054 @item set disable-randomization off
2055 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2056 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2057 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2058 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2059 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2060 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2061
2062 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2063 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2064 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2065 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2066 a code at its expected addresses.
2067
2068 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2069 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2070 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2071 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2072 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2073 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2074 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2075 a randomly chosen address.
2076
2077 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2078 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2079 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2080 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2081 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2082
2083 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2084 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2085
2086 @item show disable-randomization
2087 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2088 the virtual address space of the started program.
2089
2090 @end table
2091
2092 @node Arguments
2093 @section Your Program's Arguments
2094
2095 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2096 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2097 @code{run} command.
2098 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2099 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2100 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2101 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2102 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2103
2104 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2105 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2106 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2107 the program, not by the shell.
2108
2109 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2110 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2111
2112 @table @code
2113 @kindex set args
2114 @item set args
2115 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2116 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2117 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2118 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2119 it again without arguments.
2120
2121 @kindex show args
2122 @item show args
2123 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2124 @end table
2125
2126 @node Environment
2127 @section Your Program's Environment
2128
2129 @cindex environment (of your program)
2130 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2131 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2132 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2133 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2134 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2135 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2136 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2137
2138 @table @code
2139 @kindex path
2140 @item path @var{directory}
2141 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2142 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2143 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2144 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2145 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2146 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2147 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2148
2149 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2150 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2151 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2152 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2153 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2154 @var{directory} to the search path.
2155 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2156 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2157
2158 @kindex show paths
2159 @item show paths
2160 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2161 environment variable).
2162
2163 @kindex show environment
2164 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2165 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2166 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2167 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2168 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2169
2170 @kindex set environment
2171 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2172 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2173 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2174 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2175 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2176 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2177 null value.
2178 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2179 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2180
2181 For example, this command:
2182
2183 @smallexample
2184 set env USER = foo
2185 @end smallexample
2186
2187 @noindent
2188 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2189 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2190 are not actually required.)
2191
2192 @kindex unset environment
2193 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2194 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2195 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2196 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2197 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2198 @end table
2199
2200 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2201 the shell indicated
2202 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2203 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2204 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2205 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2206 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2207 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2208 @file{.profile}.
2209
2210 @node Working Directory
2211 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2212
2213 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2214 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2215 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2216 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2217 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2218 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2219
2220 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2221 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2222 Specify Files}.
2223
2224 @table @code
2225 @kindex cd
2226 @cindex change working directory
2227 @item cd @var{directory}
2228 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2229
2230 @kindex pwd
2231 @item pwd
2232 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2233 @end table
2234
2235 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2236 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2237 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2238 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2239 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2240 current working directory of the debuggee.
2241
2242 @node Input/Output
2243 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2244
2245 @cindex redirection
2246 @cindex i/o
2247 @cindex terminal
2248 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2249 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2250 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2251 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2252 running your program.
2253
2254 @table @code
2255 @kindex info terminal
2256 @item info terminal
2257 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2258 program is using.
2259 @end table
2260
2261 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2262 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2263
2264 @smallexample
2265 run > outfile
2266 @end smallexample
2267
2268 @noindent
2269 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2270
2271 @kindex tty
2272 @cindex controlling terminal
2273 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2274 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2275 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2276 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2277 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2278
2279 @smallexample
2280 tty /dev/ttyb
2281 @end smallexample
2282
2283 @noindent
2284 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2285 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2286 that as their controlling terminal.
2287
2288 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2289 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2290 terminal.
2291
2292 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2293 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2294 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2295 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2296
2297 @cindex inferior tty
2298 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2299 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2300 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2301 program.
2302
2303 @table @code
2304 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2305 @kindex set inferior-tty
2306 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2307
2308 @item show inferior-tty
2309 @kindex show inferior-tty
2310 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2311 @end table
2312
2313 @node Attach
2314 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2315 @kindex attach
2316 @cindex attach
2317
2318 @table @code
2319 @item attach @var{process-id}
2320 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2321 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2322 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2323 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2324 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2325
2326 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2327 executing the command.
2328 @end table
2329
2330 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2331 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2332 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2333 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2334
2335 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2336 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2337 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2338 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2339 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2340 Specify Files}.
2341
2342 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2343 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2344 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2345 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2346 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2347 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2348 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2349
2350 @table @code
2351 @kindex detach
2352 @item detach
2353 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2354 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2355 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2356 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2357 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2358 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2359 executing the command.
2360 @end table
2361
2362 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2363 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2364 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2365 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2366 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2367 Messages}).
2368
2369 @node Kill Process
2370 @section Killing the Child Process
2371
2372 @table @code
2373 @kindex kill
2374 @item kill
2375 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2376 @end table
2377
2378 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2379 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2380 is running.
2381
2382 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2383 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2384 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2385 outside the debugger.
2386
2387 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2388 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2389 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2390 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2391 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2392 breakpoint settings).
2393
2394 @node Inferiors and Programs
2395 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2396
2397 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2398 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2399 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2400 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2401 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2402 from multiple executables.
2403
2404 @cindex inferior
2405 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2406 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2407 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2408 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2409 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2410 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2411 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2412 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2413 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2414 threads running in it.
2415
2416 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2417 inferiors}}:
2418
2419 @table @code
2420 @kindex info inferiors
2421 @item info inferiors
2422 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2423
2424 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2425
2426 @enumerate
2427 @item
2428 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2429
2430 @item
2431 the target system's inferior identifier
2432
2433 @item
2434 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2435
2436 @end enumerate
2437
2438 @noindent
2439 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2440 indicates the current inferior.
2441
2442 For example,
2443 @end table
2444 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2445
2446 @smallexample
2447 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2448 Num Description Executable
2449 2 process 2307 hello
2450 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2451 @end smallexample
2452
2453 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2454
2455 @table @code
2456 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2457 @item inferior @var{infno}
2458 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2459 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2460 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2461 @end table
2462
2463
2464 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2465 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2466 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2467 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2468 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2469 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2470
2471 @table @code
2472 @kindex add-inferior
2473 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2474 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2475 executable. @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2476 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2477 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2478 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2479
2480 @kindex clone-inferior
2481 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2482 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2483 @var{infno}. @var{n} defaults to 1. @var{infno} defaults to the
2484 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2485 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2486
2487 @smallexample
2488 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2489 Num Description Executable
2490 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2491 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2492 Added inferior 2.
2493 1 inferiors added.
2494 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2495 Num Description Executable
2496 2 <null> helloworld
2497 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2498 @end smallexample
2499
2500 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2501
2502 @kindex remove-inferiors
2503 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2504 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2505 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2506 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2507
2508 @end table
2509
2510 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2511 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2512 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2513 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2514
2515 @table @code
2516 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2517 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2518 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2519 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2520 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2521 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2522
2523 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2524 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2525 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2526 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2527 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2528 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2529 @end table
2530
2531 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2532 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2533 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2534 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2535
2536
2537 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2538 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2539
2540 @table @code
2541 @kindex set print inferior-events
2542 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2543 @item set print inferior-events
2544 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2545 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2546 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2547 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2548 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2549 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2550
2551 @kindex show print inferior-events
2552 @item show print inferior-events
2553 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2554 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2555 @end table
2556
2557 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2558 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2559 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2560
2561
2562 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2563 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2564 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2565 info program-spaces}} command.
2566
2567 @table @code
2568 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2569 @item maint info program-spaces
2570 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2571 @value{GDBN}.
2572
2573 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2574
2575 @enumerate
2576 @item
2577 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2578
2579 @item
2580 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2581 the @code{file} command.
2582
2583 @end enumerate
2584
2585 @noindent
2586 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2587 indicates the current program space.
2588
2589 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2590 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2591 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2592
2593 @smallexample
2594 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2595 Id Executable
2596 2 goodbye
2597 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2598 * 1 hello
2599 @end smallexample
2600
2601 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2602 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2603 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2604 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2605 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2606
2607 @smallexample
2608 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2609 Id Executable
2610 * 1 vfork-test
2611 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2612 @end smallexample
2613
2614 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2615 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2616 @end table
2617
2618 @node Threads
2619 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2620
2621 @cindex threads of execution
2622 @cindex multiple threads
2623 @cindex switching threads
2624 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2625 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2626 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2627 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2628 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2629 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2630 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2631
2632 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2633 programs:
2634
2635 @itemize @bullet
2636 @item automatic notification of new threads
2637 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2638 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2639 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2640 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2641 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2642 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2643 messages on thread start and exit.
2644 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2645 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2646 isn't compatible with the program.
2647 @end itemize
2648
2649 @quotation
2650 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2651 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2652 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2653 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2654 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2655 like this:
2656
2657 @smallexample
2658 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2659 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2660 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2661 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2662 @end smallexample
2663 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2664 @c doesn't support threads"?
2665 @end quotation
2666
2667 @cindex focus of debugging
2668 @cindex current thread
2669 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2670 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2671 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2672 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2673 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2674
2675 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2676 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2677 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2678 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2679 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2680 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2681 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2682 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2683 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2684 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2685
2686 @smallexample
2687 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2688 @end smallexample
2689
2690 @noindent
2691 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2692 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2693 further qualifier.
2694
2695 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2696 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2697 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2698 @c program?
2699 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2700 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2701 @c threads ab initio?
2702
2703 @cindex thread number
2704 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2705 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2706 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2707
2708 @table @code
2709 @kindex info threads
2710 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2711 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2712 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2713 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2714 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2715
2716 @enumerate
2717 @item
2718 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2719
2720 @item
2721 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2722
2723 @item
2724 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2725 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2726 program itself.
2727
2728 @item
2729 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2730 @end enumerate
2731
2732 @noindent
2733 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2734 indicates the current thread.
2735
2736 For example,
2737 @end table
2738 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2739
2740 @smallexample
2741 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2742 Id Target Id Frame
2743 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2744 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2745 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2746 at threadtest.c:68
2747 @end smallexample
2748
2749 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2750 Solaris-specific command:
2751
2752 @table @code
2753 @item maint info sol-threads
2754 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2755 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2756 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2757 @end table
2758
2759 @table @code
2760 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2761 @item thread @var{threadno}
2762 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2763 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2764 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2765 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2766 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2767
2768 @smallexample
2769 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2770 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2771 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2772 8 printf ("hello\n");
2773 @end smallexample
2774
2775 @noindent
2776 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2777 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2778 threads.
2779
2780 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2781 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2782 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2783 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2784 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2785 information on convenience variables.
2786
2787 @kindex thread apply
2788 @cindex apply command to several threads
2789 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all] @var{command}
2790 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2791 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2792 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2793 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2794 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2795 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2796 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2797
2798 @kindex thread name
2799 @cindex name a thread
2800 @item thread name [@var{name}]
2801 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
2802 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
2803 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
2804
2805 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
2806 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
2807 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
2808 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
2809 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
2810
2811 @kindex thread find
2812 @cindex search for a thread
2813 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
2814 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
2815 matches the supplied regular expression.
2816
2817 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
2818 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
2819 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
2820 is the LWP id.
2821
2822 @smallexample
2823 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
2824 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
2825 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
2826 Id Target Id Frame
2827 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
2828 @end smallexample
2829
2830 @kindex set print thread-events
2831 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2832 @item set print thread-events
2833 @itemx set print thread-events on
2834 @itemx set print thread-events off
2835 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2836 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2837 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2838 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2839 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2840
2841 @kindex show print thread-events
2842 @item show print thread-events
2843 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2844 have started and exited.
2845 @end table
2846
2847 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2848 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2849 programs with multiple threads.
2850
2851 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2852 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2853
2854 @table @code
2855 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
2856 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
2857 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
2858 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
2859 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
2860 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
2861 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
2862 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
2863 macro.
2864
2865 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
2866 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
2867 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2868 to find @code{libthread_db}.
2869
2870 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2871 refers to the default system directories that are
2872 normally searched for loading shared libraries.
2873
2874 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
2875 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
2876 was loaded in the inferior process.
2877
2878 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
2879 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
2880 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
2881 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
2882 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
2883 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
2884 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
2885
2886 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
2887 only on some platforms.
2888
2889 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
2890 @item show libthread-db-search-path
2891 Display current libthread_db search path.
2892
2893 @kindex set debug libthread-db
2894 @kindex show debug libthread-db
2895 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
2896 @item set debug libthread-db
2897 @itemx show debug libthread-db
2898 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
2899 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
2900 @end table
2901
2902 @node Forks
2903 @section Debugging Forks
2904
2905 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2906 @cindex multiple processes
2907 @cindex processes, multiple
2908 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2909 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2910 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2911 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2912 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2913 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2914 will cause it to terminate.
2915
2916 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2917 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2918 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2919 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2920 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2921 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2922 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2923 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2924 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2925 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2926
2927 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2928 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2929 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2930 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2931
2932 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2933 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2934
2935 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2936 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2937
2938 @table @code
2939 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2940 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2941 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2942 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2943 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2944
2945 @table @code
2946 @item parent
2947 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2948 unimpeded. This is the default.
2949
2950 @item child
2951 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2952 unimpeded.
2953
2954 @end table
2955
2956 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2957 @item show follow-fork-mode
2958 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2959 @end table
2960
2961 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2962 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2963 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2964
2965 @table @code
2966 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2967 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2968 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2969 retain debugger control over them both.
2970
2971 @table @code
2972 @item on
2973 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2974 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2975 independently. This is the default.
2976
2977 @item off
2978 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2979 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2980 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2981 is held suspended.
2982
2983 @end table
2984
2985 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2986 @item show detach-on-fork
2987 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2988 @end table
2989
2990 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
2991 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
2992 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
2993 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
2994 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
2995 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
2996
2997 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2998 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
2999 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3000 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3001 and Programs}.
3002
3003 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3004 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3005 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3006 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3007 the child process's @code{main}.
3008
3009 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3010 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3011
3012 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3013 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3014 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3015 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3016 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3017 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3018 command.
3019
3020 @table @code
3021 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3022 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3023
3024 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3025 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3026
3027 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3028
3029 @table @code
3030 @item new
3031 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3032 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3033 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3034 original inferior.
3035
3036 For example:
3037
3038 @smallexample
3039 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3040 (gdb) info inferior
3041 Id Description Executable
3042 * 1 <null> prog1
3043 (@value{GDBP}) run
3044 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3045 Program exited normally.
3046 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3047 Id Description Executable
3048 * 2 <null> prog2
3049 1 <null> prog1
3050 @end smallexample
3051
3052 @item same
3053 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3054 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3055 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3056 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3057 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3058
3059 For example:
3060
3061 @smallexample
3062 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3063 Id Description Executable
3064 * 1 <null> prog1
3065 (@value{GDBP}) run
3066 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3067 Program exited normally.
3068 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3069 Id Description Executable
3070 * 1 <null> prog2
3071 @end smallexample
3072
3073 @end table
3074 @end table
3075
3076 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3077 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3078 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3079
3080 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3081 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3082
3083 @cindex checkpoint
3084 @cindex restart
3085 @cindex bookmark
3086 @cindex snapshot of a process
3087 @cindex rewind program state
3088
3089 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3090 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3091 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3092 later.
3093
3094 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3095 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3096 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3097 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3098 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3099
3100 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3101 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3102 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3103 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3104 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3105 start again from there.
3106
3107 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3108 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3109
3110 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3111
3112 @table @code
3113 @kindex checkpoint
3114 @item checkpoint
3115 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3116 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3117 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3118
3119 @kindex info checkpoints
3120 @item info checkpoints
3121 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3122 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3123 listed:
3124
3125 @table @code
3126 @item Checkpoint ID
3127 @item Process ID
3128 @item Code Address
3129 @item Source line, or label
3130 @end table
3131
3132 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3133 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3134 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3135 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3136 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3137 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3138 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3139
3140 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3141 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3142 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3143 the debugger.
3144
3145 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3146 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3147 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3148
3149 @end table
3150
3151 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3152 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3153 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3154 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3155 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3156 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3157 previously read data can be read again.
3158
3159 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3160 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3161 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3162 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3163 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3164 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3165
3166 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3167 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3168 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3169 different execution path this time.
3170
3171 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3172 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3173 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3174 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3175 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3176 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3177 potentially pose a problem.
3178
3179 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3180
3181 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3182 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3183 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3184 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3185 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3186 next.
3187
3188 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3189 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3190 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3191 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3192 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3193
3194 @node Stopping
3195 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3196
3197 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3198 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3199 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3200
3201 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3202 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3203 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3204 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3205 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3206 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3207 explicitly request this information at any time.
3208
3209 @table @code
3210 @kindex info program
3211 @item info program
3212 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3213 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3214 @end table
3215
3216 @menu
3217 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3218 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3219 * Signals:: Signals
3220 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3221 @end menu
3222
3223 @node Breakpoints
3224 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3225
3226 @cindex breakpoints
3227 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3228 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3229 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3230 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3231 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3232 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3233 program.
3234
3235 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3236 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3237 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3238 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3239 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3240 call).
3241
3242 @cindex watchpoints
3243 @cindex data breakpoints
3244 @cindex memory tracing
3245 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3246 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3247 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3248 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3249 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3250 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3251 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3252 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3253 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3254 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3255 same commands.
3256
3257 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3258 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3259 Automatic Display}.
3260
3261 @cindex catchpoints
3262 @cindex breakpoint on events
3263 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3264 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3265 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3266 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3267 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3268 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3269 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3270
3271 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3272 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3273 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3274 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3275 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3276 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3277 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3278 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3279 enable it again.
3280
3281 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3282 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3283 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3284 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3285 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3286 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3287 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3288
3289 @menu
3290 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3291 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3292 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3293 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3294 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3295 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3296 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3297 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3298 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3299 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3300 @end menu
3301
3302 @node Set Breaks
3303 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3304
3305 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3306 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3307 @c
3308 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3309
3310 @kindex break
3311 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3312 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3313 @cindex latest breakpoint
3314 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3315 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3316 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3317 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3318 convenience variables.
3319
3320 @table @code
3321 @item break @var{location}
3322 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3323 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3324 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3325 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3326 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3327
3328 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3329 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3330 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3331 that situation.
3332
3333 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3334 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3335 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3336
3337 @item break
3338 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3339 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3340 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3341 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3342 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3343 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3344 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3345 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3346 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3347 inside loops.
3348
3349 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3350 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3351 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3352 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3353 existed when your program stopped.
3354
3355 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3356 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3357 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3358 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3359 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3360 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3361 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3362
3363 @kindex tbreak
3364 @item tbreak @var{args}
3365 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3366 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3367 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3368 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3369
3370 @kindex hbreak
3371 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3372 @item hbreak @var{args}
3373 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3374 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3375 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3376 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3377 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3378 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3379 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3380 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3381 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3382 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3383 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3384 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3385 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3386 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3387 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3388 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3389 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3390 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3391
3392 @kindex thbreak
3393 @item thbreak @var{args}
3394 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3395 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3396 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3397 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3398 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3399 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3400 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3401 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3402
3403 @kindex rbreak
3404 @cindex regular expression
3405 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3406 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3407 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3408 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3409 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3410 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3411 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3412 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3413 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3414
3415 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3416 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3417 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3418 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3419 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3420 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3421
3422 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3423 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3424 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3425 classes.
3426
3427 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3428 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3429 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3430
3431 @smallexample
3432 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3433 @end smallexample
3434
3435 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3436 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3437 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3438 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3439 every function in a given file:
3440
3441 @smallexample
3442 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3443 @end smallexample
3444
3445 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3446 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3447
3448 @kindex info breakpoints
3449 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3450 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3451 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3452 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3453 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3454 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3455 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3456
3457 @table @emph
3458 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3459 @item Type
3460 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3461 @item Disposition
3462 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3463 @item Enabled or Disabled
3464 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3465 that are not enabled.
3466 @item Address
3467 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3468 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3469 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3470 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3471 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3472 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3473 @item What
3474 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3475 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3476 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3477 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3478 @end table
3479
3480 @noindent
3481 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3482 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3483 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3484 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3485 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3486 valid location.
3487
3488 @noindent
3489 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3490 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3491 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3492 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3493 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3494
3495 @noindent
3496 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3497 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3498 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3499 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3500 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3501 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3502 @end table
3503
3504 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3505 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3506 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3507 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3508
3509 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3510 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3511 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3512 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3513
3514 @itemize @bullet
3515 @item
3516 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3517 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3518
3519 @item
3520 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3521 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3522
3523 @item
3524 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3525 several places where that function is inlined.
3526 @end itemize
3527
3528 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3529 the relevant locations@footnote{
3530 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3531 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3532 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3533 info with line numbers for them.}.
3534
3535 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3536 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3537 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3538 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3539 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3540 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3541 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3542
3543 For example:
3544
3545 @smallexample
3546 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3547 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3548 stop only if i==1
3549 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3550 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3551 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3552 @end smallexample
3553
3554 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3555 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3556 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3557 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3558 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3559 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3560 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3561 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3562 that belong to that breakpoint.
3563
3564 @cindex pending breakpoints
3565 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3566 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3567 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3568 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3569 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3570 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3571 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3572 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3573 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3574 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3575 is not yet resolved.
3576
3577 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3578 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3579 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3580 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3581 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3582 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3583
3584 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3585 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3586 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3587 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3588
3589 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3590 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3591 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3592
3593 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3594 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3595 address specification to an address:
3596
3597 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3598 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3599 @table @code
3600 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3601 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3602 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3603
3604 @item set breakpoint pending on
3605 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3606 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3607
3608 @item set breakpoint pending off
3609 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3610 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3611 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3612
3613 @item show breakpoint pending
3614 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3615 @end table
3616
3617 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3618 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3619 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3620
3621 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3622 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3623 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3624 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3625 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3626 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3627 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3628 breakpoints.
3629
3630 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3631
3632 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3633 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3634 @table @code
3635 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3636 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3637 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3638 breakpoint must be used.
3639
3640 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3641 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3642 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3643 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3644 @end table
3645
3646 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3647 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3648 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3649 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3650 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3651 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3652 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3653 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3654 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3655
3656 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3657 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3658 @table @code
3659 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3660 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3661 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3662 removed from the target when it stops.
3663
3664 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3665 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3666 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3667 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3668 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3669
3670 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3671 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3672 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3673 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3674 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3675 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3676 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3677 @end table
3678
3679 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3680 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3681 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3682 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3683 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3684 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3685 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3686 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3687
3688
3689 @node Set Watchpoints
3690 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3691
3692 @cindex setting watchpoints
3693 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3694 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3695 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3696 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3697 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3698
3699 @itemize @bullet
3700 @item
3701 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3702
3703 @item
3704 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3705 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3706 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3707
3708 @item
3709 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3710 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3711 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3712 @end itemize
3713
3714 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3715 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3716 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3717 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3718 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3719 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3720 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3721 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3722 the expression changes.
3723
3724 @cindex software watchpoints
3725 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3726 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3727 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3728 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3729 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3730 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3731 culprit.)
3732
3733 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3734 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3735 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3736
3737 @table @code
3738 @kindex watch
3739 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3740 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3741 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3742 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3743 to watch the value of a single variable:
3744
3745 @smallexample
3746 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3747 @end smallexample
3748
3749 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3750 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3751 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3752 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3753 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3754 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3755
3756 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3757 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3758 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
3759 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
3760 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
3761 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
3762 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
3763 error.
3764
3765 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
3766 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
3767 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
3768 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
3769 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
3770 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
3771 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
3772 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
3773 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
3774 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
3775 Examples:
3776
3777 @smallexample
3778 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
3779 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
3780 @end smallexample
3781
3782 @kindex rwatch
3783 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3784 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3785 by the program.
3786
3787 @kindex awatch
3788 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3789 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3790 or written into by the program.
3791
3792 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3793 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3794 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
3795 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3796 @end table
3797
3798 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
3799 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
3800 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
3801 a never-changing value:
3802
3803 @smallexample
3804 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
3805 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
3806 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
3807 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
3808 @end smallexample
3809
3810 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3811 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3812 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3813 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3814 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3815 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3816
3817 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3818 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3819 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3820 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3821 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3822 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3823 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3824 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3825
3826 @table @code
3827 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3828 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3829 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3830
3831 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3832 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3833 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3834 @end table
3835
3836 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3837 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3838 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3839
3840 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3841
3842 @smallexample
3843 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3844 @end smallexample
3845
3846 @noindent
3847 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3848
3849 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3850 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3851 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3852 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3853 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3854 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3855 will print a message like this:
3856
3857 @smallexample
3858 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3859 @end smallexample
3860
3861 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3862 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3863 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3864 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3865 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3866 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3867 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3868 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3869
3870 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3871 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3872 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3873 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3874 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3875 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3876
3877 @smallexample
3878 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3879 @end smallexample
3880
3881 @noindent
3882 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3883
3884 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3885 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3886 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3887 expression with separately allocated resources.
3888
3889 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3890 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3891 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3892
3893 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3894 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3895 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3896 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3897 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3898 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3899 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3900 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3901 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3902
3903 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3904 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3905 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3906 watched expression from every thread.
3907
3908 @quotation
3909 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3910 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3911 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3912 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3913 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3914 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3915 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3916 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3917 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3918 @end quotation
3919
3920 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3921
3922 @node Set Catchpoints
3923 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3924 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3925 @cindex exception handlers
3926 @cindex event handling
3927
3928 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3929 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3930 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3931
3932 @table @code
3933 @kindex catch
3934 @item catch @var{event}
3935 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3936 @table @code
3937 @item throw
3938 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3939 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3940
3941 @item catch
3942 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3943
3944 @item exception
3945 @cindex Ada exception catching
3946 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3947 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3948 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3949 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3950 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3951
3952 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3953 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3954 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3955 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3956 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3957 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3958 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3959 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3960
3961 @item exception unhandled
3962 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3963
3964 @item assert
3965 A failed Ada assertion.
3966
3967 @item exec
3968 @cindex break on fork/exec
3969 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3970 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3971
3972 @item syscall
3973 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
3974 @cindex break on a system call.
3975 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
3976 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
3977 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
3978 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
3979 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
3980 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
3981 will be caught.
3982
3983 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
3984 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
3985 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
3986 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
3987
3988 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
3989 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
3990 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
3991 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
3992
3993 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
3994 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
3995 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
3996 available choices.
3997
3998 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
3999 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4000 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4001 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4002 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4003 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4004 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4005 behind the OS upgrades).
4006
4007 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4008 arguments to it:
4009
4010 @smallexample
4011 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4012 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4013 (@value{GDBP}) r
4014 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4015
4016 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4017 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4018 (@value{GDBP}) c
4019 Continuing.
4020
4021 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4022 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4023 (@value{GDBP})
4024 @end smallexample
4025
4026 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4027
4028 @smallexample
4029 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4030 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4031 (@value{GDBP}) r
4032 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4033
4034 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4035 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4036 (@value{GDBP}) c
4037 Continuing.
4038
4039 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4040 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4041 (@value{GDBP})
4042 @end smallexample
4043
4044 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4045 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4046 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4047
4048 @smallexample
4049 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4050 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4051 (@value{GDBP}) r
4052 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4053
4054 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4055 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4056 (@value{GDBP}) c
4057 Continuing.
4058
4059 Program exited normally.
4060 (@value{GDBP})
4061 @end smallexample
4062
4063 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4064 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4065 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4066 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4067
4068 @smallexample
4069 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4070 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4071 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4072 (@value{GDBP})
4073 @end smallexample
4074
4075 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4076 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4077 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4078 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4079 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4080 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4081
4082 @smallexample
4083 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4084 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4085 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4086 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4087 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4088 (@value{GDBP})
4089 @end smallexample
4090
4091 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4092
4093 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4094 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4095
4096 @smallexample
4097 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4098 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4099 @end smallexample
4100
4101 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4102
4103 @item fork
4104 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4105 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4106
4107 @item vfork
4108 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4109 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4110
4111 @end table
4112
4113 @item tcatch @var{event}
4114 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4115 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4116
4117 @end table
4118
4119 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4120
4121 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
4122 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
4123
4124 @itemize @bullet
4125 @item
4126 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4127 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4128 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4129 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4130 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4131 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4132 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4133 disabled within interactive calls.
4134
4135 @item
4136 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4137
4138 @item
4139 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4140 @end itemize
4141
4142 @cindex raise exceptions
4143 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
4144 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
4145 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
4146 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
4147 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
4148 out where the exception was raised.
4149
4150 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
4151 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
4152 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
4153 which has the following ANSI C interface:
4154
4155 @smallexample
4156 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
4157 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
4158 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
4159 @end smallexample
4160
4161 @noindent
4162 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
4163 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
4164 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
4165
4166 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
4167 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
4168 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
4169 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
4170 raised.
4171
4172
4173 @node Delete Breaks
4174 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4175
4176 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4177 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4178 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4179 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4180 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4181 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4182
4183 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4184 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4185 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4186 their breakpoint numbers.
4187
4188 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4189 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4190 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4191
4192 @table @code
4193 @kindex clear
4194 @item clear
4195 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4196 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4197 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4198 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4199
4200 @item clear @var{location}
4201 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4202 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4203 most useful ones are listed below:
4204
4205 @table @code
4206 @item clear @var{function}
4207 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4208 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4209
4210 @item clear @var{linenum}
4211 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4212 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4213 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4214 @end table
4215
4216 @cindex delete breakpoints
4217 @kindex delete
4218 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4219 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4220 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4221 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4222 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4223 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4224 @end table
4225
4226 @node Disabling
4227 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4228
4229 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4230 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4231 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4232 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4233 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4234
4235 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4236 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4237 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4238 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4239 do not know which numbers to use.
4240
4241 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4242 affects all of its locations.
4243
4244 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
4245 states of enablement:
4246
4247 @itemize @bullet
4248 @item
4249 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4250 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4251 @item
4252 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4253 @item
4254 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4255 disabled.
4256 @item
4257 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4258 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4259 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4260 @end itemize
4261
4262 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4263 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4264
4265 @table @code
4266 @kindex disable
4267 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4268 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4269 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4270 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4271 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4272 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4273 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4274
4275 @kindex enable
4276 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4277 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4278 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4279
4280 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4281 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4282 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4283
4284 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4285 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4286 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4287 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4288 @end table
4289
4290 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4291 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4292 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4293 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4294 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4295 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4296 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4297 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4298 Stepping}.)
4299
4300 @node Conditions
4301 @subsection Break Conditions
4302 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4303 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4304
4305 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4306 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4307 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4308 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4309 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4310 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4311 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4312 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4313
4314 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4315 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4316 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4317 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4318 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4319
4320 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4321 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4322 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4323 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4324 one.
4325
4326 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4327 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4328 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4329 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4330 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4331 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4332 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4333 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4334 conditions for the
4335 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4336 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4337
4338 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4339 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4340 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4341 with the @code{condition} command.
4342
4343 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4344 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4345 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4346 catchpoint.
4347
4348 @table @code
4349 @kindex condition
4350 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4351 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4352 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4353 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4354 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4355 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4356 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4357 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4358 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4359 prints an error message:
4360
4361 @smallexample
4362 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4363 @end smallexample
4364
4365 @noindent
4366 @value{GDBN} does
4367 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4368 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4369 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4370
4371 @item condition @var{bnum}
4372 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4373 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4374 @end table
4375
4376 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4377 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4378 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4379 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4380 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4381 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4382 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4383 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4384 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4385 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4386 your program reaches it.
4387
4388 @table @code
4389 @kindex ignore
4390 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4391 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4392 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4393 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4394 takes no action.
4395
4396 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4397 a count of zero.
4398
4399 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4400 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4401 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4402 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4403
4404 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4405 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4406 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4407
4408 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4409 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4410 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4411 Variables}.
4412 @end table
4413
4414 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4415
4416
4417 @node Break Commands
4418 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4419
4420 @cindex breakpoint commands
4421 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4422 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4423 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4424 enable other breakpoints.
4425
4426 @table @code
4427 @kindex commands
4428 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4429 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4430 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4431 @itemx end
4432 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4433 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4434 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4435
4436 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4437 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4438
4439 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4440 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4441 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4442 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4443 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4444 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4445 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4446 Expressions}).
4447 @end table
4448
4449 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4450 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4451
4452 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4453 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4454 that resumes execution.
4455
4456 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4457 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4458 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4459 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4460 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4461
4462 @kindex silent
4463 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4464 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4465 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4466 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4467 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4468 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4469
4470 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4471 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4472 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4473
4474 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4475 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4476
4477 @smallexample
4478 break foo if x>0
4479 commands
4480 silent
4481 printf "x is %d\n",x
4482 cont
4483 end
4484 @end smallexample
4485
4486 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4487 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4488 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4489 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4490 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4491 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4492 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4493
4494 @smallexample
4495 break 403
4496 commands
4497 silent
4498 set x = y + 4
4499 cont
4500 end
4501 @end smallexample
4502
4503 @node Save Breakpoints
4504 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4505
4506 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4507 breakpoints}} command.
4508
4509 @table @code
4510 @kindex save breakpoints
4511 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4512 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4513 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4514 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4515 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4516 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4517 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4518 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4519 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4520 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4521 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4522 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4523 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4524 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4525 that can no longer be recreated.
4526 @end table
4527
4528 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4529 @node Error in Breakpoints
4530 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4531
4532 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4533 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4534
4535 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4536 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4537 @smallexample
4538 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4539 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4540 @end smallexample
4541
4542 @noindent
4543 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4544 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4545 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4546
4547 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4548 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4549
4550 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4551 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4552 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4553
4554 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4555 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4556 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4557 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4558
4559 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4560 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4561 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4562 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4563 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4564 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4565 first in the bundle.
4566
4567 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4568 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4569 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4570 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4571 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4572 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4573 is hit.
4574
4575 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4576 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4577
4578 @smallexample
4579 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4580 @end smallexample
4581
4582 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4583 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4584 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4585 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4586 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4587 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4588 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4589 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4590
4591 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4592 adjusted breakpoints:
4593
4594 @smallexample
4595 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4596 to 0x00010410.
4597 @end smallexample
4598
4599 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4600 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4601 frequently than expected.
4602
4603 @node Continuing and Stepping
4604 @section Continuing and Stepping
4605
4606 @cindex stepping
4607 @cindex continuing
4608 @cindex resuming execution
4609 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4610 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4611 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4612 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4613 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4614 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4615 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4616 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4617
4618 @table @code
4619 @kindex continue
4620 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4621 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4622 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4623 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4624 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4625 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4626 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4627 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4628 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4629 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4630
4631 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4632 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4633 @code{continue} is ignored.
4634
4635 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4636 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4637 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4638 @code{continue}.
4639 @end table
4640
4641 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4642 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4643 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4644 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4645
4646 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4647 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4648 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4649 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4650 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4651 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4652
4653 @table @code
4654 @kindex step
4655 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4656 @item step
4657 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4658 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4659 abbreviated @code{s}.
4660
4661 @quotation
4662 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4663 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4664 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4665 @c distinction here.
4666 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4667 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4668 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4669 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4670 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4671 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4672 below.
4673 @end quotation
4674
4675 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4676 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4677 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4678 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4679 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4680 called within the line.
4681
4682 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4683 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4684 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4685 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4686 was any debugging information about the routine.
4687
4688 @item step @var{count}
4689 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4690 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4691 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4692
4693 @kindex next
4694 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4695 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4696 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4697 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4698 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4699 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4700 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4701 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4702
4703 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4704
4705
4706 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4707 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4708 @c
4709 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4710 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4711 @c function are executed without stopping.
4712
4713 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4714 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4715 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4716
4717 @kindex set step-mode
4718 @item set step-mode
4719 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4720 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4721 @itemx set step-mode on
4722 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4723 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4724 information rather than stepping over it.
4725
4726 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4727 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4728 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4729
4730 @item set step-mode off
4731 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4732 debug information. This is the default.
4733
4734 @item show step-mode
4735 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4736 source line debug information.
4737
4738 @kindex finish
4739 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4740 @item finish
4741 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4742 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4743 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4744
4745 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4746 ,Returning from a Function}).
4747
4748 @kindex until
4749 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4750 @cindex run until specified location
4751 @item until
4752 @itemx u
4753 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4754 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4755 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4756 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4757 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4758 than the address of the jump.
4759
4760 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4761 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4762 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4763 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4764 through the next iteration.
4765
4766 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4767 stack frame.
4768
4769 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4770 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4771 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4772 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4773 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4774
4775 @smallexample
4776 (@value{GDBP}) f
4777 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4778 206 expand_input();
4779 (@value{GDBP}) until
4780 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4781 @end smallexample
4782
4783 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4784 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4785 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4786 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4787 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4788 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4789 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4790
4791 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4792 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4793 argument.
4794
4795 @item until @var{location}
4796 @itemx u @var{location}
4797 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4798 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4799 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4800 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4801 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4802 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4803 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4804 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4805 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4806 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4807 invocations have returned.
4808
4809 @smallexample
4810 94 int factorial (int value)
4811 95 @{
4812 96 if (value > 1) @{
4813 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4814 98 @}
4815 99 return (value);
4816 100 @}
4817 @end smallexample
4818
4819
4820 @kindex advance @var{location}
4821 @itemx advance @var{location}
4822 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4823 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4824 @ref{Specify Location}.
4825 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4826 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4827 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4828 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4829
4830
4831 @kindex stepi
4832 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4833 @item stepi
4834 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4835 @itemx si
4836 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4837
4838 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4839 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4840 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4841 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4842
4843 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4844
4845 @need 750
4846 @kindex nexti
4847 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4848 @item nexti
4849 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4850 @itemx ni
4851 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4852 proceed until the function returns.
4853
4854 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4855 @end table
4856
4857 @subsection Skipping Over Functions and Files
4858 @cindex skipping over functions and files
4859
4860 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
4861 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
4862 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
4863
4864 For example, consider the following C function:
4865
4866 @smallexample
4867 101 int func()
4868 102 @{
4869 103 foo(boring());
4870 104 bar(boring());
4871 105 @}
4872 @end smallexample
4873
4874 @noindent
4875 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
4876 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
4877 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
4878 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
4879
4880 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
4881 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
4882 is called from many places.
4883
4884 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
4885 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
4886 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
4887 @code{foo}.
4888
4889 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
4890 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
4891
4892 @table @code
4893 @kindex skip function
4894 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
4895 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
4896 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
4897 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
4898 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
4899
4900 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
4901 will be skipped.
4902
4903 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
4904 @kbd{skip function file}.)
4905
4906 @kindex skip file
4907 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
4908 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
4909 will be skipped over when stepping.
4910
4911 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
4912 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
4913 @end table
4914
4915 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
4916 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
4917
4918 @table @code
4919 @kindex info skip
4920 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
4921 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
4922 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
4923 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
4924
4925 @table @emph
4926 @item Identifier
4927 A number identifying this skip.
4928 @item Type
4929 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
4930 @item Enabled or Disabled
4931 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
4932 @item Address
4933 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
4934 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
4935 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
4936 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
4937 address here.
4938 @item What
4939 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
4940 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
4941 where it is defined.
4942 @end table
4943
4944 @kindex skip delete
4945 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
4946 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
4947 skips.
4948
4949 @kindex skip enable
4950 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
4951 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
4952 skips.
4953
4954 @kindex skip disable
4955 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
4956 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
4957 skips.
4958
4959 @end table
4960
4961 @node Signals
4962 @section Signals
4963 @cindex signals
4964
4965 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4966 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4967 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4968 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4969 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4970 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4971 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4972 requested an alarm).
4973
4974 @cindex fatal signals
4975 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4976 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4977 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4978 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4979 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4980 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4981
4982 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4983 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4984 signal.
4985
4986 @cindex handling signals
4987 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4988 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4989 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4990 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4991 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4992
4993 @table @code
4994 @kindex info signals
4995 @kindex info handle
4996 @item info signals
4997 @itemx info handle
4998 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4999 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5000 the defined types of signals.
5001
5002 @item info signals @var{sig}
5003 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5004
5005 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5006
5007 @kindex handle
5008 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5009 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
5010 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5011 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5012 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5013 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5014 say what change to make.
5015 @end table
5016
5017 @c @group
5018 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5019 Their full names are:
5020
5021 @table @code
5022 @item nostop
5023 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5024 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5025
5026 @item stop
5027 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5028 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5029
5030 @item print
5031 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5032
5033 @item noprint
5034 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5035 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5036
5037 @item pass
5038 @itemx noignore
5039 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5040 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5041 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5042
5043 @item nopass
5044 @itemx ignore
5045 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5046 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5047 @end table
5048 @c @end group
5049
5050 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5051 program until you
5052 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5053 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5054 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5055 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5056 program sees that signal when you continue.
5057
5058 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5059 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5060 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5061 erroneous signals.
5062
5063 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5064 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5065 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5066 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5067 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5068 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5069 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5070 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5071 Program a Signal}.
5072
5073 @cindex extra signal information
5074 @anchor{extra signal information}
5075
5076 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5077 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5078 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5079 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5080 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5081 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5082 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5083 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5084 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5085 system header.
5086
5087 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5088 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5089
5090 @smallexample
5091 @group
5092 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5093 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5094 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5095 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5096 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5097 type = struct @{
5098 int si_signo;
5099 int si_errno;
5100 int si_code;
5101 union @{
5102 int _pad[28];
5103 struct @{...@} _kill;
5104 struct @{...@} _timer;
5105 struct @{...@} _rt;
5106 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5107 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5108 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5109 @} _sifields;
5110 @}
5111 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5112 type = struct @{
5113 void *si_addr;
5114 @}
5115 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5116 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5117 @end group
5118 @end smallexample
5119
5120 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5121
5122 @node Thread Stops
5123 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5124
5125 @cindex stopped threads
5126 @cindex threads, stopped
5127
5128 @cindex continuing threads
5129 @cindex threads, continuing
5130
5131 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5132 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5133 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5134 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5135 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5136 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5137 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5138 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5139 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5140
5141 @menu
5142 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5143 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5144 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5145 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5146 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5147 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5148 @end menu
5149
5150 @node All-Stop Mode
5151 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5152
5153 @cindex all-stop mode
5154
5155 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5156 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5157 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5158 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5159 underfoot.
5160
5161 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5162 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5163 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5164
5165 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5166 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5167 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5168 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5169 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5170 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5171 stops.
5172
5173 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5174 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5175 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5176 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5177
5178 @cindex automatic thread selection
5179 @cindex switching threads automatically
5180 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5181 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5182 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5183 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5184 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5185 thread.
5186
5187 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5188 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5189
5190 @table @code
5191 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5192 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5193 @cindex lock scheduler
5194 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5195 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5196 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5197 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5198 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5199 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5200 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
5201 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
5202 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
5203 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5204 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5205 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5206
5207 @item show scheduler-locking
5208 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5209 @end table
5210
5211 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5212 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5213 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5214 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5215 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5216 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5217 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5218 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5219 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5220 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5221 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5222 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5223 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5224 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5225
5226 @table @code
5227 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5228 @item set schedule-multiple
5229 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5230 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5231 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5232 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5233 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5234 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5235
5236 @item show schedule-multiple
5237 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5238 multiple processes.
5239 @end table
5240
5241 @node Non-Stop Mode
5242 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5243
5244 @cindex non-stop mode
5245
5246 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5247 @c with more details.
5248
5249 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5250 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5251 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5252 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5253 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5254 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5255
5256 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5257 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5258 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5259 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5260 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5261 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5262 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5263 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5264 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5265 independently and simultaneously.
5266
5267 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5268 or attach to your program:
5269
5270 @smallexample
5271 # Enable the async interface.
5272 set target-async 1
5273
5274 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5275 set pagination off
5276
5277 # Finally, turn it on!
5278 set non-stop on
5279 @end smallexample
5280
5281 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5282
5283 @table @code
5284 @kindex set non-stop
5285 @item set non-stop on
5286 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5287 @item set non-stop off
5288 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5289 @kindex show non-stop
5290 @item show non-stop
5291 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5292 @end table
5293
5294 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5295 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5296 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5297 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5298 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5299 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5300 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5301 default.
5302
5303 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5304 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5305 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5306
5307 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5308 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5309 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5310 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5311 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5312
5313 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5314 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5315 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5316 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5317 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5318
5319 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5320
5321 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5322 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5323 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5324 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5325 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5326 previously current thread.
5327
5328 @node Background Execution
5329 @subsection Background Execution
5330
5331 @cindex foreground execution
5332 @cindex background execution
5333 @cindex asynchronous execution
5334 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5335
5336 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5337 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5338 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5339 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5340 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5341 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5342
5343 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
5344 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
5345 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
5346
5347 @table @code
5348 @kindex set target-async
5349 @item set target-async on
5350 Enable asynchronous mode.
5351 @item set target-async off
5352 Disable asynchronous mode.
5353 @kindex show target-async
5354 @item show target-async
5355 Show the current target-async setting.
5356 @end table
5357
5358 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5359 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5360
5361 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5362 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5363 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5364 are:
5365
5366 @table @code
5367 @kindex run&
5368 @item run
5369 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5370
5371 @item attach
5372 @kindex attach&
5373 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5374
5375 @item step
5376 @kindex step&
5377 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5378
5379 @item stepi
5380 @kindex stepi&
5381 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5382
5383 @item next
5384 @kindex next&
5385 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5386
5387 @item nexti
5388 @kindex nexti&
5389 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
5390
5391 @item continue
5392 @kindex continue&
5393 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
5394
5395 @item finish
5396 @kindex finish&
5397 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
5398
5399 @item until
5400 @kindex until&
5401 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
5402
5403 @end table
5404
5405 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
5406 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
5407 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
5408 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
5409 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
5410 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
5411
5412 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
5413 using the @code{interrupt} command.
5414
5415 @table @code
5416 @kindex interrupt
5417 @item interrupt
5418 @itemx interrupt -a
5419
5420 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
5421 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
5422 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
5423 use @code{interrupt -a}.
5424 @end table
5425
5426 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5427 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
5428
5429 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
5430 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
5431 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
5432
5433 @table @code
5434 @cindex breakpoints and threads
5435 @cindex thread breakpoints
5436 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
5437 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
5438 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
5439 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
5440 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
5441 specify some source line.
5442
5443 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
5444 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
5445 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
5446 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
5447 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
5448
5449 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
5450 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
5451 program.
5452
5453 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
5454 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
5455 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
5456
5457 @smallexample
5458 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
5459 @end smallexample
5460
5461 @end table
5462
5463 @node Interrupted System Calls
5464 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
5465
5466 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
5467 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
5468 @cindex premature return from system calls
5469 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
5470 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
5471 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
5472 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
5473 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
5474 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
5475 stop execution.
5476
5477 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
5478 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
5479 style anyways.
5480
5481 For example, do not write code like this:
5482
5483 @smallexample
5484 sleep (10);
5485 @end smallexample
5486
5487 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
5488 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
5489
5490 Instead, write this:
5491
5492 @smallexample
5493 int unslept = 10;
5494 while (unslept > 0)
5495 unslept = sleep (unslept);
5496 @end smallexample
5497
5498 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
5499 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
5500 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
5501 @value{GDBN}.
5502
5503 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
5504 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
5505 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
5506 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
5507
5508 @node Observer Mode
5509 @subsection Observer Mode
5510
5511 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
5512 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
5513 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
5514 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
5515 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
5516
5517 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
5518 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
5519 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
5520 mode.
5521
5522 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
5523 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
5524 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
5525 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
5526 stream will still not be able to be placed.
5527
5528 @table @code
5529
5530 @kindex observer
5531 @item set observer on
5532 @itemx set observer off
5533 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
5534 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
5535 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
5536 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
5537
5538 @item show observer
5539 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
5540
5541 @kindex may-write-registers
5542 @item set may-write-registers on
5543 @itemx set may-write-registers off
5544 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
5545 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
5546 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
5547
5548 @item show may-write-registers
5549 Show the current permission to write registers.
5550
5551 @kindex may-write-memory
5552 @item set may-write-memory on
5553 @itemx set may-write-memory off
5554 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
5555 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
5556 defaults to @code{on}.
5557
5558 @item show may-write-memory
5559 Show the current permission to write memory.
5560
5561 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
5562 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
5563 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
5564 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
5565 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
5566 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5567
5568 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
5569 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
5570
5571 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
5572 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
5573 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
5574 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
5575 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
5576 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
5577 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5578
5579 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
5580 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
5581
5582 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
5583 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
5584 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
5585 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
5586 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
5587 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
5588 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5589
5590 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
5591 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
5592
5593 @kindex may-interrupt
5594 @item set may-interrupt on
5595 @itemx set may-interrupt off
5596 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
5597 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
5598 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
5599 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
5600
5601 @item show may-interrupt
5602 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
5603
5604 @end table
5605
5606 @node Reverse Execution
5607 @chapter Running programs backward
5608 @cindex reverse execution
5609 @cindex running programs backward
5610
5611 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
5612 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
5613 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
5614 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
5615
5616 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
5617 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
5618 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
5619 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
5620 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
5621 all target environments can support reverse execution.
5622
5623 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
5624 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
5625 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
5626 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
5627 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
5628 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
5629 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
5630 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
5631 prior values@footnote{
5632 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
5633 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
5634 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
5635
5636 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
5637 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
5638 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
5639 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
5640 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
5641 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
5642 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
5643 }.
5644
5645 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
5646 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
5647
5648 @table @code
5649 @kindex reverse-continue
5650 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
5651 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5652 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5653 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
5654 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
5655 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
5656 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
5657
5658 @kindex reverse-step
5659 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
5660 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5661 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
5662 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
5663
5664 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
5665 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
5666 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
5667 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
5668 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
5669 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
5670
5671 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
5672 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
5673
5674 @kindex reverse-stepi
5675 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
5676 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5677 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
5678 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
5679 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
5680 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
5681 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
5682
5683 @kindex reverse-next
5684 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
5685 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5686 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
5687 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
5688 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
5689 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
5690 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
5691 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
5692 line of a function back to its return to its caller
5693 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
5694
5695 @kindex reverse-nexti
5696 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
5697 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5698 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
5699 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
5700 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
5701 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
5702 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
5703 frame) is reached.
5704
5705 @kindex reverse-finish
5706 @item reverse-finish
5707 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
5708 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
5709 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
5710 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
5711
5712 @kindex set exec-direction
5713 @item set exec-direction
5714 Set the direction of target execution.
5715 @itemx set exec-direction reverse
5716 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
5717 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
5718 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
5719 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
5720 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
5721 @item set exec-direction forward
5722 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
5723 This is the default.
5724 @end table
5725
5726
5727 @node Process Record and Replay
5728 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
5729 @cindex process record and replay
5730 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
5731
5732 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
5733 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
5734 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
5735
5736 @cindex replay mode
5737 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
5738 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
5739 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
5740 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
5741 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
5742 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
5743 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
5744 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
5745 execution log.
5746
5747 @cindex record mode
5748 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
5749 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
5750 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
5751 for future replay.
5752
5753 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
5754 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
5755 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
5756 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
5757 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
5758 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
5759
5760 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
5761 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
5762 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
5763 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
5764
5765 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
5766 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
5767
5768 @table @code
5769 @kindex target record
5770 @kindex record
5771 @kindex rec
5772 @item target record
5773 This command starts the process record and replay target. The process
5774 record and replay target can only debug a process that is already
5775 running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with the
5776 @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording with
5777 the @kbd{target record} command.
5778
5779 Both @code{record} and @code{rec} are aliases of @code{target record}.
5780
5781 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
5782 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
5783 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
5784 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
5785 doesn't support displaced stepping.
5786
5787 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
5788 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
5789 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
5790 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), the
5791 process record and replay target cannot be started because it doesn't
5792 support these two modes.
5793
5794 @kindex record stop
5795 @kindex rec s
5796 @item record stop
5797 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
5798 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
5799 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
5800
5801 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
5802 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
5803 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
5804 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
5805 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
5806
5807 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
5808 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
5809 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
5810 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
5811 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
5812
5813 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
5814 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
5815
5816 @kindex record save
5817 @item record save @var{filename}
5818 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
5819 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
5820 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
5821
5822 @kindex record restore
5823 @item record restore @var{filename}
5824 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
5825 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
5826
5827 @kindex set record insn-number-max
5828 @item set record insn-number-max @var{limit}
5829 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded. Default value is 200000.
5830
5831 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
5832 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
5833 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
5834 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
5835 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
5836 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
5837 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
5838 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
5839
5840 If @var{limit} is zero, @value{GDBN} will never delete recorded
5841 instructions from the execution log. The number of recorded
5842 instructions is unlimited in this case.
5843
5844 @kindex show record insn-number-max
5845 @item show record insn-number-max
5846 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded.
5847
5848 @kindex set record stop-at-limit
5849 @item set record stop-at-limit
5850 Control the behavior when the number of recorded instructions reaches
5851 the limit. If ON (the default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit
5852 is reached for the first time and ask you whether you want to stop the
5853 inferior or continue running it and recording the execution log. If
5854 you decide to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will
5855 cause the oldest one to be deleted.
5856
5857 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
5858 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
5859
5860 @kindex show record stop-at-limit
5861 @item show record stop-at-limit
5862 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
5863
5864 @kindex set record memory-query
5865 @item set record memory-query
5866 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
5867 changes caused by an instruction. If ON, @value{GDBN} will query
5868 whether to stop the inferior in that case.
5869
5870 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
5871 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
5872 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
5873 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
5874 results.
5875
5876 @kindex show record memory-query
5877 @item show record memory-query
5878 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
5879
5880 @kindex info record
5881 @item info record
5882 Show various statistics about the state of process record and its
5883 in-memory execution log buffer, including:
5884
5885 @itemize @bullet
5886 @item
5887 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
5888 @item
5889 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
5890 @item
5891 Highest recorded instruction number.
5892 @item
5893 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
5894 @item
5895 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
5896 @item
5897 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
5898 @end itemize
5899
5900 @kindex record delete
5901 @kindex rec del
5902 @item record delete
5903 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
5904 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
5905 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
5906 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
5907 @end table
5908
5909
5910 @node Stack
5911 @chapter Examining the Stack
5912
5913 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
5914 stopped and how it got there.
5915
5916 @cindex call stack
5917 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
5918 is generated.
5919 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
5920 the arguments of the call,
5921 and the local variables of the function being called.
5922 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
5923 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
5924 stack}.
5925
5926 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
5927 stack allow you to see all of this information.
5928
5929 @cindex selected frame
5930 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
5931 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
5932 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
5933 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
5934 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
5935 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5936
5937 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5938 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
5939 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
5940
5941 @menu
5942 * Frames:: Stack frames
5943 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
5944 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
5945 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
5946
5947 @end menu
5948
5949 @node Frames
5950 @section Stack Frames
5951
5952 @cindex frame, definition
5953 @cindex stack frame
5954 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
5955 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
5956 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
5957 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
5958 which the function is executing.
5959
5960 @cindex initial frame
5961 @cindex outermost frame
5962 @cindex innermost frame
5963 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
5964 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
5965 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
5966 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
5967 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
5968 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
5969 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
5970 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
5971
5972 @cindex frame pointer
5973 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
5974 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
5975 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
5976 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
5977 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
5978 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
5979
5980 @cindex frame number
5981 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
5982 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
5983 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
5984 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
5985 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
5986
5987 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
5988 @c underflow problems.
5989 @cindex frameless execution
5990 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
5991 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
5992 @smallexample
5993 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
5994 @end smallexample
5995 generates functions without a frame.)
5996 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
5997 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
5998 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
5999 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6000 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6001 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6002 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6003
6004 @table @code
6005 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6006 @cindex current stack frame
6007 @item frame @var{args}
6008 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6009 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
6010 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6011 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6012
6013 @kindex select-frame
6014 @cindex selecting frame silently
6015 @item select-frame
6016 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6017 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6018 @code{frame}.
6019 @end table
6020
6021 @node Backtrace
6022 @section Backtraces
6023
6024 @cindex traceback
6025 @cindex call stack traces
6026 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6027 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6028 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6029 stack.
6030
6031 @table @code
6032 @kindex backtrace
6033 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6034 @item backtrace
6035 @itemx bt
6036 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6037 frames in the stack.
6038
6039 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6040 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6041
6042 @item backtrace @var{n}
6043 @itemx bt @var{n}
6044 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6045
6046 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6047 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6048 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6049
6050 @item backtrace full
6051 @itemx bt full
6052 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6053 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6054 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
6055 number of frames to print, as described above.
6056 @end table
6057
6058 @kindex where
6059 @kindex info stack
6060 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6061 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6062
6063 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6064 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6065 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6066 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6067 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6068 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6069 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6070 multi-threaded program.
6071
6072 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6073 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6074 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6075 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6076 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6077 line number.
6078
6079 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6080 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6081
6082 @smallexample
6083 @group
6084 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6085 at builtin.c:993
6086 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6087 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6088 at macro.c:71
6089 (More stack frames follow...)
6090 @end group
6091 @end smallexample
6092
6093 @noindent
6094 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
6095 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
6096 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
6097
6098 @noindent
6099 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
6100 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
6101 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
6102 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
6103 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
6104
6105 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
6106 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
6107 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
6108 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
6109 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
6110 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
6111 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
6112 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
6113 such a backtrace might look like:
6114
6115 @smallexample
6116 @group
6117 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6118 at builtin.c:993
6119 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
6120 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
6121 at macro.c:71
6122 (More stack frames follow...)
6123 @end group
6124 @end smallexample
6125
6126 @noindent
6127 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
6128 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
6129
6130 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
6131 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
6132 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
6133
6134 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
6135 @cindex program entry point
6136 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
6137 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
6138 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
6139 @code{main}@footnote{
6140 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
6141 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
6142 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
6143 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
6144 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
6145 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
6146
6147 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
6148 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
6149
6150 @table @code
6151 @item set backtrace past-main
6152 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
6153 @kindex set backtrace
6154 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
6155
6156 @item set backtrace past-main off
6157 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
6158 default.
6159
6160 @item show backtrace past-main
6161 @kindex show backtrace
6162 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
6163
6164 @item set backtrace past-entry
6165 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
6166 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
6167 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
6168 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
6169
6170 @item set backtrace past-entry off
6171 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
6172 application. This is the default.
6173
6174 @item show backtrace past-entry
6175 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
6176
6177 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
6178 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
6179 @cindex backtrace limit
6180 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
6181 unlimited.
6182
6183 @item show backtrace limit
6184 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
6185 @end table
6186
6187 @node Selection
6188 @section Selecting a Frame
6189
6190 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
6191 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
6192 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
6193 of the stack frame just selected.
6194
6195 @table @code
6196 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
6197 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
6198 @item frame @var{n}
6199 @itemx f @var{n}
6200 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
6201 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
6202 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
6203 @code{main}.
6204
6205 @item frame @var{addr}
6206 @itemx f @var{addr}
6207 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
6208 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
6209 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
6210 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
6211 switches between them.
6212
6213 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
6214 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
6215
6216 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
6217 pointer and a program counter.
6218
6219 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
6220 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
6221
6222 @kindex up
6223 @item up @var{n}
6224 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
6225 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
6226 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
6227
6228 @kindex down
6229 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
6230 @item down @var{n}
6231 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
6232 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
6233 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
6234 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
6235 @end table
6236
6237 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
6238 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
6239 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
6240 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
6241
6242 @need 1000
6243 For example:
6244
6245 @smallexample
6246 @group
6247 (@value{GDBP}) up
6248 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
6249 at env.c:10
6250 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
6251 @end group
6252 @end smallexample
6253
6254 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
6255 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
6256 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
6257 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
6258 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
6259 for details.
6260
6261 @table @code
6262 @kindex down-silently
6263 @kindex up-silently
6264 @item up-silently @var{n}
6265 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
6266 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
6267 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
6268 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
6269 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
6270 distracting.
6271 @end table
6272
6273 @node Frame Info
6274 @section Information About a Frame
6275
6276 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
6277 stack frame.
6278
6279 @table @code
6280 @item frame
6281 @itemx f
6282 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
6283 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
6284 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
6285 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
6286 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6287
6288 @kindex info frame
6289 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
6290 @item info frame
6291 @itemx info f
6292 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
6293 including:
6294
6295 @itemize @bullet
6296 @item
6297 the address of the frame
6298 @item
6299 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
6300 @item
6301 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
6302 @item
6303 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
6304 @item
6305 the address of the frame's arguments
6306 @item
6307 the address of the frame's local variables
6308 @item
6309 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
6310 @item
6311 which registers were saved in the frame
6312 @end itemize
6313
6314 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
6315 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
6316 the usual conventions.
6317
6318 @item info frame @var{addr}
6319 @itemx info f @var{addr}
6320 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
6321 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
6322 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
6323 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
6324 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6325
6326 @kindex info args
6327 @item info args
6328 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
6329
6330 @item info locals
6331 @kindex info locals
6332 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
6333 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
6334 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
6335
6336 @kindex info catch
6337 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
6338 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
6339 @item info catch
6340 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
6341 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
6342 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
6343 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
6344 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
6345
6346 @end table
6347
6348
6349 @node Source
6350 @chapter Examining Source Files
6351
6352 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
6353 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
6354 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
6355 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
6356 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
6357 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
6358 source files by explicit command.
6359
6360 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
6361 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
6362 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
6363
6364 @menu
6365 * List:: Printing source lines
6366 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
6367 * Edit:: Editing source files
6368 * Search:: Searching source files
6369 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
6370 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
6371 @end menu
6372
6373 @node List
6374 @section Printing Source Lines
6375
6376 @kindex list
6377 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
6378 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
6379 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
6380 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
6381 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
6382
6383 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
6384
6385 @table @code
6386 @item list @var{linenum}
6387 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
6388 current source file.
6389
6390 @item list @var{function}
6391 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
6392 @var{function}.
6393
6394 @item list
6395 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
6396 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
6397 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
6398 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
6399 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
6400
6401 @item list -
6402 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6403 @end table
6404
6405 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
6406 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
6407 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
6408
6409 @table @code
6410 @kindex set listsize
6411 @item set listsize @var{count}
6412 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
6413 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
6414
6415 @kindex show listsize
6416 @item show listsize
6417 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
6418 @end table
6419
6420 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
6421 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
6422 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
6423 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
6424 each repetition moves up in the source file.
6425
6426 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
6427 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
6428 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
6429 to specify some source line.
6430
6431 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
6432
6433 @table @code
6434 @item list @var{linespec}
6435 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
6436
6437 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
6438 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
6439 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
6440 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
6441 the same source file as the first linespec.
6442
6443 @item list ,@var{last}
6444 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
6445
6446 @item list @var{first},
6447 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
6448
6449 @item list +
6450 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
6451
6452 @item list -
6453 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
6454
6455 @item list
6456 As described in the preceding table.
6457 @end table
6458
6459 @node Specify Location
6460 @section Specifying a Location
6461 @cindex specifying location
6462 @cindex linespec
6463
6464 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
6465 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
6466 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
6467 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
6468
6469 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
6470 @value{GDBN} understands:
6471
6472 @table @code
6473 @item @var{linenum}
6474 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
6475
6476 @item -@var{offset}
6477 @itemx +@var{offset}
6478 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
6479 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
6480 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
6481 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
6482 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
6483 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
6484 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
6485 linespec.
6486
6487 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
6488 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
6489
6490 @item @var{function}
6491 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
6492 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
6493
6494 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
6495 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
6496
6497 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
6498 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
6499 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
6500 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
6501 functions in different source files.
6502
6503 @item @var{label}
6504 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
6505 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
6506 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
6507 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
6508 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
6509
6510 @item *@var{address}
6511 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
6512 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
6513 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
6514 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
6515 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
6516 source files.
6517
6518 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
6519 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
6520 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
6521 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
6522 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
6523 of @var{address}:
6524
6525 @table @code
6526 @item @var{expression}
6527 Any expression valid in the current working language.
6528
6529 @item @var{funcaddr}
6530 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
6531 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
6532 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
6533 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
6534 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
6535 (although the Pascal form also works).
6536
6537 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
6538 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
6539
6540 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
6541 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
6542 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
6543 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
6544 functions with identical names in different source files.
6545 @end table
6546
6547 @end table
6548
6549
6550 @node Edit
6551 @section Editing Source Files
6552 @cindex editing source files
6553
6554 @kindex edit
6555 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
6556 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
6557 The editing program of your choice
6558 is invoked with the current line set to
6559 the active line in the program.
6560 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
6561 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
6562
6563 @table @code
6564 @item edit @var{location}
6565 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
6566 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
6567 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
6568 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
6569 command most commonly used:
6570
6571 @table @code
6572 @item edit @var{number}
6573 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
6574
6575 @item edit @var{function}
6576 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
6577 @end table
6578
6579 @end table
6580
6581 @subsection Choosing your Editor
6582 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
6583 @footnote{
6584 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
6585 following command-line syntax:
6586 @smallexample
6587 ex +@var{number} file
6588 @end smallexample
6589 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
6590 the file where to start editing.}.
6591 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
6592 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
6593 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
6594 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
6595 @smallexample
6596 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
6597 export EDITOR
6598 gdb @dots{}
6599 @end smallexample
6600 or in the @code{csh} shell,
6601 @smallexample
6602 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
6603 gdb @dots{}
6604 @end smallexample
6605
6606 @node Search
6607 @section Searching Source Files
6608 @cindex searching source files
6609
6610 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
6611 regular expression.
6612
6613 @table @code
6614 @kindex search
6615 @kindex forward-search
6616 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
6617 @itemx search @var{regexp}
6618 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
6619 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
6620 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
6621 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
6622 @code{fo}.
6623
6624 @kindex reverse-search
6625 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
6626 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
6627 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
6628 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
6629 this command as @code{rev}.
6630 @end table
6631
6632 @node Source Path
6633 @section Specifying Source Directories
6634
6635 @cindex source path
6636 @cindex directories for source files
6637 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
6638 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
6639 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
6640 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
6641 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
6642 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
6643 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
6644
6645 For example, suppose an executable references the file
6646 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
6647 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
6648 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
6649 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
6650 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
6651 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
6652 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
6653 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
6654 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
6655 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
6656
6657 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
6658 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
6659 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
6660 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
6661 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
6662 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
6663
6664 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
6665 source files.
6666
6667 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
6668 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
6669 each line is in the file.
6670
6671 @kindex directory
6672 @kindex dir
6673 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
6674 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
6675 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
6676
6677 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
6678 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
6679
6680 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
6681 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
6682 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
6683 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
6684 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
6685 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
6686 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
6687 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
6688 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
6689 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
6690 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
6691 name to look up the sources.
6692
6693 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
6694 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
6695 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
6696 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
6697 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
6698 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
6699 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
6700 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
6701
6702 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
6703 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
6704 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
6705 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
6706 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
6707 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
6708 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
6709
6710 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
6711 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
6712 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
6713 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
6714 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
6715 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
6716 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
6717 command.
6718
6719 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
6720 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
6721 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
6722 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
6723 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
6724 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
6725 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
6726
6727 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
6728 @cindex default source path substitution
6729 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
6730 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
6731 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
6732 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
6733 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
6734 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
6735 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
6736 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
6737 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
6738 together.
6739
6740 @table @code
6741 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
6742 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
6743 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
6744 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
6745 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
6746 part of absolute file names) or
6747 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
6748 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
6749
6750 @kindex cdir
6751 @kindex cwd
6752 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
6753 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
6754 @cindex compilation directory
6755 @cindex current directory
6756 @cindex working directory
6757 @cindex directory, current
6758 @cindex directory, compilation
6759 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
6760 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
6761 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
6762 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
6763 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
6764 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
6765
6766 @item directory
6767 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
6768
6769 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
6770 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
6771
6772 @item set directories @var{path-list}
6773 @kindex set directories
6774 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
6775 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
6776
6777 @item show directories
6778 @kindex show directories
6779 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
6780
6781 @anchor{set substitute-path}
6782 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
6783 @kindex set substitute-path
6784 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
6785 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
6786 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
6787
6788 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
6789 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
6790
6791 @smallexample
6792 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
6793 @end smallexample
6794
6795 @noindent
6796 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
6797 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
6798 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
6799
6800 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
6801 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
6802 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
6803 the substitution.
6804
6805 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
6806
6807 @smallexample
6808 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
6809 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
6810 @end smallexample
6811
6812 @noindent
6813 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
6814 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
6815 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
6816 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
6817
6818
6819 @item unset substitute-path [path]
6820 @kindex unset substitute-path
6821 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
6822 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
6823 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
6824
6825 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
6826
6827 @item show substitute-path [path]
6828 @kindex show substitute-path
6829 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
6830 which would rewrite that path, if any.
6831
6832 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
6833 rules.
6834
6835 @end table
6836
6837 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
6838 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
6839 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
6840
6841 @enumerate
6842 @item
6843 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
6844
6845 @item
6846 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
6847 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
6848 directories in one command.
6849 @end enumerate
6850
6851 @node Machine Code
6852 @section Source and Machine Code
6853 @cindex source line and its code address
6854
6855 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
6856 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
6857 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
6858 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
6859 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6860 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
6861 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
6862 well as hex.
6863
6864 @table @code
6865 @kindex info line
6866 @item info line @var{linespec}
6867 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
6868 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
6869 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
6870 @end table
6871
6872 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
6873 the object code for the first line of function
6874 @code{m4_changequote}:
6875
6876 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
6877 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
6878 @smallexample
6879 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
6880 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
6881 @end smallexample
6882
6883 @noindent
6884 @cindex code address and its source line
6885 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
6886 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
6887 @smallexample
6888 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
6889 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
6890 @end smallexample
6891
6892 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
6893 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
6894 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
6895 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
6896 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
6897 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
6898 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
6899 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6900 Variables}).
6901
6902 @table @code
6903 @kindex disassemble
6904 @cindex assembly instructions
6905 @cindex instructions, assembly
6906 @cindex machine instructions
6907 @cindex listing machine instructions
6908 @item disassemble
6909 @itemx disassemble /m
6910 @itemx disassemble /r
6911 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
6912 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
6913 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
6914 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
6915 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
6916 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
6917 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
6918 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
6919 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
6920 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
6921
6922 @table @code
6923 @item @var{start},@var{end}
6924 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
6925 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
6926 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
6927 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
6928 @end table
6929
6930 @noindent
6931 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
6932 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
6933
6934 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
6935 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
6936
6937 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
6938 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
6939 @end table
6940
6941 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
6942 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
6943
6944 @smallexample
6945 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
6946 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
6947 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
6948 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
6949 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6950 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
6951 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
6952 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
6953 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
6954 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
6955 End of assembler dump.
6956 @end smallexample
6957
6958 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
6959 program is stopped just after function prologue:
6960
6961 @smallexample
6962 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
6963 Dump of assembler code for function main:
6964 5 @{
6965 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
6966 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
6967 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
6968 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
6969 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
6970
6971 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
6972 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
6973 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
6974
6975 7 return 0;
6976 8 @}
6977 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
6978 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
6979 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
6980
6981 End of assembler dump.
6982 @end smallexample
6983
6984 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
6985
6986 @smallexample
6987 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
6988 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
6989 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
6990 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
6991 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
6992 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
6993 End of assembler dump.
6994 @end smallexample
6995
6996 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
6997 mnemonics or other syntax.
6998
6999 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
7000 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
7001 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
7002 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
7003 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
7004
7005 @table @code
7006 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
7007 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
7008 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
7009 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
7010 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
7011 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
7012
7013 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
7014 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
7015 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
7016 assemblers for x86-based targets.
7017
7018 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
7019 @item show disassembly-flavor
7020 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
7021 @end table
7022
7023 @table @code
7024 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
7025 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
7026 @item set disassemble-next-line
7027 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
7028 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
7029 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
7030 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
7031 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
7032 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
7033 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
7034 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
7035 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
7036 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
7037 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
7038 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
7039 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
7040 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
7041 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
7042 instruction.
7043 @end table
7044
7045
7046 @node Data
7047 @chapter Examining Data
7048
7049 @cindex printing data
7050 @cindex examining data
7051 @kindex print
7052 @kindex inspect
7053 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
7054 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
7055 @c different window or something like that.
7056 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7057 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
7058 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
7059 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
7060 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
7061 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
7062
7063 @table @code
7064 @item print @var{expr}
7065 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
7066 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
7067 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
7068 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
7069 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
7070 Formats}.
7071
7072 @item print
7073 @itemx print /@var{f}
7074 @cindex reprint the last value
7075 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
7076 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
7077 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
7078 @end table
7079
7080 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
7081 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
7082 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7083
7084 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
7085 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
7086 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7087 Table}.
7088
7089 @menu
7090 * Expressions:: Expressions
7091 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
7092 * Variables:: Program variables
7093 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
7094 * Output Formats:: Output formats
7095 * Memory:: Examining memory
7096 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
7097 * Print Settings:: Print settings
7098 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
7099 * Value History:: Value history
7100 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
7101 * Registers:: Registers
7102 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
7103 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
7104 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
7105 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
7106 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
7107 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
7108 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
7109 character set than GDB does
7110 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
7111 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
7112 @end menu
7113
7114 @node Expressions
7115 @section Expressions
7116
7117 @cindex expressions
7118 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
7119 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
7120 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
7121 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
7122 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
7123 you compiled your program to include this information; see
7124 @ref{Compilation}.
7125
7126 @cindex arrays in expressions
7127 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
7128 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
7129 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
7130 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
7131 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
7132 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
7133
7134 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
7135 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
7136 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
7137 languages.
7138
7139 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
7140 expressions regardless of your programming language.
7141
7142 @cindex casts, in expressions
7143 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
7144 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
7145 at that address in memory.
7146 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
7147
7148 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
7149 to programming languages:
7150
7151 @table @code
7152 @item @@
7153 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
7154 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
7155
7156 @item ::
7157 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
7158 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
7159
7160 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
7161 @cindex type casting memory
7162 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
7163 @cindex casts, to view memory
7164 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
7165 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
7166 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
7167 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
7168 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
7169 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
7170 @end table
7171
7172 @node Ambiguous Expressions
7173 @section Ambiguous Expressions
7174 @cindex ambiguous expressions
7175
7176 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
7177 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
7178 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
7179 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
7180 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
7181 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
7182 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
7183
7184 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
7185 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
7186 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
7187 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
7188 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
7189 as well.
7190
7191 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
7192 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
7193 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
7194 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
7195 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
7196 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
7197 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
7198 choices.
7199
7200 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
7201 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
7202 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
7203
7204 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
7205 @smallexample
7206 @group
7207 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
7208 [0] cancel
7209 [1] all
7210 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
7211 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
7212 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
7213 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
7214 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
7215 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
7216 > 2 4 6
7217 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
7218 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
7219 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
7220 Multiple breakpoints were set.
7221 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
7222 breakpoints.
7223 (@value{GDBP})
7224 @end group
7225 @end smallexample
7226
7227 @table @code
7228 @kindex set multiple-symbols
7229 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
7230 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
7231
7232 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
7233 is ambiguous.
7234
7235 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
7236 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
7237 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
7238 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
7239 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
7240 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
7241 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
7242 in the use of the menu.
7243
7244 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
7245 when an ambiguity is detected.
7246
7247 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
7248 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
7249
7250 @kindex show multiple-symbols
7251 @item show multiple-symbols
7252 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
7253 @end table
7254
7255 @node Variables
7256 @section Program Variables
7257
7258 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
7259 in your program.
7260
7261 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
7262 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
7263
7264 @itemize @bullet
7265 @item
7266 global (or file-static)
7267 @end itemize
7268
7269 @noindent or
7270
7271 @itemize @bullet
7272 @item
7273 visible according to the scope rules of the
7274 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
7275 @end itemize
7276
7277 @noindent This means that in the function
7278
7279 @smallexample
7280 foo (a)
7281 int a;
7282 @{
7283 bar (a);
7284 @{
7285 int b = test ();
7286 bar (b);
7287 @}
7288 @}
7289 @end smallexample
7290
7291 @noindent
7292 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
7293 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
7294 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
7295 the block where @code{b} is declared.
7296
7297 @cindex variable name conflict
7298 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
7299 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
7300 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
7301 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
7302 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
7303 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
7304 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
7305
7306 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
7307 @ifnotinfo
7308 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
7309 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
7310 @end ifnotinfo
7311 @smallexample
7312 @var{file}::@var{variable}
7313 @var{function}::@var{variable}
7314 @end smallexample
7315
7316 @noindent
7317 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
7318 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
7319 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
7320 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
7321
7322 @smallexample
7323 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
7324 @end smallexample
7325
7326 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
7327 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
7328 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
7329 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
7330 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
7331 @c conflict?? --mew
7332
7333 @cindex wrong values
7334 @cindex variable values, wrong
7335 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
7336 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
7337 @quotation
7338 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
7339 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
7340 scope, and just before exit.
7341 @end quotation
7342 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
7343 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
7344 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
7345 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
7346 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
7347 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
7348 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
7349 variable definitions may be gone.
7350
7351 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
7352 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
7353 when compiling.
7354
7355 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
7356 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
7357 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
7358 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
7359 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
7360 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
7361 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
7362
7363 @smallexample
7364 No symbol "foo" in current context.
7365 @end smallexample
7366
7367 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
7368 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
7369 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
7370 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
7371 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
7372 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
7373 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
7374 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
7375 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
7376 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
7377 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
7378
7379 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
7380 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
7381 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
7382 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
7383
7384 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
7385 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
7386 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
7387 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
7388 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
7389
7390 @smallexample
7391 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
7392 29 i++;
7393 (gdb) next
7394 30 e (i);
7395 (gdb) print i
7396 $1 = 31
7397 (gdb) print i@@entry
7398 $2 = 30
7399 @end smallexample
7400
7401 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
7402 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
7403 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
7404 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
7405 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
7406 For program code
7407
7408 @smallexample
7409 char var0[] = "A";
7410 signed char var1[] = "A";
7411 @end smallexample
7412
7413 You get during debugging
7414 @smallexample
7415 (gdb) print var0
7416 $1 = "A"
7417 (gdb) print var1
7418 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
7419 @end smallexample
7420
7421 @node Arrays
7422 @section Artificial Arrays
7423
7424 @cindex artificial array
7425 @cindex arrays
7426 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
7427 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
7428 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
7429 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
7430 program.
7431
7432 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
7433 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
7434 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
7435 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
7436 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
7437 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
7438 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
7439 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
7440 example. If a program says
7441
7442 @smallexample
7443 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
7444 @end smallexample
7445
7446 @noindent
7447 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
7448
7449 @smallexample
7450 p *array@@len
7451 @end smallexample
7452
7453 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
7454 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
7455 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
7456 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
7457 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
7458
7459 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
7460 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
7461 The value need not be in memory:
7462 @smallexample
7463 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
7464 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7465 @end smallexample
7466
7467 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
7468 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
7469 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
7470 @smallexample
7471 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
7472 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
7473 @end smallexample
7474
7475 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
7476 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
7477 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
7478 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
7479 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7480 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
7481 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
7482 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
7483 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
7484 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
7485
7486 @smallexample
7487 set $i = 0
7488 p dtab[$i++]->fv
7489 @key{RET}
7490 @key{RET}
7491 @dots{}
7492 @end smallexample
7493
7494 @node Output Formats
7495 @section Output Formats
7496
7497 @cindex formatted output
7498 @cindex output formats
7499 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
7500 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
7501 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
7502 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
7503 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
7504
7505 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
7506 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
7507 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
7508 letters supported are:
7509
7510 @table @code
7511 @item x
7512 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
7513 hexadecimal.
7514
7515 @item d
7516 Print as integer in signed decimal.
7517
7518 @item u
7519 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
7520
7521 @item o
7522 Print as integer in octal.
7523
7524 @item t
7525 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
7526 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
7527 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
7528 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
7529
7530 @item a
7531 @cindex unknown address, locating
7532 @cindex locate address
7533 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
7534 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
7535 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
7536
7537 @smallexample
7538 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
7539 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
7540 @end smallexample
7541
7542 @noindent
7543 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
7544 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
7545
7546 @item c
7547 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
7548 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
7549 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
7550 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
7551
7552 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
7553 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
7554 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
7555 data.
7556
7557 @item f
7558 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
7559 using typical floating point syntax.
7560
7561 @item s
7562 @cindex printing strings
7563 @cindex printing byte arrays
7564 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
7565 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
7566 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
7567 natural types.
7568
7569 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
7570 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
7571 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
7572 array.
7573
7574 @item r
7575 @cindex raw printing
7576 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
7577 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
7578 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
7579 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
7580 pretty-printer which might exist.
7581 @end table
7582
7583 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
7584
7585 @smallexample
7586 p/x $pc
7587 @end smallexample
7588
7589 @noindent
7590 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
7591 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
7592
7593 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
7594 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
7595 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
7596
7597 @node Memory
7598 @section Examining Memory
7599
7600 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
7601 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
7602
7603 @cindex examining memory
7604 @table @code
7605 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
7606 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
7607 @itemx x @var{addr}
7608 @itemx x
7609 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
7610 @end table
7611
7612 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
7613 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
7614 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
7615 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
7616 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
7617
7618 @table @r
7619 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
7620 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
7621 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
7622 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
7623 @c 4.1.2.
7624
7625 @item @var{f}, the display format
7626 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
7627 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
7628 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
7629 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
7630 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
7631
7632 @item @var{u}, the unit size
7633 The unit size is any of
7634
7635 @table @code
7636 @item b
7637 Bytes.
7638 @item h
7639 Halfwords (two bytes).
7640 @item w
7641 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
7642 @item g
7643 Giant words (eight bytes).
7644 @end table
7645
7646 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
7647 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
7648 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
7649 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
7650 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
7651 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
7652 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
7653 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
7654 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
7655 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
7656 be altered.
7657
7658 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
7659 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
7660 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
7661 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
7662 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
7663 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
7664 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
7665 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
7666 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
7667 a value from memory).
7668 @end table
7669
7670 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
7671 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
7672 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
7673 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
7674 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
7675
7676 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
7677 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
7678 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
7679 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
7680 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
7681
7682 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
7683 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
7684 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
7685 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
7686 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
7687 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
7688 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
7689 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
7690 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
7691
7692 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
7693 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
7694 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
7695 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
7696 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
7697 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
7698 for successive uses of @code{x}.
7699
7700 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
7701 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
7702
7703 @smallexample
7704 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
7705 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
7706 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
7707 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
7708 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
7709 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
7710 @end smallexample
7711
7712 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
7713 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
7714 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
7715 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
7716 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
7717 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
7718 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
7719 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
7720 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
7721
7722 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
7723 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
7724 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
7725
7726 @cindex remote memory comparison
7727 @cindex verify remote memory image
7728 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
7729 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
7730 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
7731 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
7732 situations.
7733
7734 @table @code
7735 @kindex compare-sections
7736 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
7737 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
7738 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
7739 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
7740 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
7741 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
7742 remote request.
7743 @end table
7744
7745 @node Auto Display
7746 @section Automatic Display
7747 @cindex automatic display
7748 @cindex display of expressions
7749
7750 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
7751 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
7752 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
7753 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
7754 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
7755 The automatic display looks like this:
7756
7757 @smallexample
7758 2: foo = 38
7759 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
7760 @end smallexample
7761
7762 @noindent
7763 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
7764 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
7765 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
7766 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
7767 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
7768 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
7769
7770 @table @code
7771 @kindex display
7772 @item display @var{expr}
7773 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
7774 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7775
7776 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
7777
7778 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
7779 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
7780 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
7781 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
7782 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
7783
7784 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
7785 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
7786 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
7787 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
7788 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
7789 @end table
7790
7791 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
7792 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
7793 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7794
7795 @table @code
7796 @kindex delete display
7797 @kindex undisplay
7798 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
7799 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7800 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
7801 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
7802 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
7803 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
7804 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
7805
7806 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
7807 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
7808
7809 @kindex disable display
7810 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7811 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
7812 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
7813 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
7814 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
7815 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
7816 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
7817 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
7818
7819 @kindex enable display
7820 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
7821 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
7822 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
7823 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
7824 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
7825 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
7826 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
7827
7828 @item display
7829 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
7830 done when your program stops.
7831
7832 @kindex info display
7833 @item info display
7834 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
7835 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
7836 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
7837 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
7838 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
7839 @end table
7840
7841 @cindex display disabled out of scope
7842 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
7843 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
7844 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
7845 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
7846 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
7847 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
7848 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
7849 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
7850 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
7851 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
7852
7853 @node Print Settings
7854 @section Print Settings
7855
7856 @cindex format options
7857 @cindex print settings
7858 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
7859 and symbols are printed.
7860
7861 @noindent
7862 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
7863
7864 @table @code
7865 @kindex set print
7866 @item set print address
7867 @itemx set print address on
7868 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
7869 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
7870 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
7871 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
7872 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
7873 @code{set print address on}:
7874
7875 @smallexample
7876 @group
7877 (@value{GDBP}) f
7878 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
7879 at input.c:530
7880 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7881 @end group
7882 @end smallexample
7883
7884 @item set print address off
7885 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
7886 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
7887
7888 @smallexample
7889 @group
7890 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
7891 (@value{GDBP}) f
7892 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
7893 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
7894 @end group
7895 @end smallexample
7896
7897 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
7898 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
7899 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
7900 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
7901
7902 @kindex show print
7903 @item show print address
7904 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
7905 @end table
7906
7907 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
7908 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
7909 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
7910 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
7911 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
7912 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
7913 it prints a symbolic address:
7914
7915 @table @code
7916 @item set print symbol-filename on
7917 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
7918 @cindex symbol, source file and line
7919 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
7920 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7921
7922 @item set print symbol-filename off
7923 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
7924 default.
7925
7926 @item show print symbol-filename
7927 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
7928 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
7929 @end table
7930
7931 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
7932 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
7933 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
7934
7935 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
7936 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
7937
7938 @table @code
7939 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
7940 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
7941 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
7942 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
7943 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
7944 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
7945
7946 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
7947 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
7948 symbolic address.
7949 @end table
7950
7951 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
7952 @cindex pointer, finding referent
7953 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
7954 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
7955 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
7956 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
7957 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
7958 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
7959
7960 @smallexample
7961 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
7962 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
7963 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
7964 @end smallexample
7965
7966 @quotation
7967 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
7968 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
7969 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
7970 @end quotation
7971
7972 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
7973
7974 @table @code
7975 @item set print array
7976 @itemx set print array on
7977 @cindex pretty print arrays
7978 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
7979 but uses more space. The default is off.
7980
7981 @item set print array off
7982 Return to compressed format for arrays.
7983
7984 @item show print array
7985 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
7986 arrays.
7987
7988 @cindex print array indexes
7989 @item set print array-indexes
7990 @itemx set print array-indexes on
7991 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
7992 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
7993 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
7994
7995 @item set print array-indexes off
7996 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
7997
7998 @item show print array-indexes
7999 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
8000 arrays.
8001
8002 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
8003 @cindex number of array elements to print
8004 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
8005 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
8006 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
8007 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
8008 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
8009 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
8010 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
8011
8012 @item show print elements
8013 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
8014 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
8015
8016 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
8017 @kindex set print frame-arguments
8018 @cindex printing frame argument values
8019 @cindex print all frame argument values
8020 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
8021 @cindex do not print frame argument values
8022 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
8023 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
8024 values are:
8025
8026 @table @code
8027 @item all
8028 The values of all arguments are printed.
8029
8030 @item scalars
8031 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
8032 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
8033 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
8034 only scalar arguments are shown:
8035
8036 @smallexample
8037 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
8038 at frame-args.c:23
8039 @end smallexample
8040
8041 @item none
8042 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
8043 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
8044
8045 @smallexample
8046 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
8047 at frame-args.c:23
8048 @end smallexample
8049 @end table
8050
8051 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
8052 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
8053 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
8054 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
8055 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
8056 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
8057 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
8058 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
8059 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
8060 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
8061
8062 @item show print frame-arguments
8063 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
8064
8065 @anchor{set print entry-values}
8066 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
8067 @kindex set print entry-values
8068 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
8069 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
8070 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
8071 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
8072 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
8073
8074 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
8075 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
8076 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
8077 @code{no} setting.
8078
8079 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
8080 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
8081 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
8082 this information.
8083
8084 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
8085
8086 @table @code
8087 @item no
8088 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
8089 point.
8090 @smallexample
8091 #0 equal (val=5)
8092 #0 different (val=6)
8093 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
8094 #0 born (val=10)
8095 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
8096 @end smallexample
8097
8098 @item only
8099 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
8100 values are never printed.
8101 @smallexample
8102 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
8103 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
8104 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
8105 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
8106 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
8107 @end smallexample
8108
8109 @item preferred
8110 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
8111 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
8112 value for such parameter.
8113 @smallexample
8114 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
8115 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
8116 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
8117 #0 born (val=10)
8118 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
8119 @end smallexample
8120
8121 @item if-needed
8122 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
8123 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
8124 parameter.
8125 @smallexample
8126 #0 equal (val=5)
8127 #0 different (val=6)
8128 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
8129 #0 born (val=10)
8130 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
8131 @end smallexample
8132
8133 @item both
8134 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
8135 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
8136 optimizations.
8137 @smallexample
8138 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
8139 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
8140 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
8141 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
8142 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
8143 @end smallexample
8144
8145 @item compact
8146 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
8147 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
8148 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
8149 values are known and identical, print the shortened
8150 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
8151 @smallexample
8152 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
8153 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
8154 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
8155 #0 born (val=10)
8156 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
8157 @end smallexample
8158
8159 @item default
8160 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
8161 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
8162 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
8163 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
8164 @smallexample
8165 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
8166 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
8167 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
8168 #0 born (val=10)
8169 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
8170 @end smallexample
8171 @end table
8172
8173 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
8174 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
8175
8176 @item show print entry-values
8177 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
8178 entry.
8179
8180 @item set print repeats
8181 @cindex repeated array elements
8182 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
8183 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
8184 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
8185 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
8186 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
8187 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
8188 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
8189
8190 @item show print repeats
8191 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
8192 elements.
8193
8194 @item set print null-stop
8195 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
8196 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
8197 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
8198 contain only short strings.
8199 The default is off.
8200
8201 @item show print null-stop
8202 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
8203 @sc{null} character.
8204
8205 @item set print pretty on
8206 @cindex print structures in indented form
8207 @cindex indentation in structure display
8208 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
8209 per line, like this:
8210
8211 @smallexample
8212 @group
8213 $1 = @{
8214 next = 0x0,
8215 flags = @{
8216 sweet = 1,
8217 sour = 1
8218 @},
8219 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
8220 @}
8221 @end group
8222 @end smallexample
8223
8224 @item set print pretty off
8225 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
8226
8227 @smallexample
8228 @group
8229 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
8230 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
8231 @end group
8232 @end smallexample
8233
8234 @noindent
8235 This is the default format.
8236
8237 @item show print pretty
8238 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
8239
8240 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
8241 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
8242 @cindex octal escapes in strings
8243 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
8244 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
8245 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
8246 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
8247 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
8248
8249 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
8250 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
8251 international character sets, and is the default.
8252
8253 @item show print sevenbit-strings
8254 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
8255
8256 @item set print union on
8257 @cindex unions in structures, printing
8258 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
8259 and other unions. This is the default setting.
8260
8261 @item set print union off
8262 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
8263 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
8264 instead.
8265
8266 @item show print union
8267 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
8268 structures and other unions.
8269
8270 For example, given the declarations
8271
8272 @smallexample
8273 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
8274 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
8275 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
8276 Bug_forms;
8277
8278 struct thing @{
8279 Species it;
8280 union @{
8281 Tree_forms tree;
8282 Bug_forms bug;
8283 @} form;
8284 @};
8285
8286 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
8287 @end smallexample
8288
8289 @noindent
8290 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
8291
8292 @smallexample
8293 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
8294 @end smallexample
8295
8296 @noindent
8297 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
8298
8299 @smallexample
8300 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
8301 @end smallexample
8302
8303 @noindent
8304 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
8305 and in Pascal.
8306 @end table
8307
8308 @need 1000
8309 @noindent
8310 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
8311
8312 @table @code
8313 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
8314 @item set print demangle
8315 @itemx set print demangle on
8316 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
8317 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
8318 linkage. The default is on.
8319
8320 @item show print demangle
8321 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
8322
8323 @item set print asm-demangle
8324 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
8325 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
8326 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
8327 The default is off.
8328
8329 @item show print asm-demangle
8330 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
8331 or demangled form.
8332
8333 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
8334 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
8335 @kindex set demangle-style
8336 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
8337 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
8338 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
8339
8340 @table @code
8341 @item auto
8342 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
8343
8344 @item gnu
8345 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
8346 This is the default.
8347
8348 @item hp
8349 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
8350
8351 @item lucid
8352 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
8353
8354 @item arm
8355 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
8356 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
8357 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
8358 require further enhancement to permit that.
8359
8360 @end table
8361 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
8362
8363 @item show demangle-style
8364 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
8365
8366 @item set print object
8367 @itemx set print object on
8368 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
8369 @cindex display derived types
8370 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
8371 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
8372 the virtual function table.
8373
8374 @item set print object off
8375 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
8376 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
8377
8378 @item show print object
8379 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
8380
8381 @item set print static-members
8382 @itemx set print static-members on
8383 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
8384 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
8385
8386 @item set print static-members off
8387 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
8388
8389 @item show print static-members
8390 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
8391
8392 @item set print pascal_static-members
8393 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
8394 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
8395 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
8396 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
8397
8398 @item set print pascal_static-members off
8399 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
8400
8401 @item show print pascal_static-members
8402 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
8403
8404 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
8405 @item set print vtbl
8406 @itemx set print vtbl on
8407 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
8408 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
8409 @cindex VTBL display
8410 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
8411 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
8412 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
8413
8414 @item set print vtbl off
8415 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
8416
8417 @item show print vtbl
8418 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
8419 @end table
8420
8421 @node Pretty Printing
8422 @section Pretty Printing
8423
8424 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
8425 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
8426 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
8427
8428 @menu
8429 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
8430 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
8431 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
8432 @end menu
8433
8434 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
8435 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
8436
8437 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
8438 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
8439 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
8440
8441 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
8442 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
8443 pretty-printers with their names.
8444 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
8445 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
8446 Each such subprinter has its own name.
8447 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
8448
8449 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
8450 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
8451 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
8452 do anything special.
8453
8454 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
8455
8456 @itemize @bullet
8457 @item
8458 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
8459 all inferiors.
8460
8461 @item
8462 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
8463 when debugging that program.
8464 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
8465
8466 @item
8467 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
8468 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
8469 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
8470 @end itemize
8471
8472 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
8473 pretty-printers are selected,
8474
8475 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
8476 for new types.
8477
8478 @node Pretty-Printer Example
8479 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
8480
8481 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
8482
8483 @smallexample
8484 (@value{GDBP}) print s
8485 $1 = @{
8486 static npos = 4294967295,
8487 _M_dataplus = @{
8488 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
8489 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
8490 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
8491 @},
8492 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
8493 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
8494 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
8495 @}
8496 @}
8497 @end smallexample
8498
8499 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
8500
8501 @smallexample
8502 (@value{GDBP}) print s
8503 $2 = "abcd"
8504 @end smallexample
8505
8506 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
8507 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
8508 @cindex pretty-printer commands
8509
8510 @table @code
8511 @kindex info pretty-printer
8512 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8513 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
8514 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
8515
8516 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
8517 whose pretty-printers to list.
8518 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
8519 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
8520 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
8521 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
8522 looks up a printer from these three objects.
8523
8524 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
8525 to list.
8526
8527 @kindex disable pretty-printer
8528 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8529 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
8530 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
8531
8532 @kindex enable pretty-printer
8533 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
8534 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
8535 @end table
8536
8537 Example:
8538
8539 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
8540 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
8541 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
8542 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
8543
8544 @smallexample
8545 (gdb) info pretty-printer
8546 library1.so:
8547 foo
8548 library2.so:
8549 bar
8550 bar1
8551 bar2
8552 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8553 library2.so:
8554 bar
8555 bar1
8556 bar2
8557 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
8558 1 printer disabled
8559 2 of 3 printers enabled
8560 (gdb) info pretty-printer
8561 library1.so:
8562 foo [disabled]
8563 library2.so:
8564 bar
8565 bar1
8566 bar2
8567 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
8568 1 printer disabled
8569 1 of 3 printers enabled
8570 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8571 library1.so:
8572 foo [disabled]
8573 library2.so:
8574 bar
8575 bar1 [disabled]
8576 bar2
8577 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
8578 1 printer disabled
8579 0 of 3 printers enabled
8580 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
8581 library1.so:
8582 foo [disabled]
8583 library2.so:
8584 bar [disabled]
8585 bar1 [disabled]
8586 bar2
8587 @end smallexample
8588
8589 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
8590 as can each individual subprinter.
8591
8592 @node Value History
8593 @section Value History
8594
8595 @cindex value history
8596 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
8597 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
8598 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
8599 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
8600 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
8601 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
8602 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
8603 symbol table.
8604
8605 @cindex @code{$}
8606 @cindex @code{$$}
8607 @cindex history number
8608 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
8609 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
8610 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
8611 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
8612 history number.
8613
8614 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
8615 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
8616 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
8617 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
8618 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
8619 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
8620 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
8621
8622 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
8623 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
8624
8625 @smallexample
8626 p *$
8627 @end smallexample
8628
8629 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
8630 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
8631
8632 @smallexample
8633 p *$.next
8634 @end smallexample
8635
8636 @noindent
8637 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
8638 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
8639
8640 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
8641 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
8642
8643 @smallexample
8644 print x
8645 set x=5
8646 @end smallexample
8647
8648 @noindent
8649 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
8650 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
8651
8652 @table @code
8653 @kindex show values
8654 @item show values
8655 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
8656 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
8657 values} does not change the history.
8658
8659 @item show values @var{n}
8660 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
8661
8662 @item show values +
8663 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
8664 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
8665 @end table
8666
8667 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
8668 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
8669
8670 @node Convenience Vars
8671 @section Convenience Variables
8672
8673 @cindex convenience variables
8674 @cindex user-defined variables
8675 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
8676 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
8677 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
8678 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
8679 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
8680
8681 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
8682 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
8683 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
8684 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
8685 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
8686
8687 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
8688 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
8689 For example:
8690
8691 @smallexample
8692 set $foo = *object_ptr
8693 @end smallexample
8694
8695 @noindent
8696 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
8697 @code{object_ptr}.
8698
8699 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
8700 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
8701 value with another assignment at any time.
8702
8703 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
8704 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
8705 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
8706 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
8707
8708 @table @code
8709 @kindex show convenience
8710 @cindex show all user variables
8711 @item show convenience
8712 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
8713 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
8714
8715 @kindex init-if-undefined
8716 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
8717 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
8718 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
8719 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
8720 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
8721 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
8722 override default values used in a command script.
8723
8724 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
8725 any side-effects do not occur.
8726 @end table
8727
8728 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
8729 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
8730 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
8731
8732 @smallexample
8733 set $i = 0
8734 print bar[$i++]->contents
8735 @end smallexample
8736
8737 @noindent
8738 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
8739
8740 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
8741 values likely to be useful.
8742
8743 @table @code
8744 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
8745 @item $_
8746 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
8747 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
8748 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
8749 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
8750 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
8751 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
8752 to the type of @code{$__}.
8753
8754 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
8755 @item $__
8756 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
8757 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
8758 to match the format in which the data was printed.
8759
8760 @item $_exitcode
8761 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
8762 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
8763 the program being debugged terminates.
8764
8765 @item $_sdata
8766 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
8767 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
8768 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
8769 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
8770 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
8771
8772 @item $_siginfo
8773 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
8774 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
8775 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
8776 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
8777 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
8778
8779 @item $_tlb
8780 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
8781 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
8782 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
8783 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
8784 @xref{General Query Packets}.
8785 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
8786
8787 @end table
8788
8789 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
8790 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
8791 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
8792
8793 @cindex convenience functions
8794 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
8795 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
8796 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
8797 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
8798 @value{GDBN}.
8799
8800 @table @code
8801 @item help function
8802 @kindex help function
8803 @cindex show all convenience functions
8804 Print a list of all convenience functions.
8805 @end table
8806
8807 @node Registers
8808 @section Registers
8809
8810 @cindex registers
8811 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
8812 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
8813 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
8814 your machine.
8815
8816 @table @code
8817 @kindex info registers
8818 @item info registers
8819 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
8820 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8821
8822 @kindex info all-registers
8823 @cindex floating point registers
8824 @item info all-registers
8825 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
8826 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
8827
8828 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
8829 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
8830 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
8831 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
8832 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
8833 @end table
8834
8835 @cindex stack pointer register
8836 @cindex program counter register
8837 @cindex process status register
8838 @cindex frame pointer register
8839 @cindex standard registers
8840 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
8841 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
8842 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
8843 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
8844 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
8845 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
8846 register that contains the processor status. For example,
8847 you could print the program counter in hex with
8848
8849 @smallexample
8850 p/x $pc
8851 @end smallexample
8852
8853 @noindent
8854 or print the instruction to be executed next with
8855
8856 @smallexample
8857 x/i $pc
8858 @end smallexample
8859
8860 @noindent
8861 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
8862 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
8863 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
8864 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
8865 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
8866 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
8867 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
8868
8869 @smallexample
8870 set $sp += 4
8871 @end smallexample
8872
8873 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
8874 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
8875 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
8876 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
8877 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
8878 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
8879 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
8880
8881 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
8882 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
8883 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
8884 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
8885 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
8886 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
8887 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
8888
8889 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
8890 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
8891 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
8892 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
8893 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
8894 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
8895 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
8896 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
8897 prints the data in both formats.
8898
8899 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
8900 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
8901 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
8902 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
8903 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
8904 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
8905 registers in @code{struct} notation:
8906
8907 @smallexample
8908 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
8909 $1 = @{
8910 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
8911 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
8912 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
8913 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
8914 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
8915 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
8916 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
8917 @}
8918 @end smallexample
8919
8920 @noindent
8921 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
8922 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
8923 value to a @code{struct} member:
8924
8925 @smallexample
8926 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
8927 @end smallexample
8928
8929 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
8930 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
8931 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
8932 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
8933 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
8934 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
8935
8936 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
8937 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
8938 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
8939 frame makes no difference.
8940
8941 @node Floating Point Hardware
8942 @section Floating Point Hardware
8943 @cindex floating point
8944
8945 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
8946 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
8947
8948 @table @code
8949 @kindex info float
8950 @item info float
8951 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
8952 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
8953 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
8954 the ARM and x86 machines.
8955 @end table
8956
8957 @node Vector Unit
8958 @section Vector Unit
8959 @cindex vector unit
8960
8961 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
8962 more information about the status of the vector unit.
8963
8964 @table @code
8965 @kindex info vector
8966 @item info vector
8967 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
8968 layout vary depending on the hardware.
8969 @end table
8970
8971 @node OS Information
8972 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
8973 @cindex OS information
8974
8975 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
8976 you debug your program.
8977
8978 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
8979 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
8980 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
8981 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
8982 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
8983 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
8984 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
8985 structure.
8986
8987 @table @code
8988 @item info udot
8989 @kindex info udot
8990 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
8991 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
8992 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
8993 the @code{examine} command.
8994 @end table
8995
8996 @cindex auxiliary vector
8997 @cindex vector, auxiliary
8998 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
8999 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
9000 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
9001 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
9002 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
9003 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
9004 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
9005 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
9006 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
9007 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
9008 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
9009
9010 @table @code
9011 @kindex info auxv
9012 @item info auxv
9013 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
9014 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
9015 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
9016 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
9017 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
9018 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
9019 an unrecognized tag.
9020 @end table
9021
9022 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information
9023 and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets,
9024 this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
9025 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
9026
9027 @table @code
9028 @kindex info os
9029 @item info os
9030 List the types of OS information available for the target. If the
9031 target does not return a list of possible types, this command will
9032 report an error.
9033
9034 @kindex info os processes
9035 @item info os processes
9036 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
9037 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and
9038 the command corresponding to the process.
9039 @end table
9040
9041 @node Memory Region Attributes
9042 @section Memory Region Attributes
9043 @cindex memory region attributes
9044
9045 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
9046 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
9047 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
9048 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
9049 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
9050 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
9051 user can override the fetched regions.
9052
9053 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
9054 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
9055 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
9056 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
9057 all memory.
9058
9059 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
9060 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
9061
9062 @table @code
9063 @kindex mem
9064 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
9065 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
9066 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
9067 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
9068 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
9069 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
9070
9071 @item mem auto
9072 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
9073 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
9074
9075 @kindex delete mem
9076 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
9077 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
9078 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
9079
9080 @kindex disable mem
9081 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
9082 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
9083 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
9084 It may be enabled again later.
9085
9086 @kindex enable mem
9087 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
9088 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
9089
9090 @kindex info mem
9091 @item info mem
9092 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
9093 for each region:
9094
9095 @table @emph
9096 @item Memory Region Number
9097 @item Enabled or Disabled.
9098 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
9099 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
9100
9101 @item Lo Address
9102 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
9103
9104 @item Hi Address
9105 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
9106
9107 @item Attributes
9108 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
9109 @end table
9110 @end table
9111
9112
9113 @subsection Attributes
9114
9115 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
9116 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
9117 write accesses to a memory region.
9118
9119 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
9120 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
9121 etc.@: from accessing memory.
9122
9123 @table @code
9124 @item ro
9125 Memory is read only.
9126 @item wo
9127 Memory is write only.
9128 @item rw
9129 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
9130 @end table
9131
9132 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
9133 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
9134 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
9135 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
9136 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
9137
9138 @table @code
9139 @item 8
9140 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
9141 @item 16
9142 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
9143 @item 32
9144 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
9145 @item 64
9146 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
9147 @end table
9148
9149 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
9150 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
9151 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
9152 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
9153 @c
9154 @c @table @code
9155 @c @item hwbreak
9156 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
9157 @c @item swbreak (default)
9158 @c @end table
9159
9160 @subsubsection Data Cache
9161 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
9162 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
9163 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
9164 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
9165 registers.
9166
9167 @table @code
9168 @item cache
9169 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
9170 @item nocache
9171 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
9172 @end table
9173
9174 @subsection Memory Access Checking
9175 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
9176 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
9177 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
9178 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
9179
9180 @table @code
9181 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
9182 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
9183 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
9184 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
9185 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
9186 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
9187 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
9188 The default value is @code{on}.
9189 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
9190 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
9191 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
9192 @end table
9193
9194
9195 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
9196 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
9197 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
9198 @c
9199 @c @table @code
9200 @c @item verify
9201 @c @item noverify (default)
9202 @c @end table
9203
9204 @node Dump/Restore Files
9205 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
9206 @cindex dump/restore files
9207 @cindex append data to a file
9208 @cindex dump data to a file
9209 @cindex restore data from a file
9210
9211 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
9212 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
9213 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
9214 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
9215 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
9216 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
9217 files.
9218
9219 @table @code
9220
9221 @kindex dump
9222 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
9223 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
9224 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
9225 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
9226
9227 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
9228 @table @code
9229 @item binary
9230 Raw binary form.
9231 @item ihex
9232 Intel hex format.
9233 @item srec
9234 Motorola S-record format.
9235 @item tekhex
9236 Tektronix Hex format.
9237 @end table
9238
9239 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
9240 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
9241 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
9242 form.
9243
9244 @kindex append
9245 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
9246 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
9247 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
9248 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
9249 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
9250
9251 @kindex restore
9252 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
9253 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
9254 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
9255 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
9256 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
9257
9258 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
9259 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
9260 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
9261 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
9262 from that location.
9263
9264 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
9265 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
9266 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
9267 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
9268
9269 @end table
9270
9271 @node Core File Generation
9272 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
9273 @cindex dump core from inferior
9274
9275 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
9276 image of a running process and its process status (register values
9277 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
9278 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
9279 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
9280 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
9281 the post-mortem debugging mode.
9282
9283 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
9284 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
9285 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
9286
9287 @table @code
9288 @kindex gcore
9289 @kindex generate-core-file
9290 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
9291 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
9292 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
9293 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
9294 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
9295 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
9296
9297 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
9298 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
9299 @end table
9300
9301 @node Character Sets
9302 @section Character Sets
9303 @cindex character sets
9304 @cindex charset
9305 @cindex translating between character sets
9306 @cindex host character set
9307 @cindex target character set
9308
9309 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
9310 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
9311 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
9312 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
9313 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
9314 @dfn{target character set}.
9315
9316 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
9317 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
9318 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
9319 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
9320 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
9321 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
9322 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
9323 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
9324 character and string literals in expressions.
9325
9326 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
9327 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
9328 target-charset} command, described below.
9329
9330 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
9331 support:
9332
9333 @table @code
9334 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
9335 @kindex set target-charset
9336 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
9337 list of supported target character sets, type
9338 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
9339
9340 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
9341 @kindex set host-charset
9342 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
9343
9344 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
9345 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
9346 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
9347 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
9348 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
9349
9350 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
9351 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
9352 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
9353
9354 @item set charset @var{charset}
9355 @kindex set charset
9356 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
9357 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
9358 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
9359 for both host and target.
9360
9361 @item show charset
9362 @kindex show charset
9363 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
9364
9365 @item show host-charset
9366 @kindex show host-charset
9367 Show the name of the current host character set.
9368
9369 @item show target-charset
9370 @kindex show target-charset
9371 Show the name of the current target character set.
9372
9373 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
9374 @kindex set target-wide-charset
9375 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
9376 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
9377 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
9378 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
9379
9380 @item show target-wide-charset
9381 @kindex show target-wide-charset
9382 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
9383 @end table
9384
9385 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
9386 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
9387 @file{charset-test.c}:
9388
9389 @smallexample
9390 #include <stdio.h>
9391
9392 char ascii_hello[]
9393 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
9394 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
9395 char ibm1047_hello[]
9396 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
9397 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
9398
9399 main ()
9400 @{
9401 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
9402 @}
9403 @end smallexample
9404
9405 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
9406 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
9407 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
9408
9409 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
9410
9411 @smallexample
9412 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
9413 $ gdb -nw charset-test
9414 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
9415 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
9416 @dots{}
9417 (@value{GDBP})
9418 @end smallexample
9419
9420 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
9421 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
9422 strings:
9423
9424 @smallexample
9425 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9426 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
9427 (@value{GDBP})
9428 @end smallexample
9429
9430 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
9431 initial character set:
9432 @smallexample
9433 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
9434 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9435 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
9436 (@value{GDBP})
9437 @end smallexample
9438
9439 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
9440 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
9441 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
9442 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
9443 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
9444
9445 @smallexample
9446 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
9447 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
9448 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
9449 $2 = 72 'H'
9450 (@value{GDBP})
9451 @end smallexample
9452
9453 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
9454 literals you use in expressions:
9455
9456 @smallexample
9457 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
9458 $3 = 43 '+'
9459 (@value{GDBP})
9460 @end smallexample
9461
9462 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
9463 character.
9464
9465 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
9466 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
9467 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
9468
9469 @smallexample
9470 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
9471 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
9472 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
9473 $5 = 200 '\310'
9474 (@value{GDBP})
9475 @end smallexample
9476
9477 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
9478 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
9479
9480 @smallexample
9481 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
9482 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
9483 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
9484 @end smallexample
9485
9486 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
9487 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
9488 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
9489 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
9490 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
9491
9492 @smallexample
9493 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
9494 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
9495 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
9496 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
9497 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
9498 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
9499 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
9500 $7 = 72 '\110'
9501 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
9502 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
9503 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
9504 $9 = 200 'H'
9505 (@value{GDBP})
9506 @end smallexample
9507
9508 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
9509 string literals you use in expressions:
9510
9511 @smallexample
9512 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
9513 $10 = 78 '+'
9514 (@value{GDBP})
9515 @end smallexample
9516
9517 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
9518 character.
9519
9520 @node Caching Remote Data
9521 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
9522 @cindex caching data of remote targets
9523
9524 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a
9525 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
9526 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
9527 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately, simply
9528 caching everything would lead to incorrect results, since @value{GDBN}
9529 does not necessarily know anything about volatile values, memory-mapped I/O
9530 addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode})
9531 memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command is executing.
9532 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
9533 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
9534 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
9535 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
9536 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.}.
9537 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
9538 cacheable; see @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
9539
9540 @table @code
9541 @kindex set remotecache
9542 @item set remotecache on
9543 @itemx set remotecache off
9544 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
9545 with old scripts.
9546
9547 @kindex show remotecache
9548 @item show remotecache
9549 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
9550
9551 @kindex set stack-cache
9552 @item set stack-cache on
9553 @itemx set stack-cache off
9554 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{ON}, use
9555 caching. By default, this option is @code{ON}.
9556
9557 @kindex show stack-cache
9558 @item show stack-cache
9559 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
9560
9561 @kindex info dcache
9562 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
9563 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
9564 information displayed includes the dcache width and depth, and for
9565 each cache line, its number, address, and how many times it was
9566 referenced. This command is useful for debugging the data cache
9567 operation.
9568
9569 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
9570 printed in hex.
9571
9572 @item set dcache size @var{size}
9573 @cindex dcache size
9574 @kindex set dcache size
9575 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
9576
9577 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
9578 @cindex dcache line-size
9579 @kindex set dcache line-size
9580 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
9581 Must be a power of 2.
9582
9583 @item show dcache size
9584 @kindex show dcache size
9585 Show maximum number of dcache entries. See also @ref{Caching Remote Data, info dcache}.
9586
9587 @item show dcache line-size
9588 @kindex show dcache line-size
9589 Show default size of dcache lines. See also @ref{Caching Remote Data, info dcache}.
9590
9591 @end table
9592
9593 @node Searching Memory
9594 @section Search Memory
9595 @cindex searching memory
9596
9597 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
9598 @code{find} command.
9599
9600 @table @code
9601 @kindex find
9602 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
9603 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
9604 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
9605 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
9606 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
9607 @end table
9608
9609 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
9610 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
9611
9612 @table @r
9613 @item @var{s}, search query size
9614 The size of each search query value.
9615
9616 @table @code
9617 @item b
9618 bytes
9619 @item h
9620 halfwords (two bytes)
9621 @item w
9622 words (four bytes)
9623 @item g
9624 giant words (eight bytes)
9625 @end table
9626
9627 All values are interpreted in the current language.
9628 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
9629 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
9630
9631 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
9632 value's type in the current language.
9633 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
9634 pattern as a mixture of types.
9635 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
9636 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
9637 which is typically four bytes.
9638
9639 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
9640 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
9641 @end table
9642
9643 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
9644 (@code{"}).
9645 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
9646 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
9647
9648 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
9649 number of matches found.
9650
9651 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
9652 @samp{$_}.
9653 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
9654
9655 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
9656
9657 @smallexample
9658 void
9659 hello ()
9660 @{
9661 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
9662 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
9663 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
9664 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
9665 printf ("%s\n", hello);
9666 @}
9667 @end smallexample
9668
9669 @noindent
9670 you get during debugging:
9671
9672 @smallexample
9673 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
9674 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
9675 1 pattern found
9676 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
9677 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
9678 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
9679 2 patterns found
9680 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
9681 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
9682 1 pattern found
9683 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
9684 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
9685 1 pattern found
9686 (gdb) print $numfound
9687 $1 = 1
9688 (gdb) print $_
9689 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
9690 @end smallexample
9691
9692 @node Optimized Code
9693 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
9694 @cindex optimized code, debugging
9695 @cindex debugging optimized code
9696
9697 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
9698 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
9699 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
9700 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
9701 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
9702 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
9703 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
9704
9705 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
9706 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
9707 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
9708 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
9709
9710 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
9711 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
9712 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
9713 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
9714 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
9715 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
9716
9717 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
9718 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
9719 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
9720 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
9721 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
9722
9723 @menu
9724 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
9725 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
9726 @end menu
9727
9728 @node Inline Functions
9729 @section Inline Functions
9730 @cindex inline functions, debugging
9731
9732 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
9733 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
9734 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
9735 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
9736 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
9737 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
9738 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
9739 @code{info frame} command.
9740
9741 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
9742 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
9743 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
9744 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
9745 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
9746 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
9747 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
9748 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
9749 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
9750 local variables in the caller.
9751
9752 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
9753 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
9754 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
9755 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
9756 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
9757 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
9758 instructions are executed.
9759
9760 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
9761 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
9762 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
9763 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
9764
9765 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
9766 function calls are the same as normal calls:
9767
9768 @itemize @bullet
9769 @item
9770 You cannot set breakpoints on inlined functions. @value{GDBN}
9771 either reports that there is no symbol with that name, or else sets the
9772 breakpoint only on non-inlined copies of the function. This limitation
9773 will be removed in a future version of @value{GDBN}; until then,
9774 set a breakpoint by line number on the first line of the inlined
9775 function instead.
9776
9777 @item
9778 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
9779 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
9780 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
9781 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
9782 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
9783 or inside the inlined function instead.
9784
9785 @item
9786 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
9787 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
9788 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
9789 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
9790
9791 @end itemize
9792
9793 @node Tail Call Frames
9794 @section Tail Call Frames
9795 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
9796
9797 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
9798 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
9799 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
9800 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
9801 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
9802
9803 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
9804 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
9805 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
9806 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
9807 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
9808 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
9809 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
9810
9811 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9812 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9813 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9814 this information.
9815
9816 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
9817 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
9818
9819 @smallexample
9820 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
9821 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
9822 (gdb) info frame
9823 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
9824 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
9825 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
9826 source language c++.
9827 Arglist at unknown address.
9828 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
9829 @end smallexample
9830
9831 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
9832 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
9833 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
9834 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
9835 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
9836 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
9837
9838 @table @code
9839 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
9840 @item set debug entry-values
9841 @kindex set debug entry-values
9842 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
9843 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
9844 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
9845 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
9846 result.
9847
9848 @item show debug entry-values
9849 @kindex show debug entry-values
9850 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
9851 values at function entry and tail calls.
9852 @end table
9853
9854 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
9855 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
9856 reference by variable @code{x}):
9857
9858 @smallexample
9859 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
9860 void (*x) (void) = c;
9861 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
9862 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
9863 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
9864
9865 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
9866 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
9867 a () at t.c:3
9868 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
9869 (gdb) bt
9870 #0 a () at t.c:3
9871 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
9872 @end smallexample
9873
9874 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
9875
9876 @smallexample
9877 int i;
9878 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
9879 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
9880 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
9881 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
9882 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
9883 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
9884 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
9885 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
9886
9887 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
9888 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
9889 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
9890 (gdb) bt
9891 #0 f () at t.c:2
9892 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
9893 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
9894 @end smallexample
9895
9896 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
9897 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
9898
9899 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
9900 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
9901 @set ARROW @click{}
9902 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
9903 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
9904 @end ifset
9905 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
9906 @set ARROW ->
9907 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
9908 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
9909 @end ifclear
9910
9911 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
9912 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
9913 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
9914
9915 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
9916 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
9917 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
9918 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
9919 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
9920 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
9921
9922 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
9923 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
9924 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
9925 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
9926 omitted.
9927
9928 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
9929 entry may fail:
9930
9931 @smallexample
9932 int v;
9933 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
9934 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
9935 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
9936 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
9937 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
9938 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
9939
9940 (gdb) bt
9941 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
9942 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
9943 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
9944 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
9945 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
9946 @end smallexample
9947
9948 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
9949 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
9950 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
9951 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
9952 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
9953
9954 @node Macros
9955 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
9956
9957 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
9958 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
9959 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
9960 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
9961 where it was defined.
9962
9963 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
9964 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
9965 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
9966 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
9967
9968 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
9969 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
9970 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
9971 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
9972 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
9973 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
9974 see @ref{List}.
9975
9976 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
9977 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
9978 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
9979
9980 @table @code
9981
9982 @kindex macro expand
9983 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
9984 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
9985 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
9986 @item macro expand @var{expression}
9987 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
9988 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
9989 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
9990 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
9991 it can be any string of tokens.
9992
9993 @kindex macro exp1
9994 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
9995 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
9996 @cindex expand macro once
9997 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
9998 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
9999 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
10000 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
10001 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
10002 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
10003 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
10004 can be any string of tokens.
10005
10006 @kindex info macro
10007 @cindex macro definition, showing
10008 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
10009 @cindex macros, from debug info
10010 @item info macro @var{macro}
10011 Show the current definition of the named @var{macro}, and describe the
10012 source location or compiler command-line where that definition was established.
10013
10014 @kindex info macros
10015 @item info macros @var{linespec}
10016 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
10017 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
10018 command-line where those definitions were established.
10019
10020 @kindex info definitions
10021 @item info definitions @var{macro}
10022 Show all definitions of the named @var{macro} that are defined in the current
10023 compilation unit, and describe the source location or compiler command-line
10024 where those definitions were established.
10025
10026 @kindex macro define
10027 @cindex user-defined macros
10028 @cindex defining macros interactively
10029 @cindex macros, user-defined
10030 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
10031 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
10032 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
10033 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
10034 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
10035 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
10036 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
10037 @var{arglist}.
10038
10039 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
10040 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
10041 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
10042 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
10043 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
10044
10045 @kindex macro undef
10046 @item macro undef @var{macro}
10047 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
10048 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
10049 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
10050 in the program being debugged.
10051
10052 @kindex macro list
10053 @item macro list
10054 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
10055 @end table
10056
10057 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
10058 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
10059 show our source files:
10060
10061 @smallexample
10062 $ cat sample.c
10063 #include <stdio.h>
10064 #include "sample.h"
10065
10066 #define M 42
10067 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
10068
10069 main ()
10070 @{
10071 #define N 28
10072 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10073 #undef N
10074 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
10075 #define N 1729
10076 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
10077 @}
10078 $ cat sample.h
10079 #define Q <
10080 $
10081 @end smallexample
10082
10083 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
10084 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
10085 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
10086 information.
10087
10088 @smallexample
10089 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
10090 $
10091 @end smallexample
10092
10093 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
10094
10095 @smallexample
10096 $ gdb -nw sample
10097 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
10098 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
10099 GDB is free software, @dots{}
10100 (@value{GDBP})
10101 @end smallexample
10102
10103 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
10104 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
10105 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
10106
10107 @smallexample
10108 (@value{GDBP}) list main
10109 3
10110 4 #define M 42
10111 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
10112 6
10113 7 main ()
10114 8 @{
10115 9 #define N 28
10116 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10117 11 #undef N
10118 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
10119 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
10120 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
10121 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
10122 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
10123 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
10124 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
10125 #define Q <
10126 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
10127 expands to: (42 + 1)
10128 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
10129 expands to: once (M + 1)
10130 (@value{GDBP})
10131 @end smallexample
10132
10133 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
10134 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
10135 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
10136 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
10137
10138 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
10139 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
10140
10141 @smallexample
10142 (@value{GDBP}) break main
10143 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
10144 (@value{GDBP}) run
10145 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
10146
10147 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
10148 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
10149 (@value{GDBP})
10150 @end smallexample
10151
10152 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
10153
10154 @smallexample
10155 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
10156 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
10157 #define N 28
10158 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
10159 expands to: 28 < 42
10160 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
10161 $1 = 1
10162 (@value{GDBP})
10163 @end smallexample
10164
10165 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
10166 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
10167 thereof) in force at each point:
10168
10169 @smallexample
10170 (@value{GDBP}) next
10171 Hello, world!
10172 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
10173 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
10174 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
10175 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
10176 (@value{GDBP}) next
10177 We're so creative.
10178 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
10179 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
10180 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
10181 #define N 1729
10182 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
10183 expands to: 1729 < 42
10184 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
10185 $2 = 0
10186 (@value{GDBP})
10187 @end smallexample
10188
10189 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
10190 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
10191 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
10192 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
10193
10194 @smallexample
10195 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
10196 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
10197 -D__STDC__=1
10198 (@value{GDBP})
10199 @end smallexample
10200
10201
10202 @node Tracepoints
10203 @chapter Tracepoints
10204 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
10205 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
10206
10207 @cindex tracepoints
10208 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
10209 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
10210 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
10211 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
10212 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
10213 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
10214 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
10215
10216 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
10217 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
10218 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
10219 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
10220 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
10221 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
10222 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
10223 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
10224 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
10225 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
10226 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
10227
10228 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
10229 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
10230 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
10231 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
10232 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
10233 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
10234 Packets}.
10235
10236 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
10237 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
10238 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
10239
10240 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
10241
10242 @menu
10243 * Set Tracepoints::
10244 * Analyze Collected Data::
10245 * Tracepoint Variables::
10246 * Trace Files::
10247 @end menu
10248
10249 @node Set Tracepoints
10250 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
10251
10252 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
10253 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
10254 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
10255 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
10256 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
10257 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
10258 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
10259
10260 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
10261 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
10262 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
10263 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
10264 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
10265 tracepoint was hit.
10266
10267 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
10268 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
10269 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
10270 either.
10271
10272 @cindex fast tracepoints
10273 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
10274 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
10275 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
10276
10277 @cindex static tracepoints
10278 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
10279 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
10280 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
10281 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
10282 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
10283 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
10284 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
10285 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
10286 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
10287 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
10288 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
10289 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
10290 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
10291 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
10292 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
10293 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
10294 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
10295 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
10296 static tracepoint marker.
10297
10298 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
10299 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
10300
10301 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
10302 conditions and actions.
10303
10304 @menu
10305 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
10306 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
10307 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
10308 * Tracepoint Conditions::
10309 * Trace State Variables::
10310 * Tracepoint Actions::
10311 * Listing Tracepoints::
10312 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
10313 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
10314 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
10315 @end menu
10316
10317 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
10318 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
10319
10320 @table @code
10321 @cindex set tracepoint
10322 @kindex trace
10323 @item trace @var{location}
10324 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
10325 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
10326 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
10327 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
10328 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
10329 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
10330 changing its actions doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
10331 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
10332 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts.
10333
10334 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
10335
10336 @smallexample
10337 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
10338
10339 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
10340
10341 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
10342
10343 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
10344
10345 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
10346 @end smallexample
10347
10348 @noindent
10349 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
10350
10351 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
10352 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
10353 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
10354 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
10355 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
10356 information on tracepoint conditions.
10357
10358 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
10359 @cindex set fast tracepoint
10360 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
10361 @kindex ftrace
10362 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
10363 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
10364 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
10365 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
10366 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
10367 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
10368 message.
10369
10370 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
10371 @code{trace}.
10372
10373 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
10374 @cindex set static tracepoint
10375 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
10376 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
10377 @kindex strace
10378 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
10379 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
10380 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
10381 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
10382 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
10383
10384 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
10385 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
10386 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
10387 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
10388 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
10389 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
10390 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
10391 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
10392 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
10393 tracing engine:
10394
10395 @smallexample
10396 main ()
10397 @{
10398 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
10399 @}
10400 @end smallexample
10401
10402 @noindent
10403 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
10404 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
10405
10406 @smallexample
10407 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
10408 Cnt Enb ID Address What
10409 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
10410 Data: "str %s"
10411 [etc...]
10412 @end smallexample
10413
10414 @noindent
10415 so you may probe the marker above with:
10416
10417 @smallexample
10418 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
10419 @end smallexample
10420
10421 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
10422 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
10423 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
10424 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
10425 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
10426 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
10427 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
10428 the @samp{Data:} field.
10429
10430 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
10431 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
10432 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
10433
10434 @vindex $tpnum
10435 @cindex last tracepoint number
10436 @cindex recent tracepoint number
10437 @cindex tracepoint number
10438 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
10439 of the most recently set tracepoint.
10440
10441 @kindex delete tracepoint
10442 @cindex tracepoint deletion
10443 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10444 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
10445 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
10446 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
10447
10448 Examples:
10449
10450 @smallexample
10451 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
10452
10453 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
10454 @end smallexample
10455
10456 @noindent
10457 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
10458 @end table
10459
10460 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
10461 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
10462
10463 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
10464
10465 @table @code
10466 @kindex disable tracepoint
10467 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10468 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
10469 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
10470 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
10471 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
10472 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
10473 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
10474 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
10475 next trace experiment.
10476
10477 @kindex enable tracepoint
10478 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10479 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
10480 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
10481 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
10482 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
10483 next time a trace experiment is run.
10484 @end table
10485
10486 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
10487 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
10488
10489 @table @code
10490 @kindex passcount
10491 @cindex tracepoint pass count
10492 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
10493 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
10494 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
10495 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
10496 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
10497 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
10498 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
10499 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
10500 user.
10501
10502 Examples:
10503
10504 @smallexample
10505 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
10506 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
10507
10508 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
10509 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
10510 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
10511 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
10512 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
10513 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
10514 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
10515 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
10516 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
10517 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
10518 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
10519 @end smallexample
10520 @end table
10521
10522 @node Tracepoint Conditions
10523 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
10524 @cindex conditional tracepoints
10525 @cindex tracepoint conditions
10526
10527 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
10528 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
10529 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
10530 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
10531 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
10532 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
10533 is true.
10534
10535 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
10536 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
10537 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
10538 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
10539 just as with breakpoints.
10540
10541 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
10542 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
10543 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
10544 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
10545 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
10546 accesses, and so forth.
10547
10548 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
10549 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
10550 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
10551 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
10552 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
10553 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
10554 search through.
10555
10556 @smallexample
10557 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
10558 @end smallexample
10559
10560 @node Trace State Variables
10561 @subsection Trace State Variables
10562 @cindex trace state variables
10563
10564 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
10565 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
10566 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
10567 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
10568 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
10569 integers.
10570
10571 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
10572 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
10573 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
10574 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
10575
10576 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
10577 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
10578 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
10579 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
10580 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
10581 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
10582 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
10583 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
10584 variable with the same name.
10585
10586 @table @code
10587
10588 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
10589 @kindex tvariable
10590 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
10591 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
10592 @var{expression}. @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
10593 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
10594 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
10595 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
10596 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
10597 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
10598 value. The default initial value is 0.
10599
10600 @item info tvariables
10601 @kindex info tvariables
10602 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
10603 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
10604 currently running.
10605
10606 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
10607 @kindex delete tvariable
10608 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
10609 are specified.
10610
10611 @end table
10612
10613 @node Tracepoint Actions
10614 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
10615
10616 @table @code
10617 @kindex actions
10618 @cindex tracepoint actions
10619 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
10620 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
10621 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
10622 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
10623 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
10624 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
10625 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
10626 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
10627 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
10628 @code{while-stepping}.
10629
10630 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
10631 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
10632 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
10633
10634 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
10635 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
10636 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
10637
10638 @smallexample
10639 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
10640
10641 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
10642
10643 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
10644 @end smallexample
10645
10646 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
10647 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
10648 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
10649 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
10650 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
10651 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
10652 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
10653 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
10654
10655 @smallexample
10656 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
10657 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10658 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
10659 > collect bar,baz
10660 > collect $regs
10661 > while-stepping 12
10662 > collect $pc, arr[i]
10663 > end
10664 end
10665 @end smallexample
10666
10667 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
10668 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10669 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
10670 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
10671 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
10672 special arguments are supported:
10673
10674 @table @code
10675 @item $regs
10676 Collect all registers.
10677
10678 @item $args
10679 Collect all function arguments.
10680
10681 @item $locals
10682 Collect all local variables.
10683
10684 @item $_ret
10685 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
10686 of a backtrace.
10687
10688 @item $_sdata
10689 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
10690 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
10691 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
10692 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
10693 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
10694 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
10695 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
10696 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
10697 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
10698
10699 @smallexample
10700 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
10701 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
10702 @end smallexample
10703
10704 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
10705 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
10706 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
10707 @value{GDBN}.
10708 @end table
10709
10710 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
10711 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
10712 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
10713
10714 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
10715 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
10716 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
10717 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
10718 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
10719 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
10720 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
10721 @samp{mystr}.
10722
10723 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
10724 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
10725
10726 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
10727 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10728 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
10729 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
10730 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
10731 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
10732 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
10733 action were used.
10734
10735 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
10736 @item while-stepping @var{n}
10737 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
10738 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
10739 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
10740 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
10741
10742 @smallexample
10743 > while-stepping 12
10744 > collect $regs, myglobal
10745 > end
10746 >
10747 @end smallexample
10748
10749 @noindent
10750 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
10751 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
10752 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
10753 @code{stepping}.
10754
10755 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
10756 @kindex set default-collect
10757 @cindex default collection action
10758 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
10759 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
10760 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
10761 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
10762 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
10763 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
10764
10765 @item show default-collect
10766 @kindex show default-collect
10767 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
10768 tracepoint hit.
10769
10770 @end table
10771
10772 @node Listing Tracepoints
10773 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
10774
10775 @table @code
10776 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
10777 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
10778 @cindex information about tracepoints
10779 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
10780 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
10781 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
10782 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
10783 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
10784 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
10785
10786 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
10787 tracing:
10788
10789 @itemize @bullet
10790 @item
10791 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
10792 @end itemize
10793
10794 @smallexample
10795 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
10796 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
10797 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
10798 while-stepping 20
10799 collect globfoo, $regs
10800 end
10801 collect globfoo2
10802 end
10803 pass count 1200
10804 (@value{GDBP})
10805 @end smallexample
10806
10807 @noindent
10808 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
10809 @end table
10810
10811 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
10812 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
10813
10814 @table @code
10815 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
10816 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
10817 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
10818 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
10819 program.
10820
10821 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
10822
10823 @table @emph
10824 @item Count
10825 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
10826 stable identifier.
10827 @item ID
10828 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
10829 @item Enabled or Disabled
10830 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
10831 that are not enabled.
10832 @item Address
10833 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
10834 @item What
10835 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
10836 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
10837 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
10838 will be left blank.
10839 @end table
10840
10841 @noindent
10842 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
10843
10844 @table @emph
10845 @item Data
10846 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
10847 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
10848 marker call.
10849 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
10850 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
10851 @end table
10852
10853 @smallexample
10854 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
10855 Cnt ID Enb Address What
10856 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
10857 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
10858 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
10859 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
10860 Data: str %s
10861 (@value{GDBP})
10862 @end smallexample
10863 @end table
10864
10865 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
10866 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
10867
10868 @table @code
10869 @kindex tstart
10870 @cindex start a new trace experiment
10871 @cindex collected data discarded
10872 @item tstart
10873 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
10874 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
10875 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
10876 experiment.
10877
10878 @kindex tstop
10879 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
10880 @item tstop
10881 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
10882 stops collecting data.
10883
10884 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
10885 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
10886 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
10887
10888 @kindex tstatus
10889 @cindex status of trace data collection
10890 @cindex trace experiment, status of
10891 @item tstatus
10892 This command displays the status of the current trace data
10893 collection.
10894 @end table
10895
10896 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
10897
10898 @smallexample
10899 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
10900 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
10901 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
10902 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
10903 > while-stepping 11
10904 > collect $regs
10905 > end
10906 > end
10907 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
10908 [time passes @dots{}]
10909 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
10910 @end smallexample
10911
10912 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
10913 @cindex disconnected tracing
10914 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
10915 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
10916 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
10917 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
10918 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
10919 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
10920 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
10921 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
10922
10923 @table @code
10924 @item set disconnected-tracing on
10925 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
10926 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
10927 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
10928 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
10929 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
10930 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
10931 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
10932
10933 @item show disconnected-tracing
10934 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
10935 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
10936
10937 @end table
10938
10939 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
10940 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
10941 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
10942 it will continue after reconnection.
10943
10944 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
10945 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
10946 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
10947 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
10948 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
10949 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
10950 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
10951 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
10952 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
10953 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
10954
10955 @cindex circular trace buffer
10956 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
10957 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
10958 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
10959 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
10960 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
10961 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
10962 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
10963 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
10964 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
10965 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
10966 the next run.
10967
10968 @table @code
10969 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
10970 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
10971 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
10972 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
10973 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
10974 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
10975 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
10976
10977 @item show circular-trace-buffer
10978 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
10979 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
10980 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
10981 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
10982 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
10983
10984 @end table
10985
10986 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
10987 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
10988
10989 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
10990 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
10991 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
10992 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
10993 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
10994 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
10995 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
10996 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
10997 mentioned here.
10998
10999 @itemize @bullet
11000
11001 @item
11002 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
11003 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
11004 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
11005 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
11006 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
11007 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
11008 cannot be collected either.
11009
11010 @item
11011 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
11012 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
11013 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
11014 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
11015 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
11016 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
11017 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
11018 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
11019 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
11020 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
11021
11022 @item
11023 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
11024 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
11025 in a misleading way.
11026
11027 @item
11028 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
11029 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
11030 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
11031 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
11032 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
11033 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
11034 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
11035 by @code{ptr}.
11036
11037 @item
11038 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
11039 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
11040 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
11041 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
11042 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
11043 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
11044 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
11045 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
11046 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
11047 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
11048 invalid address.
11049
11050 @item
11051 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
11052 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
11053 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
11054 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
11055 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
11056 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
11057 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
11058 it to zero.
11059
11060 @end itemize
11061
11062 @node Analyze Collected Data
11063 @section Using the Collected Data
11064
11065 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
11066 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
11067 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
11068 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
11069 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
11070 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
11071 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
11072 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
11073 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
11074 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
11075 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
11076 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
11077 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
11078 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
11079 the buffer will fail.
11080
11081 @menu
11082 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
11083 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
11084 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
11085 @end menu
11086
11087 @node tfind
11088 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
11089
11090 @kindex tfind
11091 @cindex select trace snapshot
11092 @cindex find trace snapshot
11093 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
11094 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
11095 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
11096 snapshot is selected.
11097
11098 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
11099
11100 @table @code
11101 @item tfind start
11102 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
11103 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
11104
11105 @item tfind none
11106 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
11107
11108 @item tfind end
11109 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
11110
11111 @item tfind
11112 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
11113
11114 @item tfind -
11115 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
11116 retracing earlier steps.
11117
11118 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
11119 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
11120 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
11121 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
11122 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
11123
11124 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
11125 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
11126 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
11127 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
11128 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
11129
11130 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
11131 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
11132 addresses (exclusive).
11133
11134 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
11135 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
11136 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
11137
11138 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
11139 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
11140 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
11141 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
11142 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
11143 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
11144 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
11145 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
11146 @end table
11147
11148 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
11149 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
11150 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
11151 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
11152 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
11153 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
11154 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
11155 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
11156 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
11157 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
11158 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
11159 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
11160 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
11161 tracepoint as the current one.
11162
11163 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
11164 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
11165 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
11166 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
11167 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
11168
11169 @smallexample
11170 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
11171 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
11172 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
11173 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
11174 > tfind
11175 > end
11176
11177 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
11178 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
11179 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
11180 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
11181 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
11182 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
11183 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
11184 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
11185 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
11186 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
11187 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
11188 @end smallexample
11189
11190 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
11191 the buffer:
11192
11193 @smallexample
11194 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
11195 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
11196 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
11197 > tfind line
11198 > end
11199
11200 Frame 0, X = 1
11201 Frame 7, X = 2
11202 Frame 13, X = 255
11203 @end smallexample
11204
11205 @node tdump
11206 @subsection @code{tdump}
11207 @kindex tdump
11208 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
11209 @cindex tracepoint data, display
11210
11211 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
11212 the current trace snapshot.
11213
11214 @smallexample
11215 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
11216 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
11217 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
11218 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
11219 > end
11220
11221 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
11222
11223 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
11224 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
11225 at gdb_test.c:444
11226 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
11227
11228 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
11229 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
11230 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
11231 d1 0x18 24
11232 d2 0x80 128
11233 d3 0x33 51
11234 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
11235 d5 0x22 34
11236 d6 0xe0 224
11237 d7 0x380035 3670069
11238 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
11239 a1 0x3000668 50333288
11240 a2 0x100 256
11241 a3 0x322000 3284992
11242 a4 0x3000698 50333336
11243 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
11244 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
11245 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
11246 ps 0x0 0
11247 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
11248 fpcontrol 0x0 0
11249 fpstatus 0x0 0
11250 fpiaddr 0x0 0
11251 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
11252 p1 = (void *) 0x11
11253 p2 = (void *) 0x22
11254 p3 = (void *) 0x33
11255 p4 = (void *) 0x44
11256 p5 = (void *) 0x55
11257 p6 = (void *) 0x66
11258 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
11259
11260 (@value{GDBP})
11261 @end smallexample
11262
11263 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
11264 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
11265 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
11266 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
11267
11268 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
11269 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
11270 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
11271 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
11272 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
11273 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
11274 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
11275 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
11276 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
11277 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
11278
11279 @node save tracepoints
11280 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
11281 @kindex save tracepoints
11282 @kindex save-tracepoints
11283 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
11284
11285 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
11286 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
11287 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
11288 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
11289 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
11290 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
11291
11292 @node Tracepoint Variables
11293 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
11294 @cindex tracepoint variables
11295 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
11296
11297 @table @code
11298 @vindex $trace_frame
11299 @item (int) $trace_frame
11300 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
11301 snapshot is selected.
11302
11303 @vindex $tracepoint
11304 @item (int) $tracepoint
11305 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
11306
11307 @vindex $trace_line
11308 @item (int) $trace_line
11309 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
11310
11311 @vindex $trace_file
11312 @item (char []) $trace_file
11313 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
11314
11315 @vindex $trace_func
11316 @item (char []) $trace_func
11317 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
11318 @end table
11319
11320 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
11321 use @code{output} instead.
11322
11323 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
11324 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
11325 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
11326 which are managed by the target.
11327
11328 @smallexample
11329 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
11330
11331 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
11332 > output $trace_file
11333 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
11334 > tfind
11335 > end
11336 @end smallexample
11337
11338 @node Trace Files
11339 @section Using Trace Files
11340 @cindex trace files
11341
11342 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
11343 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
11344 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
11345 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
11346 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
11347
11348 @table @code
11349
11350 @kindex tsave
11351 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
11352 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
11353 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
11354 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
11355 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
11356 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
11357 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
11358 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
11359 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
11360
11361 @kindex target tfile
11362 @kindex tfile
11363 @item target tfile @var{filename}
11364 Use the file named @var{filename} as a source of trace data. Commands
11365 that examine data work as they do with a live target, but it is not
11366 possible to run any new trace experiments. @code{tstatus} will report
11367 the state of the trace run at the moment the data was saved, as well
11368 as the current trace frame you are examining. @var{filename} must be
11369 on a filesystem accessible to the host.
11370
11371 @end table
11372
11373 @node Overlays
11374 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
11375 @cindex overlays
11376
11377 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
11378 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
11379 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
11380 use overlays.
11381
11382 @menu
11383 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
11384 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
11385 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
11386 mapped by asking the inferior.
11387 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
11388 @end menu
11389
11390 @node How Overlays Work
11391 @section How Overlays Work
11392 @cindex mapped overlays
11393 @cindex unmapped overlays
11394 @cindex load address, overlay's
11395 @cindex mapped address
11396 @cindex overlay area
11397
11398 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
11399 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
11400 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
11401 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
11402 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
11403
11404 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
11405 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
11406 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
11407 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
11408 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
11409 largest overlay as well.
11410
11411 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
11412 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
11413 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
11414 there.
11415
11416 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
11417 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
11418 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
11419
11420 @smallexample
11421 @group
11422 Data Instruction Larger
11423 Address Space Address Space Address Space
11424 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
11425 | | | | | |
11426 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
11427 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
11428 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
11429 | and heap | | | | | |
11430 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
11431 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
11432 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
11433 | | | | | |
11434 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
11435 address | | | | | |
11436 | overlay | <-' | | |
11437 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
11438 | | <---. | | load address
11439 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
11440 | | | |
11441 +-----------+ | |
11442 +-----------+
11443 | |
11444 +-----------+
11445
11446 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
11447 @end group
11448 @end smallexample
11449
11450 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
11451 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
11452 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
11453 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
11454 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
11455 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
11456 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
11457 program and the overlay area.
11458
11459 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
11460 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
11461 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
11462 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
11463 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
11464 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
11465 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
11466
11467 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
11468 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
11469 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
11470
11471 @itemize @bullet
11472
11473 @item
11474 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
11475 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
11476 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
11477 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
11478
11479 @item
11480 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
11481 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
11482 your program's performance.
11483
11484 @item
11485 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
11486 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
11487 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
11488 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
11489 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
11490 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
11491 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
11492
11493 @item
11494 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
11495 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
11496 instruction and data spaces.
11497
11498 @end itemize
11499
11500 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
11501 improved in many ways:
11502
11503 @itemize @bullet
11504
11505 @item
11506 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
11507 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
11508 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
11509 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
11510 area in the usual way.
11511
11512 @item
11513 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
11514 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
11515
11516 @item
11517 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
11518 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
11519 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
11520 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
11521 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
11522 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
11523 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
11524
11525 @end itemize
11526
11527
11528 @node Overlay Commands
11529 @section Overlay Commands
11530
11531 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
11532 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
11533 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
11534 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
11535 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
11536 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
11537
11538 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
11539 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
11540
11541 @table @code
11542 @item overlay off
11543 @kindex overlay
11544 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
11545 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
11546 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
11547 overlay support is disabled.
11548
11549 @item overlay manual
11550 @cindex manual overlay debugging
11551 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
11552 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
11553 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
11554 commands described below.
11555
11556 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
11557 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
11558 @cindex map an overlay
11559 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
11560 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
11561 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
11562 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
11563 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
11564 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
11565
11566 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
11567 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
11568 @cindex unmap an overlay
11569 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
11570 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
11571 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
11572 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
11573
11574 @item overlay auto
11575 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
11576 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
11577 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
11578 Overlay Debugging}.
11579
11580 @item overlay load-target
11581 @itemx overlay load
11582 @cindex reloading the overlay table
11583 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
11584 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
11585 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
11586 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
11587 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
11588
11589 @item overlay list-overlays
11590 @itemx overlay list
11591 @cindex listing mapped overlays
11592 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
11593 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
11594
11595 @end table
11596
11597 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
11598 of the function the address falls in:
11599
11600 @smallexample
11601 (@value{GDBP}) print main
11602 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
11603 @end smallexample
11604 @noindent
11605 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
11606 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
11607 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
11608 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
11609
11610 @smallexample
11611 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
11612 No sections are mapped.
11613 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
11614 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
11615 @end smallexample
11616 @noindent
11617 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
11618 name normally:
11619
11620 @smallexample
11621 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
11622 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
11623 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
11624 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
11625 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
11626 @end smallexample
11627
11628 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
11629 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
11630 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
11631 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
11632 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
11633
11634 @itemize @bullet
11635 @item
11636 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
11637 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
11638 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
11639 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
11640 @item
11641 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
11642 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
11643 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
11644 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
11645 breakpoints properly.
11646 @end itemize
11647
11648
11649 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
11650 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
11651 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
11652
11653 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
11654 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
11655 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
11656 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
11657 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
11658 current state of the overlays.
11659
11660 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
11661 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
11662
11663 @table @asis
11664
11665 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
11666 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
11667
11668 @smallexample
11669 struct
11670 @{
11671 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
11672 unsigned long vma;
11673
11674 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
11675 unsigned long size;
11676
11677 /* The overlay's load address. */
11678 unsigned long lma;
11679
11680 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
11681 zero otherwise. */
11682 unsigned long mapped;
11683 @}
11684 @end smallexample
11685
11686 @item @code{_novlys}:
11687 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
11688 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
11689
11690 @end table
11691
11692 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
11693 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
11694 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
11695 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
11696 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
11697 currently mapped.
11698
11699 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
11700 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
11701 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
11702 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
11703 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
11704 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
11705 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
11706 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
11707 are not being executed.
11708
11709 @node Overlay Sample Program
11710 @section Overlay Sample Program
11711 @cindex overlay example program
11712
11713 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
11714 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
11715 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
11716 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
11717 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
11718 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
11719 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
11720
11721 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
11722 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
11723 suite. The program consists of the following files from
11724 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
11725
11726 @table @file
11727 @item overlays.c
11728 The main program file.
11729 @item ovlymgr.c
11730 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
11731 @item foo.c
11732 @itemx bar.c
11733 @itemx baz.c
11734 @itemx grbx.c
11735 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
11736 @item d10v.ld
11737 @itemx m32r.ld
11738 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
11739 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
11740 @end table
11741
11742 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
11743 cross-compiler like this:
11744
11745 @smallexample
11746 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
11747 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
11748 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
11749 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
11750 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
11751 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
11752 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
11753 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
11754 @end smallexample
11755
11756 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
11757 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
11758 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
11759
11760
11761 @node Languages
11762 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
11763 @cindex languages
11764
11765 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
11766 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
11767 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
11768 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
11769 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
11770 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
11771
11772 @cindex working language
11773 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
11774 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
11775 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
11776 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
11777 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
11778 language}.
11779
11780 @menu
11781 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
11782 * Show:: Displaying the language
11783 * Checks:: Type and range checks
11784 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
11785 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
11786 @end menu
11787
11788 @node Setting
11789 @section Switching Between Source Languages
11790
11791 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
11792 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
11793 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
11794 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
11795 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
11796 are printed, etc.
11797
11798 In addition to the working language, every source file that
11799 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
11800 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
11801 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
11802 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
11803 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
11804 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
11805 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
11806 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
11807 Displaying the Language}.
11808
11809 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
11810 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
11811 another language. In that case, make the
11812 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
11813 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
11814 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
11815
11816 @menu
11817 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
11818 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
11819 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
11820 @end menu
11821
11822 @node Filenames
11823 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
11824
11825 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
11826 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
11827
11828 @table @file
11829 @item .ada
11830 @itemx .ads
11831 @itemx .adb
11832 @itemx .a
11833 Ada source file.
11834
11835 @item .c
11836 C source file
11837
11838 @item .C
11839 @itemx .cc
11840 @itemx .cp
11841 @itemx .cpp
11842 @itemx .cxx
11843 @itemx .c++
11844 C@t{++} source file
11845
11846 @item .d
11847 D source file
11848
11849 @item .m
11850 Objective-C source file
11851
11852 @item .f
11853 @itemx .F
11854 Fortran source file
11855
11856 @item .mod
11857 Modula-2 source file
11858
11859 @item .s
11860 @itemx .S
11861 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
11862 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
11863 @end table
11864
11865 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
11866 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
11867
11868 @node Manually
11869 @subsection Setting the Working Language
11870
11871 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
11872 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
11873 your program.
11874
11875 @kindex set language
11876 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
11877 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
11878 a language, such as
11879 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
11880 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
11881
11882 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
11883 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
11884 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
11885 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
11886 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
11887 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
11888 command such as:
11889
11890 @smallexample
11891 print a = b + c
11892 @end smallexample
11893
11894 @noindent
11895 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
11896 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
11897 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
11898 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
11899
11900 @node Automatically
11901 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
11902
11903 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
11904 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
11905 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
11906 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
11907 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
11908 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
11909 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
11910 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
11911 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
11912
11913 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
11914 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
11915 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
11916 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
11917 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
11918
11919 @node Show
11920 @section Displaying the Language
11921
11922 The following commands help you find out which language is the
11923 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
11924
11925 @table @code
11926 @item show language
11927 @kindex show language
11928 Display the current working language. This is the
11929 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
11930 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
11931
11932 @item info frame
11933 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
11934 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
11935 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
11936 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
11937 information listed here.
11938
11939 @item info source
11940 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
11941 Display the source language of this source file.
11942 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
11943 information listed here.
11944 @end table
11945
11946 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
11947 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
11948 with a language explicitly:
11949
11950 @table @code
11951 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
11952 @kindex set extension-language
11953 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
11954 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
11955
11956 @item info extensions
11957 @kindex info extensions
11958 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
11959 @end table
11960
11961 @node Checks
11962 @section Type and Range Checking
11963
11964 @quotation
11965 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
11966 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
11967 section documents the intended facilities.
11968 @end quotation
11969 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
11970
11971 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
11972 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
11973 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
11974 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
11975 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
11976 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
11977 errors when your program is running.
11978
11979 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
11980 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
11981 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
11982 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
11983 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
11984 automatically based on your program's source language.
11985 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
11986 settings of supported languages.
11987
11988 @menu
11989 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
11990 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
11991 @end menu
11992
11993 @cindex type checking
11994 @cindex checks, type
11995 @node Type Checking
11996 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
11997
11998 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
11999 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
12000 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
12001 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
12002
12003 @smallexample
12004 1 + 2 @result{} 3
12005 @exdent but
12006 @error{} 1 + 2.3
12007 @end smallexample
12008
12009 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
12010 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
12011
12012 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
12013 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
12014 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
12015 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
12016 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
12017 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
12018 also issues a warning.
12019
12020 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
12021 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
12022 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
12023 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
12024 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
12025 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
12026
12027 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
12028 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
12029 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
12030 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
12031 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
12032 details on specific languages.
12033
12034 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
12035
12036 @kindex set check type
12037 @kindex show check type
12038 @table @code
12039 @item set check type auto
12040 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
12041 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
12042 each language.
12043
12044 @item set check type on
12045 @itemx set check type off
12046 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
12047 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
12048 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
12049 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
12050 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
12051
12052 @item set check type warn
12053 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
12054 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
12055 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
12056 numbers and structures.
12057
12058 @item show type
12059 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
12060 is setting it automatically.
12061 @end table
12062
12063 @cindex range checking
12064 @cindex checks, range
12065 @node Range Checking
12066 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
12067
12068 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
12069 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
12070 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
12071 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
12072 not exceed the bounds of the array.
12073
12074 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
12075 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
12076 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
12077 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
12078
12079 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
12080 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
12081 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
12082 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
12083 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
12084 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
12085
12086 @smallexample
12087 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
12088 @end smallexample
12089
12090 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
12091 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
12092 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
12093
12094 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
12095
12096 @kindex set check range
12097 @kindex show check range
12098 @table @code
12099 @item set check range auto
12100 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
12101 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
12102 each language.
12103
12104 @item set check range on
12105 @itemx set check range off
12106 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
12107 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
12108 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
12109 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
12110
12111 @item set check range warn
12112 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
12113 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
12114 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
12115 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
12116 systems).
12117
12118 @item show range
12119 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
12120 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
12121 @end table
12122
12123 @node Supported Languages
12124 @section Supported Languages
12125
12126 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, OpenCL C, Pascal,
12127 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
12128 @c This is false ...
12129 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
12130 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
12131 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
12132 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
12133 language.
12134
12135 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
12136 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
12137 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
12138 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
12139 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
12140 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
12141 language reference or tutorial.
12142
12143 @menu
12144 * C:: C and C@t{++}
12145 * D:: D
12146 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
12147 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
12148 * Fortran:: Fortran
12149 * Pascal:: Pascal
12150 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
12151 * Ada:: Ada
12152 @end menu
12153
12154 @node C
12155 @subsection C and C@t{++}
12156
12157 @cindex C and C@t{++}
12158 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
12159
12160 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
12161 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
12162 together.
12163
12164 @cindex C@t{++}
12165 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
12166 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
12167 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
12168 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
12169 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
12170 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
12171 compiler (@code{aCC}).
12172
12173 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
12174 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
12175 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
12176 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
12177 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
12178 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
12179
12180 @menu
12181 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
12182 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
12183 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
12184 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
12185 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
12186 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
12187 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
12188 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
12189 @end menu
12190
12191 @node C Operators
12192 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
12193
12194 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
12195
12196 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
12197 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
12198 often defined on groups of types.
12199
12200 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
12201
12202 @itemize @bullet
12203
12204 @item
12205 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
12206 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
12207
12208 @item
12209 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
12210 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
12211
12212 @item
12213 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
12214
12215 @item
12216 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
12217
12218 @end itemize
12219
12220 @noindent
12221 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
12222 in order of increasing precedence:
12223
12224 @table @code
12225 @item ,
12226 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
12227 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
12228 expression being the last expression evaluated.
12229
12230 @item =
12231 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
12232 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
12233
12234 @item @var{op}=
12235 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
12236 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
12237 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
12238 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
12239 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
12240
12241 @item ?:
12242 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
12243 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
12244 integral type.
12245
12246 @item ||
12247 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
12248
12249 @item &&
12250 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
12251
12252 @item |
12253 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
12254
12255 @item ^
12256 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
12257
12258 @item &
12259 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
12260
12261 @item ==@r{, }!=
12262 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
12263 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
12264
12265 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
12266 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
12267 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
12268 and non-zero for true.
12269
12270 @item <<@r{, }>>
12271 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
12272
12273 @item @@
12274 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
12275
12276 @item +@r{, }-
12277 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
12278 pointer types.
12279
12280 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
12281 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
12282 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
12283 integral types.
12284
12285 @item ++@r{, }--
12286 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
12287 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
12288 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
12289 operation takes place.
12290
12291 @item *
12292 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
12293 @code{++}.
12294
12295 @item &
12296 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
12297
12298 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
12299 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
12300 to examine the address
12301 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
12302 stored.
12303
12304 @item -
12305 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
12306 precedence as @code{++}.
12307
12308 @item !
12309 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
12310 @code{++}.
12311
12312 @item ~
12313 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
12314 @code{++}.
12315
12316
12317 @item .@r{, }->
12318 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
12319 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
12320 pointer based on the stored type information.
12321 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
12322
12323 @item .*@r{, }->*
12324 Dereferences of pointers to members.
12325
12326 @item []
12327 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
12328 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
12329
12330 @item ()
12331 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
12332
12333 @item ::
12334 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
12335 and @code{class} types.
12336
12337 @item ::
12338 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
12339 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
12340 above.
12341 @end table
12342
12343 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
12344 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
12345 predefined meaning.
12346
12347 @node C Constants
12348 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
12349
12350 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
12351
12352 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
12353 following ways:
12354
12355 @itemize @bullet
12356 @item
12357 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
12358 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
12359 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
12360 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
12361 @code{long} value.
12362
12363 @item
12364 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
12365 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
12366 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
12367 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
12368 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
12369 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
12370 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
12371 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
12372 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
12373 constant.
12374
12375 @item
12376 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
12377 integral equivalents.
12378
12379 @item
12380 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
12381 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
12382 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
12383 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
12384 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
12385 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
12386 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
12387 @samp{\n} for newline.
12388
12389 @item
12390 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
12391 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
12392 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
12393 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
12394 characters.
12395
12396 @item
12397 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
12398 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
12399
12400 @item
12401 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
12402 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
12403 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
12404 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
12405 @end itemize
12406
12407 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
12408 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
12409
12410 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
12411 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
12412
12413 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
12414 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
12415 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
12416 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
12417 @quotation
12418 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
12419 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
12420 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
12421 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
12422 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
12423 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
12424 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
12425 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
12426 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
12427 C@t{++} code.
12428 @end quotation
12429
12430 @enumerate
12431
12432 @cindex member functions
12433 @item
12434 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
12435
12436 @smallexample
12437 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
12438 @end smallexample
12439
12440 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
12441 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
12442 @item
12443 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
12444 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
12445 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
12446 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
12447
12448 @cindex call overloaded functions
12449 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
12450 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
12451 @item
12452 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
12453 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
12454 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
12455 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
12456 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
12457 default arguments.
12458
12459 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
12460 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
12461 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
12462 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
12463 number of function arguments.
12464
12465 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
12466 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
12467 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
12468
12469 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
12470 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
12471 @smallexample
12472 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
12473 @end smallexample
12474
12475 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
12476 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
12477
12478 @cindex reference declarations
12479 @item
12480 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
12481 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
12482 dereferenced.
12483
12484 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
12485 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
12486 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
12487 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
12488 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
12489
12490 @item
12491 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
12492 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
12493 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
12494 necessary, for example in an expression like
12495 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
12496 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
12497 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
12498 @end enumerate
12499
12500 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
12501 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
12502 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
12503 invoking user-defined operators.
12504
12505 @node C Defaults
12506 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
12507
12508 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
12509
12510 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
12511 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
12512 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
12513 selects the working language.
12514
12515 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
12516 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
12517 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
12518 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
12519 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
12520 for further details.
12521
12522 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
12523 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
12524 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
12525
12526 @node C Checks
12527 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
12528
12529 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
12530
12531 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
12532 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
12533 considers two variables type equivalent if:
12534
12535 @itemize @bullet
12536 @item
12537 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
12538 enumerated tag.
12539
12540 @item
12541 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
12542 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
12543
12544 @ignore
12545 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
12546 @c FIXME--beers?
12547 @item
12548 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
12549 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
12550 compilers.)
12551 @end ignore
12552 @end itemize
12553
12554 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
12555 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
12556 that is not itself an array.
12557
12558 @node Debugging C
12559 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
12560
12561 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
12562 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
12563 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
12564 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
12565
12566 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
12567 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
12568 ,Expressions}.
12569
12570 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
12571 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
12572
12573 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
12574
12575 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
12576 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
12577
12578 @table @code
12579 @cindex break in overloaded functions
12580 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
12581 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
12582 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
12583 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
12584 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
12585
12586 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
12587 @item rbreak @var{regex}
12588 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
12589 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
12590 classes.
12591 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
12592
12593 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
12594 @item catch throw
12595 @itemx catch catch
12596 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
12597 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
12598
12599 @cindex inheritance
12600 @item ptype @var{typename}
12601 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
12602 @var{typename}.
12603 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
12604
12605 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
12606 @item set print demangle
12607 @itemx show print demangle
12608 @itemx set print asm-demangle
12609 @itemx show print asm-demangle
12610 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
12611 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
12612 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12613
12614 @item set print object
12615 @itemx show print object
12616 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
12617 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12618
12619 @item set print vtbl
12620 @itemx show print vtbl
12621 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
12622 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
12623 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
12624 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
12625
12626 @kindex set overload-resolution
12627 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
12628 @item set overload-resolution on
12629 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
12630 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
12631 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
12632 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
12633 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
12634 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
12635
12636 @item set overload-resolution off
12637 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
12638 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
12639 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
12640 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
12641 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
12642 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
12643 argument types.
12644
12645 @kindex show overload-resolution
12646 @item show overload-resolution
12647 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
12648
12649 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
12650 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
12651 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
12652 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
12653 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
12654 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
12655 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
12656 @end table
12657
12658 @node Decimal Floating Point
12659 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
12660 @cindex decimal floating point format
12661
12662 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
12663 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
12664 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
12665 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
12666
12667 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
12668 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
12669 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
12670 target.
12671
12672 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
12673 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
12674 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
12675
12676 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
12677 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
12678 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
12679
12680 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
12681 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
12682 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
12683
12684 @node D
12685 @subsection D
12686
12687 @cindex D
12688 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
12689 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
12690 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
12691
12692 @node Objective-C
12693 @subsection Objective-C
12694
12695 @cindex Objective-C
12696 This section provides information about some commands and command
12697 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
12698 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
12699 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
12700
12701 @menu
12702 * Method Names in Commands::
12703 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
12704 @end menu
12705
12706 @node Method Names in Commands
12707 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
12708
12709 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
12710 names as line specifications:
12711
12712 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
12713 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
12714 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
12715 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
12716 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
12717 @itemize
12718 @item @code{clear}
12719 @item @code{break}
12720 @item @code{info line}
12721 @item @code{jump}
12722 @item @code{list}
12723 @end itemize
12724
12725 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
12726
12727 @smallexample
12728 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
12729 @end smallexample
12730
12731 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
12732 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
12733 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
12734 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
12735 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
12736 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
12737 debugged, enter:
12738
12739 @smallexample
12740 break -[Fruit create]
12741 @end smallexample
12742
12743 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
12744 enter:
12745
12746 @smallexample
12747 list +[NSText initialize]
12748 @end smallexample
12749
12750 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
12751 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
12752 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
12753 is also possible to specify just a method name:
12754
12755 @smallexample
12756 break create
12757 @end smallexample
12758
12759 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
12760 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
12761 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
12762 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
12763 none apply.
12764
12765 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
12766 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
12767
12768 @smallexample
12769 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
12770 @end smallexample
12771
12772 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
12773 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
12774 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
12775 @kindex print-object
12776 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
12777
12778 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
12779
12780 @smallexample
12781 print -[@var{object} hash]
12782 @end smallexample
12783
12784 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
12785 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
12786 @noindent
12787 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
12788 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
12789 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
12790 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
12791 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
12792 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
12793
12794 @node OpenCL C
12795 @subsection OpenCL C
12796
12797 @cindex OpenCL C
12798 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
12799
12800 @menu
12801 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
12802 * OpenCL C Expressions::
12803 * OpenCL C Operators::
12804 @end menu
12805
12806 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
12807 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
12808
12809 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
12810 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
12811 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
12812 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
12813 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
12814
12815 @node OpenCL C Expressions
12816 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
12817
12818 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
12819 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
12820 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
12821 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
12822
12823 @node OpenCL C Operators
12824 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
12825
12826 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
12827 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
12828 vector data types.
12829
12830 @node Fortran
12831 @subsection Fortran
12832 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
12833
12834 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
12835 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
12836
12837 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
12838 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
12839 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
12840 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
12841 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
12842 underscore.
12843
12844 @menu
12845 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
12846 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
12847 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
12848 @end menu
12849
12850 @node Fortran Operators
12851 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
12852
12853 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
12854
12855 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
12856 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
12857 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
12858
12859 @table @code
12860 @item **
12861 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
12862 of the second one.
12863
12864 @item :
12865 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
12866 represent a section of array.
12867
12868 @item %
12869 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
12870 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
12871 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
12872 union type.
12873 @end table
12874
12875 @node Fortran Defaults
12876 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
12877
12878 @cindex Fortran Defaults
12879
12880 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
12881 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
12882 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
12883 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
12884
12885 @node Special Fortran Commands
12886 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
12887
12888 @cindex Special Fortran commands
12889
12890 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
12891 such as displaying common blocks.
12892
12893 @table @code
12894 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
12895 @kindex info common
12896 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
12897 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
12898 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
12899 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
12900 printed.
12901 @end table
12902
12903 @node Pascal
12904 @subsection Pascal
12905
12906 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
12907 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
12908 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
12909 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
12910 syntax.
12911
12912 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
12913 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
12914 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
12915
12916 @node Modula-2
12917 @subsection Modula-2
12918
12919 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
12920
12921 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
12922 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
12923 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
12924 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
12925 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
12926 table.
12927
12928 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
12929 @menu
12930 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
12931 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
12932 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
12933 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
12934 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
12935 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
12936 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
12937 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
12938 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
12939 @end menu
12940
12941 @node M2 Operators
12942 @subsubsection Operators
12943 @cindex Modula-2 operators
12944
12945 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
12946 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
12947 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
12948 following definitions hold:
12949
12950 @itemize @bullet
12951
12952 @item
12953 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
12954 their subranges.
12955
12956 @item
12957 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
12958
12959 @item
12960 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
12961
12962 @item
12963 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
12964 @var{type}}.
12965
12966 @item
12967 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
12968
12969 @item
12970 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
12971
12972 @item
12973 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
12974 @end itemize
12975
12976 @noindent
12977 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
12978 increasing precedence:
12979
12980 @table @code
12981 @item ,
12982 Function argument or array index separator.
12983
12984 @item :=
12985 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
12986 @var{value}.
12987
12988 @item <@r{, }>
12989 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
12990 types.
12991
12992 @item <=@r{, }>=
12993 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
12994 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
12995 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
12996
12997 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
12998 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
12999 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
13000 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
13001 comment character.
13002
13003 @item IN
13004 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
13005 Same precedence as @code{<}.
13006
13007 @item OR
13008 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
13009
13010 @item AND@r{, }&
13011 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
13012
13013 @item @@
13014 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
13015
13016 @item +@r{, }-
13017 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
13018 and difference on set types.
13019
13020 @item *
13021 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
13022 on set types.
13023
13024 @item /
13025 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
13026 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
13027
13028 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
13029 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
13030 precedence as @code{*}.
13031
13032 @item -
13033 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
13034
13035 @item ^
13036 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
13037
13038 @item NOT
13039 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
13040 @code{^}.
13041
13042 @item .
13043 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
13044 precedence as @code{^}.
13045
13046 @item []
13047 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
13048
13049 @item ()
13050 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
13051 as @code{^}.
13052
13053 @item ::@r{, }.
13054 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
13055 @end table
13056
13057 @quotation
13058 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
13059 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
13060 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
13061 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
13062 @end quotation
13063
13064
13065 @node Built-In Func/Proc
13066 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
13067 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
13068
13069 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
13070 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
13071
13072 @table @var
13073
13074 @item a
13075 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
13076
13077 @item c
13078 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
13079
13080 @item i
13081 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
13082
13083 @item m
13084 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
13085 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
13086 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
13087
13088 @item n
13089 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
13090
13091 @item r
13092 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
13093
13094 @item t
13095 represents a type.
13096
13097 @item v
13098 represents a variable.
13099
13100 @item x
13101 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
13102 explanation of the function for details.
13103 @end table
13104
13105 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
13106
13107 @table @code
13108 @item ABS(@var{n})
13109 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
13110
13111 @item CAP(@var{c})
13112 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
13113 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
13114
13115 @item CHR(@var{i})
13116 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
13117
13118 @item DEC(@var{v})
13119 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
13120
13121 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
13122 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
13123 new value.
13124
13125 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
13126 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
13127 set.
13128
13129 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
13130 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
13131
13132 @item HIGH(@var{a})
13133 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
13134
13135 @item INC(@var{v})
13136 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
13137
13138 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
13139 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
13140 new value.
13141
13142 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
13143 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
13144 there. Returns the new set.
13145
13146 @item MAX(@var{t})
13147 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
13148
13149 @item MIN(@var{t})
13150 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
13151
13152 @item ODD(@var{i})
13153 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
13154
13155 @item ORD(@var{x})
13156 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
13157 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
13158 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
13159 integral, character and enumerated types.
13160
13161 @item SIZE(@var{x})
13162 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
13163
13164 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
13165 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
13166
13167 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
13168 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
13169
13170 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
13171 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
13172 @end table
13173
13174 @quotation
13175 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
13176 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
13177 an error.
13178 @end quotation
13179
13180 @cindex Modula-2 constants
13181 @node M2 Constants
13182 @subsubsection Constants
13183
13184 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
13185 ways:
13186
13187 @itemize @bullet
13188
13189 @item
13190 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
13191 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
13192 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
13193 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
13194
13195 @item
13196 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
13197 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
13198 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
13199 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
13200 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
13201 digits.
13202
13203 @item
13204 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
13205 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
13206 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
13207 followed by a @samp{C}.
13208
13209 @item
13210 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
13211 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
13212 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
13213 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
13214 sequences.
13215
13216 @item
13217 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
13218
13219 @item
13220 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
13221 @code{FALSE}.
13222
13223 @item
13224 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
13225
13226 @item
13227 Set constants are not yet supported.
13228 @end itemize
13229
13230 @node M2 Types
13231 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
13232 @cindex Modula-2 types
13233
13234 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
13235 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
13236 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
13237 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
13238 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
13239 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
13240
13241 The first example contains the following section of code:
13242
13243 @smallexample
13244 VAR
13245 s: SET OF CHAR ;
13246 r: [20..40] ;
13247 @end smallexample
13248
13249 @noindent
13250 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
13251 @code{r} and @code{s}.
13252
13253 @smallexample
13254 (@value{GDBP}) print s
13255 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
13256 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
13257 SET OF CHAR
13258 (@value{GDBP}) print r
13259 21
13260 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
13261 [20..40]
13262 @end smallexample
13263
13264 @noindent
13265 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
13266
13267 @smallexample
13268 VAR
13269 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
13270 @end smallexample
13271
13272 @noindent
13273 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
13274
13275 @smallexample
13276 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
13277 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
13278 @end smallexample
13279
13280 @noindent
13281 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
13282 expressions using the debugger.
13283
13284 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
13285 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
13286
13287 @smallexample
13288 VAR
13289 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
13290 @end smallexample
13291
13292 @smallexample
13293 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
13294 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
13295 @end smallexample
13296
13297 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
13298 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
13299 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
13300 above.
13301
13302 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
13303
13304 @smallexample
13305 TYPE
13306 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
13307 t = [blue..yellow] ;
13308 VAR
13309 s: t ;
13310 BEGIN
13311 s := blue ;
13312 @end smallexample
13313
13314 @noindent
13315 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
13316 and value of a variable.
13317
13318 @smallexample
13319 (@value{GDBP}) print s
13320 $1 = blue
13321 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
13322 type = [blue..yellow]
13323 @end smallexample
13324
13325 @noindent
13326 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
13327 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
13328 their @code{C} counterparts.
13329
13330 @smallexample
13331 VAR
13332 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
13333 BEGIN
13334 s[1] := 1 ;
13335 @end smallexample
13336
13337 @smallexample
13338 (@value{GDBP}) print s
13339 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
13340 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
13341 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
13342 @end smallexample
13343
13344 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
13345 pointer types as shown in this example:
13346
13347 @smallexample
13348 VAR
13349 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
13350 BEGIN
13351 NEW(s) ;
13352 s^[1] := 1 ;
13353 @end smallexample
13354
13355 @noindent
13356 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
13357
13358 @smallexample
13359 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
13360 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
13361 @end smallexample
13362
13363 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
13364 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
13365 types:
13366
13367 @smallexample
13368 TYPE
13369 foo = RECORD
13370 f1: CARDINAL ;
13371 f2: CHAR ;
13372 f3: myarray ;
13373 END ;
13374
13375 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
13376 myrange = [-2..2] ;
13377 VAR
13378 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
13379 @end smallexample
13380
13381 @noindent
13382 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
13383 below.
13384
13385 @smallexample
13386 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
13387 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
13388 f1 : CARDINAL;
13389 f2 : CHAR;
13390 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
13391 END
13392 @end smallexample
13393
13394 @node M2 Defaults
13395 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
13396 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
13397
13398 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
13399 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
13400 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
13401 selected the working language.
13402
13403 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
13404 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
13405 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
13406 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
13407
13408 @node Deviations
13409 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
13410 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
13411
13412 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
13413 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
13414
13415 @itemize @bullet
13416 @item
13417 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
13418 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
13419 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
13420 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
13421 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
13422 returned a pointer.)
13423
13424 @item
13425 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
13426 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
13427 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
13428 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
13429
13430 @item
13431 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
13432 argument.
13433
13434 @item
13435 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
13436 @end itemize
13437
13438 @node M2 Checks
13439 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
13440 @cindex Modula-2 checks
13441
13442 @quotation
13443 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
13444 range checking.
13445 @end quotation
13446 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
13447
13448 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
13449
13450 @itemize @bullet
13451 @item
13452 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
13453 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
13454
13455 @item
13456 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
13457 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
13458 @end itemize
13459
13460 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
13461 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
13462
13463 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
13464 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
13465
13466 @node M2 Scope
13467 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
13468 @cindex scope
13469 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
13470 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
13471 @ifinfo
13472 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
13473 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
13474 @end ifinfo
13475 @ifnotinfo
13476 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
13477 @end ifnotinfo
13478
13479 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
13480 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
13481 similar syntax:
13482
13483 @smallexample
13484
13485 @var{module} . @var{id}
13486 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
13487 @end smallexample
13488
13489 @noindent
13490 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
13491 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
13492 identifier within your program, except another module.
13493
13494 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
13495 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
13496 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
13497 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
13498
13499 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
13500 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
13501 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
13502 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
13503 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
13504 @var{module}.
13505
13506 @node GDB/M2
13507 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
13508
13509 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
13510 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
13511 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
13512 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
13513 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
13514 analogue in Modula-2.
13515
13516 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
13517 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
13518 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
13519 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
13520 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
13521 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
13522
13523 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
13524 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
13525 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
13526
13527 @node Ada
13528 @subsection Ada
13529 @cindex Ada
13530
13531 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
13532 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
13533 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
13534 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
13535 to be difficult.
13536
13537
13538 @cindex expressions in Ada
13539 @menu
13540 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
13541 and semantics supported by Ada mode
13542 in @value{GDBN}.
13543 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
13544 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
13545 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
13546 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
13547 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
13548 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
13549 Profile
13550 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
13551 @end menu
13552
13553 @node Ada Mode Intro
13554 @subsubsection Introduction
13555 @cindex Ada mode, general
13556
13557 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
13558 syntax, with some extensions.
13559 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
13560
13561 @itemize @bullet
13562 @item
13563 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
13564 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
13565 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
13566 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
13567
13568 @item
13569 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
13570 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
13571
13572 @item
13573 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
13574 @end itemize
13575
13576 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
13577 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
13578 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
13579 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
13580 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
13581
13582 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
13583 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
13584 was translated from an Ada source file.
13585
13586 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
13587 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
13588 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
13589 middle (to allow based literals).
13590
13591 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
13592 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
13593 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
13594 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
13595 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
13596 functions to procedures elsewhere.
13597
13598 @node Omissions from Ada
13599 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
13600 @cindex Ada, omissions from
13601
13602 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
13603
13604 @itemize @bullet
13605 @item
13606 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
13607
13608 @itemize @minus
13609 @item
13610 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
13611 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
13612
13613 @item
13614 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
13615
13616 @item
13617 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
13618
13619 @item
13620 @t{'Tag}.
13621
13622 @item
13623 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
13624 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
13625
13626 @item
13627 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
13628 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
13629
13630 @item
13631 @t{'Address}.
13632 @end itemize
13633
13634 @item
13635 The names in
13636 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
13637 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
13638 not currently available.
13639
13640 @item
13641 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
13642 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
13643 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
13644 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
13645 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
13646 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
13647 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
13648 indeterminate values.
13649
13650 @item
13651 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
13652 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
13653 are not implemented.
13654
13655 @item
13656 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
13657 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
13658 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
13659 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
13660 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
13661
13662 @smallexample
13663 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
13664 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
13665 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
13666 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
13667 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
13668 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
13669 @end smallexample
13670
13671 Changing a
13672 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
13673 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
13674 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
13675 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
13676 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
13677 declared to have a type such as:
13678
13679 @smallexample
13680 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
13681 Id : Integer;
13682 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
13683 end record;
13684 @end smallexample
13685
13686 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
13687 assignments:
13688
13689 @smallexample
13690 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
13691 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
13692 @end smallexample
13693
13694 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
13695 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
13696 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
13697 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
13698 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
13699 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
13700 redundant component associations, although which component values are
13701 assigned in such cases is not defined.
13702
13703 @item
13704 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
13705
13706 @item
13707 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
13708 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
13709 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
13710 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
13711 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
13712 the proper resolution.
13713
13714 @item
13715 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
13716
13717 @item
13718 Entry calls are not implemented.
13719
13720 @item
13721 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
13722 formats are not supported.
13723
13724 @item
13725 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
13726
13727 @item
13728 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
13729 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
13730 context.
13731 Should your program
13732 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
13733 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
13734 @end itemize
13735
13736 @node Additions to Ada
13737 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
13738 @cindex Ada, deviations from
13739
13740 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
13741 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
13742
13743 @itemize @bullet
13744 @item
13745 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
13746 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
13747 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
13748 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
13749 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
13750 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
13751 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
13752 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
13753
13754 @item
13755 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
13756 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
13757 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
13758
13759 @item
13760 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
13761 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
13762
13763 @item
13764 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
13765 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
13766 @end itemize
13767
13768 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
13769 additions specific to Ada:
13770
13771 @itemize @bullet
13772 @item
13773 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
13774 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
13775
13776 @smallexample
13777 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
13778 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
13779 @end smallexample
13780
13781 @item
13782 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
13783 the value of its right-hand operand.
13784 This allows, for example,
13785 complex conditional breaks:
13786
13787 @smallexample
13788 (@value{GDBP}) break f
13789 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
13790 @end smallexample
13791
13792 @item
13793 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
13794 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
13795 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
13796 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
13797 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
13798 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
13799 in strings. For example,
13800 @smallexample
13801 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
13802 @end smallexample
13803 @noindent
13804 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
13805 after each period.
13806
13807 @item
13808 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
13809 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
13810 to write
13811
13812 @smallexample
13813 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
13814 @end smallexample
13815
13816 @item
13817 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
13818 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
13819 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
13820 of 3 might print as
13821
13822 @smallexample
13823 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
13824 @end smallexample
13825
13826 @noindent
13827 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
13828 clause.
13829
13830 @item
13831 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
13832 multi-character subsequence of
13833 their names (an exact match gets preference).
13834 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
13835 in place of @t{a'length}.
13836
13837 @item
13838 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
13839 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
13840 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
13841 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
13842 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
13843 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
13844 For example,
13845 @smallexample
13846 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
13847 @end smallexample
13848
13849 @item
13850 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
13851 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
13852 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
13853 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
13854 object.
13855
13856 @end itemize
13857
13858 @node Stopping Before Main Program
13859 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
13860
13861 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
13862 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
13863 before reaching the main procedure.
13864 As defined in the Ada Reference
13865 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
13866 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
13867 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
13868 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
13869
13870 @node Ada Tasks
13871 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
13872 @cindex Ada, tasking
13873
13874 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
13875 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
13876
13877 @table @code
13878 @kindex info tasks
13879 @item info tasks
13880 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
13881
13882
13883 @smallexample
13884 @iftex
13885 @leftskip=0.5cm
13886 @end iftex
13887 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13888 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13889 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13890 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
13891 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
13892 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
13893
13894 @end smallexample
13895
13896 @noindent
13897 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
13898 task currently being inspected.
13899
13900 @table @asis
13901 @item ID
13902 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
13903
13904 @item TID
13905 The Ada task ID.
13906
13907 @item P-ID
13908 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
13909
13910 @item Pri
13911 The base priority of the task.
13912
13913 @item State
13914 Current state of the task.
13915
13916 @table @code
13917 @item Unactivated
13918 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
13919 executing.
13920
13921 @item Runnable
13922 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
13923 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
13924
13925 @item Terminated
13926 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
13927 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
13928 terminated themselves.
13929
13930 @item Child Activation Wait
13931 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
13932
13933 @item Accept Statement
13934 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
13935
13936 @item Waiting on entry call
13937 The task is waiting on an entry call.
13938
13939 @item Async Select Wait
13940 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
13941 select statement.
13942
13943 @item Delay Sleep
13944 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
13945 alternative open.
13946
13947 @item Child Termination Wait
13948 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
13949 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
13950 waiting on a terminate Phase.
13951
13952 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
13953 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
13954 finish terminating.
13955
13956 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
13957 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
13958 @end table
13959
13960 @item Name
13961 Name of the task in the program.
13962
13963 @end table
13964
13965 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
13966 @item info task @var{taskno}
13967 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
13968 the following example:
13969 @smallexample
13970 @iftex
13971 @leftskip=0.5cm
13972 @end iftex
13973 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13974 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13975 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13976 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
13977 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
13978 Ada Task: 0x807c468
13979 Name: task_1
13980 Thread: 0x807f378
13981 Parent: 1 (main_task)
13982 Base Priority: 15
13983 State: Runnable
13984 @end smallexample
13985
13986 @item task
13987 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
13988 @cindex current Ada task ID
13989 This command prints the ID of the current task.
13990
13991 @smallexample
13992 @iftex
13993 @leftskip=0.5cm
13994 @end iftex
13995 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
13996 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
13997 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
13998 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
13999 (@value{GDBP}) task
14000 [Current task is 2]
14001 @end smallexample
14002
14003 @item task @var{taskno}
14004 @cindex Ada task switching
14005 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
14006 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
14007 from the current task to the given task.
14008
14009 @smallexample
14010 @iftex
14011 @leftskip=0.5cm
14012 @end iftex
14013 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
14014 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
14015 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
14016 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
14017 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
14018 [Switching to task 1]
14019 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
14020 (@value{GDBP}) bt
14021 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
14022 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
14023 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
14024 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
14025 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
14026 @end smallexample
14027
14028 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
14029 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
14030 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
14031 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
14032 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
14033 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
14034 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}).
14035 @var{linespec} specifies source lines, as described
14036 in @ref{Specify Location}.
14037
14038 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
14039 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
14040 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. @var{taskno} is one of the
14041 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
14042 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
14043
14044 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
14045 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
14046 program.
14047
14048 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
14049 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
14050 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
14051
14052 For example,
14053
14054 @smallexample
14055 @iftex
14056 @leftskip=0.5cm
14057 @end iftex
14058 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
14059 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
14060 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
14061 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
14062 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
14063 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
14064 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
14065 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
14066 (@value{GDBP}) cont
14067 Continuing.
14068 task # 1 running
14069 task # 2 running
14070
14071 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
14072 15 flush;
14073 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
14074 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
14075 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
14076 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
14077 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
14078 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
14079 @end smallexample
14080 @end table
14081
14082 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
14083 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
14084 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
14085
14086 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
14087 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
14088 the platform being used.
14089 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
14090 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
14091 as usual.
14092
14093 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
14094 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
14095 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
14096 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
14097 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
14098 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
14099
14100 @node Ravenscar Profile
14101 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
14102 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
14103
14104 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
14105 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
14106 requirements.
14107
14108 @table @code
14109 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
14110 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
14111 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
14112 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
14113 Profile. This is the default.
14114
14115 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
14116 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
14117 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
14118 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
14119 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
14120 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
14121 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
14122
14123 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
14124 @item show ravenscar task-switching
14125 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
14126 using the Ravenscar Profile.
14127
14128 @end table
14129
14130 @node Ada Glitches
14131 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
14132 @cindex Ada, problems
14133
14134 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
14135 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
14136 @value{GDBN},
14137 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
14138 and the GNU Ada compiler.
14139
14140 @itemize @bullet
14141 @item
14142 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
14143 storage are invisible to the debugger.
14144
14145 @item
14146 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
14147 argument lists are treated as positional).
14148
14149 @item
14150 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
14151
14152 @item
14153 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
14154 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
14155 the host machine.
14156
14157 @item
14158 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
14159 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
14160 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
14161 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
14162 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
14163 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
14164 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
14165 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
14166 you can usually resolve the confusion
14167 by qualifying the problematic names with package
14168 @code{Standard} explicitly.
14169 @end itemize
14170
14171 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
14172 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
14173 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
14174 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
14175 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
14176 enabled.
14177
14178 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
14179 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
14180 @table @code
14181
14182 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
14183 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
14184 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
14185 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
14186 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
14187 This is the default.
14188
14189 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
14190 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
14191 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
14192 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
14193 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
14194 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
14195 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
14196
14197 @end table
14198
14199 @node Unsupported Languages
14200 @section Unsupported Languages
14201
14202 @cindex unsupported languages
14203 @cindex minimal language
14204 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
14205 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
14206 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
14207 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
14208 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
14209 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
14210
14211 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
14212 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
14213 language.
14214
14215 @node Symbols
14216 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
14217
14218 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
14219 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
14220 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
14221 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
14222 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
14223 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
14224 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
14225
14226 @cindex symbol names
14227 @cindex names of symbols
14228 @cindex quoting names
14229 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
14230 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
14231 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
14232 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
14233 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
14234 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
14235 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
14236 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
14237
14238 @smallexample
14239 p 'foo.c'::x
14240 @end smallexample
14241
14242 @noindent
14243 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
14244
14245 @table @code
14246 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
14247 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
14248 @kindex set case-sensitive
14249 @item set case-sensitive on
14250 @itemx set case-sensitive off
14251 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
14252 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
14253 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
14254 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
14255 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
14256 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
14257 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
14258 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
14259 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
14260 case-insensitive matches.
14261
14262 @kindex show case-sensitive
14263 @item show case-sensitive
14264 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
14265 lookups.
14266
14267 @kindex info address
14268 @cindex address of a symbol
14269 @item info address @var{symbol}
14270 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
14271 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
14272 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
14273 is always stored.
14274
14275 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
14276 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
14277 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
14278
14279 @kindex info symbol
14280 @cindex symbol from address
14281 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
14282 @item info symbol @var{addr}
14283 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
14284 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
14285 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
14286
14287 @smallexample
14288 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
14289 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
14290 @end smallexample
14291
14292 @noindent
14293 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
14294 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
14295
14296 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
14297 library containing the symbol is also printed:
14298
14299 @smallexample
14300 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
14301 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
14302 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
14303 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
14304 @end smallexample
14305
14306 @kindex whatis
14307 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
14308 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
14309 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
14310 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
14311
14312 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
14313 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
14314 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
14315
14316 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
14317 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
14318 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
14319 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
14320 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
14321 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
14322 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
14323 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
14324 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
14325
14326 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
14327 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
14328 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
14329 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
14330 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
14331 unroll it.
14332
14333 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
14334 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
14335 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
14336
14337 @kindex ptype
14338 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
14339 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
14340 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
14341 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
14342
14343 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
14344 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
14345 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
14346 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
14347 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
14348 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
14349 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
14350 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
14351
14352 For example, for this variable declaration:
14353
14354 @smallexample
14355 typedef double real_t;
14356 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
14357 typedef struct complex complex_t;
14358 complex_t var;
14359 real_t *real_pointer_var;
14360 @end smallexample
14361
14362 @noindent
14363 the two commands give this output:
14364
14365 @smallexample
14366 @group
14367 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
14368 type = complex_t
14369 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
14370 type = struct complex @{
14371 real_t real;
14372 double imag;
14373 @}
14374 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
14375 type = struct complex
14376 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
14377 type = struct complex
14378 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
14379 type = struct complex @{
14380 real_t real;
14381 double imag;
14382 @}
14383 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
14384 type = real_t *
14385 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
14386 type = double *
14387 @end group
14388 @end smallexample
14389
14390 @noindent
14391 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
14392 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
14393
14394 @cindex incomplete type
14395 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
14396 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
14397 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
14398 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
14399 given these declarations:
14400
14401 @smallexample
14402 struct foo;
14403 struct foo *fooptr;
14404 @end smallexample
14405
14406 @noindent
14407 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
14408
14409 @smallexample
14410 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
14411 $1 = <incomplete type>
14412 @end smallexample
14413
14414 @noindent
14415 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
14416 completely specified.
14417
14418 @kindex info types
14419 @item info types @var{regexp}
14420 @itemx info types
14421 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
14422 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
14423 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
14424 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
14425 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
14426 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
14427 name is @code{value}.
14428
14429 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
14430 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
14431 lists all source files where a type is defined.
14432
14433 @kindex info scope
14434 @cindex local variables
14435 @item info scope @var{location}
14436 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
14437 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
14438 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
14439 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
14440 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
14441
14442 @smallexample
14443 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
14444 Scope for command_line_handler:
14445 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
14446 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
14447 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
14448 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
14449 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
14450 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
14451 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
14452 @end smallexample
14453
14454 @noindent
14455 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
14456 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
14457 collect}.
14458
14459 @kindex info source
14460 @item info source
14461 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
14462 the function containing the current point of execution:
14463 @itemize @bullet
14464 @item
14465 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
14466 @item
14467 the directory it was compiled in,
14468 @item
14469 its length, in lines,
14470 @item
14471 which programming language it is written in,
14472 @item
14473 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
14474 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
14475 @item
14476 whether the debugging information includes information about
14477 preprocessor macros.
14478 @end itemize
14479
14480
14481 @kindex info sources
14482 @item info sources
14483 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
14484 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
14485 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
14486
14487 @kindex info functions
14488 @item info functions
14489 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
14490
14491 @item info functions @var{regexp}
14492 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
14493 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
14494 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
14495 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
14496 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
14497 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
14498 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
14499
14500 @kindex info variables
14501 @item info variables
14502 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
14503 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
14504
14505 @item info variables @var{regexp}
14506 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
14507 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
14508 @var{regexp}.
14509
14510 @kindex info classes
14511 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
14512 @item info classes
14513 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
14514 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
14515 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
14516 expression.
14517
14518 @kindex info selectors
14519 @item info selectors
14520 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
14521 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
14522 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
14523 expression.
14524
14525 @ignore
14526 This was never implemented.
14527 @kindex info methods
14528 @item info methods
14529 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
14530 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
14531 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
14532 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
14533 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
14534 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
14535 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
14536 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
14537 @end ignore
14538
14539 @cindex reloading symbols
14540 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
14541 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
14542 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
14543 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
14544 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
14545
14546 @table @code
14547 @kindex set symbol-reloading
14548 @item set symbol-reloading on
14549 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
14550 object file with a particular name is seen again.
14551
14552 @item set symbol-reloading off
14553 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
14554 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
14555 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
14556 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
14557 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
14558 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
14559 name.
14560
14561 @kindex show symbol-reloading
14562 @item show symbol-reloading
14563 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
14564 @end table
14565
14566 @cindex opaque data types
14567 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
14568 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
14569 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
14570 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
14571 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
14572 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
14573 another source file. The default is on.
14574
14575 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
14576 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
14577
14578 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
14579 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
14580 is printed as follows:
14581 @smallexample
14582 @{<no data fields>@}
14583 @end smallexample
14584
14585 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
14586 @item show opaque-type-resolution
14587 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
14588
14589 @kindex maint print symbols
14590 @cindex symbol dump
14591 @kindex maint print psymbols
14592 @cindex partial symbol dump
14593 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
14594 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
14595 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
14596 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
14597 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
14598 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
14599 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
14600 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
14601 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
14602 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
14603 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
14604 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
14605 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
14606 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
14607 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
14608 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
14609 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
14610
14611 @kindex maint info symtabs
14612 @kindex maint info psymtabs
14613 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
14614 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14615 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14616 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
14617 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
14618 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
14619
14620 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
14621 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
14622 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
14623 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
14624 structure in more detail. For example:
14625
14626 @smallexample
14627 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
14628 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
14629 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
14630 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
14631 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
14632 readin no
14633 fullname (null)
14634 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
14635 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
14636 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
14637 dependencies (none)
14638 @}
14639 @}
14640 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
14641 (@value{GDBP})
14642 @end smallexample
14643 @noindent
14644 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
14645 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
14646 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
14647 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
14648 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
14649
14650 @smallexample
14651 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
14652 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
14653 line 1574.
14654 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
14655 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
14656 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
14657 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
14658 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
14659 dirname (null)
14660 fullname (null)
14661 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
14662 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
14663 debugformat DWARF 2
14664 @}
14665 @}
14666 (@value{GDBP})
14667 @end smallexample
14668 @end table
14669
14670
14671 @node Altering
14672 @chapter Altering Execution
14673
14674 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
14675 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
14676 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
14677 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
14678 program.
14679
14680 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
14681 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
14682 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
14683
14684 @menu
14685 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
14686 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
14687 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
14688 * Returning:: Returning from a function
14689 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
14690 * Patching:: Patching your program
14691 @end menu
14692
14693 @node Assignment
14694 @section Assignment to Variables
14695
14696 @cindex assignment
14697 @cindex setting variables
14698 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
14699 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
14700
14701 @smallexample
14702 print x=4
14703 @end smallexample
14704
14705 @noindent
14706 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
14707 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
14708 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
14709 information on operators in supported languages.
14710
14711 @kindex set variable
14712 @cindex variables, setting
14713 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
14714 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
14715 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
14716 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
14717 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
14718
14719 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
14720 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
14721 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
14722 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
14723 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
14724 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
14725 command @code{set width}:
14726
14727 @smallexample
14728 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
14729 type = double
14730 (@value{GDBP}) p width
14731 $4 = 13
14732 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
14733 Invalid syntax in expression.
14734 @end smallexample
14735
14736 @noindent
14737 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
14738 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
14739
14740 @smallexample
14741 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
14742 @end smallexample
14743
14744 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
14745 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
14746 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
14747 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
14748 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
14749 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
14750
14751 @smallexample
14752 @group
14753 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
14754 type = double
14755 (@value{GDBP}) p g
14756 $1 = 1
14757 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
14758 (@value{GDBP}) p g
14759 $2 = 1
14760 (@value{GDBP}) r
14761 The program being debugged has been started already.
14762 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
14763 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
14764 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
14765 Invalid bfd target.
14766 (@value{GDBP}) show g
14767 The current BFD target is "=4".
14768 @end group
14769 @end smallexample
14770
14771 @noindent
14772 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
14773 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
14774 @code{g}, use
14775
14776 @smallexample
14777 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
14778 @end smallexample
14779
14780 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
14781 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
14782 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
14783 same length or shorter.
14784 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
14785 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
14786
14787 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
14788 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
14789 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
14790 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
14791 and representation in memory), and
14792
14793 @smallexample
14794 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
14795 @end smallexample
14796
14797 @noindent
14798 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
14799
14800 @node Jumping
14801 @section Continuing at a Different Address
14802
14803 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
14804 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
14805 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
14806
14807 @table @code
14808 @kindex jump
14809 @item jump @var{linespec}
14810 @itemx jump @var{location}
14811 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
14812 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
14813 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
14814 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
14815 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
14816 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14817
14818 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
14819 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
14820 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
14821 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
14822 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
14823 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
14824 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
14825 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
14826 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
14827 @end table
14828
14829 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
14830 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
14831 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
14832 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
14833 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
14834 example,
14835
14836 @smallexample
14837 set $pc = 0x485
14838 @end smallexample
14839
14840 @noindent
14841 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
14842 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
14843 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
14844
14845 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
14846 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
14847 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
14848 detail.
14849
14850 @c @group
14851 @node Signaling
14852 @section Giving your Program a Signal
14853 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
14854
14855 @table @code
14856 @kindex signal
14857 @item signal @var{signal}
14858 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
14859 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
14860 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
14861 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
14862
14863 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
14864 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
14865 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
14866 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
14867 signal.
14868
14869 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
14870 after executing the command.
14871 @end table
14872 @c @end group
14873
14874 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
14875 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
14876 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
14877 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
14878 passes the signal directly to your program.
14879
14880
14881 @node Returning
14882 @section Returning from a Function
14883
14884 @table @code
14885 @cindex returning from a function
14886 @kindex return
14887 @item return
14888 @itemx return @var{expression}
14889 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
14890 command. If you give an
14891 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
14892 value.
14893 @end table
14894
14895 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
14896 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
14897 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
14898 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
14899
14900 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
14901 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
14902 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
14903 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
14904 of functions.
14905
14906 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
14907 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
14908 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
14909 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
14910 selected stack frame returns naturally.
14911
14912 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
14913 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
14914 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
14915 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
14916 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
14917 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
14918 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
14919 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
14920 assignment into the right register(s).
14921
14922 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
14923 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
14924 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
14925 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
14926 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
14927 into a @code{long long int}:
14928
14929 @smallexample
14930 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
14931 29 return 31;
14932 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
14933 Make func return now? (y or n) y
14934 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
14935 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
14936 (@value{GDBP})
14937 @end smallexample
14938
14939 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
14940 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
14941 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
14942 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
14943 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
14944 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
14945 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
14946 an appropriate cast explicitly:
14947
14948 @smallexample
14949 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
14950 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
14951 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
14952 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
14953 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
14954 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
14955 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
14956 (@value{GDBP})
14957 @end smallexample
14958
14959 @node Calling
14960 @section Calling Program Functions
14961
14962 @table @code
14963 @cindex calling functions
14964 @cindex inferior functions, calling
14965 @item print @var{expr}
14966 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
14967 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
14968 debugged.
14969
14970 @kindex call
14971 @item call @var{expr}
14972 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
14973 returned values.
14974
14975 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
14976 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
14977 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
14978 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
14979 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
14980 value history.
14981 @end table
14982
14983 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
14984 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
14985 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
14986 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
14987
14988 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
14989 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
14990 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
14991 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
14992 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
14993 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
14994 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
14995 in that case is controlled by the
14996 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
14997
14998 @table @code
14999 @item set unwindonsignal
15000 @kindex set unwindonsignal
15001 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
15002 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
15003 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
15004 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
15005 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
15006 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
15007 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
15008 received.
15009
15010 @item show unwindonsignal
15011 @kindex show unwindonsignal
15012 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
15013 @value{GDBN}.
15014
15015 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
15016 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
15017 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
15018 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
15019 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
15020 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
15021 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
15022 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
15023 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
15024 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
15025
15026 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
15027 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
15028 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
15029 @value{GDBN}.
15030
15031 @end table
15032
15033 @cindex weak alias functions
15034 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
15035 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
15036 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
15037 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
15038 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
15039 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
15040 function instead.
15041
15042 @node Patching
15043 @section Patching Programs
15044
15045 @cindex patching binaries
15046 @cindex writing into executables
15047 @cindex writing into corefiles
15048
15049 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
15050 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
15051 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
15052 patching your program's binary.
15053
15054 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
15055 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
15056 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
15057 repairs.
15058
15059 @table @code
15060 @kindex set write
15061 @item set write on
15062 @itemx set write off
15063 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
15064 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
15065 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
15066
15067 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
15068 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
15069 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
15070
15071 @item show write
15072 @kindex show write
15073 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
15074 as well as reading.
15075 @end table
15076
15077 @node GDB Files
15078 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
15079
15080 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
15081 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
15082 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
15083 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
15084
15085 @menu
15086 * Files:: Commands to specify files
15087 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
15088 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
15089 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
15090 * Data Files:: GDB data files
15091 @end menu
15092
15093 @node Files
15094 @section Commands to Specify Files
15095
15096 @cindex symbol table
15097 @cindex core dump file
15098
15099 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
15100 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
15101 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
15102 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
15103
15104 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
15105 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
15106 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
15107 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
15108 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
15109 new files are useful.
15110
15111 @table @code
15112 @cindex executable file
15113 @kindex file
15114 @item file @var{filename}
15115 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
15116 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
15117 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
15118 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
15119 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
15120 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
15121 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
15122 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
15123
15124 @cindex unlinked object files
15125 @cindex patching object files
15126 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
15127 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
15128 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
15129 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
15130 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
15131 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
15132 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
15133 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
15134
15135 @item file
15136 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
15137 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
15138
15139 @kindex exec-file
15140 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
15141 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
15142 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
15143 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
15144 discard information on the executable file.
15145
15146 @kindex symbol-file
15147 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
15148 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
15149 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
15150 table and program to run from the same file.
15151
15152 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
15153 program's symbol table.
15154
15155 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
15156 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
15157 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
15158 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
15159 @value{GDBN}.
15160
15161 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
15162 executing it once.
15163
15164 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
15165 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
15166 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
15167 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
15168 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
15169 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
15170 optimized code.
15171
15172 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
15173 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
15174 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
15175 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
15176 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
15177
15178 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
15179 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
15180 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
15181 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
15182 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
15183 Warnings and Messages}.)
15184
15185 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
15186 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
15187 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
15188 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
15189 in stabs format.
15190
15191 @kindex readnow
15192 @cindex reading symbols immediately
15193 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
15194 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
15195 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
15196 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
15197 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
15198 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
15199 entire symbol table available.
15200
15201 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
15202 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
15203 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
15204 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
15205 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
15206 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
15207 @c files.
15208
15209 @kindex core-file
15210 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
15211 @itemx core
15212 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
15213 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
15214 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
15215 executable file itself for other parts.
15216
15217 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
15218 to be used.
15219
15220 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
15221 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
15222 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
15223 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
15224 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
15225
15226 @kindex add-symbol-file
15227 @cindex dynamic linking
15228 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
15229 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
15230 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
15231 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
15232 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
15233 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
15234 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
15235 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
15236 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
15237 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
15238 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
15239 @var{address} as an expression.
15240
15241 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
15242 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
15243 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
15244 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
15245 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
15246
15247 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
15248 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
15249 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
15250 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
15251 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
15252 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
15253 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
15254 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
15255 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
15256
15257 @itemize @bullet
15258 @item
15259 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
15260 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
15261 @item
15262 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
15263 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
15264 @item
15265 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
15266 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
15267 @end itemize
15268
15269 @noindent
15270 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
15271 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
15272 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
15273 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
15274 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
15275 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
15276 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
15277 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
15278 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
15279 way.
15280
15281 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
15282
15283 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
15284 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
15285 @cindex load symbols from memory
15286 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
15287 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
15288 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
15289 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
15290 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
15291 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
15292 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
15293 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
15294 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
15295
15296 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
15297 @kindex assf
15298 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
15299 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
15300 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
15301 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
15302 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
15303 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
15304 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
15305 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
15306 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
15307 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
15308
15309 @kindex section
15310 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
15311 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
15312 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
15313 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
15314 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
15315 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
15316 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
15317 their addresses.
15318
15319 @kindex info files
15320 @kindex info target
15321 @item info files
15322 @itemx info target
15323 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
15324 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
15325 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
15326 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
15327 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
15328 current ones.
15329
15330 @kindex maint info sections
15331 @item maint info sections
15332 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
15333 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
15334 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
15335 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
15336 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
15337 may be arbitrarily combined):
15338
15339 @table @code
15340 @item ALLOBJ
15341 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
15342 @item @var{sections}
15343 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
15344 @item @var{section-flags}
15345 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
15346 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
15347 @table @code
15348 @item ALLOC
15349 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
15350 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
15351 @item LOAD
15352 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
15353 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
15354 @item RELOC
15355 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
15356 @item READONLY
15357 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
15358 @item CODE
15359 Section contains executable code only.
15360 @item DATA
15361 Section contains data only (no executable code).
15362 @item ROM
15363 Section will reside in ROM.
15364 @item CONSTRUCTOR
15365 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
15366 @item HAS_CONTENTS
15367 Section is not empty.
15368 @item NEVER_LOAD
15369 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
15370 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
15371 A notification to the linker that the section contains
15372 COFF shared library information.
15373 @item IS_COMMON
15374 Section contains common symbols.
15375 @end table
15376 @end table
15377 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
15378 @cindex read-only sections
15379 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
15380 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
15381 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
15382 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
15383 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
15384 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
15385 enhancement to debugging performance.
15386
15387 The default is off.
15388
15389 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
15390 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
15391 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
15392 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
15393
15394 @item show trust-readonly-sections
15395 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
15396 @end table
15397
15398 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
15399 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
15400 name and remembers it that way.
15401
15402 @cindex shared libraries
15403 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
15404 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
15405 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
15406
15407 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
15408 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
15409
15410 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
15411 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
15412 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
15413 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
15414 debugging a core file).
15415
15416 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
15417 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
15418
15419 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
15420 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
15421 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
15422
15423 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
15424 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
15425 particularly large or there are many of them.
15426
15427 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
15428 commands:
15429
15430 @table @code
15431 @kindex set auto-solib-add
15432 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
15433 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
15434 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
15435 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
15436 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
15437 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
15438 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
15439
15440 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
15441 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
15442 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
15443 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
15444 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
15445 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
15446 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
15447 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
15448 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
15449
15450 @kindex show auto-solib-add
15451 @item show auto-solib-add
15452 Display the current autoloading mode.
15453 @end table
15454
15455 @cindex load shared library
15456 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
15457 command:
15458
15459 @table @code
15460 @kindex info sharedlibrary
15461 @kindex info share
15462 @item info share @var{regex}
15463 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
15464 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
15465 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
15466 all shared libraries that are loaded.
15467
15468 @kindex sharedlibrary
15469 @kindex share
15470 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
15471 @itemx share @var{regex}
15472 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
15473 Unix regular expression.
15474 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
15475 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
15476 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
15477 loaded.
15478
15479 @item nosharedlibrary
15480 @kindex nosharedlibrary
15481 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
15482 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
15483 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
15484 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
15485 discarded.
15486 @end table
15487
15488 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
15489 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
15490 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
15491
15492 @table @code
15493 @item set stop-on-solib-events
15494 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
15495 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
15496 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
15497 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
15498 shared library.
15499
15500 @item show stop-on-solib-events
15501 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
15502 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
15503 library events happen.
15504 @end table
15505
15506 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
15507 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
15508 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
15509 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
15510 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
15511 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
15512 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
15513 not.
15514
15515 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
15516 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
15517 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
15518 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
15519 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
15520
15521 @table @code
15522 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
15523 @cindex system root, alternate
15524 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
15525 @kindex set sysroot
15526 @item set sysroot @var{path}
15527 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
15528 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
15529 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
15530 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
15531 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
15532 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
15533 under @var{path}.
15534
15535 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
15536 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
15537 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
15538 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
15539 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
15540 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
15541 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
15542 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
15543 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
15544
15545 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
15546 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
15547 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
15548 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
15549 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
15550
15551 @smallexample
15552 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
15553 @end smallexample
15554
15555 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
15556 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
15557 system:
15558
15559 @smallexample
15560 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
15561 @end smallexample
15562
15563 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
15564 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
15565 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
15566 colons:
15567
15568 @smallexample
15569 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
15570 @end smallexample
15571
15572 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
15573 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
15574 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
15575 @samp{z}):
15576
15577 @smallexample
15578 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
15579 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
15580 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
15581 @end smallexample
15582
15583 @noindent
15584 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
15585 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
15586 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
15587
15588 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
15589 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
15590
15591 @smallexample
15592 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
15593 @end smallexample
15594
15595 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
15596 if you don't want or need to.
15597
15598 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
15599 sysroot}.
15600
15601 @cindex default system root
15602 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
15603 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
15604 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
15605 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
15606 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
15607 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
15608 location.
15609
15610 @kindex show sysroot
15611 @item show sysroot
15612 Display the current shared library prefix.
15613
15614 @kindex set solib-search-path
15615 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
15616 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
15617 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
15618 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
15619 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
15620 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
15621 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
15622 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
15623 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
15624 of shared library symbols.
15625
15626 @kindex show solib-search-path
15627 @item show solib-search-path
15628 Display the current shared library search path.
15629
15630 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
15631 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
15632 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
15633 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
15634 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
15635
15636 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
15637 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
15638 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
15639 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
15640 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
15641 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
15642 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
15643 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
15644 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
15645 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
15646 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
15647 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
15648 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
15649 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
15650 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
15651 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
15652 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
15653 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
15654 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
15655 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
15656 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
15657 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
15658
15659 @table @code
15660 @item unix
15661 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
15662 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
15663 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
15664 the forward slash.
15665
15666 @item dos-based
15667 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
15668 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
15669 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
15670 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
15671 considered directory separators.
15672
15673 @item auto
15674 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
15675 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
15676 This is the default.
15677 @end table
15678 @end table
15679
15680
15681 @node Separate Debug Files
15682 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
15683 @cindex separate debugging information files
15684 @cindex debugging information in separate files
15685 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
15686 @cindex debugging information directory, global
15687 @cindex global debugging information directory
15688 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
15689 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
15690
15691 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
15692 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
15693 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
15694 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
15695 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
15696 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
15697 install only when they need to debug a problem.
15698
15699 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
15700 file:
15701
15702 @itemize @bullet
15703 @item
15704 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
15705 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
15706 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
15707 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
15708 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
15709 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
15710 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
15711 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
15712
15713 @item
15714 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
15715 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
15716 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
15717 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
15718 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
15719 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
15720 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
15721 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
15722 below.
15723 @end itemize
15724
15725 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
15726 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
15727
15728 @itemize @bullet
15729 @item
15730 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
15731 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
15732 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
15733 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
15734 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
15735
15736 @item
15737 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
15738 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
15739 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
15740 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
15741 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
15742 hex characters, not 10.)
15743 @end itemize
15744
15745 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
15746 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
15747 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
15748 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
15749 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
15750 debug information files, in the indicated order:
15751
15752 @itemize @minus
15753 @item
15754 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
15755 @item
15756 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
15757 @item
15758 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
15759 @item
15760 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
15761 @end itemize
15762
15763 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
15764 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
15765
15766 @table @code
15767
15768 @kindex set debug-file-directory
15769 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
15770 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
15771 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple directory components can be set
15772 concatenating them by a directory separator.
15773
15774 @kindex show debug-file-directory
15775 @item show debug-file-directory
15776 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
15777 information files.
15778
15779 @end table
15780
15781 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
15782 @cindex debug link sections
15783 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
15784 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
15785
15786 @itemize
15787 @item
15788 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
15789 a zero byte,
15790 @item
15791 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
15792 boundary within the section, and
15793 @item
15794 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
15795 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
15796 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
15797 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
15798 @end itemize
15799
15800 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
15801 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
15802 described above.
15803
15804 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
15805 @cindex build ID sections
15806 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
15807 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
15808 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
15809 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
15810 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
15811 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
15812 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
15813 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
15814 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
15815
15816 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
15817 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
15818 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
15819 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
15820 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
15821 in an ordinary executable.
15822
15823 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
15824 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
15825 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
15826 following commands:
15827
15828 @smallexample
15829 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
15830 @kbd{strip -g foo}
15831 @end smallexample
15832
15833 @noindent
15834 These commands remove the debugging
15835 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
15836 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
15837 two files:
15838
15839 @itemize @bullet
15840 @item
15841 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
15842 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
15843
15844 @smallexample
15845 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
15846 @end smallexample
15847
15848 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
15849 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
15850 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
15851 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
15852
15853 @item
15854 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
15855 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
15856 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
15857 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
15858 @end itemize
15859
15860 @noindent
15861
15862 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
15863 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
15864 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
15865
15866 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
15867 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
15868 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
15869 @c different ways!
15870 @ifhtml
15871 @display
15872 @html
15873 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
15874 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
15875 @end html
15876 @end display
15877 @end ifhtml
15878 @ifnothtml
15879 @display
15880 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
15881 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
15882 @end display
15883 @end ifnothtml
15884
15885 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
15886 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
15887 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
15888 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
15889 CRC.
15890
15891 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
15892 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{Remote Protocol,
15893 , @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol}). However in the
15894 case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed @emph{most}
15895 significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so trailing
15896 zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
15897
15898 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
15899 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
15900 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
15901 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
15902 @code{0xffffffff}.
15903
15904 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
15905 @smallexample
15906 unsigned long
15907 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
15908 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
15909 @{
15910 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
15911 @{
15912 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
15913 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
15914 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
15915 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
15916 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
15917 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
15918 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
15919 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
15920 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
15921 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
15922 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
15923 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
15924 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
15925 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
15926 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
15927 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
15928 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
15929 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
15930 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
15931 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
15932 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
15933 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
15934 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
15935 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
15936 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
15937 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
15938 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
15939 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
15940 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
15941 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
15942 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
15943 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
15944 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
15945 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
15946 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
15947 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
15948 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
15949 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
15950 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
15951 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
15952 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
15953 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
15954 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
15955 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
15956 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
15957 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
15958 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
15959 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
15960 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
15961 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
15962 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
15963 0x2d02ef8d
15964 @};
15965 unsigned char *end;
15966
15967 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
15968 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
15969 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
15970 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
15971 @}
15972 @end smallexample
15973
15974 @noindent
15975 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
15976
15977
15978 @node Index Files
15979 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
15980 @cindex index files
15981 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
15982
15983 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
15984 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
15985 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
15986 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
15987 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
15988 startup.
15989
15990 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
15991 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
15992 using @command{objcopy}.
15993
15994 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
15995
15996 @table @code
15997 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
15998 @kindex save gdb-index
15999 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
16000 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
16001 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
16002 @var{directory}.
16003 @end table
16004
16005 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
16006 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
16007
16008 @smallexample
16009 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
16010 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
16011 @end smallexample
16012
16013 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
16014 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
16015 currently work for programs using Ada.
16016
16017 @node Symbol Errors
16018 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
16019
16020 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
16021 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
16022 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
16023 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
16024 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
16025 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
16026 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
16027 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
16028 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
16029 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
16030 Messages}).
16031
16032 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
16033
16034 @table @code
16035 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
16036
16037 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
16038 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
16039 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
16040 in its outer scope blocks.
16041
16042 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
16043 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
16044 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
16045 function.
16046
16047 @item block at @var{address} out of order
16048
16049 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
16050 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
16051 do so.
16052
16053 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
16054 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
16055 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
16056 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
16057 Messages}.)
16058
16059 @item bad block start address patched
16060
16061 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
16062 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
16063 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
16064
16065 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
16066 starting on the previous source line.
16067
16068 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
16069
16070 @cindex foo
16071 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
16072 larger than the size of the string table.
16073
16074 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
16075 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
16076 with this name.
16077
16078 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
16079
16080 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
16081 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
16082 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
16083
16084 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
16085 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
16086 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
16087 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
16088 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
16089 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
16090
16091 @item stub type has NULL name
16092
16093 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
16094
16095 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
16096 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
16097 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
16098 it.
16099
16100 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
16101
16102 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
16103
16104 @end table
16105
16106 @node Data Files
16107 @section GDB Data Files
16108
16109 @cindex prefix for data files
16110 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
16111 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
16112
16113 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
16114 is currently using.
16115
16116 @table @code
16117 @kindex set data-directory
16118 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
16119 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
16120 to @var{directory}.
16121
16122 @kindex show data-directory
16123 @item show data-directory
16124 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
16125 @end table
16126
16127 @cindex default data directory
16128 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
16129 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
16130 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
16131 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
16132 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
16133 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
16134 location.
16135
16136 The data directory may also be specified with the
16137 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
16138 @xref{Mode Options}.
16139
16140 @node Targets
16141 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
16142
16143 @cindex debugging target
16144 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
16145
16146 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
16147 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
16148 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
16149 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
16150 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
16151 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
16152 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
16153 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
16154
16155 @cindex target architecture
16156 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
16157 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
16158 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
16159 command.
16160
16161 @table @code
16162 @kindex set architecture
16163 @kindex show architecture
16164 @item set architecture @var{arch}
16165 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
16166 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
16167 supported architectures.
16168
16169 @item show architecture
16170 Show the current target architecture.
16171
16172 @item set processor
16173 @itemx processor
16174 @kindex set processor
16175 @kindex show processor
16176 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
16177 and @code{show architecture}.
16178 @end table
16179
16180 @menu
16181 * Active Targets:: Active targets
16182 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
16183 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
16184 @end menu
16185
16186 @node Active Targets
16187 @section Active Targets
16188
16189 @cindex stacking targets
16190 @cindex active targets
16191 @cindex multiple targets
16192
16193 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
16194 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
16195 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
16196 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
16197 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
16198 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
16199 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
16200 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
16201 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
16202
16203 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
16204 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
16205 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
16206 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
16207
16208 @node Target Commands
16209 @section Commands for Managing Targets
16210
16211 @table @code
16212 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
16213 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
16214 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
16215 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
16216 protocol of the target machine.
16217
16218 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
16219 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
16220 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
16221
16222 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
16223 after executing the command.
16224
16225 @kindex help target
16226 @item help target
16227 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
16228 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
16229 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16230
16231 @item help target @var{name}
16232 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
16233 select it.
16234
16235 @kindex set gnutarget
16236 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
16237 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
16238 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
16239 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
16240 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
16241 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
16242
16243 @quotation
16244 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
16245 you must know the actual BFD name.
16246 @end quotation
16247
16248 @noindent
16249 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
16250
16251 @kindex show gnutarget
16252 @item show gnutarget
16253 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
16254 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
16255 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
16256 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
16257 @end table
16258
16259 @cindex common targets
16260 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
16261 configuration):
16262
16263 @table @code
16264 @kindex target
16265 @item target exec @var{program}
16266 @cindex executable file target
16267 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
16268 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
16269
16270 @item target core @var{filename}
16271 @cindex core dump file target
16272 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
16273 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
16274
16275 @item target remote @var{medium}
16276 @cindex remote target
16277 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
16278 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
16279 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
16280
16281 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
16282 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
16283
16284 @smallexample
16285 target remote /dev/ttya
16286 @end smallexample
16287
16288 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
16289 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
16290 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
16291 clobbered by the download.
16292
16293 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
16294 @cindex built-in simulator target
16295 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
16296 In general,
16297 @smallexample
16298 target sim
16299 load
16300 run
16301 @end smallexample
16302 @noindent
16303 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
16304 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
16305 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
16306 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
16307 Processors}.
16308
16309 @end table
16310
16311 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
16312
16313 @table @code
16314
16315 @item target nrom @var{dev}
16316 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
16317 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
16318
16319 @end table
16320
16321 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
16322 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
16323
16324 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
16325 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
16326 various aspects of this process.
16327
16328 @table @code
16329
16330 @item set hash
16331 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
16332 @cindex hash mark while downloading
16333 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
16334 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
16335 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
16336 monitor.
16337
16338 @item show hash
16339 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
16340 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
16341
16342 @item set debug monitor
16343 @kindex set debug monitor
16344 @cindex display remote monitor communications
16345 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
16346 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
16347
16348 @item show debug monitor
16349 @kindex show debug monitor
16350 Show the current status of displaying communications between
16351 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
16352 @end table
16353
16354 @table @code
16355
16356 @kindex load @var{filename}
16357 @item load @var{filename}
16358 @anchor{load}
16359 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
16360 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
16361 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
16362 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
16363 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
16364 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
16365
16366 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
16367 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
16368 target is @dots{}}''
16369
16370 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
16371 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
16372 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
16373 specifies a fixed address.
16374 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
16375
16376 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
16377 load programs into flash memory.
16378
16379 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
16380 @end table
16381
16382 @node Byte Order
16383 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
16384
16385 @cindex choosing target byte order
16386 @cindex target byte order
16387
16388 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
16389 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
16390 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
16391 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
16392 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
16393 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
16394
16395 @table @code
16396 @kindex set endian
16397 @item set endian big
16398 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
16399
16400 @item set endian little
16401 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
16402
16403 @item set endian auto
16404 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
16405 executable.
16406
16407 @item show endian
16408 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
16409
16410 @end table
16411
16412 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
16413 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
16414 target system.
16415
16416
16417 @node Remote Debugging
16418 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
16419 @cindex remote debugging
16420
16421 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
16422 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
16423 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
16424 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
16425 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
16426
16427 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
16428 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
16429 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
16430 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
16431 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
16432 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
16433
16434 Other remote targets may be available in your
16435 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
16436
16437 @menu
16438 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
16439 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
16440 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
16441 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
16442 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
16443 @end menu
16444
16445 @node Connecting
16446 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
16447
16448 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
16449 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
16450 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
16451 program as the first argument.
16452
16453 @cindex @code{target remote}
16454 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
16455 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
16456 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
16457 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
16458 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
16459 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
16460
16461 @table @code
16462
16463 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
16464 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
16465 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
16466 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
16467
16468 @smallexample
16469 target remote /dev/ttyb
16470 @end smallexample
16471
16472 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
16473 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
16474 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
16475 @code{target} command.
16476
16477 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
16478 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
16479 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
16480 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
16481 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
16482 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
16483 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
16484 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
16485 target.
16486
16487 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
16488 @code{manyfarms}:
16489
16490 @smallexample
16491 target remote manyfarms:2828
16492 @end smallexample
16493
16494 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
16495 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
16496 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
16497 port 1234 on your local machine:
16498
16499 @smallexample
16500 target remote :1234
16501 @end smallexample
16502 @noindent
16503
16504 Note that the colon is still required here.
16505
16506 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
16507 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
16508 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
16509 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
16510
16511 @smallexample
16512 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
16513 @end smallexample
16514
16515 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
16516 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
16517 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
16518 cause havoc with your debugging session.
16519
16520 @item target remote | @var{command}
16521 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
16522 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
16523 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
16524 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
16525 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
16526 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
16527 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
16528 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
16529
16530 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
16531 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
16532 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
16533
16534 @end table
16535
16536 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
16537 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
16538 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
16539 need to use @kbd{run}.
16540
16541 @cindex interrupting remote programs
16542 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
16543 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
16544 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
16545 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
16546 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
16547 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
16548
16549 @smallexample
16550 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
16551 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
16552 @end smallexample
16553
16554 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
16555 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
16556 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
16557 goes back to waiting.
16558
16559 @table @code
16560 @kindex detach (remote)
16561 @item detach
16562 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
16563 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
16564 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
16565 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
16566 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
16567
16568 @kindex disconnect
16569 @item disconnect
16570 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
16571 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
16572 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
16573 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
16574 another target.
16575
16576 @cindex send command to remote monitor
16577 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
16578 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
16579 @kindex monitor
16580 @item monitor @var{cmd}
16581 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
16582 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
16583 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
16584 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
16585 and implement.
16586 @end table
16587
16588 @node File Transfer
16589 @section Sending files to a remote system
16590 @cindex remote target, file transfer
16591 @cindex file transfer
16592 @cindex sending files to remote systems
16593
16594 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
16595 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
16596 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
16597 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
16598 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
16599 the only way to upload or download files.
16600
16601 Not all remote targets support these commands.
16602
16603 @table @code
16604 @kindex remote put
16605 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
16606 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
16607 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
16608
16609 @kindex remote get
16610 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
16611 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
16612 on the host system.
16613
16614 @kindex remote delete
16615 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
16616 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
16617
16618 @end table
16619
16620 @node Server
16621 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
16622
16623 @kindex gdbserver
16624 @cindex remote connection without stubs
16625 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
16626 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
16627 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
16628
16629 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
16630 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
16631 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
16632 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
16633 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
16634 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
16635 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
16636 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
16637 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
16638 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
16639 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
16640 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
16641 choice for debugging.
16642
16643 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
16644 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
16645 protocol.
16646
16647 @quotation
16648 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
16649 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
16650 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
16651 target system with the same privileges as the user running
16652 @code{gdbserver}.
16653 @end quotation
16654
16655 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
16656 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
16657 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
16658
16659 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
16660 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
16661 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
16662 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
16663 system does all the symbol handling.
16664
16665 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
16666 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
16667 syntax is:
16668
16669 @smallexample
16670 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
16671 @end smallexample
16672
16673 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
16674 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
16675 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
16676 @file{/dev/com1}:
16677
16678 @smallexample
16679 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
16680 @end smallexample
16681
16682 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
16683 with it.
16684
16685 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
16686
16687 @smallexample
16688 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
16689 @end smallexample
16690
16691 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
16692 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
16693 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
16694 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
16695 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
16696 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
16697 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
16698 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
16699 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
16700 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
16701 @code{target remote} command.
16702
16703 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
16704 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
16705 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
16706
16707 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
16708 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
16709
16710 @smallexample
16711 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
16712 @end smallexample
16713
16714 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
16715 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
16716
16717 @pindex pidof
16718 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
16719 @code{pidof} utility:
16720
16721 @smallexample
16722 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
16723 @end smallexample
16724
16725 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
16726 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
16727 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
16728
16729 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
16730 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
16731 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
16732
16733 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
16734 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
16735 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
16736 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
16737
16738 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
16739 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
16740 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
16741 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
16742 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
16743 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
16744 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
16745 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
16746 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
16747
16748 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
16749 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
16750 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
16751 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
16752 the program you want to debug.
16753
16754 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
16755 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
16756 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
16757 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
16758 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
16759 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
16760
16761 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
16762
16763 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
16764
16765 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
16766 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
16767 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
16768 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
16769 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
16770 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
16771 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
16772 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
16773
16774 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
16775 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
16776 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
16777
16778 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
16779 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
16780 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
16781 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
16782 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
16783 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
16784 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
16785 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
16786 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
16787 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
16788 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
16789 instance closes its port after the first connection.
16790
16791 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
16792
16793 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
16794 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
16795 status information about the debugging process.
16796 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
16797 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
16798 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
16799 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
16800
16801 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
16802 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
16803 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
16804 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
16805 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
16806
16807 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
16808 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
16809 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
16810 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
16811
16812 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
16813 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
16814 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
16815 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
16816
16817 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
16818 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
16819 environment:
16820
16821 @smallexample
16822 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
16823 @end smallexample
16824
16825 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
16826
16827 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
16828
16829 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
16830 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
16831 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
16832 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
16833
16834 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
16835 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
16836 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
16837 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
16838 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
16839 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
16840 programs.
16841
16842 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
16843 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
16844 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
16845 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
16846 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
16847 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
16848 already on the target.
16849
16850 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
16851 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
16852 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
16853
16854 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
16855 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
16856 Here are the available commands.
16857
16858 @table @code
16859 @item monitor help
16860 List the available monitor commands.
16861
16862 @item monitor set debug 0
16863 @itemx monitor set debug 1
16864 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
16865
16866 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
16867 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
16868 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
16869 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
16870
16871 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
16872 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
16873 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
16874 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
16875 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
16876 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
16877
16878 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
16879 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
16880
16881 @item monitor exit
16882 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
16883 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
16884 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
16885 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
16886 of a multi-process mode debug session.
16887
16888 @end table
16889
16890 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
16891 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
16892
16893 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
16894 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
16895
16896 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
16897 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
16898 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
16899 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
16900 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
16901 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
16902 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
16903 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
16904 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
16905 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
16906 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
16907 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
16908
16909 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
16910
16911 @table @code
16912 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
16913
16914 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
16915 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
16916 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
16917
16918 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
16919
16920 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
16921 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
16922 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
16923 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
16924 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
16925 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
16926
16927 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
16928
16929 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
16930 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
16931 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
16932 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
16933 command for that. For example:
16934
16935 @smallexample
16936 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
16937 @end smallexample
16938
16939 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
16940 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
16941 @end table
16942
16943 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
16944 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
16945 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
16946 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
16947 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
16948 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
16949 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
16950 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
16951 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
16952 @code{gdbserver} like so:
16953
16954 @smallexample
16955 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
16956 @end smallexample
16957
16958 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
16959
16960 @smallexample
16961 $ gdb myprogram
16962 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
16963 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
16964 (@value{GDBP}) b main
16965 (@value{GDBP}) continue
16966 @end smallexample
16967
16968 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
16969 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
16970 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
16971 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
16972 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
16973 tracing.
16974
16975 @node Remote Configuration
16976 @section Remote Configuration
16977
16978 @kindex set remote
16979 @kindex show remote
16980 This section documents the configuration options available when
16981 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
16982 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
16983 system-call-allowed}.
16984
16985 @table @code
16986 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
16987 @cindex address size for remote targets
16988 @cindex bits in remote address
16989 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
16990 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
16991 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
16992 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
16993
16994 @item show remoteaddresssize
16995 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
16996
16997 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
16998 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
16999 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
17000 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
17001 remote targets.
17002
17003 @item show remotebaud
17004 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
17005
17006 @item set remotebreak
17007 @cindex interrupt remote programs
17008 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
17009 @anchor{set remotebreak}
17010 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
17011 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
17012 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
17013 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
17014 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
17015
17016 @item show remotebreak
17017 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
17018 interrupt the remote program.
17019
17020 @item set remoteflow on
17021 @itemx set remoteflow off
17022 @kindex set remoteflow
17023 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
17024 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
17025
17026 @item show remoteflow
17027 @kindex show remoteflow
17028 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
17029
17030 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
17031 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
17032 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
17033 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
17034 @code{ascii}.
17035
17036 @item show remotelogbase
17037 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
17038 protocol.
17039
17040 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
17041 @cindex record serial communications on file
17042 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
17043 default is not to record at all.
17044
17045 @item show remotelogfile.
17046 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
17047 serial communications.
17048
17049 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
17050 @cindex timeout for serial communications
17051 @cindex remote timeout
17052 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
17053 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
17054
17055 @item show remotetimeout
17056 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
17057 responses.
17058
17059 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
17060 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
17061 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
17062 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
17063 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
17064 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
17065 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
17066 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
17067
17068 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
17069 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
17070 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
17071 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
17072 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
17073 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
17074 as unlimited.
17075
17076 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
17077 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
17078 a remote hardware watchpoint.
17079
17080 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
17081 @itemx show remote exec-file
17082 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
17083 @cindex executable file, for remote target
17084 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
17085 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
17086 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
17087 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
17088
17089 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
17090 @cindex interrupt remote programs
17091 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
17092 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
17093 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
17094 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
17095 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
17096 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
17097 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
17098 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
17099
17100 @item show interrupt-sequence
17101 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
17102 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
17103 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
17104 also known as Magic SysRq g.
17105
17106 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
17107 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
17108 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
17109 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
17110 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
17111 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
17112
17113 @item show interrupt-on-connect
17114 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
17115 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
17116
17117 @kindex set tcp
17118 @kindex show tcp
17119 @item set tcp auto-retry on
17120 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
17121 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
17122 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
17123 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
17124 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
17125 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
17126 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
17127 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
17128
17129 @item set tcp auto-retry off
17130 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
17131
17132 @item show tcp auto-retry
17133 Show the current auto-retry setting.
17134
17135 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
17136 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
17137 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
17138 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
17139 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
17140 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
17141 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
17142 value.
17143
17144 @item show tcp connect-timeout
17145 Show the current connection timeout setting.
17146 @end table
17147
17148 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
17149 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
17150 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
17151 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
17152 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
17153 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
17154 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
17155 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
17156 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
17157
17158 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
17159 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
17160 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
17161 @value{GDBN} developers.
17162
17163 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
17164 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
17165 are:
17166
17167 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
17168 @item Command Name
17169 @tab Remote Packet
17170 @tab Related Features
17171
17172 @item @code{fetch-register}
17173 @tab @code{p}
17174 @tab @code{info registers}
17175
17176 @item @code{set-register}
17177 @tab @code{P}
17178 @tab @code{set}
17179
17180 @item @code{binary-download}
17181 @tab @code{X}
17182 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
17183
17184 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
17185 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
17186 @tab @code{info auxv}
17187
17188 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
17189 @tab @code{qSymbol}
17190 @tab Detecting multiple threads
17191
17192 @item @code{attach}
17193 @tab @code{vAttach}
17194 @tab @code{attach}
17195
17196 @item @code{verbose-resume}
17197 @tab @code{vCont}
17198 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
17199
17200 @item @code{run}
17201 @tab @code{vRun}
17202 @tab @code{run}
17203
17204 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
17205 @tab @code{Z0}
17206 @tab @code{break}
17207
17208 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
17209 @tab @code{Z1}
17210 @tab @code{hbreak}
17211
17212 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
17213 @tab @code{Z2}
17214 @tab @code{watch}
17215
17216 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
17217 @tab @code{Z3}
17218 @tab @code{rwatch}
17219
17220 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
17221 @tab @code{Z4}
17222 @tab @code{awatch}
17223
17224 @item @code{target-features}
17225 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
17226 @tab @code{set architecture}
17227
17228 @item @code{library-info}
17229 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
17230 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
17231
17232 @item @code{memory-map}
17233 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
17234 @tab @code{info mem}
17235
17236 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
17237 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
17238 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
17239
17240 @item @code{read-spu-object}
17241 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
17242 @tab @code{info spu}
17243
17244 @item @code{write-spu-object}
17245 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
17246 @tab @code{info spu}
17247
17248 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
17249 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
17250 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
17251
17252 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
17253 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
17254 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
17255
17256 @item @code{threads}
17257 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
17258 @tab @code{info threads}
17259
17260 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
17261 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
17262 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
17263
17264 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
17265 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
17266 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
17267
17268 @item @code{search-memory}
17269 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
17270 @tab @code{find}
17271
17272 @item @code{supported-packets}
17273 @tab @code{qSupported}
17274 @tab Remote communications parameters
17275
17276 @item @code{pass-signals}
17277 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
17278 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
17279
17280 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
17281 @tab @code{vFile:close}
17282 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
17283
17284 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
17285 @tab @code{vFile:open}
17286 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
17287
17288 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
17289 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
17290 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
17291
17292 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
17293 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
17294 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
17295
17296 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
17297 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
17298 @tab @code{remote delete}
17299
17300 @item @code{noack-packet}
17301 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
17302 @tab Packet acknowledgment
17303
17304 @item @code{osdata}
17305 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
17306 @tab @code{info os}
17307
17308 @item @code{query-attached}
17309 @tab @code{qAttached}
17310 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
17311
17312 @item @code{traceframe-info}
17313 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
17314 @tab Traceframe info
17315
17316 @item @code{disable-randomization}
17317 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
17318 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
17319 @end multitable
17320
17321 @node Remote Stub
17322 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
17323
17324 @cindex debugging stub, example
17325 @cindex remote stub, example
17326 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
17327 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
17328 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
17329 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
17330 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
17331 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
17332 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
17333 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
17334
17335 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
17336 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
17337 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
17338 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
17339 program, you need:
17340
17341 @enumerate
17342 @item
17343 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
17344 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
17345 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
17346
17347 @item
17348 A C subroutine library to support your program's
17349 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
17350
17351 @item
17352 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
17353 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
17354 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
17355 documentation.
17356 @end enumerate
17357
17358 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
17359 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
17360 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
17361
17362 @table @emph
17363 @item On the host,
17364 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
17365 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
17366 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
17367
17368 @item On the target,
17369 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
17370 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
17371 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
17372
17373 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
17374 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
17375 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
17376 @end table
17377
17378 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
17379 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
17380 @sc{sparc} boards.
17381
17382 @cindex remote serial stub list
17383 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
17384
17385 @table @code
17386
17387 @item i386-stub.c
17388 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
17389 @cindex Intel
17390 @cindex i386
17391 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
17392
17393 @item m68k-stub.c
17394 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
17395 @cindex Motorola 680x0
17396 @cindex m680x0
17397 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
17398
17399 @item sh-stub.c
17400 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
17401 @cindex Renesas
17402 @cindex SH
17403 For Renesas SH architectures.
17404
17405 @item sparc-stub.c
17406 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
17407 @cindex Sparc
17408 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
17409
17410 @item sparcl-stub.c
17411 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
17412 @cindex Fujitsu
17413 @cindex SparcLite
17414 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
17415
17416 @end table
17417
17418 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
17419 recently added stubs.
17420
17421 @menu
17422 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
17423 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
17424 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
17425 @end menu
17426
17427 @node Stub Contents
17428 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
17429
17430 @cindex remote serial stub
17431 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
17432 subroutines:
17433
17434 @table @code
17435 @item set_debug_traps
17436 @findex set_debug_traps
17437 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
17438 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
17439 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
17440 beginning of your program.
17441
17442 @item handle_exception
17443 @findex handle_exception
17444 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
17445 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
17446 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
17447 run when a trap is triggered.
17448
17449 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
17450 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
17451 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
17452 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
17453 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
17454 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
17455 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
17456 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
17457 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
17458 machine.
17459
17460 @item breakpoint
17461 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
17462 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
17463 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
17464 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
17465 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
17466 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
17467 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
17468 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
17469 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
17470 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
17471 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
17472
17473 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
17474 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
17475 start of your debugging session.
17476 @end table
17477
17478 @node Bootstrapping
17479 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
17480
17481 @cindex remote stub, support routines
17482 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
17483 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
17484 debugging target machine.
17485
17486 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
17487 serial port.
17488
17489 @table @code
17490 @item int getDebugChar()
17491 @findex getDebugChar
17492 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
17493 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
17494 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
17495
17496 @item void putDebugChar(int)
17497 @findex putDebugChar
17498 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
17499 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
17500 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
17501 @end table
17502
17503 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
17504 @cindex interrupting remote targets
17505 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
17506 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
17507 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
17508 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
17509 remote system to stop.
17510
17511 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
17512 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
17513 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
17514 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
17515
17516 Other routines you need to supply are:
17517
17518 @table @code
17519 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
17520 @findex exceptionHandler
17521 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
17522 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
17523 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
17524 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
17525 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
17526 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
17527 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
17528 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
17529 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
17530 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
17531 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
17532 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
17533 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
17534
17535 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
17536 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
17537 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
17538 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
17539 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
17540
17541 @item void flush_i_cache()
17542 @findex flush_i_cache
17543 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
17544 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
17545 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
17546
17547 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
17548 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
17549 @end table
17550
17551 @noindent
17552 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
17553
17554 @table @code
17555 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
17556 @findex memset
17557 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
17558 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
17559 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
17560 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
17561 @end table
17562
17563 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
17564 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
17565 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
17566 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
17567
17568
17569 @node Debug Session
17570 @subsection Putting it All Together
17571
17572 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
17573 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
17574 steps.
17575
17576 @enumerate
17577 @item
17578 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
17579 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
17580 @display
17581 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
17582 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
17583 @end display
17584
17585 @item
17586 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
17587
17588 @smallexample
17589 set_debug_traps();
17590 breakpoint();
17591 @end smallexample
17592
17593 @item
17594 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
17595 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
17596
17597 @smallexample
17598 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
17599 @end smallexample
17600
17601 @noindent
17602 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
17603 function in your program, that function is called when
17604 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
17605 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
17606 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
17607
17608 @item
17609 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
17610 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
17611
17612 @item
17613 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
17614 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
17615
17616 @item
17617 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
17618 @c document that. FIXME.
17619 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
17620 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
17621
17622 @item
17623 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
17624 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
17625
17626 @end enumerate
17627
17628 @node Configurations
17629 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
17630
17631 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
17632 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
17633 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
17634
17635 There are three major categories of configurations: native
17636 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
17637 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
17638 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
17639 are quite different from each other.
17640
17641 @menu
17642 * Native::
17643 * Embedded OS::
17644 * Embedded Processors::
17645 * Architectures::
17646 @end menu
17647
17648 @node Native
17649 @section Native
17650
17651 This section describes details specific to particular native
17652 configurations.
17653
17654 @menu
17655 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
17656 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
17657 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
17658 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
17659 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
17660 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
17661 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
17662 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
17663 @end menu
17664
17665 @node HP-UX
17666 @subsection HP-UX
17667
17668 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
17669 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
17670 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
17671
17672
17673 @node BSD libkvm Interface
17674 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
17675
17676 @cindex libkvm
17677 @cindex kernel memory image
17678 @cindex kernel crash dump
17679
17680 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
17681 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
17682 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
17683 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
17684 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
17685 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
17686 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
17687 @code{kvm} target:
17688
17689 @smallexample
17690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
17691 @end smallexample
17692
17693 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
17694 argument:
17695
17696 @smallexample
17697 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
17698 @end smallexample
17699
17700 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
17701 available:
17702
17703 @table @code
17704 @kindex kvm
17705 @item kvm pcb
17706 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
17707
17708 @item kvm proc
17709 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
17710 modern FreeBSD systems.
17711 @end table
17712
17713 @node SVR4 Process Information
17714 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
17715 @cindex /proc
17716 @cindex examine process image
17717 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
17718
17719 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
17720 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
17721 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
17722 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
17723 proc} is available to report information about the process running
17724 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
17725 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
17726 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
17727 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
17728
17729 @table @code
17730 @kindex info proc
17731 @cindex process ID
17732 @item info proc
17733 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
17734 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
17735 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
17736 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
17737 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
17738 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
17739 executable file's absolute file name.
17740
17741 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
17742 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
17743 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
17744 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
17745 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
17746 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
17747
17748 @item info proc mappings
17749 @cindex memory address space mappings
17750 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
17751 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
17752 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
17753 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
17754 memory access rights to that range.
17755
17756 @item info proc stat
17757 @itemx info proc status
17758 @cindex process detailed status information
17759 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
17760 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
17761 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
17762 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
17763 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
17764 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
17765 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
17766
17767 @item info proc all
17768 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
17769 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
17770
17771 @ignore
17772 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
17773 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
17774 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
17775 @kindex info proc times
17776 @item info proc times
17777 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
17778 its children.
17779
17780 @kindex info proc id
17781 @item info proc id
17782 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
17783 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
17784 @end ignore
17785
17786 @item set procfs-trace
17787 @kindex set procfs-trace
17788 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
17789 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
17790
17791 @item show procfs-trace
17792 @kindex show procfs-trace
17793 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
17794
17795 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
17796 @kindex set procfs-file
17797 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
17798 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
17799 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
17800 standard output.
17801
17802 @item show procfs-file
17803 @kindex show procfs-file
17804 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
17805
17806 @item proc-trace-entry
17807 @itemx proc-trace-exit
17808 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
17809 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
17810 @kindex proc-trace-entry
17811 @kindex proc-trace-exit
17812 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
17813 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
17814 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
17815 from the @code{syscall} interface.
17816
17817 @item info pidlist
17818 @kindex info pidlist
17819 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
17820 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
17821 processes and all the threads within each process.
17822
17823 @item info meminfo
17824 @kindex info meminfo
17825 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
17826 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
17827 @end table
17828
17829 @node DJGPP Native
17830 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
17831 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
17832 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
17833 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
17834
17835 @cindex DPMI
17836 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
17837 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
17838 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
17839 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
17840
17841 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
17842 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
17843 subsection describes those commands.
17844
17845 @table @code
17846 @kindex info dos
17847 @item info dos
17848 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
17849 information about the target system and important OS structures.
17850
17851 @kindex sysinfo
17852 @cindex MS-DOS system info
17853 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
17854 @item info dos sysinfo
17855 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
17856 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
17857 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
17858
17859 @cindex GDT
17860 @cindex LDT
17861 @cindex IDT
17862 @cindex segment descriptor tables
17863 @cindex descriptor tables display
17864 @item info dos gdt
17865 @itemx info dos ldt
17866 @itemx info dos idt
17867 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
17868 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
17869 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
17870 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
17871 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
17872 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
17873 rights.
17874
17875 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
17876 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
17877 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
17878 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
17879 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
17880
17881 @cindex garbled pointers
17882 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
17883 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
17884 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
17885 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
17886 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
17887 debugged program's data segment:
17888
17889 @smallexample
17890 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
17891 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
17892 @end smallexample
17893
17894 @noindent
17895 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
17896 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
17897
17898 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
17899 @item info dos pde
17900 @itemx info dos pte
17901 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
17902 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
17903 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
17904 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
17905 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
17906 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
17907 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
17908 that is currently in use.
17909
17910 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
17911 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
17912 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
17913 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
17914 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
17915 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
17916 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
17917
17918 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
17919 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
17920 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
17921 controller.
17922
17923 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
17924
17925 @cindex physical address from linear address
17926 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
17927 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
17928 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
17929 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
17930 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
17931 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
17932 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
17933
17934 @smallexample
17935 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
17936 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
17937 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
17938 @end smallexample
17939
17940 @noindent
17941 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
17942 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
17943 attributes of that page.
17944
17945 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
17946 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
17947 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
17948 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
17949 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
17950 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
17951
17952 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
17953 transfer buffer:
17954
17955 @smallexample
17956 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
17957 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
17958 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
17959 @end smallexample
17960
17961 @noindent
17962 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
17963 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
17964 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
17965 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
17966 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
17967
17968 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
17969 @end table
17970
17971 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
17972 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
17973 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
17974 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
17975
17976 @table @code
17977 @kindex set com1base
17978 @kindex set com1irq
17979 @kindex set com2base
17980 @kindex set com2irq
17981 @kindex set com3base
17982 @kindex set com3irq
17983 @kindex set com4base
17984 @kindex set com4irq
17985 @item set com1base @var{addr}
17986 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
17987 port.
17988
17989 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
17990 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
17991 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
17992
17993 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
17994 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
17995 other 3 COM ports.
17996
17997 @kindex show com1base
17998 @kindex show com1irq
17999 @kindex show com2base
18000 @kindex show com2irq
18001 @kindex show com3base
18002 @kindex show com3irq
18003 @kindex show com4base
18004 @kindex show com4irq
18005 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
18006 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
18007 lines used by the COM ports.
18008
18009 @item info serial
18010 @kindex info serial
18011 @cindex DOS serial port status
18012 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
18013 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
18014 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
18015 counts of various errors encountered so far.
18016 @end table
18017
18018
18019 @node Cygwin Native
18020 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
18021 @cindex MS Windows debugging
18022 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
18023 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
18024
18025 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
18026 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
18027
18028 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
18029 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
18030 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
18031 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
18032 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
18033 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
18034 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
18035 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
18036
18037 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
18038 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
18039 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
18040
18041 @table @code
18042 @kindex info w32
18043 @item info w32
18044 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
18045 information about the target system and important OS structures.
18046
18047 @item info w32 selector
18048 This command displays information returned by
18049 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
18050 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
18051 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
18052 Without argument, this command displays information
18053 about the six segment registers.
18054
18055 @item info w32 thread-information-block
18056 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
18057 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
18058 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
18059
18060 @kindex info dll
18061 @item info dll
18062 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
18063
18064 @kindex dll-symbols
18065 @item dll-symbols
18066 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
18067 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
18068
18069 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
18070 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
18071 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
18072 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
18073 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
18074 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
18075 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
18076 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
18077 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
18078 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
18079 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
18080
18081 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
18082 @item show cygwin-exceptions
18083 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
18084 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
18085
18086 @kindex set new-console
18087 @item set new-console @var{mode}
18088 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
18089 be started in a new console on next start.
18090 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
18091 be started in the same console as the debugger.
18092
18093 @kindex show new-console
18094 @item show new-console
18095 Displays whether a new console is used
18096 when the debuggee is started.
18097
18098 @kindex set new-group
18099 @item set new-group @var{mode}
18100 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
18101 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
18102 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
18103 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
18104
18105 @kindex show new-group
18106 @item show new-group
18107 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
18108
18109 @kindex set debugevents
18110 @item set debugevents
18111 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
18112 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
18113 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
18114 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
18115 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
18116
18117 @kindex set debugexec
18118 @item set debugexec
18119 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
18120 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
18121
18122 @kindex set debugexceptions
18123 @item set debugexceptions
18124 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
18125 debuggee seen by the debugger.
18126
18127 @kindex set debugmemory
18128 @item set debugmemory
18129 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
18130 and writes by the debugger.
18131
18132 @kindex set shell
18133 @item set shell
18134 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
18135 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
18136
18137 @kindex show shell
18138 @item show shell
18139 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
18140
18141 @end table
18142
18143 @menu
18144 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
18145 @end menu
18146
18147 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
18148 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
18149 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
18150 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
18151
18152 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
18153 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
18154 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
18155 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
18156 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
18157 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
18158 ``minimal symbols''.
18159
18160 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
18161 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
18162 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
18163 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
18164 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
18165 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
18166 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
18167 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
18168 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
18169 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
18170
18171 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
18172
18173 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
18174 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
18175 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
18176 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
18177 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
18178 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
18179 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
18180 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
18181 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
18182
18183 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
18184 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
18185 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
18186 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
18187 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
18188 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
18189
18190 @smallexample
18191 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
18192 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
18193
18194 Non-debugging symbols:
18195 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
18196 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
18197 @end smallexample
18198
18199 @smallexample
18200 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
18201 All functions matching regular expression "!":
18202
18203 Non-debugging symbols:
18204 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
18205 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
18206 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
18207 [etc...]
18208 @end smallexample
18209
18210 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
18211
18212 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
18213 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
18214 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
18215 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
18216 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
18217 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
18218 a function within a DLL without a running program.
18219
18220 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
18221 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
18222 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
18223 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
18224 problem:
18225
18226 @smallexample
18227 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
18228 $1 = 268572168
18229 @end smallexample
18230
18231 @smallexample
18232 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
18233 0x10021610: "\230y\""
18234 @end smallexample
18235
18236 And two possible solutions:
18237
18238 @smallexample
18239 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
18240 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
18241 @end smallexample
18242
18243 @smallexample
18244 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
18245 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
18246 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
18247 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
18248 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
18249 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
18250 @end smallexample
18251
18252 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
18253 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
18254 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
18255 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
18256 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
18257
18258 @smallexample
18259 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
18260 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
18261 @end smallexample
18262
18263 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
18264 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
18265 safe.
18266
18267 @node Hurd Native
18268 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
18269 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
18270
18271 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
18272 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
18273
18274 @table @code
18275 @item set signals
18276 @itemx set sigs
18277 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
18278 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
18279 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
18280 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
18281 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
18282 @code{signals}.
18283
18284 @item show signals
18285 @itemx show sigs
18286 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
18287 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
18288 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
18289
18290 @item set signal-thread
18291 @itemx set sigthread
18292 @kindex set signal-thread
18293 @kindex set sigthread
18294 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
18295 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
18296 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
18297 signal-thread}.
18298
18299 @item show signal-thread
18300 @itemx show sigthread
18301 @kindex show signal-thread
18302 @kindex show sigthread
18303 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
18304 delivered a signal.
18305
18306 @item set stopped
18307 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
18308 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
18309 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
18310 continued by delivering a signal to it.
18311
18312 @item show stopped
18313 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
18314 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
18315 stopped.
18316
18317 @item set exceptions
18318 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
18319 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
18320 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
18321 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
18322 trapping on.
18323
18324 @item show exceptions
18325 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
18326 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
18327
18328 @item set task pause
18329 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
18330 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
18331 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
18332 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
18333 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
18334 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
18335 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
18336 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
18337 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
18338
18339 @item show task pause
18340 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
18341 Show the current state of task suspension.
18342
18343 @item set task detach-suspend-count
18344 @cindex task suspend count
18345 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18346 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
18347 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
18348
18349 @item show task detach-suspend-count
18350 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
18351
18352 @item set task exception-port
18353 @itemx set task excp
18354 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18355 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
18356 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
18357 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
18358
18359 @item set noninvasive
18360 @cindex noninvasive task options
18361 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
18362 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
18363 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
18364 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
18365
18366 @item info send-rights
18367 @itemx info receive-rights
18368 @itemx info port-rights
18369 @itemx info port-sets
18370 @itemx info dead-names
18371 @itemx info ports
18372 @itemx info psets
18373 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18374 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18375 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18376 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18377 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18378 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
18379 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
18380 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
18381 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
18382
18383 @item set thread pause
18384 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
18385 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18386 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
18387 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
18388 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
18389 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
18390 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
18391 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
18392 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
18393 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
18394 only the current thread.
18395
18396 @item show thread pause
18397 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
18398 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
18399
18400 @item set thread run
18401 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
18402
18403 @item show thread run
18404 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
18405
18406 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
18407 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18408 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18409 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
18410 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
18411 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
18412 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
18413
18414 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
18415 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
18416 detaching.
18417
18418 @item set thread exception-port
18419 @itemx set thread excp
18420 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
18421 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
18422 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
18423
18424 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
18425 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
18426 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
18427 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
18428
18429 @item set thread default
18430 @itemx show thread default
18431 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
18432 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
18433 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
18434 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
18435 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
18436 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
18437 the non-default commands.
18438 @end table
18439
18440
18441 @node Neutrino
18442 @subsection QNX Neutrino
18443 @cindex QNX Neutrino
18444
18445 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
18446 Neutrino target:
18447
18448 @table @code
18449 @item set debug nto-debug
18450 @kindex set debug nto-debug
18451 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
18452 Neutrino support.
18453
18454 @item show debug nto-debug
18455 @kindex show debug nto-debug
18456 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
18457 @end table
18458
18459 @node Darwin
18460 @subsection Darwin
18461 @cindex Darwin
18462
18463 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
18464
18465 @table @code
18466 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
18467 @kindex set debug darwin
18468 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
18469 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
18470
18471 @item show debug darwin
18472 @kindex show debug darwin
18473 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
18474
18475 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
18476 @kindex set debug mach-o
18477 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
18478 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
18479 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
18480 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
18481 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
18482 usage.
18483
18484 @item show debug mach-o
18485 @kindex show debug mach-o
18486 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
18487
18488 @item set mach-exceptions on
18489 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
18490 @kindex set mach-exceptions
18491 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
18492 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
18493 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
18494 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
18495
18496 @item show mach-exceptions
18497 @kindex show mach-exceptions
18498 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
18499 @end table
18500
18501
18502 @node Embedded OS
18503 @section Embedded Operating Systems
18504
18505 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
18506 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
18507 architectures.
18508
18509 @menu
18510 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
18511 @end menu
18512
18513 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
18514 various real-time operating systems.
18515
18516 @node VxWorks
18517 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
18518
18519 @cindex VxWorks
18520
18521 @table @code
18522
18523 @kindex target vxworks
18524 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
18525 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
18526 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
18527
18528 @end table
18529
18530 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
18531 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
18532
18533 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
18534 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
18535 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
18536 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
18537 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
18538 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
18539 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
18540
18541 @table @code
18542 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
18543 @kindex vxworks-timeout
18544 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
18545 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
18546 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
18547 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
18548 of a thin network line.
18549 @end table
18550
18551 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
18552 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
18553 procedures.
18554
18555 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
18556 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
18557 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
18558 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
18559 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
18560 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
18561 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
18562 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
18563 manual.
18564 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
18565
18566 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
18567 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
18568 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
18569 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
18570
18571 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
18572
18573 @smallexample
18574 (vxgdb)
18575 @end smallexample
18576
18577 @menu
18578 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
18579 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
18580 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
18581 @end menu
18582
18583 @node VxWorks Connection
18584 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
18585
18586 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
18587 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
18588
18589 @smallexample
18590 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
18591 @end smallexample
18592
18593 @need 750
18594 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
18595
18596 @smallexample
18597 Attaching remote machine across net...
18598 Connected to tt.
18599 @end smallexample
18600
18601 @need 1000
18602 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
18603 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
18604 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
18605 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
18606 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
18607
18608 @smallexample
18609 prog.o: No such file or directory.
18610 @end smallexample
18611
18612 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
18613 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
18614 command again.
18615
18616 @node VxWorks Download
18617 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
18618
18619 @cindex download to VxWorks
18620 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
18621 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
18622 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
18623 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
18624 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
18625 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
18626 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
18627 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
18628 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
18629 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
18630 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
18631 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
18632 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
18633 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
18634 program, type this on VxWorks:
18635
18636 @smallexample
18637 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
18638 @end smallexample
18639
18640 @noindent
18641 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
18642
18643 @smallexample
18644 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
18645 (vxgdb) load prog.o
18646 @end smallexample
18647
18648 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
18649
18650 @smallexample
18651 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
18652 @end smallexample
18653
18654 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
18655 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
18656 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
18657 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
18658 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
18659 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
18660 table.)
18661
18662 @node VxWorks Attach
18663 @subsubsection Running Tasks
18664
18665 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
18666 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
18667 follows:
18668
18669 @smallexample
18670 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
18671 @end smallexample
18672
18673 @noindent
18674 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
18675 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
18676 the time of attachment.
18677
18678 @node Embedded Processors
18679 @section Embedded Processors
18680
18681 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
18682 configurations.
18683
18684 @cindex send command to simulator
18685 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
18686 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
18687
18688 @table @code
18689 @item sim @var{command}
18690 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
18691 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
18692 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
18693 acceptable commands.
18694 @end table
18695
18696
18697 @menu
18698 * ARM:: ARM RDI
18699 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
18700 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
18701 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
18702 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
18703 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
18704 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
18705 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
18706 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
18707 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
18708 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
18709 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
18710 * CRIS:: CRIS
18711 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
18712 @end menu
18713
18714 @node ARM
18715 @subsection ARM
18716 @cindex ARM RDI
18717
18718 @table @code
18719 @kindex target rdi
18720 @item target rdi @var{dev}
18721 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
18722 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
18723 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
18724
18725 @kindex target rdp
18726 @item target rdp @var{dev}
18727 ARM Demon monitor.
18728
18729 @end table
18730
18731 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
18732
18733 @table @code
18734 @item set arm disassembler
18735 @kindex set arm
18736 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
18737 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
18738
18739 @item show arm disassembler
18740 @kindex show arm
18741 Show the current disassembly style.
18742
18743 @item set arm apcs32
18744 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
18745 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
18746
18747 @item show arm apcs32
18748 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
18749
18750 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
18751 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
18752 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
18753
18754 @table @code
18755 @item auto
18756 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
18757 @item softfpa
18758 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
18759 processors.
18760 @item fpa
18761 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
18762 @item softvfp
18763 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
18764 @item vfp
18765 VFP co-processor.
18766 @end table
18767
18768 @item show arm fpu
18769 Show the current type of the FPU.
18770
18771 @item set arm abi
18772 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
18773
18774 @item show arm abi
18775 Show the currently used ABI.
18776
18777 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
18778 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
18779 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
18780 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
18781 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
18782 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
18783 register).
18784
18785 @item show arm fallback-mode
18786 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
18787
18788 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
18789 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
18790 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
18791 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
18792 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
18793
18794 @item show arm force-mode
18795 Show the current forced instruction mode.
18796
18797 @item set debug arm
18798 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
18799 target support subsystem.
18800
18801 @item show debug arm
18802 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
18803 @end table
18804
18805 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
18806 using the RDI interface:
18807
18808 @table @code
18809 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18810 @kindex rdilogfile
18811 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
18812 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
18813 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
18814 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
18815 @file{rdi.log}.
18816
18817 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
18818 @kindex rdilogenable
18819 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
18820 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
18821 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
18822 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
18823 are logged to a file.
18824
18825 @item set rdiromatzero
18826 @kindex set rdiromatzero
18827 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
18828 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
18829 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
18830 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
18831 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
18832
18833 @item show rdiromatzero
18834 @kindex show rdiromatzero
18835 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
18836
18837 @item set rdiheartbeat
18838 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
18839 @cindex RDI heartbeat
18840 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
18841 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
18842 well as the Angel monitor.
18843
18844 @item show rdiheartbeat
18845 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
18846 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
18847 @end table
18848
18849 @table @code
18850 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18851 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
18852
18853 @table @code
18854 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
18855 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support.
18856 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
18857 The default value is @code{all}.
18858
18859 @table @code
18860 @item none
18861 @item demon
18862 @item angel
18863 @item redboot
18864 @item all
18865 @end table
18866 @end table
18867 @end table
18868
18869 @node M32R/D
18870 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
18871
18872 @table @code
18873 @kindex target m32r
18874 @item target m32r @var{dev}
18875 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
18876
18877 @kindex target m32rsdi
18878 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
18879 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
18880 @end table
18881
18882 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
18883
18884 @table @code
18885 @item set download-path @var{path}
18886 @kindex set download-path
18887 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
18888 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
18889
18890 @item show download-path
18891 @kindex show download-path
18892 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
18893
18894 @item set board-address @var{addr}
18895 @kindex set board-address
18896 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
18897 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
18898
18899 @item show board-address
18900 @kindex show board-address
18901 Show the current IP address of the target board.
18902
18903 @item set server-address @var{addr}
18904 @kindex set server-address
18905 @cindex download server address (M32R)
18906 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
18907 host machine.
18908
18909 @item show server-address
18910 @kindex show server-address
18911 Display the IP address of the download server.
18912
18913 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18914 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
18915 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
18916 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
18917 executable file is uploaded.
18918
18919 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
18920 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
18921 Test the @code{upload} command.
18922 @end table
18923
18924 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
18925
18926 @table @code
18927 @item sdireset
18928 @kindex sdireset
18929 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
18930 This command resets the SDI connection.
18931
18932 @item sdistatus
18933 @kindex sdistatus
18934 This command shows the SDI connection status.
18935
18936 @item debug_chaos
18937 @kindex debug_chaos
18938 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
18939 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
18940
18941 @item use_debug_dma
18942 @kindex use_debug_dma
18943 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
18944
18945 @item use_mon_code
18946 @kindex use_mon_code
18947 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
18948
18949 @item use_ib_break
18950 @kindex use_ib_break
18951 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
18952
18953 @item use_dbt_break
18954 @kindex use_dbt_break
18955 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
18956 @end table
18957
18958 @node M68K
18959 @subsection M68k
18960
18961 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
18962 target command for the following ROM monitor.
18963
18964 @table @code
18965
18966 @kindex target dbug
18967 @item target dbug @var{dev}
18968 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
18969
18970 @end table
18971
18972 @node MicroBlaze
18973 @subsection MicroBlaze
18974 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
18975 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
18976
18977 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
18978 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
18979 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
18980 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
18981 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
18982 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
18983 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
18984 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
18985 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
18986 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
18987 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
18988
18989 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
18990
18991 @table @code
18992 @item target remote :1234
18993 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
18994 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
18995
18996 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
18997 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
18998 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
18999
19000 @item load
19001 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
19002
19003 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
19004 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
19005
19006 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
19007 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
19008 @end table
19009
19010 @node MIPS Embedded
19011 @subsection MIPS Embedded
19012
19013 @cindex MIPS boards
19014 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
19015 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
19016 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
19017
19018 @need 1000
19019 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
19020
19021 @table @code
19022 @item target mips @var{port}
19023 @kindex target mips @var{port}
19024 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
19025 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
19026 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
19027 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
19028 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
19029 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
19030
19031 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
19032 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
19033 debugger:
19034
19035 @smallexample
19036 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
19037 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
19038 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
19039 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
19040 (@value{GDBP}) run
19041 @end smallexample
19042
19043 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
19044 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
19045 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
19046 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
19047 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
19048
19049 @item target pmon @var{port}
19050 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
19051 PMON ROM monitor.
19052
19053 @item target ddb @var{port}
19054 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
19055 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
19056
19057 @item target lsi @var{port}
19058 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
19059 LSI variant of PMON.
19060
19061 @kindex target r3900
19062 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
19063 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
19064
19065 @kindex target array
19066 @item target array @var{dev}
19067 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
19068
19069 @end table
19070
19071
19072 @noindent
19073 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
19074
19075 @table @code
19076 @item set mipsfpu double
19077 @itemx set mipsfpu single
19078 @itemx set mipsfpu none
19079 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
19080 @itemx show mipsfpu
19081 @kindex set mipsfpu
19082 @kindex show mipsfpu
19083 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
19084 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
19085 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
19086 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
19087 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
19088 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
19089 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
19090 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
19091 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
19092 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
19093 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
19094 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
19095 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
19096
19097 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
19098 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
19099 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
19100
19101 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
19102 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
19103
19104 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
19105 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
19106 @itemx show timeout
19107 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
19108 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
19109 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
19110 @kindex set timeout
19111 @kindex show timeout
19112 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
19113 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
19114 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
19115 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
19116 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
19117 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
19118 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
19119 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
19120 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
19121 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
19122
19123 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
19124 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
19125 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
19126 to run before stopping.
19127
19128 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
19129 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
19130 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
19131 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
19132 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
19133 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
19134
19135 @item show syn-garbage-limit
19136 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
19137 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
19138 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
19139
19140 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
19141 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
19142 @cindex remote monitor prompt
19143 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
19144 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
19145 @table @asis
19146 @item pmon target
19147 @samp{PMON}
19148 @item ddb target
19149 @samp{NEC010}
19150 @item lsi target
19151 @samp{PMON>}
19152 @end table
19153
19154 @item show monitor-prompt
19155 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
19156 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
19157 remote monitor.
19158
19159 @item set monitor-warnings
19160 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
19161 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
19162 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
19163 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
19164 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
19165
19166 @item show monitor-warnings
19167 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
19168 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
19169
19170 @item pmon @var{command}
19171 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
19172 @cindex send PMON command
19173 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
19174 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
19175 @end table
19176
19177 @node OpenRISC 1000
19178 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
19179 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
19180
19181 @cindex or1k boards
19182 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
19183 about platform and commands.
19184
19185 @table @code
19186
19187 @kindex target jtag
19188 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
19189
19190 Connects to remote JTAG server.
19191 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
19192 connected via parallel port to the board.
19193
19194 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
19195
19196 @kindex or1ksim
19197 @item or1ksim @var{command}
19198 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
19199 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
19200
19201 @kindex info or1k spr
19202 @item info or1k spr
19203 Displays spr groups.
19204
19205 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
19206 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
19207 Displays register names in selected group.
19208
19209 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
19210 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
19211 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
19212 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
19213 Shows information about specified spr register.
19214
19215 @kindex spr
19216 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
19217 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
19218 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
19219 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
19220 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
19221 @end table
19222
19223 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
19224 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
19225 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
19226 triggers can be set using:
19227 @table @code
19228 @item $LEA/$LDATA
19229 Load effective address/data
19230 @item $SEA/$SDATA
19231 Store effective address/data
19232 @item $AEA/$ADATA
19233 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
19234 @item $FETCH
19235 Fetch data
19236 @end table
19237
19238 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
19239 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
19240
19241 @code{htrace} commands:
19242 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
19243 @table @code
19244 @kindex hwatch
19245 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
19246 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
19247 or Data. For example:
19248
19249 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
19250
19251 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
19252
19253 @kindex htrace
19254 @item htrace info
19255 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
19256
19257 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
19258 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
19259
19260 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
19261 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
19262
19263 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
19264 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
19265
19266 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
19267 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
19268 triggered.
19269
19270 @item htrace enable
19271 @itemx htrace disable
19272 Enables/disables the HW trace.
19273
19274 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
19275 Clears currently recorded trace data.
19276
19277 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
19278 will be written there.
19279
19280 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
19281 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
19282
19283 @item htrace mode continuous
19284 Set continuous trace mode.
19285
19286 @item htrace mode suspend
19287 Set suspend trace mode.
19288
19289 @end table
19290
19291 @node PowerPC Embedded
19292 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
19293
19294 @cindex DVC register
19295 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
19296 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
19297
19298 @smallexample
19299 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
19300 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
19301 @end smallexample
19302
19303 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
19304 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
19305 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
19306 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
19307 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
19308 or newer.
19309
19310 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
19311 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
19312 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
19313 watching variables of scalar types.
19314
19315 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
19316 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
19317
19318 @smallexample
19319 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
19320 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
19321 @end smallexample
19322
19323 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
19324 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
19325
19326 @cindex ranged breakpoint
19327 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
19328 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
19329 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
19330 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
19331 use the @code{break-range} command.
19332
19333 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
19334
19335 @table @code
19336 @kindex break-range
19337 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
19338 Set a breakpoint for an address range.
19339 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location} can specify a function name,
19340 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
19341 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
19342 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
19343 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
19344 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
19345 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
19346
19347 @kindex set powerpc
19348 @item set powerpc soft-float
19349 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
19350 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
19351 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
19352 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
19353
19354 @item set powerpc vector-abi
19355 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
19356 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
19357 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
19358 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
19359 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
19360 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
19361 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
19362
19363 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
19364 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
19365 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
19366 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
19367 address of its first byte.
19368
19369 @kindex target dink32
19370 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
19371 DINK32 ROM monitor.
19372
19373 @kindex target ppcbug
19374 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
19375 @kindex target ppcbug1
19376 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
19377 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
19378
19379 @kindex target sds
19380 @item target sds @var{dev}
19381 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
19382 @end table
19383
19384 @cindex SDS protocol
19385 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
19386 by @value{GDBN}:
19387
19388 @table @code
19389 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
19390 @kindex set sdstimeout
19391 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
19392 default is 2 seconds.
19393
19394 @item show sdstimeout
19395 @kindex show sdstimeout
19396 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
19397
19398 @item sds @var{command}
19399 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
19400 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
19401 @end table
19402
19403
19404 @node PA
19405 @subsection HP PA Embedded
19406
19407 @table @code
19408
19409 @kindex target op50n
19410 @item target op50n @var{dev}
19411 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
19412
19413 @kindex target w89k
19414 @item target w89k @var{dev}
19415 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
19416
19417 @end table
19418
19419 @node Sparclet
19420 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
19421
19422 @cindex Sparclet
19423
19424 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
19425 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
19426 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
19427 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
19428 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
19429
19430 @table @code
19431 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
19432 @kindex remotetimeout
19433 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
19434 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
19435 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
19436 @end table
19437
19438 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
19439 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
19440 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
19441 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
19442 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
19443
19444 @smallexample
19445 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
19446 @end smallexample
19447
19448 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
19449
19450 @smallexample
19451 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
19452 @end smallexample
19453
19454 @cindex running, on Sparclet
19455 Once you have set
19456 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
19457 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
19458 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
19459
19460 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
19461
19462 @smallexample
19463 (gdbslet)
19464 @end smallexample
19465
19466 @menu
19467 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
19468 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
19469 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
19470 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
19471 @end menu
19472
19473 @node Sparclet File
19474 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
19475
19476 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
19477
19478 @smallexample
19479 (gdbslet) file prog
19480 @end smallexample
19481
19482 @need 1000
19483 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
19484 @value{GDBN} locates
19485 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
19486 path.
19487 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
19488 files will be searched as well.
19489 @value{GDBN} locates
19490 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
19491 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
19492 If it fails
19493 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
19494
19495 @smallexample
19496 prog: No such file or directory.
19497 @end smallexample
19498
19499 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
19500 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
19501 @code{target} command again.
19502
19503 @node Sparclet Connection
19504 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
19505
19506 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
19507 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
19508
19509 @smallexample
19510 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
19511 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
19512 main () at ../prog.c:3
19513 @end smallexample
19514
19515 @need 750
19516 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
19517
19518 @smallexample
19519 Connected to ttya.
19520 @end smallexample
19521
19522 @node Sparclet Download
19523 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
19524
19525 @cindex download to Sparclet
19526 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
19527 you can use the @value{GDBN}
19528 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
19529 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
19530 command.
19531 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
19532 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
19533 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
19534 of each of the file's sections.
19535 For instance, if the program
19536 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
19537 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
19538
19539 @smallexample
19540 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
19541 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
19542 @end smallexample
19543
19544 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
19545 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
19546 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
19547
19548 @node Sparclet Execution
19549 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
19550
19551 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
19552 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
19553 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
19554 manual for the list of commands.
19555
19556 @smallexample
19557 (gdbslet) b main
19558 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
19559 (gdbslet) run
19560 Starting program: prog
19561 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
19562 3 char *symarg = 0;
19563 (gdbslet) step
19564 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
19565 (gdbslet)
19566 @end smallexample
19567
19568 @node Sparclite
19569 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
19570
19571 @table @code
19572
19573 @kindex target sparclite
19574 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
19575 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
19576 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
19577 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
19578 remote protocol.
19579
19580 @end table
19581
19582 @node Z8000
19583 @subsection Zilog Z8000
19584
19585 @cindex Z8000
19586 @cindex simulator, Z8000
19587 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
19588
19589 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
19590 a Z8000 simulator.
19591
19592 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
19593 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
19594 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
19595 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
19596
19597 @table @code
19598 @item target sim @var{args}
19599 @kindex sim
19600 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
19601 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
19602 options, specify them via @var{args}.
19603 @end table
19604
19605 @noindent
19606 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
19607 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
19608 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
19609 to run your program, and so on.
19610
19611 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
19612 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
19613 additional items of information as specially named registers:
19614
19615 @table @code
19616
19617 @item cycles
19618 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
19619
19620 @item insts
19621 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
19622
19623 @item time
19624 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
19625
19626 @end table
19627
19628 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
19629 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
19630 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
19631 simulated clock ticks.
19632
19633 @node AVR
19634 @subsection Atmel AVR
19635 @cindex AVR
19636
19637 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
19638 following AVR-specific commands:
19639
19640 @table @code
19641 @item info io_registers
19642 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
19643 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
19644 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
19645 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
19646 @end table
19647
19648 @node CRIS
19649 @subsection CRIS
19650 @cindex CRIS
19651
19652 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
19653 following CRIS-specific commands:
19654
19655 @table @code
19656 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
19657 @cindex CRIS version
19658 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
19659 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
19660 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
19661
19662 @item show cris-version
19663 Show the current CRIS version.
19664
19665 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
19666 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
19667 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
19668 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
19669 @code{R59}.
19670
19671 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
19672 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
19673
19674 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
19675 @cindex CRIS mode
19676 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
19677 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
19678 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
19679
19680 @item show cris-mode
19681 Show the current CRIS mode.
19682 @end table
19683
19684 @node Super-H
19685 @subsection Renesas Super-H
19686 @cindex Super-H
19687
19688 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
19689 commands:
19690
19691 @table @code
19692 @item regs
19693 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
19694 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
19695
19696 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
19697 @kindex set sh calling-convention
19698 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
19699 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
19700 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
19701 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
19702 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
19703 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
19704 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
19705 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
19706 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
19707 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
19708
19709 @item show sh calling-convention
19710 @kindex show sh calling-convention
19711 Show the current calling convention setting.
19712
19713 @end table
19714
19715
19716 @node Architectures
19717 @section Architectures
19718
19719 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
19720 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
19721
19722 @menu
19723 * i386::
19724 * A29K::
19725 * Alpha::
19726 * MIPS::
19727 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
19728 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
19729 * PowerPC::
19730 @end menu
19731
19732 @node i386
19733 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
19734
19735 @table @code
19736 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
19737 @kindex set struct-convention
19738 @cindex struct return convention
19739 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
19740 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
19741 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
19742 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
19743 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
19744 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
19745 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
19746 be returned in a register.
19747
19748 @item show struct-convention
19749 @kindex show struct-convention
19750 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
19751 from functions.
19752 @end table
19753
19754 @node A29K
19755 @subsection A29K
19756
19757 @table @code
19758
19759 @kindex set rstack_high_address
19760 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
19761 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
19762 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
19763 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
19764 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
19765 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
19766 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
19767 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
19768 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
19769 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
19770 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
19771 hexadecimal.
19772
19773 @kindex show rstack_high_address
19774 @item show rstack_high_address
19775 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
19776 processors.
19777
19778 @end table
19779
19780 @node Alpha
19781 @subsection Alpha
19782
19783 See the following section.
19784
19785 @node MIPS
19786 @subsection MIPS
19787
19788 @cindex stack on Alpha
19789 @cindex stack on MIPS
19790 @cindex Alpha stack
19791 @cindex MIPS stack
19792 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
19793 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
19794 find the beginning of a function.
19795
19796 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
19797 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
19798 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
19799 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
19800 commands:
19801
19802 @table @code
19803 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
19804 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
19805 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
19806 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
19807 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
19808 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
19809 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
19810 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
19811
19812 @item show heuristic-fence-post
19813 Display the current limit.
19814 @end table
19815
19816 @noindent
19817 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
19818 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
19819
19820 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
19821 programs:
19822
19823 @table @code
19824 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
19825 @kindex set mips abi
19826 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
19827 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
19828 values of @var{arg} are:
19829
19830 @table @samp
19831 @item auto
19832 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
19833 default).
19834 @item o32
19835 @item o64
19836 @item n32
19837 @item n64
19838 @item eabi32
19839 @item eabi64
19840 @item auto
19841 @end table
19842
19843 @item show mips abi
19844 @kindex show mips abi
19845 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
19846
19847 @item set mipsfpu
19848 @itemx show mipsfpu
19849 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
19850
19851 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
19852 @kindex set mips mask-address
19853 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
19854 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
19855 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
19856 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
19857 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
19858
19859 @item show mips mask-address
19860 @kindex show mips mask-address
19861 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
19862 not.
19863
19864 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19865 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19866 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
19867 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
19868 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
19869 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
19870
19871 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19872 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
19873 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
19874
19875 @item set debug mips
19876 @kindex set debug mips
19877 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
19878 target code in @value{GDBN}.
19879
19880 @item show debug mips
19881 @kindex show debug mips
19882 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
19883 @end table
19884
19885
19886 @node HPPA
19887 @subsection HPPA
19888 @cindex HPPA support
19889
19890 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
19891 following special commands:
19892
19893 @table @code
19894 @item set debug hppa
19895 @kindex set debug hppa
19896 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
19897 messages are to be displayed.
19898
19899 @item show debug hppa
19900 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
19901
19902 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
19903 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
19904 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
19905 given @var{address}.
19906
19907 @end table
19908
19909
19910 @node SPU
19911 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
19912 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
19913 @cindex SPU
19914
19915 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
19916 it provides the following special commands:
19917
19918 @table @code
19919 @item info spu event
19920 @kindex info spu
19921 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
19922 and pending event status.
19923
19924 @item info spu signal
19925 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
19926 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
19927 notification channels.
19928
19929 @item info spu mailbox
19930 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
19931 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
19932 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
19933
19934 @item info spu dma
19935 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
19936 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
19937 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
19938
19939 @item info spu proxydma
19940 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
19941 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
19942 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
19943
19944 @end table
19945
19946 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
19947 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
19948 special commands:
19949
19950 @table @code
19951 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
19952 @kindex set spu
19953 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
19954 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
19955 function. The default is @code{off}.
19956
19957 @item show spu stop-on-load
19958 @kindex show spu
19959 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
19960
19961 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
19962 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
19963 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
19964 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
19965 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
19966 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
19967
19968 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
19969 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
19970
19971 @end table
19972
19973 @node PowerPC
19974 @subsection PowerPC
19975 @cindex PowerPC architecture
19976
19977 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
19978 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
19979 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
19980 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
19981 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
19982
19983 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
19984 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
19985 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
19986
19987 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
19988 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
19989
19990
19991 @node Controlling GDB
19992 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
19993
19994 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
19995 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
19996 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
19997 described here.
19998
19999 @menu
20000 * Prompt:: Prompt
20001 * Editing:: Command editing
20002 * Command History:: Command history
20003 * Screen Size:: Screen size
20004 * Numbers:: Numbers
20005 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
20006 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
20007 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
20008 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
20009 @end menu
20010
20011 @node Prompt
20012 @section Prompt
20013
20014 @cindex prompt
20015
20016 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
20017 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
20018 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
20019 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
20020 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
20021 which one you are talking to.
20022
20023 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
20024 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
20025 or a prompt that does not.
20026
20027 @table @code
20028 @kindex set prompt
20029 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
20030 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
20031
20032 @kindex show prompt
20033 @item show prompt
20034 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
20035 @end table
20036
20037 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
20038 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
20039 are:
20040
20041 @table @code
20042 @kindex set extended-prompt
20043 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
20044 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
20045 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
20046 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
20047 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
20048 is displayed.
20049
20050 For example:
20051
20052 @smallexample
20053 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
20054 @end smallexample
20055
20056 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
20057 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
20058
20059 @kindex show extended-prompt
20060 @item show extended-prompt
20061 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
20062 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
20063 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
20064 @end table
20065
20066 @node Editing
20067 @section Command Editing
20068 @cindex readline
20069 @cindex command line editing
20070
20071 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
20072 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
20073 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
20074 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
20075 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
20076 debugging sessions.
20077
20078 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
20079 command @code{set}.
20080
20081 @table @code
20082 @kindex set editing
20083 @cindex editing
20084 @item set editing
20085 @itemx set editing on
20086 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
20087
20088 @item set editing off
20089 Disable command line editing.
20090
20091 @kindex show editing
20092 @item show editing
20093 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
20094 @end table
20095
20096 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
20097 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
20098 @end ifset
20099 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
20100 @xref{Command Line Editing},
20101 @end ifclear
20102 for more details about the Readline
20103 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
20104 encouraged to read that chapter.
20105
20106 @node Command History
20107 @section Command History
20108 @cindex command history
20109
20110 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
20111 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
20112 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
20113 history facility.
20114
20115 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
20116 package, to provide the history facility.
20117 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
20118 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
20119 @end ifset
20120 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
20121 @xref{Using History Interactively},
20122 @end ifclear
20123 for the detailed description of the History library.
20124
20125 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
20126 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
20127 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
20128 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
20129 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
20130 pressed on a line by itself.
20131
20132 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
20133 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
20134 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
20135 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
20136
20137 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
20138 history.
20139
20140 @table @code
20141 @cindex history substitution
20142 @cindex history file
20143 @kindex set history filename
20144 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
20145 @item set history filename @var{fname}
20146 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
20147 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
20148 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
20149 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
20150 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
20151 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
20152 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
20153 is not set.
20154
20155 @cindex save command history
20156 @kindex set history save
20157 @item set history save
20158 @itemx set history save on
20159 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
20160 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
20161
20162 @item set history save off
20163 Stop recording command history in a file.
20164
20165 @cindex history size
20166 @kindex set history size
20167 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
20168 @item set history size @var{size}
20169 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
20170 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
20171 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
20172 @end table
20173
20174 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
20175 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
20176 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
20177 @end ifset
20178 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
20179 @xref{Event Designators},
20180 @end ifclear
20181 for more details.
20182
20183 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
20184 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
20185 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
20186 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
20187 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
20188 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
20189 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
20190 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
20191
20192 The commands to control history expansion are:
20193
20194 @table @code
20195 @item set history expansion on
20196 @itemx set history expansion
20197 @kindex set history expansion
20198 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
20199
20200 @item set history expansion off
20201 Disable history expansion.
20202
20203 @c @group
20204 @kindex show history
20205 @item show history
20206 @itemx show history filename
20207 @itemx show history save
20208 @itemx show history size
20209 @itemx show history expansion
20210 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
20211 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
20212 @c @end group
20213 @end table
20214
20215 @table @code
20216 @kindex show commands
20217 @cindex show last commands
20218 @cindex display command history
20219 @item show commands
20220 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
20221
20222 @item show commands @var{n}
20223 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
20224
20225 @item show commands +
20226 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
20227 @end table
20228
20229 @node Screen Size
20230 @section Screen Size
20231 @cindex size of screen
20232 @cindex pauses in output
20233
20234 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
20235 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
20236 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
20237 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
20238 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
20239 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
20240 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
20241 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
20242
20243 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
20244 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
20245 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
20246 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
20247 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
20248 width} commands:
20249
20250 @table @code
20251 @kindex set height
20252 @kindex set width
20253 @kindex show width
20254 @kindex show height
20255 @item set height @var{lpp}
20256 @itemx show height
20257 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
20258 @itemx show width
20259 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
20260 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
20261 commands display the current settings.
20262
20263 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
20264 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
20265 file or to an editor buffer.
20266
20267 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
20268 from wrapping its output.
20269
20270 @item set pagination on
20271 @itemx set pagination off
20272 @kindex set pagination
20273 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
20274 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}. Note that
20275 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
20276 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
20277
20278 @item show pagination
20279 @kindex show pagination
20280 Show the current pagination mode.
20281 @end table
20282
20283 @node Numbers
20284 @section Numbers
20285 @cindex number representation
20286 @cindex entering numbers
20287
20288 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
20289 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
20290 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
20291 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
20292 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
20293 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
20294 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
20295 both input and output with the commands described below.
20296
20297 @table @code
20298 @kindex set input-radix
20299 @item set input-radix @var{base}
20300 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
20301 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
20302 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
20303 example, any of
20304
20305 @smallexample
20306 set input-radix 012
20307 set input-radix 10.
20308 set input-radix 0xa
20309 @end smallexample
20310
20311 @noindent
20312 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
20313 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
20314 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
20315 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
20316 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
20317 change the radix.
20318
20319 @kindex set output-radix
20320 @item set output-radix @var{base}
20321 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
20322 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
20323 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
20324
20325 @kindex show input-radix
20326 @item show input-radix
20327 Display the current default base for numeric input.
20328
20329 @kindex show output-radix
20330 @item show output-radix
20331 Display the current default base for numeric display.
20332
20333 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
20334 @itemx show radix
20335 @kindex set radix
20336 @kindex show radix
20337 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
20338 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
20339 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
20340 default value of 10.
20341
20342 @end table
20343
20344 @node ABI
20345 @section Configuring the Current ABI
20346
20347 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
20348 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
20349 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
20350 current ABI.
20351
20352 @cindex OS ABI
20353 @kindex set osabi
20354 @kindex show osabi
20355
20356 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
20357 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
20358 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
20359 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
20360 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
20361 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
20362 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
20363 platform provides.
20364
20365 @table @code
20366 @item show osabi
20367 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
20368
20369 @item set osabi
20370 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
20371
20372 @item set osabi @var{abi}
20373 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
20374 @end table
20375
20376 @cindex float promotion
20377
20378 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
20379 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
20380 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
20381 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
20382 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
20383 @code{double} and then passed.
20384
20385 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
20386 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
20387 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
20388
20389 @table @code
20390 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
20391 @item set coerce-float-to-double
20392 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
20393 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
20394 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
20395
20396 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
20397 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
20398 functions.
20399
20400 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
20401 @item show coerce-float-to-double
20402 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
20403 @end table
20404
20405 @kindex set cp-abi
20406 @kindex show cp-abi
20407 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
20408 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
20409 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
20410 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
20411 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
20412 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
20413 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
20414 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
20415 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
20416 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
20417 ``auto''.
20418
20419 @table @code
20420 @item show cp-abi
20421 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
20422
20423 @item set cp-abi
20424 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
20425
20426 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
20427 @itemx set cp-abi auto
20428 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
20429 @end table
20430
20431 @node Messages/Warnings
20432 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
20433
20434 @cindex verbose operation
20435 @cindex optional warnings
20436 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
20437 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
20438 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
20439 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
20440
20441 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
20442 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
20443 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
20444
20445 @table @code
20446 @kindex set verbose
20447 @item set verbose on
20448 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
20449
20450 @item set verbose off
20451 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
20452
20453 @kindex show verbose
20454 @item show verbose
20455 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
20456 @end table
20457
20458 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
20459 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
20460 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
20461 Symbol Files}).
20462
20463 @table @code
20464
20465 @kindex set complaints
20466 @item set complaints @var{limit}
20467 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
20468 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
20469 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
20470 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
20471
20472 @kindex show complaints
20473 @item show complaints
20474 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
20475
20476 @end table
20477
20478 @anchor{confirmation requests}
20479 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
20480 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
20481 you try to run a program which is already running:
20482
20483 @smallexample
20484 (@value{GDBP}) run
20485 The program being debugged has been started already.
20486 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
20487 @end smallexample
20488
20489 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
20490 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
20491
20492 @table @code
20493
20494 @kindex set confirm
20495 @cindex flinching
20496 @cindex confirmation
20497 @cindex stupid questions
20498 @item set confirm off
20499 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
20500 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
20501 automatically disables confirmation requests.
20502
20503 @item set confirm on
20504 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
20505
20506 @kindex show confirm
20507 @item show confirm
20508 Displays state of confirmation requests.
20509
20510 @end table
20511
20512 @cindex command tracing
20513 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
20514 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
20515 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
20516 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
20517
20518 @table @code
20519 @kindex set trace-commands
20520 @cindex command scripts, debugging
20521 @item set trace-commands on
20522 Enable command tracing.
20523 @item set trace-commands off
20524 Disable command tracing.
20525 @item show trace-commands
20526 Display the current state of command tracing.
20527 @end table
20528
20529 @node Debugging Output
20530 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
20531 @cindex optional debugging messages
20532
20533 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
20534 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
20535 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
20536 section documents those commands.
20537
20538 @table @code
20539 @kindex set exec-done-display
20540 @item set exec-done-display
20541 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
20542 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
20543 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
20544 @kindex show exec-done-display
20545 @item show exec-done-display
20546 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
20547 notification.
20548 @kindex set debug
20549 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
20550 @cindex architecture debugging info
20551 @item set debug arch
20552 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
20553 @kindex show debug
20554 @item show debug arch
20555 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
20556 @item set debug aix-thread
20557 @cindex AIX threads
20558 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
20559 module.
20560 @item show debug aix-thread
20561 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
20562 @item set debug check-physname
20563 @cindex physname
20564 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
20565 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
20566 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
20567 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
20568 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
20569 both ways and display any discrepancies.
20570 @item show debug check-physname
20571 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
20572 @item set debug dwarf2-die
20573 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
20574 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
20575 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
20576 A value of zero turns off the display.
20577 @item show debug dwarf2-die
20578 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
20579 @item set debug displaced
20580 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
20581 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
20582 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
20583 @item show debug displaced
20584 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
20585 related to displaced stepping.
20586 @item set debug event
20587 @cindex event debugging info
20588 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
20589 default is off.
20590 @item show debug event
20591 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
20592 info.
20593 @item set debug expression
20594 @cindex expression debugging info
20595 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
20596 expression parsing. The default is off.
20597 @item show debug expression
20598 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
20599 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
20600 @item set debug frame
20601 @cindex frame debugging info
20602 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
20603 default is off.
20604 @item show debug frame
20605 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
20606 info.
20607 @item set debug gnu-nat
20608 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
20609 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
20610 @item show debug gnu-nat
20611 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
20612 @item set debug infrun
20613 @cindex inferior debugging info
20614 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
20615 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
20616 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
20617 @item show debug infrun
20618 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
20619 @item set debug jit
20620 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
20621 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
20622 @item show debug jit
20623 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
20624 @item set debug lin-lwp
20625 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
20626 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
20627 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
20628 @item show debug lin-lwp
20629 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
20630 @item set debug observer
20631 @cindex observer debugging info
20632 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
20633 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
20634 @item show debug observer
20635 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
20636 @item set debug overload
20637 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
20638 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
20639 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
20640 is off.
20641 @item show debug overload
20642 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
20643 debugging info.
20644 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
20645 @cindex debug expression parser
20646 @item set debug parser
20647 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
20648 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
20649 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
20650 details. The default is off.
20651 @item show debug parser
20652 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
20653 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
20654 @cindex serial connections, debugging
20655 @cindex debug remote protocol
20656 @cindex remote protocol debugging
20657 @cindex display remote packets
20658 @item set debug remote
20659 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
20660 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
20661 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
20662 @item show debug remote
20663 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
20664 @item set debug serial
20665 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
20666 default is off.
20667 @item show debug serial
20668 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
20669 info.
20670 @item set debug solib-frv
20671 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
20672 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
20673 @item show debug solib-frv
20674 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
20675 messages.
20676 @item set debug target
20677 @cindex target debugging info
20678 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
20679 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
20680 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
20681 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
20682 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
20683 @item show debug target
20684 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
20685 info.
20686 @item set debug timestamp
20687 @cindex timestampping debugging info
20688 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
20689 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
20690 message.
20691 @item show debug timestamp
20692 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
20693 debugging info.
20694 @item set debugvarobj
20695 @cindex variable object debugging info
20696 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
20697 info. The default is off.
20698 @item show debugvarobj
20699 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
20700 debugging info.
20701 @item set debug xml
20702 @cindex XML parser debugging
20703 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
20704 @item show debug xml
20705 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
20706 @end table
20707
20708 @node Other Misc Settings
20709 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
20710 @cindex miscellaneous settings
20711
20712 @table @code
20713 @kindex set interactive-mode
20714 @item set interactive-mode
20715 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
20716 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
20717 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
20718 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
20719 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
20720 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
20721 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
20722 is, non-interactively otherwise.
20723
20724 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
20725 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
20726 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
20727 inside a cygwin window.
20728
20729 @kindex show interactive-mode
20730 @item show interactive-mode
20731 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
20732 @end table
20733
20734 @node Extending GDB
20735 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
20736 @cindex extending GDB
20737
20738 @value{GDBN} provides three mechanisms for extension. The first is based
20739 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, the second is based on the
20740 Python scripting language, and the third is for defining new aliases of
20741 existing commands.
20742
20743 To facilitate the use of the first two extensions, @value{GDBN} is capable
20744 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
20745 can recognize which scripting language is being used by looking at
20746 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
20747 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
20748 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
20749
20750 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
20751 setting:
20752
20753 @table @code
20754 @kindex set script-extension
20755 @kindex show script-extension
20756 @item set script-extension off
20757 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
20758
20759 @item set script-extension soft
20760 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
20761 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
20762 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
20763 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
20764
20765 @item set script-extension strict
20766 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
20767 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
20768 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
20769
20770 @item show script-extension
20771 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
20772
20773 @end table
20774
20775 @menu
20776 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
20777 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
20778 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
20779 @end menu
20780
20781 @node Sequences
20782 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
20783
20784 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
20785 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
20786 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
20787 files.
20788
20789 @menu
20790 * Define:: How to define your own commands
20791 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
20792 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
20793 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
20794 @end menu
20795
20796 @node Define
20797 @subsection User-defined Commands
20798
20799 @cindex user-defined command
20800 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
20801 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
20802 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
20803 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
20804 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
20805 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
20806
20807 @smallexample
20808 define adder
20809 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
20810 end
20811 @end smallexample
20812
20813 @noindent
20814 To execute the command use:
20815
20816 @smallexample
20817 adder 1 2 3
20818 @end smallexample
20819
20820 @noindent
20821 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
20822 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
20823 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
20824 functions calls.
20825
20826 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
20827 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
20828 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
20829 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
20830
20831 @smallexample
20832 define adder
20833 if $argc == 2
20834 print $arg0 + $arg1
20835 end
20836 if $argc == 3
20837 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
20838 end
20839 end
20840 @end smallexample
20841
20842 @table @code
20843
20844 @kindex define
20845 @item define @var{commandname}
20846 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
20847 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
20848 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
20849 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
20850 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
20851 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
20852
20853 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
20854 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
20855 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
20856
20857 @kindex document
20858 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
20859 @item document @var{commandname}
20860 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
20861 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
20862 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
20863 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
20864 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
20865 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
20866
20867 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
20868 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
20869 does not change the documentation.
20870
20871 @kindex dont-repeat
20872 @cindex don't repeat command
20873 @item dont-repeat
20874 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
20875 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
20876 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
20877
20878 @kindex help user-defined
20879 @item help user-defined
20880 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
20881 (if any) for each.
20882
20883 @kindex show user
20884 @item show user
20885 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
20886 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
20887 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
20888 definitions for all user-defined commands.
20889
20890 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
20891 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
20892 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
20893 @item show max-user-call-depth
20894 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
20895 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
20896 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
20897 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
20898 @end table
20899
20900 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
20901 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
20902
20903 When user-defined commands are executed, the
20904 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
20905 stops execution of the user-defined command.
20906
20907 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
20908 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
20909 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
20910 messages when used in a user-defined command.
20911
20912 @node Hooks
20913 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
20914 @cindex command hooks
20915 @cindex hooks, for commands
20916 @cindex hooks, pre-command
20917
20918 @kindex hook
20919 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
20920 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
20921 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
20922 before that command.
20923
20924 @cindex hooks, post-command
20925 @kindex hookpost
20926 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
20927 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
20928 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
20929 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
20930 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
20931
20932 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
20933 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
20934
20935 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
20936 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
20937
20938 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
20939 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
20940 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
20941 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
20942 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
20943
20944 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
20945 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
20946 you could define:
20947
20948 @smallexample
20949 define hook-stop
20950 handle SIGALRM nopass
20951 end
20952
20953 define hook-run
20954 handle SIGALRM pass
20955 end
20956
20957 define hook-continue
20958 handle SIGALRM pass
20959 end
20960 @end smallexample
20961
20962 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
20963 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
20964 you could define:
20965
20966 @smallexample
20967 define hook-echo
20968 echo <<<---
20969 end
20970
20971 define hookpost-echo
20972 echo --->>>\n
20973 end
20974
20975 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
20976 <<<---Hello World--->>>
20977 (@value{GDBP})
20978
20979 @end smallexample
20980
20981 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
20982 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
20983 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
20984 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
20985 @c or not?
20986 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
20987 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
20988 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
20989
20990 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
20991 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
20992 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
20993
20994 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
20995 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
20996
20997 @node Command Files
20998 @subsection Command Files
20999
21000 @cindex command files
21001 @cindex scripting commands
21002 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
21003 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
21004 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
21005 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
21006 terminal.
21007
21008 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
21009 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
21010 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
21011 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
21012 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
21013
21014 @table @code
21015 @kindex source
21016 @cindex execute commands from a file
21017 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
21018 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
21019 @end table
21020
21021 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
21022 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
21023 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
21024 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
21025 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
21026
21027 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
21028 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
21029 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
21030 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
21031 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
21032 is not relevant to scripts.
21033
21034 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
21035 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
21036 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
21037 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
21038 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
21039 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
21040 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
21041 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
21042 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
21043 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
21044 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
21045 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
21046 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
21047 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
21048
21049 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
21050 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
21051 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
21052
21053 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
21054 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
21055 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
21056 when called from command files.
21057
21058 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
21059 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
21060 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
21061 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
21062 the next command.
21063
21064 @smallexample
21065 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
21066 @end smallexample
21067
21068 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
21069 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
21070 would be directed to @file{log}.
21071
21072 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
21073 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
21074 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
21075 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
21076 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
21077 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
21078 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
21079 conditionally, etc.
21080
21081 @table @code
21082 @kindex if
21083 @kindex else
21084 @item if
21085 @itemx else
21086 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
21087 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
21088 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
21089 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
21090 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
21091 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
21092 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
21093
21094 @kindex while
21095 @item while
21096 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
21097 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
21098 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
21099 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
21100 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
21101 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
21102
21103 @kindex loop_break
21104 @item loop_break
21105 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
21106 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
21107 line.
21108
21109 @kindex loop_continue
21110 @item loop_continue
21111 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
21112 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
21113 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
21114 the controlling expression.
21115
21116 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
21117 @item end
21118 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
21119 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
21120 @end table
21121
21122
21123 @node Output
21124 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
21125
21126 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
21127 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
21128 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
21129 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
21130 want.
21131
21132 @table @code
21133 @kindex echo
21134 @item echo @var{text}
21135 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
21136 @c because it is not in ANSI.
21137 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
21138 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
21139 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
21140 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
21141 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
21142 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
21143 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
21144 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
21145 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
21146
21147 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
21148 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
21149
21150 @smallexample
21151 echo This is some text\n\
21152 which is continued\n\
21153 onto several lines.\n
21154 @end smallexample
21155
21156 produces the same output as
21157
21158 @smallexample
21159 echo This is some text\n
21160 echo which is continued\n
21161 echo onto several lines.\n
21162 @end smallexample
21163
21164 @kindex output
21165 @item output @var{expression}
21166 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
21167 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
21168 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
21169 on expressions.
21170
21171 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
21172 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
21173 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
21174 Formats}, for more information.
21175
21176 @kindex printf
21177 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
21178 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
21179 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
21180 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
21181 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
21182 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
21183 executing the code below:
21184
21185 @smallexample
21186 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
21187 @end smallexample
21188
21189 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
21190 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
21191 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
21192 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
21193 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
21194 printed.
21195
21196 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
21197
21198 @smallexample
21199 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
21200 @end smallexample
21201
21202 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
21203 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
21204 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
21205
21206 @itemize @bullet
21207 @item
21208 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
21209
21210 @item
21211 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
21212 width.
21213
21214 @item
21215 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
21216 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
21217
21218 @item
21219 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
21220 supported.
21221
21222 @item
21223 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
21224
21225 @item
21226 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
21227 @end itemize
21228
21229 @noindent
21230 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
21231 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
21232 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
21233 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
21234
21235 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
21236 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
21237 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
21238 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
21239 supported.
21240
21241 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
21242 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
21243 together with a floating point specifier.
21244 letters:
21245
21246 @itemize @bullet
21247 @item
21248 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
21249
21250 @item
21251 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
21252
21253 @item
21254 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
21255 @end itemize
21256
21257 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
21258 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
21259 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
21260
21261 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
21262 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
21263
21264 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
21265 @smallexample
21266 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
21267 @end smallexample
21268
21269 @kindex eval
21270 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
21271 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
21272 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
21273
21274 @end table
21275
21276 @node Python
21277 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
21278 @cindex python scripting
21279 @cindex scripting with python
21280
21281 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
21282 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
21283 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
21284
21285 @cindex python directory
21286 Python scripts used by @value{GDBN} should be installed in
21287 @file{@var{data-directory}/python}, where @var{data-directory} is
21288 the data directory as determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}).
21289 This directory, known as the @dfn{python directory},
21290 is automatically added to the Python Search Path in order to allow
21291 the Python interpreter to locate all scripts installed at this location.
21292
21293 Additionally, @value{GDBN} commands and convenience functions which
21294 are written in Python and are located in the
21295 @file{@var{data-directory}/python/gdb/command} or
21296 @file{@var{data-directory}/python/gdb/function} directories are
21297 automatically imported when @value{GDBN} starts.
21298
21299 @menu
21300 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
21301 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
21302 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading Python code.
21303 * Python modules:: Python modules provided by @value{GDBN}.
21304 @end menu
21305
21306 @node Python Commands
21307 @subsection Python Commands
21308 @cindex python commands
21309 @cindex commands to access python
21310
21311 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
21312 and one related setting:
21313
21314 @table @code
21315 @kindex python
21316 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
21317 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
21318
21319 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
21320 argument as a Python command. For example:
21321
21322 @smallexample
21323 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
21324 23
21325 @end smallexample
21326
21327 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
21328 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
21329 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
21330 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
21331 containing @code{end}. For example:
21332
21333 @smallexample
21334 (@value{GDBP}) python
21335 Type python script
21336 End with a line saying just "end".
21337 >print 23
21338 >end
21339 23
21340 @end smallexample
21341
21342 @kindex maint set python print-stack
21343 @item maint set python print-stack
21344 This command is now deprecated. Instead use @code{set python
21345 print-stack}
21346
21347 @kindex set python print-stack
21348 @item set python print-stack
21349 By default, @value{GDBN} will not print a stack trace when an error
21350 occurs in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{set
21351 python print-stack}: if @code{on}, then Python stack printing is
21352 enabled; if @code{off}, the default, then Python stack printing is
21353 disabled.
21354 @end table
21355
21356 It is also possible to execute a Python script from the @value{GDBN}
21357 interpreter:
21358
21359 @table @code
21360 @item source @file{script-name}
21361 The script name must end with @samp{.py} and @value{GDBN} must be configured
21362 to recognize the script language based on filename extension using
21363 the @code{script-extension} setting. @xref{Extending GDB, ,Extending GDB}.
21364
21365 @item python execfile ("script-name")
21366 This method is based on the @code{execfile} Python built-in function,
21367 and thus is always available.
21368 @end table
21369
21370 @node Python API
21371 @subsection Python API
21372 @cindex python api
21373 @cindex programming in python
21374
21375 @cindex python stdout
21376 @cindex python pagination
21377 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
21378 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
21379 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
21380 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
21381 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
21382
21383 @menu
21384 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
21385 * Exception Handling:: How Python exceptions are translated.
21386 * Values From Inferior:: Python representation of values.
21387 * Types In Python:: Python representation of types.
21388 * Pretty Printing API:: Pretty-printing values.
21389 * Selecting Pretty-Printers:: How GDB chooses a pretty-printer.
21390 * Writing a Pretty-Printer:: Writing a Pretty-Printer.
21391 * Inferiors In Python:: Python representation of inferiors (processes)
21392 * Events In Python:: Listening for events from @value{GDBN}.
21393 * Threads In Python:: Accessing inferior threads from Python.
21394 * Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
21395 * Parameters In Python:: Adding new @value{GDBN} parameters.
21396 * Functions In Python:: Writing new convenience functions.
21397 * Progspaces In Python:: Program spaces.
21398 * Objfiles In Python:: Object files.
21399 * Frames In Python:: Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
21400 * Blocks In Python:: Accessing frame blocks from Python.
21401 * Symbols In Python:: Python representation of symbols.
21402 * Symbol Tables In Python:: Python representation of symbol tables.
21403 * Lazy Strings In Python:: Python representation of lazy strings.
21404 * Breakpoints In Python:: Manipulating breakpoints using Python.
21405 @end menu
21406
21407 @node Basic Python
21408 @subsubsection Basic Python
21409
21410 @cindex python functions
21411 @cindex python module
21412 @cindex gdb module
21413 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
21414 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
21415 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
21416 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
21417
21418 @findex gdb.PYTHONDIR
21419 @defvar gdb.PYTHONDIR
21420 A string containing the python directory (@pxref{Python}).
21421 @end defvar
21422
21423 @findex gdb.execute
21424 @defun gdb.execute (command @r{[}, from_tty @r{[}, to_string@r{]]})
21425 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
21426 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
21427 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
21428
21429 @var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
21430 command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
21431 It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
21432
21433 By default, any output produced by @var{command} is sent to
21434 @value{GDBN}'s standard output. If the @var{to_string} parameter is
21435 @code{True}, then output will be collected by @code{gdb.execute} and
21436 returned as a string. The default is @code{False}, in which case the
21437 return value is @code{None}. If @var{to_string} is @code{True}, the
21438 @value{GDBN} virtual terminal will be temporarily set to unlimited width
21439 and height, and its pagination will be disabled; @pxref{Screen Size}.
21440 @end defun
21441
21442 @findex gdb.breakpoints
21443 @defun gdb.breakpoints ()
21444 Return a sequence holding all of @value{GDBN}'s breakpoints.
21445 @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for more information.
21446 @end defun
21447
21448 @findex gdb.parameter
21449 @defun gdb.parameter (parameter)
21450 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
21451 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
21452 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
21453 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
21454
21455 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
21456 @code{gdb.error} (@pxref{Exception Handling}). Otherwise, the
21457 parameter's value is converted to a Python value of the appropriate
21458 type, and returned.
21459 @end defun
21460
21461 @findex gdb.history
21462 @defun gdb.history (number)
21463 Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
21464 History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
21465 If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
21466 and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
21467 find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
21468 return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
21469 doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{gdb.error} exception will be
21470 raised.
21471
21472 If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
21473 @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
21474 @end defun
21475
21476 @findex gdb.parse_and_eval
21477 @defun gdb.parse_and_eval (expression)
21478 Parse @var{expression} as an expression in the current language,
21479 evaluate it, and return the result as a @code{gdb.Value}.
21480 @var{expression} must be a string.
21481
21482 This function can be useful when implementing a new command
21483 (@pxref{Commands In Python}), as it provides a way to parse the
21484 command's argument as an expression. It is also useful simply to
21485 compute values, for example, it is the only way to get the value of a
21486 convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) as a @code{gdb.Value}.
21487 @end defun
21488
21489 @findex gdb.post_event
21490 @defun gdb.post_event (event)
21491 Put @var{event}, a callable object taking no arguments, into
21492 @value{GDBN}'s internal event queue. This callable will be invoked at
21493 some later point, during @value{GDBN}'s event processing. Events
21494 posted using @code{post_event} will be run in the order in which they
21495 were posted; however, there is no way to know when they will be
21496 processed relative to other events inside @value{GDBN}.
21497
21498 @value{GDBN} is not thread-safe. If your Python program uses multiple
21499 threads, you must be careful to only call @value{GDBN}-specific
21500 functions in the main @value{GDBN} thread. @code{post_event} ensures
21501 this. For example:
21502
21503 @smallexample
21504 (@value{GDBP}) python
21505 >import threading
21506 >
21507 >class Writer():
21508 > def __init__(self, message):
21509 > self.message = message;
21510 > def __call__(self):
21511 > gdb.write(self.message)
21512 >
21513 >class MyThread1 (threading.Thread):
21514 > def run (self):
21515 > gdb.post_event(Writer("Hello "))
21516 >
21517 >class MyThread2 (threading.Thread):
21518 > def run (self):
21519 > gdb.post_event(Writer("World\n"))
21520 >
21521 >MyThread1().start()
21522 >MyThread2().start()
21523 >end
21524 (@value{GDBP}) Hello World
21525 @end smallexample
21526 @end defun
21527
21528 @findex gdb.write
21529 @defun gdb.write (string @r{[}, stream{]})
21530 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated output stream. The
21531 optional @var{stream} determines the stream to print to. The default
21532 stream is @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream. Possible stream
21533 values are:
21534
21535 @table @code
21536 @findex STDOUT
21537 @findex gdb.STDOUT
21538 @item gdb.STDOUT
21539 @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream.
21540
21541 @findex STDERR
21542 @findex gdb.STDERR
21543 @item gdb.STDERR
21544 @value{GDBN}'s standard error stream.
21545
21546 @findex STDLOG
21547 @findex gdb.STDLOG
21548 @item gdb.STDLOG
21549 @value{GDBN}'s log stream (@pxref{Logging Output}).
21550 @end table
21551
21552 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
21553 call this function and will automatically direct the output to the
21554 relevant stream.
21555 @end defun
21556
21557 @findex gdb.flush
21558 @defun gdb.flush ()
21559 Flush the buffer of a @value{GDBN} paginated stream so that the
21560 contents are displayed immediately. @value{GDBN} will flush the
21561 contents of a stream automatically when it encounters a newline in the
21562 buffer. The optional @var{stream} determines the stream to flush. The
21563 default stream is @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream. Possible
21564 stream values are:
21565
21566 @table @code
21567 @findex STDOUT
21568 @findex gdb.STDOUT
21569 @item gdb.STDOUT
21570 @value{GDBN}'s standard output stream.
21571
21572 @findex STDERR
21573 @findex gdb.STDERR
21574 @item gdb.STDERR
21575 @value{GDBN}'s standard error stream.
21576
21577 @findex STDLOG
21578 @findex gdb.STDLOG
21579 @item gdb.STDLOG
21580 @value{GDBN}'s log stream (@pxref{Logging Output}).
21581
21582 @end table
21583
21584 Flushing @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
21585 call this function for the relevant stream.
21586 @end defun
21587
21588 @findex gdb.target_charset
21589 @defun gdb.target_charset ()
21590 Return the name of the current target character set (@pxref{Character
21591 Sets}). This differs from @code{gdb.parameter('target-charset')} in
21592 that @samp{auto} is never returned.
21593 @end defun
21594
21595 @findex gdb.target_wide_charset
21596 @defun gdb.target_wide_charset ()
21597 Return the name of the current target wide character set
21598 (@pxref{Character Sets}). This differs from
21599 @code{gdb.parameter('target-wide-charset')} in that @samp{auto} is
21600 never returned.
21601 @end defun
21602
21603 @findex gdb.solib_name
21604 @defun gdb.solib_name (address)
21605 Return the name of the shared library holding the given @var{address}
21606 as a string, or @code{None}.
21607 @end defun
21608
21609 @findex gdb.decode_line
21610 @defun gdb.decode_line @r{[}expression@r{]}
21611 Return locations of the line specified by @var{expression}, or of the
21612 current line if no argument was given. This function returns a Python
21613 tuple containing two elements. The first element contains a string
21614 holding any unparsed section of @var{expression} (or @code{None} if
21615 the expression has been fully parsed). The second element contains
21616 either @code{None} or another tuple that contains all the locations
21617 that match the expression represented as @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line}
21618 objects (@pxref{Symbol Tables In Python}). If @var{expression} is
21619 provided, it is decoded the way that @value{GDBN}'s inbuilt
21620 @code{break} or @code{edit} commands do (@pxref{Specify Location}).
21621 @end defun
21622
21623 @defun gdb.prompt_hook (current_prompt)
21624 @anchor{prompt_hook}
21625
21626 If @var{prompt_hook} is callable, @value{GDBN} will call the method
21627 assigned to this operation before a prompt is displayed by
21628 @value{GDBN}.
21629
21630 The parameter @code{current_prompt} contains the current @value{GDBN}
21631 prompt. This method must return a Python string, or @code{None}. If
21632 a string is returned, the @value{GDBN} prompt will be set to that
21633 string. If @code{None} is returned, @value{GDBN} will continue to use
21634 the current prompt.
21635
21636 Some prompts cannot be substituted in @value{GDBN}. Secondary prompts
21637 such as those used by readline for command input, and annotation
21638 related prompts are prohibited from being changed.
21639 @end defun
21640
21641 @node Exception Handling
21642 @subsubsection Exception Handling
21643 @cindex python exceptions
21644 @cindex exceptions, python
21645
21646 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
21647 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
21648 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
21649 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
21650 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
21651 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
21652 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
21653
21654 @smallexample
21655 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
21656 Traceback (most recent call last):
21657 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
21658 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
21659 @end smallexample
21660
21661 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by
21662 Python code are converted to Python exceptions. The type of the
21663 Python exception depends on the error.
21664
21665 @ftable @code
21666 @item gdb.error
21667 This is the base class for most exceptions generated by @value{GDBN}.
21668 It is derived from @code{RuntimeError}, for compatibility with earlier
21669 versions of @value{GDBN}.
21670
21671 If an error occurring in @value{GDBN} does not fit into some more
21672 specific category, then the generated exception will have this type.
21673
21674 @item gdb.MemoryError
21675 This is a subclass of @code{gdb.error} which is thrown when an
21676 operation tried to access invalid memory in the inferior.
21677
21678 @item KeyboardInterrupt
21679 User interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
21680 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception.
21681 @end ftable
21682
21683 In all cases, your exception handler will see the @value{GDBN} error
21684 message as its value and the Python call stack backtrace at the Python
21685 statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
21686 traceback.
21687
21688 @findex gdb.GdbError
21689 When implementing @value{GDBN} commands in Python via @code{gdb.Command},
21690 it is useful to be able to throw an exception that doesn't cause a
21691 traceback to be printed. For example, the user may have invoked the
21692 command incorrectly. Use the @code{gdb.GdbError} exception
21693 to handle this case. Example:
21694
21695 @smallexample
21696 (gdb) python
21697 >class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
21698 > """Greet the whole world."""
21699 > def __init__ (self):
21700 > super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
21701 > def invoke (self, args, from_tty):
21702 > argv = gdb.string_to_argv (args)
21703 > if len (argv) != 0:
21704 > raise gdb.GdbError ("hello-world takes no arguments")
21705 > print "Hello, World!"
21706 >HelloWorld ()
21707 >end
21708 (gdb) hello-world 42
21709 hello-world takes no arguments
21710 @end smallexample
21711
21712 @node Values From Inferior
21713 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
21714 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
21715 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
21716
21717 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
21718 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
21719 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
21720 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
21721 fetching values when necessary.
21722
21723 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
21724 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
21725 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
21726
21727 @smallexample
21728 bar = some_val + 2
21729 @end smallexample
21730
21731 @noindent
21732 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
21733 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
21734
21735 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
21736 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
21737 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
21738 can access its @code{foo} element with:
21739
21740 @smallexample
21741 bar = some_val['foo']
21742 @end smallexample
21743
21744 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
21745
21746 A @code{gdb.Value} that represents a function can be executed via
21747 inferior function call. Any arguments provided to the call must match
21748 the function's prototype, and must be provided in the order specified
21749 by that prototype.
21750
21751 For example, @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance
21752 representing a function that takes two integers as arguments. To
21753 execute this function, call it like so:
21754
21755 @smallexample
21756 result = some_val (10,20)
21757 @end smallexample
21758
21759 Any values returned from a function call will be stored as a
21760 @code{gdb.Value}.
21761
21762 The following attributes are provided:
21763
21764 @table @code
21765 @defvar Value.address
21766 If this object is addressable, this read-only attribute holds a
21767 @code{gdb.Value} object representing the address. Otherwise,
21768 this attribute holds @code{None}.
21769 @end defvar
21770
21771 @cindex optimized out value in Python
21772 @defvar Value.is_optimized_out
21773 This read-only boolean attribute is true if the compiler optimized out
21774 this value, thus it is not available for fetching from the inferior.
21775 @end defvar
21776
21777 @defvar Value.type
21778 The type of this @code{gdb.Value}. The value of this attribute is a
21779 @code{gdb.Type} object (@pxref{Types In Python}).
21780 @end defvar
21781
21782 @defvar Value.dynamic_type
21783 The dynamic type of this @code{gdb.Value}. This uses C@t{++} run-time
21784 type information (@acronym{RTTI}) to determine the dynamic type of the
21785 value. If this value is of class type, it will return the class in
21786 which the value is embedded, if any. If this value is of pointer or
21787 reference to a class type, it will compute the dynamic type of the
21788 referenced object, and return a pointer or reference to that type,
21789 respectively. In all other cases, it will return the value's static
21790 type.
21791
21792 Note that this feature will only work when debugging a C@t{++} program
21793 that includes @acronym{RTTI} for the object in question. Otherwise,
21794 it will just return the static type of the value as in @kbd{ptype foo}
21795 (@pxref{Symbols, ptype}).
21796 @end defvar
21797
21798 @defvar Value.is_lazy
21799 The value of this read-only boolean attribute is @code{True} if this
21800 @code{gdb.Value} has not yet been fetched from the inferior.
21801 @value{GDBN} does not fetch values until necessary, for efficiency.
21802 For example:
21803
21804 @smallexample
21805 myval = gdb.parse_and_eval ('somevar')
21806 @end smallexample
21807
21808 The value of @code{somevar} is not fetched at this time. It will be
21809 fetched when the value is needed, or when the @code{fetch_lazy}
21810 method is invoked.
21811 @end defvar
21812 @end table
21813
21814 The following methods are provided:
21815
21816 @table @code
21817 @defun Value.__init__ (@var{val})
21818 Many Python values can be converted directly to a @code{gdb.Value} via
21819 this object initializer. Specifically:
21820
21821 @table @asis
21822 @item Python boolean
21823 A Python boolean is converted to the boolean type from the current
21824 language.
21825
21826 @item Python integer
21827 A Python integer is converted to the C @code{long} type for the
21828 current architecture.
21829
21830 @item Python long
21831 A Python long is converted to the C @code{long long} type for the
21832 current architecture.
21833
21834 @item Python float
21835 A Python float is converted to the C @code{double} type for the
21836 current architecture.
21837
21838 @item Python string
21839 A Python string is converted to a target string, using the current
21840 target encoding.
21841
21842 @item @code{gdb.Value}
21843 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.Value}, then a copy of the value is made.
21844
21845 @item @code{gdb.LazyString}
21846 If @code{val} is a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings In
21847 Python}), then the lazy string's @code{value} method is called, and
21848 its result is used.
21849 @end table
21850 @end defun
21851
21852 @defun Value.cast (type)
21853 Return a new instance of @code{gdb.Value} that is the result of
21854 casting this instance to the type described by @var{type}, which must
21855 be a @code{gdb.Type} object. If the cast cannot be performed for some
21856 reason, this method throws an exception.
21857 @end defun
21858
21859 @defun Value.dereference ()
21860 For pointer data types, this method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object
21861 whose contents is the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if
21862 @code{foo} is a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
21863
21864 @smallexample
21865 int *foo;
21866 @end smallexample
21867
21868 @noindent
21869 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
21870 @code{foo} points to like this:
21871
21872 @smallexample
21873 bar = foo.dereference ()
21874 @end smallexample
21875
21876 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
21877 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
21878 @end defun
21879
21880 @defun Value.dynamic_cast (type)
21881 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{dynamic_cast}
21882 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
21883 @end defun
21884
21885 @defun Value.reinterpret_cast (type)
21886 Like @code{Value.cast}, but works as if the C@t{++} @code{reinterpret_cast}
21887 operator were used. Consult a C@t{++} reference for details.
21888 @end defun
21889
21890 @defun Value.string (@r{[}encoding@r{[}, errors@r{[}, length@r{]]]})
21891 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
21892 converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
21893 throw an exception.
21894
21895 Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
21896 @code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
21897 language.
21898
21899 For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
21900 array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
21901 by a zero of the appropriate width. However if the optional length
21902 argument is given, the string will be converted to that given length,
21903 ignoring any embedded zeros that the string may contain.
21904
21905 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
21906 naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
21907 @code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
21908 the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
21909 @code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
21910 to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
21911 @var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
21912 (@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
21913 will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
21914
21915 The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
21916 argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
21917
21918 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
21919 fetched and converted to the given length.
21920 @end defun
21921
21922 @defun Value.lazy_string (@r{[}encoding @r{[}, length@r{]]})
21923 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
21924 converts the contents to a @code{gdb.LazyString} (@pxref{Lazy Strings
21925 In Python}). Otherwise, this method will throw an exception.
21926
21927 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
21928 naming the encoding of the @code{gdb.LazyString}. Some examples are:
21929 @samp{ascii}, @samp{iso-8859-6} or @samp{utf-8}. If the
21930 @var{encoding} argument is an encoding that @value{GDBN} does
21931 recognize, @value{GDBN} will raise an error.
21932
21933 When a lazy string is printed, the @value{GDBN} encoding machinery is
21934 used to convert the string during printing. If the optional
21935 @var{encoding} argument is not provided, or is an empty string,
21936 @value{GDBN} will automatically select the encoding most suitable for
21937 the string type. For further information on encoding in @value{GDBN}
21938 please see @ref{Character Sets}.
21939
21940 If the optional @var{length} argument is given, the string will be
21941 fetched and encoded to the length of characters specified. If
21942 the @var{length} argument is not provided, the string will be fetched
21943 and encoded until a null of appropriate width is found.
21944 @end defun
21945
21946 @defun Value.fetch_lazy ()
21947 If the @code{gdb.Value} object is currently a lazy value
21948 (@code{gdb.Value.is_lazy} is @code{True}), then the value is
21949 fetched from the inferior. Any errors that occur in the process
21950 will produce a Python exception.
21951
21952 If the @code{gdb.Value} object is not a lazy value, this method
21953 has no effect.
21954
21955 This method does not return a value.
21956 @end defun
21957
21958 @end table
21959
21960 @node Types In Python
21961 @subsubsection Types In Python
21962 @cindex types in Python
21963 @cindex Python, working with types
21964
21965 @tindex gdb.Type
21966 @value{GDBN} represents types from the inferior using the class
21967 @code{gdb.Type}.
21968
21969 The following type-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
21970 module:
21971
21972 @findex gdb.lookup_type
21973 @defun gdb.lookup_type (name @r{[}, block@r{]})
21974 This function looks up a type by name. @var{name} is the name of the
21975 type to look up. It must be a string.
21976
21977 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
21978 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
21979
21980 Ordinarily, this function will return an instance of @code{gdb.Type}.
21981 If the named type cannot be found, it will throw an exception.
21982 @end defun
21983
21984 If the type is a structure or class type, or an enum type, the fields
21985 of that type can be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}.
21986 For example, if @code{some_type} is a @code{gdb.Type} instance holding
21987 a structure type, you can access its @code{foo} field with:
21988
21989 @smallexample
21990 bar = some_type['foo']
21991 @end smallexample
21992
21993 @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Field} object; see below under the
21994 description of the @code{Type.fields} method for a description of the
21995 @code{gdb.Field} class.
21996
21997 An instance of @code{Type} has the following attributes:
21998
21999 @table @code
22000 @defvar Type.code
22001 The type code for this type. The type code will be one of the
22002 @code{TYPE_CODE_} constants defined below.
22003 @end defvar
22004
22005 @defvar Type.sizeof
22006 The size of this type, in target @code{char} units. Usually, a
22007 target's @code{char} type will be an 8-bit byte. However, on some
22008 unusual platforms, this type may have a different size.
22009 @end defvar
22010
22011 @defvar Type.tag
22012 The tag name for this type. The tag name is the name after
22013 @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} in C and C@t{++}; not all
22014 languages have this concept. If this type has no tag name, then
22015 @code{None} is returned.
22016 @end defvar
22017 @end table
22018
22019 The following methods are provided:
22020
22021 @table @code
22022 @defun Type.fields ()
22023 For structure and union types, this method returns the fields. Range
22024 types have two fields, the minimum and maximum values. Enum types
22025 have one field per enum constant. Function and method types have one
22026 field per parameter. The base types of C@t{++} classes are also
22027 represented as fields. If the type has no fields, or does not fit
22028 into one of these categories, an empty sequence will be returned.
22029
22030 Each field is a @code{gdb.Field} object, with some pre-defined attributes:
22031 @table @code
22032 @item bitpos
22033 This attribute is not available for @code{static} fields (as in
22034 C@t{++} or Java). For non-@code{static} fields, the value is the bit
22035 position of the field. For @code{enum} fields, the value is the
22036 enumeration member's integer representation.
22037
22038 @item name
22039 The name of the field, or @code{None} for anonymous fields.
22040
22041 @item artificial
22042 This is @code{True} if the field is artificial, usually meaning that
22043 it was provided by the compiler and not the user. This attribute is
22044 always provided, and is @code{False} if the field is not artificial.
22045
22046 @item is_base_class
22047 This is @code{True} if the field represents a base class of a C@t{++}
22048 structure. This attribute is always provided, and is @code{False}
22049 if the field is not a base class of the type that is the argument of
22050 @code{fields}, or if that type was not a C@t{++} class.
22051
22052 @item bitsize
22053 If the field is packed, or is a bitfield, then this will have a
22054 non-zero value, which is the size of the field in bits. Otherwise,
22055 this will be zero; in this case the field's size is given by its type.
22056
22057 @item type
22058 The type of the field. This is usually an instance of @code{Type},
22059 but it can be @code{None} in some situations.
22060 @end table
22061 @end defun
22062
22063 @defun Type.array (@var{n1} @r{[}, @var{n2}@r{]})
22064 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an array of this
22065 type. If one argument is given, it is the inclusive upper bound of
22066 the array; in this case the lower bound is zero. If two arguments are
22067 given, the first argument is the lower bound of the array, and the
22068 second argument is the upper bound of the array. An array's length
22069 must not be negative, but the bounds can be.
22070 @end defun
22071
22072 @defun Type.const ()
22073 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
22074 @code{const}-qualified variant of this type.
22075 @end defun
22076
22077 @defun Type.volatile ()
22078 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a
22079 @code{volatile}-qualified variant of this type.
22080 @end defun
22081
22082 @defun Type.unqualified ()
22083 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents an unqualified
22084 variant of this type. That is, the result is neither @code{const} nor
22085 @code{volatile}.
22086 @end defun
22087
22088 @defun Type.range ()
22089 Return a Python @code{Tuple} object that contains two elements: the
22090 low bound of the argument type and the high bound of that type. If
22091 the type does not have a range, @value{GDBN} will raise a
22092 @code{gdb.error} exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
22093 @end defun
22094
22095 @defun Type.reference ()
22096 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a reference to this
22097 type.
22098 @end defun
22099
22100 @defun Type.pointer ()
22101 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents a pointer to this
22102 type.
22103 @end defun
22104
22105 @defun Type.strip_typedefs ()
22106 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} that represents the real type,
22107 after removing all layers of typedefs.
22108 @end defun
22109
22110 @defun Type.target ()
22111 Return a new @code{gdb.Type} object which represents the target type
22112 of this type.
22113
22114 For a pointer type, the target type is the type of the pointed-to
22115 object. For an array type (meaning C-like arrays), the target type is
22116 the type of the elements of the array. For a function or method type,
22117 the target type is the type of the return value. For a complex type,
22118 the target type is the type of the elements. For a typedef, the
22119 target type is the aliased type.
22120
22121 If the type does not have a target, this method will throw an
22122 exception.
22123 @end defun
22124
22125 @defun Type.template_argument (n @r{[}, block@r{]})
22126 If this @code{gdb.Type} is an instantiation of a template, this will
22127 return a new @code{gdb.Type} which represents the type of the
22128 @var{n}th template argument.
22129
22130 If this @code{gdb.Type} is not a template type, this will throw an
22131 exception. Ordinarily, only C@t{++} code will have template types.
22132
22133 If @var{block} is given, then @var{name} is looked up in that scope.
22134 Otherwise, it is searched for globally.
22135 @end defun
22136 @end table
22137
22138
22139 Each type has a code, which indicates what category this type falls
22140 into. The available type categories are represented by constants
22141 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
22142
22143 @table @code
22144 @findex TYPE_CODE_PTR
22145 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
22146 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_PTR
22147 The type is a pointer.
22148
22149 @findex TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
22150 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
22151 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
22152 The type is an array.
22153
22154 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
22155 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
22156 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
22157 The type is a structure.
22158
22159 @findex TYPE_CODE_UNION
22160 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
22161 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_UNION
22162 The type is a union.
22163
22164 @findex TYPE_CODE_ENUM
22165 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
22166 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_ENUM
22167 The type is an enum.
22168
22169 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
22170 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
22171 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLAGS
22172 A bit flags type, used for things such as status registers.
22173
22174 @findex TYPE_CODE_FUNC
22175 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
22176 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_FUNC
22177 The type is a function.
22178
22179 @findex TYPE_CODE_INT
22180 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
22181 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_INT
22182 The type is an integer type.
22183
22184 @findex TYPE_CODE_FLT
22185 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
22186 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_FLT
22187 A floating point type.
22188
22189 @findex TYPE_CODE_VOID
22190 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
22191 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_VOID
22192 The special type @code{void}.
22193
22194 @findex TYPE_CODE_SET
22195 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
22196 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_SET
22197 A Pascal set type.
22198
22199 @findex TYPE_CODE_RANGE
22200 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
22201 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_RANGE
22202 A range type, that is, an integer type with bounds.
22203
22204 @findex TYPE_CODE_STRING
22205 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
22206 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_STRING
22207 A string type. Note that this is only used for certain languages with
22208 language-defined string types; C strings are not represented this way.
22209
22210 @findex TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
22211 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
22212 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_BITSTRING
22213 A string of bits.
22214
22215 @findex TYPE_CODE_ERROR
22216 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
22217 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_ERROR
22218 An unknown or erroneous type.
22219
22220 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHOD
22221 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
22222 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHOD
22223 A method type, as found in C@t{++} or Java.
22224
22225 @findex TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
22226 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
22227 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_METHODPTR
22228 A pointer-to-member-function.
22229
22230 @findex TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
22231 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
22232 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_MEMBERPTR
22233 A pointer-to-member.
22234
22235 @findex TYPE_CODE_REF
22236 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
22237 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_REF
22238 A reference type.
22239
22240 @findex TYPE_CODE_CHAR
22241 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
22242 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_CHAR
22243 A character type.
22244
22245 @findex TYPE_CODE_BOOL
22246 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
22247 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_BOOL
22248 A boolean type.
22249
22250 @findex TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
22251 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
22252 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_COMPLEX
22253 A complex float type.
22254
22255 @findex TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
22256 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
22257 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
22258 A typedef to some other type.
22259
22260 @findex TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
22261 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
22262 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_NAMESPACE
22263 A C@t{++} namespace.
22264
22265 @findex TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
22266 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
22267 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_DECFLOAT
22268 A decimal floating point type.
22269
22270 @findex TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
22271 @findex gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
22272 @item gdb.TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION
22273 A function internal to @value{GDBN}. This is the type used to represent
22274 convenience functions.
22275 @end table
22276
22277 Further support for types is provided in the @code{gdb.types}
22278 Python module (@pxref{gdb.types}).
22279
22280 @node Pretty Printing API
22281 @subsubsection Pretty Printing API
22282
22283 An example output is provided (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
22284
22285 A pretty-printer is just an object that holds a value and implements a
22286 specific interface, defined here.
22287
22288 @defun pretty_printer.children (self)
22289 @value{GDBN} will call this method on a pretty-printer to compute the
22290 children of the pretty-printer's value.
22291
22292 This method must return an object conforming to the Python iterator
22293 protocol. Each item returned by the iterator must be a tuple holding
22294 two elements. The first element is the ``name'' of the child; the
22295 second element is the child's value. The value can be any Python
22296 object which is convertible to a @value{GDBN} value.
22297
22298 This method is optional. If it does not exist, @value{GDBN} will act
22299 as though the value has no children.
22300 @end defun
22301
22302 @defun pretty_printer.display_hint (self)
22303 The CLI may call this method and use its result to change the
22304 formatting of a value. The result will also be supplied to an MI
22305 consumer as a @samp{displayhint} attribute of the variable being
22306 printed.
22307
22308 This method is optional. If it does exist, this method must return a
22309 string.
22310
22311 Some display hints are predefined by @value{GDBN}:
22312
22313 @table @samp
22314 @item array
22315 Indicate that the object being printed is ``array-like''. The CLI
22316 uses this to respect parameters such as @code{set print elements} and
22317 @code{set print array}.
22318
22319 @item map
22320 Indicate that the object being printed is ``map-like'', and that the
22321 children of this value can be assumed to alternate between keys and
22322 values.
22323
22324 @item string
22325 Indicate that the object being printed is ``string-like''. If the
22326 printer's @code{to_string} method returns a Python string of some
22327 kind, then @value{GDBN} will call its internal language-specific
22328 string-printing function to format the string. For the CLI this means
22329 adding quotation marks, possibly escaping some characters, respecting
22330 @code{set print elements}, and the like.
22331 @end table
22332 @end defun
22333
22334 @defun pretty_printer.to_string (self)
22335 @value{GDBN} will call this method to display the string
22336 representation of the value passed to the object's constructor.
22337
22338 When printing from the CLI, if the @code{to_string} method exists,
22339 then @value{GDBN} will prepend its result to the values returned by
22340 @code{children}. Exactly how this formatting is done is dependent on
22341 the display hint, and may change as more hints are added. Also,
22342 depending on the print settings (@pxref{Print Settings}), the CLI may
22343 print just the result of @code{to_string} in a stack trace, omitting
22344 the result of @code{children}.
22345
22346 If this method returns a string, it is printed verbatim.
22347
22348 Otherwise, if this method returns an instance of @code{gdb.Value},
22349 then @value{GDBN} prints this value. This may result in a call to
22350 another pretty-printer.
22351
22352 If instead the method returns a Python value which is convertible to a
22353 @code{gdb.Value}, then @value{GDBN} performs the conversion and prints
22354 the resulting value. Again, this may result in a call to another
22355 pretty-printer. Python scalars (integers, floats, and booleans) and
22356 strings are convertible to @code{gdb.Value}; other types are not.
22357
22358 Finally, if this method returns @code{None} then no further operations
22359 are peformed in this method and nothing is printed.
22360
22361 If the result is not one of these types, an exception is raised.
22362 @end defun
22363
22364 @value{GDBN} provides a function which can be used to look up the
22365 default pretty-printer for a @code{gdb.Value}:
22366
22367 @findex gdb.default_visualizer
22368 @defun gdb.default_visualizer (value)
22369 This function takes a @code{gdb.Value} object as an argument. If a
22370 pretty-printer for this value exists, then it is returned. If no such
22371 printer exists, then this returns @code{None}.
22372 @end defun
22373
22374 @node Selecting Pretty-Printers
22375 @subsubsection Selecting Pretty-Printers
22376
22377 The Python list @code{gdb.pretty_printers} contains an array of
22378 functions or callable objects that have been registered via addition
22379 as a pretty-printer. Printers in this list are called @code{global}
22380 printers, they're available when debugging all inferiors.
22381 Each @code{gdb.Progspace} contains a @code{pretty_printers} attribute.
22382 Each @code{gdb.Objfile} also contains a @code{pretty_printers}
22383 attribute.
22384
22385 Each function on these lists is passed a single @code{gdb.Value}
22386 argument and should return a pretty-printer object conforming to the
22387 interface definition above (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}). If a function
22388 cannot create a pretty-printer for the value, it should return
22389 @code{None}.
22390
22391 @value{GDBN} first checks the @code{pretty_printers} attribute of each
22392 @code{gdb.Objfile} in the current program space and iteratively calls
22393 each enabled lookup routine in the list for that @code{gdb.Objfile}
22394 until it receives a pretty-printer object.
22395 If no pretty-printer is found in the objfile lists, @value{GDBN} then
22396 searches the pretty-printer list of the current program space,
22397 calling each enabled function until an object is returned.
22398 After these lists have been exhausted, it tries the global
22399 @code{gdb.pretty_printers} list, again calling each enabled function until an
22400 object is returned.
22401
22402 The order in which the objfiles are searched is not specified. For a
22403 given list, functions are always invoked from the head of the list,
22404 and iterated over sequentially until the end of the list, or a printer
22405 object is returned.
22406
22407 For various reasons a pretty-printer may not work.
22408 For example, the underlying data structure may have changed and
22409 the pretty-printer is out of date.
22410
22411 The consequences of a broken pretty-printer are severe enough that
22412 @value{GDBN} provides support for enabling and disabling individual
22413 printers. For example, if @code{print frame-arguments} is on,
22414 a backtrace can become highly illegible if any argument is printed
22415 with a broken printer.
22416
22417 Pretty-printers are enabled and disabled by attaching an @code{enabled}
22418 attribute to the registered function or callable object. If this attribute
22419 is present and its value is @code{False}, the printer is disabled, otherwise
22420 the printer is enabled.
22421
22422 @node Writing a Pretty-Printer
22423 @subsubsection Writing a Pretty-Printer
22424 @cindex writing a pretty-printer
22425
22426 A pretty-printer consists of two parts: a lookup function to detect
22427 if the type is supported, and the printer itself.
22428
22429 Here is an example showing how a @code{std::string} printer might be
22430 written. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for details on the API this class
22431 must provide.
22432
22433 @smallexample
22434 class StdStringPrinter(object):
22435 "Print a std::string"
22436
22437 def __init__(self, val):
22438 self.val = val
22439
22440 def to_string(self):
22441 return self.val['_M_dataplus']['_M_p']
22442
22443 def display_hint(self):
22444 return 'string'
22445 @end smallexample
22446
22447 And here is an example showing how a lookup function for the printer
22448 example above might be written.
22449
22450 @smallexample
22451 def str_lookup_function(val):
22452 lookup_tag = val.type.tag
22453 if lookup_tag == None:
22454 return None
22455 regex = re.compile("^std::basic_string<char,.*>$")
22456 if regex.match(lookup_tag):
22457 return StdStringPrinter(val)
22458 return None
22459 @end smallexample
22460
22461 The example lookup function extracts the value's type, and attempts to
22462 match it to a type that it can pretty-print. If it is a type the
22463 printer can pretty-print, it will return a printer object. If not, it
22464 returns @code{None}.
22465
22466 We recommend that you put your core pretty-printers into a Python
22467 package. If your pretty-printers are for use with a library, we
22468 further recommend embedding a version number into the package name.
22469 This practice will enable @value{GDBN} to load multiple versions of
22470 your pretty-printers at the same time, because they will have
22471 different names.
22472
22473 You should write auto-loaded code (@pxref{Auto-loading}) such that it
22474 can be evaluated multiple times without changing its meaning. An
22475 ideal auto-load file will consist solely of @code{import}s of your
22476 printer modules, followed by a call to a register pretty-printers with
22477 the current objfile.
22478
22479 Taken as a whole, this approach will scale nicely to multiple
22480 inferiors, each potentially using a different library version.
22481 Embedding a version number in the Python package name will ensure that
22482 @value{GDBN} is able to load both sets of printers simultaneously.
22483 Then, because the search for pretty-printers is done by objfile, and
22484 because your auto-loaded code took care to register your library's
22485 printers with a specific objfile, @value{GDBN} will find the correct
22486 printers for the specific version of the library used by each
22487 inferior.
22488
22489 To continue the @code{std::string} example (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}),
22490 this code might appear in @code{gdb.libstdcxx.v6}:
22491
22492 @smallexample
22493 def register_printers(objfile):
22494 objfile.pretty_printers.add(str_lookup_function)
22495 @end smallexample
22496
22497 @noindent
22498 And then the corresponding contents of the auto-load file would be:
22499
22500 @smallexample
22501 import gdb.libstdcxx.v6
22502 gdb.libstdcxx.v6.register_printers(gdb.current_objfile())
22503 @end smallexample
22504
22505 The previous example illustrates a basic pretty-printer.
22506 There are a few things that can be improved on.
22507 The printer doesn't have a name, making it hard to identify in a
22508 list of installed printers. The lookup function has a name, but
22509 lookup functions can have arbitrary, even identical, names.
22510
22511 Second, the printer only handles one type, whereas a library typically has
22512 several types. One could install a lookup function for each desired type
22513 in the library, but one could also have a single lookup function recognize
22514 several types. The latter is the conventional way this is handled.
22515 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
22516 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
22517
22518 The @code{gdb.printing} module provides a formal way of solving these
22519 problems (@pxref{gdb.printing}).
22520 Here is another example that handles multiple types.
22521
22522 These are the types we are going to pretty-print:
22523
22524 @smallexample
22525 struct foo @{ int a, b; @};
22526 struct bar @{ struct foo x, y; @};
22527 @end smallexample
22528
22529 Here are the printers:
22530
22531 @smallexample
22532 class fooPrinter:
22533 """Print a foo object."""
22534
22535 def __init__(self, val):
22536 self.val = val
22537
22538 def to_string(self):
22539 return ("a=<" + str(self.val["a"]) +
22540 "> b=<" + str(self.val["b"]) + ">")
22541
22542 class barPrinter:
22543 """Print a bar object."""
22544
22545 def __init__(self, val):
22546 self.val = val
22547
22548 def to_string(self):
22549 return ("x=<" + str(self.val["x"]) +
22550 "> y=<" + str(self.val["y"]) + ">")
22551 @end smallexample
22552
22553 This example doesn't need a lookup function, that is handled by the
22554 @code{gdb.printing} module. Instead a function is provided to build up
22555 the object that handles the lookup.
22556
22557 @smallexample
22558 import gdb.printing
22559
22560 def build_pretty_printer():
22561 pp = gdb.printing.RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter(
22562 "my_library")
22563 pp.add_printer('foo', '^foo$', fooPrinter)
22564 pp.add_printer('bar', '^bar$', barPrinter)
22565 return pp
22566 @end smallexample
22567
22568 And here is the autoload support:
22569
22570 @smallexample
22571 import gdb.printing
22572 import my_library
22573 gdb.printing.register_pretty_printer(
22574 gdb.current_objfile(),
22575 my_library.build_pretty_printer())
22576 @end smallexample
22577
22578 Finally, when this printer is loaded into @value{GDBN}, here is the
22579 corresponding output of @samp{info pretty-printer}:
22580
22581 @smallexample
22582 (gdb) info pretty-printer
22583 my_library.so:
22584 my_library
22585 foo
22586 bar
22587 @end smallexample
22588
22589 @node Inferiors In Python
22590 @subsubsection Inferiors In Python
22591 @cindex inferiors in Python
22592
22593 @findex gdb.Inferior
22594 Programs which are being run under @value{GDBN} are called inferiors
22595 (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). Python scripts can access
22596 information about and manipulate inferiors controlled by @value{GDBN}
22597 via objects of the @code{gdb.Inferior} class.
22598
22599 The following inferior-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
22600 module:
22601
22602 @defun gdb.inferiors ()
22603 Return a tuple containing all inferior objects.
22604 @end defun
22605
22606 @defun gdb.selected_inferior ()
22607 Return an object representing the current inferior.
22608 @end defun
22609
22610 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following attributes:
22611
22612 @table @code
22613 @defvar Inferior.num
22614 ID of inferior, as assigned by GDB.
22615 @end defvar
22616
22617 @defvar Inferior.pid
22618 Process ID of the inferior, as assigned by the underlying operating
22619 system.
22620 @end defvar
22621
22622 @defvar Inferior.was_attached
22623 Boolean signaling whether the inferior was created using `attach', or
22624 started by @value{GDBN} itself.
22625 @end defvar
22626 @end table
22627
22628 A @code{gdb.Inferior} object has the following methods:
22629
22630 @table @code
22631 @defun Inferior.is_valid ()
22632 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Inferior} object is valid,
22633 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Inferior} object will become invalid
22634 if the inferior no longer exists within @value{GDBN}. All other
22635 @code{gdb.Inferior} methods will throw an exception if it is invalid
22636 at the time the method is called.
22637 @end defun
22638
22639 @defun Inferior.threads ()
22640 This method returns a tuple holding all the threads which are valid
22641 when it is called. If there are no valid threads, the method will
22642 return an empty tuple.
22643 @end defun
22644
22645 @findex gdb.read_memory
22646 @defun Inferior.read_memory (address, length)
22647 Read @var{length} bytes of memory from the inferior, starting at
22648 @var{address}. Returns a buffer object, which behaves much like an array
22649 or a string. It can be modified and given to the @code{gdb.write_memory}
22650 function.
22651 @end defun
22652
22653 @findex gdb.write_memory
22654 @defun Inferior.write_memory (address, buffer @r{[}, length@r{]})
22655 Write the contents of @var{buffer} to the inferior, starting at
22656 @var{address}. The @var{buffer} parameter must be a Python object
22657 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
22658 object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. If given, @var{length}
22659 determines the number of bytes from @var{buffer} to be written.
22660 @end defun
22661
22662 @findex gdb.search_memory
22663 @defun Inferior.search_memory (address, length, pattern)
22664 Search a region of the inferior memory starting at @var{address} with
22665 the given @var{length} using the search pattern supplied in
22666 @var{pattern}. The @var{pattern} parameter must be a Python object
22667 which supports the buffer protocol, i.e., a string, an array or the
22668 object returned from @code{gdb.read_memory}. Returns a Python @code{Long}
22669 containing the address where the pattern was found, or @code{None} if
22670 the pattern could not be found.
22671 @end defun
22672 @end table
22673
22674 @node Events In Python
22675 @subsubsection Events In Python
22676 @cindex inferior events in Python
22677
22678 @value{GDBN} provides a general event facility so that Python code can be
22679 notified of various state changes, particularly changes that occur in
22680 the inferior.
22681
22682 An @dfn{event} is just an object that describes some state change. The
22683 type of the object and its attributes will vary depending on the details
22684 of the change. All the existing events are described below.
22685
22686 In order to be notified of an event, you must register an event handler
22687 with an @dfn{event registry}. An event registry is an object in the
22688 @code{gdb.events} module which dispatches particular events. A registry
22689 provides methods to register and unregister event handlers:
22690
22691 @table @code
22692 @defun EventRegistry.connect (object)
22693 Add the given callable @var{object} to the registry. This object will be
22694 called when an event corresponding to this registry occurs.
22695 @end defun
22696
22697 @defun EventRegistry.disconnect (object)
22698 Remove the given @var{object} from the registry. Once removed, the object
22699 will no longer receive notifications of events.
22700 @end defun
22701 @end table
22702
22703 Here is an example:
22704
22705 @smallexample
22706 def exit_handler (event):
22707 print "event type: exit"
22708 print "exit code: %d" % (event.exit_code)
22709
22710 gdb.events.exited.connect (exit_handler)
22711 @end smallexample
22712
22713 In the above example we connect our handler @code{exit_handler} to the
22714 registry @code{events.exited}. Once connected, @code{exit_handler} gets
22715 called when the inferior exits. The argument @dfn{event} in this example is
22716 of type @code{gdb.ExitedEvent}. As you can see in the example the
22717 @code{ExitedEvent} object has an attribute which indicates the exit code of
22718 the inferior.
22719
22720 The following is a listing of the event registries that are available and
22721 details of the events they emit:
22722
22723 @table @code
22724
22725 @item events.cont
22726 Emits @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
22727
22728 Some events can be thread specific when @value{GDBN} is running in non-stop
22729 mode. When represented in Python, these events all extend
22730 @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}. Note, this event is not emitted directly; instead,
22731 events which are emitted by this or other modules might extend this event.
22732 Examples of these events are @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} and
22733 @code{gdb.ContinueEvent}.
22734
22735 @table @code
22736 @defvar ThreadEvent.inferior_thread
22737 In non-stop mode this attribute will be set to the specific thread which was
22738 involved in the emitted event. Otherwise, it will be set to @code{None}.
22739 @end defvar
22740 @end table
22741
22742 Emits @code{gdb.ContinueEvent} which extends @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
22743
22744 This event indicates that the inferior has been continued after a stop. For
22745 inherited attribute refer to @code{gdb.ThreadEvent} above.
22746
22747 @item events.exited
22748 Emits @code{events.ExitedEvent} which indicates that the inferior has exited.
22749 @code{events.ExitedEvent} has two attributes:
22750 @table @code
22751 @defvar ExitedEvent.exit_code
22752 An integer representing the exit code, if available, which the inferior
22753 has returned. (The exit code could be unavailable if, for example,
22754 @value{GDBN} detaches from the inferior.) If the exit code is unavailable,
22755 the attribute does not exist.
22756 @end defvar
22757 @defvar ExitedEvent inferior
22758 A reference to the inferior which triggered the @code{exited} event.
22759 @end defvar
22760 @end table
22761
22762 @item events.stop
22763 Emits @code{gdb.StopEvent} which extends @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}.
22764
22765 Indicates that the inferior has stopped. All events emitted by this registry
22766 extend StopEvent. As a child of @code{gdb.ThreadEvent}, @code{gdb.StopEvent}
22767 will indicate the stopped thread when @value{GDBN} is running in non-stop
22768 mode. Refer to @code{gdb.ThreadEvent} above for more details.
22769
22770 Emits @code{gdb.SignalEvent} which extends @code{gdb.StopEvent}.
22771
22772 This event indicates that the inferior or one of its threads has received as
22773 signal. @code{gdb.SignalEvent} has the following attributes:
22774
22775 @table @code
22776 @defvar SignalEvent.stop_signal
22777 A string representing the signal received by the inferior. A list of possible
22778 signal values can be obtained by running the command @code{info signals} in
22779 the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
22780 @end defvar
22781 @end table
22782
22783 Also emits @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} which extends @code{gdb.StopEvent}.
22784
22785 @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent} event indicates that one or more breakpoints have
22786 been hit, and has the following attributes:
22787
22788 @table @code
22789 @defvar BreakpointEvent.breakpoints
22790 A sequence containing references to all the breakpoints (type
22791 @code{gdb.Breakpoint}) that were hit.
22792 @xref{Breakpoints In Python}, for details of the @code{gdb.Breakpoint} object.
22793 @end defvar
22794 @defvar BreakpointEvent.breakpoint
22795 A reference to the first breakpoint that was hit.
22796 This function is maintained for backward compatibility and is now deprecated
22797 in favor of the @code{gdb.BreakpointEvent.breakpoints} attribute.
22798 @end defvar
22799 @end table
22800
22801 @item events.new_objfile
22802 Emits @code{gdb.NewObjFileEvent} which indicates that a new object file has
22803 been loaded by @value{GDBN}. @code{gdb.NewObjFileEvent} has one attribute:
22804
22805 @table @code
22806 @defvar NewObjFileEvent.new_objfile
22807 A reference to the object file (@code{gdb.Objfile}) which has been loaded.
22808 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for details of the @code{gdb.Objfile} object.
22809 @end defvar
22810 @end table
22811
22812 @end table
22813
22814 @node Threads In Python
22815 @subsubsection Threads In Python
22816 @cindex threads in python
22817
22818 @findex gdb.InferiorThread
22819 Python scripts can access information about, and manipulate inferior threads
22820 controlled by @value{GDBN}, via objects of the @code{gdb.InferiorThread} class.
22821
22822 The following thread-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
22823 module:
22824
22825 @findex gdb.selected_thread
22826 @defun gdb.selected_thread ()
22827 This function returns the thread object for the selected thread. If there
22828 is no selected thread, this will return @code{None}.
22829 @end defun
22830
22831 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following attributes:
22832
22833 @table @code
22834 @defvar InferiorThread.name
22835 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using
22836 @code{thread name}, then this returns that name. Otherwise, if an
22837 OS-supplied name is available, then it is returned. Otherwise, this
22838 returns @code{None}.
22839
22840 This attribute can be assigned to. The new value must be a string
22841 object, which sets the new name, or @code{None}, which removes any
22842 user-specified thread name.
22843 @end defvar
22844
22845 @defvar InferiorThread.num
22846 ID of the thread, as assigned by GDB.
22847 @end defvar
22848
22849 @defvar InferiorThread.ptid
22850 ID of the thread, as assigned by the operating system. This attribute is a
22851 tuple containing three integers. The first is the Process ID (PID); the second
22852 is the Lightweight Process ID (LWPID), and the third is the Thread ID (TID).
22853 Either the LWPID or TID may be 0, which indicates that the operating system
22854 does not use that identifier.
22855 @end defvar
22856 @end table
22857
22858 A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object has the following methods:
22859
22860 @table @code
22861 @defun InferiorThread.is_valid ()
22862 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object is valid,
22863 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.InferiorThread} object will become
22864 invalid if the thread exits, or the inferior that the thread belongs
22865 is deleted. All other @code{gdb.InferiorThread} methods will throw an
22866 exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
22867 @end defun
22868
22869 @defun InferiorThread.switch ()
22870 This changes @value{GDBN}'s currently selected thread to the one represented
22871 by this object.
22872 @end defun
22873
22874 @defun InferiorThread.is_stopped ()
22875 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is stopped.
22876 @end defun
22877
22878 @defun InferiorThread.is_running ()
22879 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is running.
22880 @end defun
22881
22882 @defun InferiorThread.is_exited ()
22883 Return a Boolean indicating whether the thread is exited.
22884 @end defun
22885 @end table
22886
22887 @node Commands In Python
22888 @subsubsection Commands In Python
22889
22890 @cindex commands in python
22891 @cindex python commands
22892 You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
22893 command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
22894 class, most commonly using a subclass.
22895
22896 @defun Command.__init__ (name, @var{command_class} @r{[}, @var{completer_class} @r{[}, @var{prefix}@r{]]})
22897 The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
22898 with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
22899 subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
22900
22901 @var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
22902 multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
22903 commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
22904 an exception is raised.
22905
22906 There is no support for multi-line commands.
22907
22908 @var{command_class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
22909 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
22910 new command in the help system.
22911
22912 @var{completer_class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
22913 one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
22914 tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
22915 given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
22916 @code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
22917 error will occur when completion is attempted.
22918
22919 @var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
22920 command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
22921 registered.
22922
22923 The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
22924 documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
22925 documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
22926 not documented.'' is used.
22927 @end defun
22928
22929 @cindex don't repeat Python command
22930 @defun Command.dont_repeat ()
22931 By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
22932 blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
22933 behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
22934 to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
22935 @end defun
22936
22937 @defun Command.invoke (argument, from_tty)
22938 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
22939
22940 @var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
22941 leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
22942
22943 @var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
22944 command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
22945 that the command came from elsewhere.
22946
22947 If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
22948 @code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
22949
22950 @findex gdb.string_to_argv
22951 To break @var{argument} up into an argv-like string use
22952 @code{gdb.string_to_argv}. This function behaves identically to
22953 @value{GDBN}'s internal argument lexer @code{buildargv}.
22954 It is recommended to use this for consistency.
22955 Arguments are separated by spaces and may be quoted.
22956 Example:
22957
22958 @smallexample
22959 print gdb.string_to_argv ("1 2\ \\\"3 '4 \"5' \"6 '7\"")
22960 ['1', '2 "3', '4 "5', "6 '7"]
22961 @end smallexample
22962
22963 @end defun
22964
22965 @cindex completion of Python commands
22966 @defun Command.complete (text, word)
22967 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
22968 completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
22969 this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
22970 (@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
22971 complete}).
22972
22973 The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
22974 holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
22975 @var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
22976 using a word-breaking heuristic.
22977
22978 The @code{complete} method can return several values:
22979 @itemize @bullet
22980 @item
22981 If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
22982 used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
22983 contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
22984 allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
22985 string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
22986 sequence are ignored.
22987
22988 @item
22989 If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
22990 below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
22991 function is invoked, and its result is used.
22992
22993 @item
22994 All other results are treated as though there were no available
22995 completions.
22996 @end itemize
22997 @end defun
22998
22999 When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
23000 some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
23001 commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
23002 listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
23003 command. The available classifications are represented by constants
23004 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
23005
23006 @table @code
23007 @findex COMMAND_NONE
23008 @findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
23009 @item gdb.COMMAND_NONE
23010 The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
23011 this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
23012
23013 @findex COMMAND_RUNNING
23014 @findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
23015 @item gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
23016 The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
23017 @code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
23018 Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
23019 commands in this category.
23020
23021 @findex COMMAND_DATA
23022 @findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
23023 @item gdb.COMMAND_DATA
23024 The command is related to data or variables. For example,
23025 @code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
23026 @kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
23027 in this category.
23028
23029 @findex COMMAND_STACK
23030 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
23031 @item gdb.COMMAND_STACK
23032 The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
23033 @code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
23034 category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
23035 list of commands in this category.
23036
23037 @findex COMMAND_FILES
23038 @findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
23039 @item gdb.COMMAND_FILES
23040 This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
23041 @code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
23042 Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
23043 commands in this category.
23044
23045 @findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
23046 @findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
23047 @item gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
23048 This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
23049 things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
23050 but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
23051 @code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
23052 @kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
23053 commands in this category.
23054
23055 @findex COMMAND_STATUS
23056 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
23057 @item gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
23058 The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
23059 state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
23060 and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
23061 @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
23062
23063 @findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
23064 @findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
23065 @item gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
23066 The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
23067 @code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
23068 breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
23069 this category.
23070
23071 @findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
23072 @findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
23073 @item gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
23074 The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
23075 @code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
23076 @kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
23077 commands in this category.
23078
23079 @findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
23080 @findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
23081 @item gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
23082 The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
23083 general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
23084 @code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
23085 obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
23086 category.
23087
23088 @findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
23089 @findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
23090 @item gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
23091 The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
23092 @code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
23093 Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
23094 commands in this category.
23095 @end table
23096
23097 A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
23098 specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
23099 from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
23100 constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
23101
23102 @table @code
23103 @findex COMPLETE_NONE
23104 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
23105 @item gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
23106 This constant means that no completion should be done.
23107
23108 @findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
23109 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
23110 @item gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
23111 This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
23112
23113 @findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
23114 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
23115 @item gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
23116 This constant means that location completion should be done.
23117 @xref{Specify Location}.
23118
23119 @findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
23120 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
23121 @item gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
23122 This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
23123 command names.
23124
23125 @findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
23126 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
23127 @item gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
23128 This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
23129 as the source.
23130 @end table
23131
23132 The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
23133 implemented in Python:
23134
23135 @smallexample
23136 class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
23137 """Greet the whole world."""
23138
23139 def __init__ (self):
23140 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
23141
23142 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
23143 print "Hello, World!"
23144
23145 HelloWorld ()
23146 @end smallexample
23147
23148 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
23149 registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
23150 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
23151 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
23152
23153 @node Parameters In Python
23154 @subsubsection Parameters In Python
23155
23156 @cindex parameters in python
23157 @cindex python parameters
23158 @tindex gdb.Parameter
23159 @tindex Parameter
23160 You can implement new @value{GDBN} parameters using Python. A new
23161 parameter is implemented as an instance of the @code{gdb.Parameter}
23162 class.
23163
23164 Parameters are exposed to the user via the @code{set} and
23165 @code{show} commands. @xref{Help}.
23166
23167 There are many parameters that already exist and can be set in
23168 @value{GDBN}. Two examples are: @code{set follow fork} and
23169 @code{set charset}. Setting these parameters influences certain
23170 behavior in @value{GDBN}. Similarly, you can define parameters that
23171 can be used to influence behavior in custom Python scripts and commands.
23172
23173 @defun Parameter.__init__ (name, @var{command-class}, @var{parameter-class} @r{[}, @var{enum-sequence}@r{]})
23174 The object initializer for @code{Parameter} registers the new
23175 parameter with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked
23176 from the subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
23177
23178 @var{name} is the name of the new parameter. If @var{name} consists
23179 of multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
23180 parameters. An example of this can be illustrated with the
23181 @code{set print} set of parameters. If @var{name} is
23182 @code{print foo}, then @code{print} will be searched as the prefix
23183 parameter. In this case the parameter can subsequently be accessed in
23184 @value{GDBN} as @code{set print foo}.
23185
23186 If @var{name} consists of multiple words, and no prefix parameter group
23187 can be found, an exception is raised.
23188
23189 @var{command-class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
23190 (@pxref{Commands In Python}). This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to
23191 categorize the new parameter in the help system.
23192
23193 @var{parameter-class} should be one of the @samp{PARAM_} constants
23194 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} the type of the new
23195 parameter; this information is used for input validation and
23196 completion.
23197
23198 If @var{parameter-class} is @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then
23199 @var{enum-sequence} must be a sequence of strings. These strings
23200 represent the possible values for the parameter.
23201
23202 If @var{parameter-class} is not @code{PARAM_ENUM}, then the presence
23203 of a fourth argument will cause an exception to be thrown.
23204
23205 The help text for the new parameter is taken from the Python
23206 documentation string for the parameter's class, if there is one. If
23207 there is no documentation string, a default value is used.
23208 @end defun
23209
23210 @defvar Parameter.set_doc
23211 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
23212 the help text for this parameter's @code{set} command. The value is
23213 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
23214 have no effect.
23215 @end defvar
23216
23217 @defvar Parameter.show_doc
23218 If this attribute exists, and is a string, then its value is used as
23219 the help text for this parameter's @code{show} command. The value is
23220 examined when @code{Parameter.__init__} is invoked; subsequent changes
23221 have no effect.
23222 @end defvar
23223
23224 @defvar Parameter.value
23225 The @code{value} attribute holds the underlying value of the
23226 parameter. It can be read and assigned to just as any other
23227 attribute. @value{GDBN} does validation when assignments are made.
23228 @end defvar
23229
23230 There are two methods that should be implemented in any
23231 @code{Parameter} class. These are:
23232
23233 @defun Parameter.get_set_string (self)
23234 @value{GDBN} will call this method when a @var{parameter}'s value has
23235 been changed via the @code{set} API (for example, @kbd{set foo off}).
23236 The @code{value} attribute has already been populated with the new
23237 value and may be used in output. This method must return a string.
23238 @end defun
23239
23240 @defun Parameter.get_show_string (self, svalue)
23241 @value{GDBN} will call this method when a @var{parameter}'s
23242 @code{show} API has been invoked (for example, @kbd{show foo}). The
23243 argument @code{svalue} receives the string representation of the
23244 current value. This method must return a string.
23245 @end defun
23246
23247 When a new parameter is defined, its type must be specified. The
23248 available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
23249 module:
23250
23251 @table @code
23252 @findex PARAM_BOOLEAN
23253 @findex gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN
23254 @item gdb.PARAM_BOOLEAN
23255 The value is a plain boolean. The Python boolean values, @code{True}
23256 and @code{False} are the only valid values.
23257
23258 @findex PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
23259 @findex gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
23260 @item gdb.PARAM_AUTO_BOOLEAN
23261 The value has three possible states: true, false, and @samp{auto}. In
23262 Python, true and false are represented using boolean constants, and
23263 @samp{auto} is represented using @code{None}.
23264
23265 @findex PARAM_UINTEGER
23266 @findex gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER
23267 @item gdb.PARAM_UINTEGER
23268 The value is an unsigned integer. The value of 0 should be
23269 interpreted to mean ``unlimited''.
23270
23271 @findex PARAM_INTEGER
23272 @findex gdb.PARAM_INTEGER
23273 @item gdb.PARAM_INTEGER
23274 The value is a signed integer. The value of 0 should be interpreted
23275 to mean ``unlimited''.
23276
23277 @findex PARAM_STRING
23278 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING
23279 @item gdb.PARAM_STRING
23280 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, any escape
23281 sequences, such as @samp{\t}, @samp{\f}, and octal escapes, are
23282 translated into corresponding characters and encoded into the current
23283 host charset.
23284
23285 @findex PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
23286 @findex gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
23287 @item gdb.PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE
23288 The value is a string. When the user modifies the string, escapes are
23289 passed through untranslated.
23290
23291 @findex PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
23292 @findex gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
23293 @item gdb.PARAM_OPTIONAL_FILENAME
23294 The value is a either a filename (a string), or @code{None}.
23295
23296 @findex PARAM_FILENAME
23297 @findex gdb.PARAM_FILENAME
23298 @item gdb.PARAM_FILENAME
23299 The value is a filename. This is just like
23300 @code{PARAM_STRING_NOESCAPE}, but uses file names for completion.
23301
23302 @findex PARAM_ZINTEGER
23303 @findex gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER
23304 @item gdb.PARAM_ZINTEGER
23305 The value is an integer. This is like @code{PARAM_INTEGER}, except 0
23306 is interpreted as itself.
23307
23308 @findex PARAM_ENUM
23309 @findex gdb.PARAM_ENUM
23310 @item gdb.PARAM_ENUM
23311 The value is a string, which must be one of a collection string
23312 constants provided when the parameter is created.
23313 @end table
23314
23315 @node Functions In Python
23316 @subsubsection Writing new convenience functions
23317
23318 @cindex writing convenience functions
23319 @cindex convenience functions in python
23320 @cindex python convenience functions
23321 @tindex gdb.Function
23322 @tindex Function
23323 You can implement new convenience functions (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
23324 in Python. A convenience function is an instance of a subclass of the
23325 class @code{gdb.Function}.
23326
23327 @defun Function.__init__ (name)
23328 The initializer for @code{Function} registers the new function with
23329 @value{GDBN}. The argument @var{name} is the name of the function,
23330 a string. The function will be visible to the user as a convenience
23331 variable of type @code{internal function}, whose name is the same as
23332 the given @var{name}.
23333
23334 The documentation for the new function is taken from the documentation
23335 string for the new class.
23336 @end defun
23337
23338 @defun Function.invoke (@var{*args})
23339 When a convenience function is evaluated, its arguments are converted
23340 to instances of @code{gdb.Value}, and then the function's
23341 @code{invoke} method is called. Note that @value{GDBN} does not
23342 predetermine the arity of convenience functions. Instead, all
23343 available arguments are passed to @code{invoke}, following the
23344 standard Python calling convention. In particular, a convenience
23345 function can have default values for parameters without ill effect.
23346
23347 The return value of this method is used as its value in the enclosing
23348 expression. If an ordinary Python value is returned, it is converted
23349 to a @code{gdb.Value} following the usual rules.
23350 @end defun
23351
23352 The following code snippet shows how a trivial convenience function can
23353 be implemented in Python:
23354
23355 @smallexample
23356 class Greet (gdb.Function):
23357 """Return string to greet someone.
23358 Takes a name as argument."""
23359
23360 def __init__ (self):
23361 super (Greet, self).__init__ ("greet")
23362
23363 def invoke (self, name):
23364 return "Hello, %s!" % name.string ()
23365
23366 Greet ()
23367 @end smallexample
23368
23369 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
23370 registration of the function with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
23371 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
23372 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
23373
23374 @node Progspaces In Python
23375 @subsubsection Program Spaces In Python
23376
23377 @cindex progspaces in python
23378 @tindex gdb.Progspace
23379 @tindex Progspace
23380 A program space, or @dfn{progspace}, represents a symbolic view
23381 of an address space.
23382 It consists of all of the objfiles of the program.
23383 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
23384 @xref{Inferiors and Programs, program spaces}, for more details
23385 about program spaces.
23386
23387 The following progspace-related functions are available in the
23388 @code{gdb} module:
23389
23390 @findex gdb.current_progspace
23391 @defun gdb.current_progspace ()
23392 This function returns the program space of the currently selected inferior.
23393 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}.
23394 @end defun
23395
23396 @findex gdb.progspaces
23397 @defun gdb.progspaces ()
23398 Return a sequence of all the progspaces currently known to @value{GDBN}.
23399 @end defun
23400
23401 Each progspace is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Progspace}
23402 class.
23403
23404 @defvar Progspace.filename
23405 The file name of the progspace as a string.
23406 @end defvar
23407
23408 @defvar Progspace.pretty_printers
23409 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
23410 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
23411 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
23412 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
23413 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
23414 information.
23415 @end defvar
23416
23417 @node Objfiles In Python
23418 @subsubsection Objfiles In Python
23419
23420 @cindex objfiles in python
23421 @tindex gdb.Objfile
23422 @tindex Objfile
23423 @value{GDBN} loads symbols for an inferior from various
23424 symbol-containing files (@pxref{Files}). These include the primary
23425 executable file, any shared libraries used by the inferior, and any
23426 separate debug info files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}).
23427 @value{GDBN} calls these symbol-containing files @dfn{objfiles}.
23428
23429 The following objfile-related functions are available in the
23430 @code{gdb} module:
23431
23432 @findex gdb.current_objfile
23433 @defun gdb.current_objfile ()
23434 When auto-loading a Python script (@pxref{Auto-loading}), @value{GDBN}
23435 sets the ``current objfile'' to the corresponding objfile. This
23436 function returns the current objfile. If there is no current objfile,
23437 this function returns @code{None}.
23438 @end defun
23439
23440 @findex gdb.objfiles
23441 @defun gdb.objfiles ()
23442 Return a sequence of all the objfiles current known to @value{GDBN}.
23443 @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
23444 @end defun
23445
23446 Each objfile is represented by an instance of the @code{gdb.Objfile}
23447 class.
23448
23449 @defvar Objfile.filename
23450 The file name of the objfile as a string.
23451 @end defvar
23452
23453 @defvar Objfile.pretty_printers
23454 The @code{pretty_printers} attribute is a list of functions. It is
23455 used to look up pretty-printers. A @code{Value} is passed to each
23456 function in order; if the function returns @code{None}, then the
23457 search continues. Otherwise, the return value should be an object
23458 which is used to format the value. @xref{Pretty Printing API}, for more
23459 information.
23460 @end defvar
23461
23462 A @code{gdb.Objfile} object has the following methods:
23463
23464 @defun Objfile.is_valid ()
23465 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Objfile} object is valid,
23466 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Objfile} object can become invalid
23467 if the object file it refers to is not loaded in @value{GDBN} any
23468 longer. All other @code{gdb.Objfile} methods will throw an exception
23469 if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
23470 @end defun
23471
23472 @node Frames In Python
23473 @subsubsection Accessing inferior stack frames from Python.
23474
23475 @cindex frames in python
23476 When the debugged program stops, @value{GDBN} is able to analyze its call
23477 stack (@pxref{Frames,,Stack frames}). The @code{gdb.Frame} class
23478 represents a frame in the stack. A @code{gdb.Frame} object is only valid
23479 while its corresponding frame exists in the inferior's stack. If you try
23480 to use an invalid frame object, @value{GDBN} will throw a @code{gdb.error}
23481 exception (@pxref{Exception Handling}).
23482
23483 Two @code{gdb.Frame} objects can be compared for equality with the @code{==}
23484 operator, like:
23485
23486 @smallexample
23487 (@value{GDBP}) python print gdb.newest_frame() == gdb.selected_frame ()
23488 True
23489 @end smallexample
23490
23491 The following frame-related functions are available in the @code{gdb} module:
23492
23493 @findex gdb.selected_frame
23494 @defun gdb.selected_frame ()
23495 Return the selected frame object. (@pxref{Selection,,Selecting a Frame}).
23496 @end defun
23497
23498 @findex gdb.newest_frame
23499 @defun gdb.newest_frame ()
23500 Return the newest frame object for the selected thread.
23501 @end defun
23502
23503 @defun gdb.frame_stop_reason_string (reason)
23504 Return a string explaining the reason why @value{GDBN} stopped unwinding
23505 frames, as expressed by the given @var{reason} code (an integer, see the
23506 @code{unwind_stop_reason} method further down in this section).
23507 @end defun
23508
23509 A @code{gdb.Frame} object has the following methods:
23510
23511 @table @code
23512 @defun Frame.is_valid ()
23513 Returns true if the @code{gdb.Frame} object is valid, false if not.
23514 A frame object can become invalid if the frame it refers to doesn't
23515 exist anymore in the inferior. All @code{gdb.Frame} methods will throw
23516 an exception if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
23517 @end defun
23518
23519 @defun Frame.name ()
23520 Returns the function name of the frame, or @code{None} if it can't be
23521 obtained.
23522 @end defun
23523
23524 @defun Frame.type ()
23525 Returns the type of the frame. The value can be one of:
23526 @table @code
23527 @item gdb.NORMAL_FRAME
23528 An ordinary stack frame.
23529
23530 @item gdb.DUMMY_FRAME
23531 A fake stack frame that was created by @value{GDBN} when performing an
23532 inferior function call.
23533
23534 @item gdb.INLINE_FRAME
23535 A frame representing an inlined function. The function was inlined
23536 into a @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME} that is older than this one.
23537
23538 @item gdb.TAILCALL_FRAME
23539 A frame representing a tail call. @xref{Tail Call Frames}.
23540
23541 @item gdb.SIGTRAMP_FRAME
23542 A signal trampoline frame. This is the frame created by the OS when
23543 it calls into a signal handler.
23544
23545 @item gdb.ARCH_FRAME
23546 A fake stack frame representing a cross-architecture call.
23547
23548 @item gdb.SENTINEL_FRAME
23549 This is like @code{gdb.NORMAL_FRAME}, but it is only used for the
23550 newest frame.
23551 @end table
23552 @end defun
23553
23554 @defun Frame.unwind_stop_reason ()
23555 Return an integer representing the reason why it's not possible to find
23556 more frames toward the outermost frame. Use
23557 @code{gdb.frame_stop_reason_string} to convert the value returned by this
23558 function to a string. The value can be one of:
23559
23560 @table @code
23561 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_NO_REASON
23562 No particular reason (older frames should be available).
23563
23564 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_NULL_ID
23565 The previous frame's analyzer returns an invalid result.
23566
23567 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_OUTERMOST
23568 This frame is the outermost.
23569
23570 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_UNAVAILABLE
23571 Cannot unwind further, because that would require knowing the
23572 values of registers or memory that have not been collected.
23573
23574 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_INNER_ID
23575 This frame ID looks like it ought to belong to a NEXT frame,
23576 but we got it for a PREV frame. Normally, this is a sign of
23577 unwinder failure. It could also indicate stack corruption.
23578
23579 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_SAME_ID
23580 This frame has the same ID as the previous one. That means
23581 that unwinding further would almost certainly give us another
23582 frame with exactly the same ID, so break the chain. Normally,
23583 this is a sign of unwinder failure. It could also indicate
23584 stack corruption.
23585
23586 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_NO_SAVED_PC
23587 The frame unwinder did not find any saved PC, but we needed
23588 one to unwind further.
23589
23590 @item gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_FIRST_ERROR
23591 Any stop reason greater or equal to this value indicates some kind
23592 of error. This special value facilitates writing code that tests
23593 for errors in unwinding in a way that will work correctly even if
23594 the list of the other values is modified in future @value{GDBN}
23595 versions. Using it, you could write:
23596 @smallexample
23597 reason = gdb.selected_frame().unwind_stop_reason ()
23598 reason_str = gdb.frame_stop_reason_string (reason)
23599 if reason >= gdb.FRAME_UNWIND_FIRST_ERROR:
23600 print "An error occured: %s" % reason_str
23601 @end smallexample
23602 @end table
23603
23604 @end defun
23605
23606 @defun Frame.pc ()
23607 Returns the frame's resume address.
23608 @end defun
23609
23610 @defun Frame.block ()
23611 Return the frame's code block. @xref{Blocks In Python}.
23612 @end defun
23613
23614 @defun Frame.function ()
23615 Return the symbol for the function corresponding to this frame.
23616 @xref{Symbols In Python}.
23617 @end defun
23618
23619 @defun Frame.older ()
23620 Return the frame that called this frame.
23621 @end defun
23622
23623 @defun Frame.newer ()
23624 Return the frame called by this frame.
23625 @end defun
23626
23627 @defun Frame.find_sal ()
23628 Return the frame's symtab and line object.
23629 @xref{Symbol Tables In Python}.
23630 @end defun
23631
23632 @defun Frame.read_var (variable @r{[}, block@r{]})
23633 Return the value of @var{variable} in this frame. If the optional
23634 argument @var{block} is provided, search for the variable from that
23635 block; otherwise start at the frame's current block (which is
23636 determined by the frame's current program counter). @var{variable}
23637 must be a string or a @code{gdb.Symbol} object. @var{block} must be a
23638 @code{gdb.Block} object.
23639 @end defun
23640
23641 @defun Frame.select ()
23642 Set this frame to be the selected frame. @xref{Stack, ,Examining the
23643 Stack}.
23644 @end defun
23645 @end table
23646
23647 @node Blocks In Python
23648 @subsubsection Accessing frame blocks from Python.
23649
23650 @cindex blocks in python
23651 @tindex gdb.Block
23652
23653 Within each frame, @value{GDBN} maintains information on each block
23654 stored in that frame. These blocks are organized hierarchically, and
23655 are represented individually in Python as a @code{gdb.Block}.
23656 Please see @ref{Frames In Python}, for a more in-depth discussion on
23657 frames. Furthermore, see @ref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}, for more
23658 detailed technical information on @value{GDBN}'s book-keeping of the
23659 stack.
23660
23661 The following block-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
23662 module:
23663
23664 @findex gdb.block_for_pc
23665 @defun gdb.block_for_pc (pc)
23666 Return the @code{gdb.Block} containing the given @var{pc} value. If the
23667 block cannot be found for the @var{pc} value specified, the function
23668 will return @code{None}.
23669 @end defun
23670
23671 A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following methods:
23672
23673 @table @code
23674 @defun Block.is_valid ()
23675 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Block} object is valid,
23676 @code{False} if not. A block object can become invalid if the block it
23677 refers to doesn't exist anymore in the inferior. All other
23678 @code{gdb.Block} methods will throw an exception if it is invalid at
23679 the time the method is called. This method is also made available to
23680 the Python iterator object that @code{gdb.Block} provides in an iteration
23681 context and via the Python @code{iter} built-in function.
23682 @end defun
23683 @end table
23684
23685 A @code{gdb.Block} object has the following attributes:
23686
23687 @table @code
23688 @defvar Block.start
23689 The start address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
23690 @end defvar
23691
23692 @defvar Block.end
23693 The end address of the block. This attribute is not writable.
23694 @end defvar
23695
23696 @defvar Block.function
23697 The name of the block represented as a @code{gdb.Symbol}. If the
23698 block is not named, then this attribute holds @code{None}. This
23699 attribute is not writable.
23700 @end defvar
23701
23702 @defvar Block.superblock
23703 The block containing this block. If this parent block does not exist,
23704 this attribute holds @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
23705 @end defvar
23706
23707 @defvar Block.global_block
23708 The global block associated with this block. This attribute is not
23709 writable.
23710 @end defvar
23711
23712 @defvar Block.static_block
23713 The static block associated with this block. This attribute is not
23714 writable.
23715 @end defvar
23716
23717 @defvar Block.is_global
23718 @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Block} object is a global block,
23719 @code{False} if not. This attribute is not
23720 writable.
23721 @end defvar
23722
23723 @defvar Block.is_static
23724 @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Block} object is a static block,
23725 @code{False} if not. This attribute is not writable.
23726 @end defvar
23727 @end table
23728
23729 @node Symbols In Python
23730 @subsubsection Python representation of Symbols.
23731
23732 @cindex symbols in python
23733 @tindex gdb.Symbol
23734
23735 @value{GDBN} represents every variable, function and type as an
23736 entry in a symbol table. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
23737 Similarly, Python represents these symbols in @value{GDBN} with the
23738 @code{gdb.Symbol} object.
23739
23740 The following symbol-related functions are available in the @code{gdb}
23741 module:
23742
23743 @findex gdb.lookup_symbol
23744 @defun gdb.lookup_symbol (name @r{[}, block @r{[}, domain@r{]]})
23745 This function searches for a symbol by name. The search scope can be
23746 restricted to the parameters defined in the optional domain and block
23747 arguments.
23748
23749 @var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string. The
23750 optional @var{block} argument restricts the search to symbols visible
23751 in that @var{block}. The @var{block} argument must be a
23752 @code{gdb.Block} object. If omitted, the block for the current frame
23753 is used. The optional @var{domain} argument restricts
23754 the search to the domain type. The @var{domain} argument must be a
23755 domain constant defined in the @code{gdb} module and described later
23756 in this chapter.
23757
23758 The result is a tuple of two elements.
23759 The first element is a @code{gdb.Symbol} object or @code{None} if the symbol
23760 is not found.
23761 If the symbol is found, the second element is @code{True} if the symbol
23762 is a field of a method's object (e.g., @code{this} in C@t{++}),
23763 otherwise it is @code{False}.
23764 If the symbol is not found, the second element is @code{False}.
23765 @end defun
23766
23767 @findex gdb.lookup_global_symbol
23768 @defun gdb.lookup_global_symbol (name @r{[}, domain@r{]})
23769 This function searches for a global symbol by name.
23770 The search scope can be restricted to by the domain argument.
23771
23772 @var{name} is the name of the symbol. It must be a string.
23773 The optional @var{domain} argument restricts the search to the domain type.
23774 The @var{domain} argument must be a domain constant defined in the @code{gdb}
23775 module and described later in this chapter.
23776
23777 The result is a @code{gdb.Symbol} object or @code{None} if the symbol
23778 is not found.
23779 @end defun
23780
23781 A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following attributes:
23782
23783 @table @code
23784 @defvar Symbol.type
23785 The type of the symbol or @code{None} if no type is recorded.
23786 This attribute is represented as a @code{gdb.Type} object.
23787 @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not writable.
23788 @end defvar
23789
23790 @defvar Symbol.symtab
23791 The symbol table in which the symbol appears. This attribute is
23792 represented as a @code{gdb.Symtab} object. @xref{Symbol Tables In
23793 Python}. This attribute is not writable.
23794 @end defvar
23795
23796 @defvar Symbol.name
23797 The name of the symbol as a string. This attribute is not writable.
23798 @end defvar
23799
23800 @defvar Symbol.linkage_name
23801 The name of the symbol, as used by the linker (i.e., may be mangled).
23802 This attribute is not writable.
23803 @end defvar
23804
23805 @defvar Symbol.print_name
23806 The name of the symbol in a form suitable for output. This is either
23807 @code{name} or @code{linkage_name}, depending on whether the user
23808 asked @value{GDBN} to display demangled or mangled names.
23809 @end defvar
23810
23811 @defvar Symbol.addr_class
23812 The address class of the symbol. This classifies how to find the value
23813 of a symbol. Each address class is a constant defined in the
23814 @code{gdb} module and described later in this chapter.
23815 @end defvar
23816
23817 @defvar Symbol.is_argument
23818 @code{True} if the symbol is an argument of a function.
23819 @end defvar
23820
23821 @defvar Symbol.is_constant
23822 @code{True} if the symbol is a constant.
23823 @end defvar
23824
23825 @defvar Symbol.is_function
23826 @code{True} if the symbol is a function or a method.
23827 @end defvar
23828
23829 @defvar Symbol.is_variable
23830 @code{True} if the symbol is a variable.
23831 @end defvar
23832 @end table
23833
23834 A @code{gdb.Symbol} object has the following methods:
23835
23836 @table @code
23837 @defun Symbol.is_valid ()
23838 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symbol} object is valid,
23839 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symbol} object can become invalid if
23840 the symbol it refers to does not exist in @value{GDBN} any longer.
23841 All other @code{gdb.Symbol} methods will throw an exception if it is
23842 invalid at the time the method is called.
23843 @end defun
23844 @end table
23845
23846 The available domain categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
23847 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
23848
23849 @table @code
23850 @findex SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
23851 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
23852 @item gdb.SYMBOL_UNDEF_DOMAIN
23853 This is used when a domain has not been discovered or none of the
23854 following domains apply. This usually indicates an error either
23855 in the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
23856 @findex SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
23857 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
23858 @item gdb.SYMBOL_VAR_DOMAIN
23859 This domain contains variables, function names, typedef names and enum
23860 type values.
23861 @findex SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
23862 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
23863 @item gdb.SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN
23864 This domain holds struct, union and enum type names.
23865 @findex SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
23866 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
23867 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LABEL_DOMAIN
23868 This domain contains names of labels (for gotos).
23869 @findex SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
23870 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
23871 @item gdb.SYMBOL_VARIABLES_DOMAIN
23872 This domain holds a subset of the @code{SYMBOLS_VAR_DOMAIN}; it
23873 contains everything minus functions and types.
23874 @findex SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
23875 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_FUNCTIONS_DOMAIN
23876 @item gdb.SYMBOL_FUNCTION_DOMAIN
23877 This domain contains all functions.
23878 @findex SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
23879 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
23880 @item gdb.SYMBOL_TYPES_DOMAIN
23881 This domain contains all types.
23882 @end table
23883
23884 The available address class categories in @code{gdb.Symbol} are represented
23885 as constants in the @code{gdb} module:
23886
23887 @table @code
23888 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
23889 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
23890 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNDEF
23891 If this is returned by address class, it indicates an error either in
23892 the symbol information or in @value{GDBN}'s handling of symbols.
23893 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
23894 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
23895 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST
23896 Value is constant int.
23897 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
23898 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
23899 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_STATIC
23900 Value is at a fixed address.
23901 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
23902 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
23903 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGISTER
23904 Value is in a register.
23905 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
23906 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
23907 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_ARG
23908 Value is an argument. This value is at the offset stored within the
23909 symbol inside the frame's argument list.
23910 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
23911 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
23912 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REF_ARG
23913 Value address is stored in the frame's argument list. Just like
23914 @code{LOC_ARG} except that the value's address is stored at the
23915 offset, not the value itself.
23916 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
23917 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
23918 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_REGPARM_ADDR
23919 Value is a specified register. Just like @code{LOC_REGISTER} except
23920 the register holds the address of the argument instead of the argument
23921 itself.
23922 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
23923 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
23924 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_LOCAL
23925 Value is a local variable.
23926 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
23927 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
23928 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_TYPEDEF
23929 Value not used. Symbols in the domain @code{SYMBOL_STRUCT_DOMAIN} all
23930 have this class.
23931 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
23932 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
23933 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_BLOCK
23934 Value is a block.
23935 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
23936 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
23937 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_CONST_BYTES
23938 Value is a byte-sequence.
23939 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
23940 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
23941 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_UNRESOLVED
23942 Value is at a fixed address, but the address of the variable has to be
23943 determined from the minimal symbol table whenever the variable is
23944 referenced.
23945 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
23946 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
23947 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT
23948 The value does not actually exist in the program.
23949 @findex SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
23950 @findex gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
23951 @item gdb.SYMBOL_LOC_COMPUTED
23952 The value's address is a computed location.
23953 @end table
23954
23955 @node Symbol Tables In Python
23956 @subsubsection Symbol table representation in Python.
23957
23958 @cindex symbol tables in python
23959 @tindex gdb.Symtab
23960 @tindex gdb.Symtab_and_line
23961
23962 Access to symbol table data maintained by @value{GDBN} on the inferior
23963 is exposed to Python via two objects: @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} and
23964 @code{gdb.Symtab}. Symbol table and line data for a frame is returned
23965 from the @code{find_sal} method in @code{gdb.Frame} object.
23966 @xref{Frames In Python}.
23967
23968 For more information on @value{GDBN}'s symbol table management, see
23969 @ref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, for more information.
23970
23971 A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following attributes:
23972
23973 @table @code
23974 @defvar Symtab_and_line.symtab
23975 The symbol table object (@code{gdb.Symtab}) for this frame.
23976 This attribute is not writable.
23977 @end defvar
23978
23979 @defvar Symtab_and_line.pc
23980 Indicates the current program counter address. This attribute is not
23981 writable.
23982 @end defvar
23983
23984 @defvar Symtab_and_line.line
23985 Indicates the current line number for this object. This
23986 attribute is not writable.
23987 @end defvar
23988 @end table
23989
23990 A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object has the following methods:
23991
23992 @table @code
23993 @defun Symtab_and_line.is_valid ()
23994 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object is valid,
23995 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} object can become
23996 invalid if the Symbol table and line object it refers to does not
23997 exist in @value{GDBN} any longer. All other
23998 @code{gdb.Symtab_and_line} methods will throw an exception if it is
23999 invalid at the time the method is called.
24000 @end defun
24001 @end table
24002
24003 A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following attributes:
24004
24005 @table @code
24006 @defvar Symtab.filename
24007 The symbol table's source filename. This attribute is not writable.
24008 @end defvar
24009
24010 @defvar Symtab.objfile
24011 The symbol table's backing object file. @xref{Objfiles In Python}.
24012 This attribute is not writable.
24013 @end defvar
24014 @end table
24015
24016 A @code{gdb.Symtab} object has the following methods:
24017
24018 @table @code
24019 @defun Symtab.is_valid ()
24020 Returns @code{True} if the @code{gdb.Symtab} object is valid,
24021 @code{False} if not. A @code{gdb.Symtab} object can become invalid if
24022 the symbol table it refers to does not exist in @value{GDBN} any
24023 longer. All other @code{gdb.Symtab} methods will throw an exception
24024 if it is invalid at the time the method is called.
24025 @end defun
24026
24027 @defun Symtab.fullname ()
24028 Return the symbol table's source absolute file name.
24029 @end defun
24030 @end table
24031
24032 @node Breakpoints In Python
24033 @subsubsection Manipulating breakpoints using Python
24034
24035 @cindex breakpoints in python
24036 @tindex gdb.Breakpoint
24037
24038 Python code can manipulate breakpoints via the @code{gdb.Breakpoint}
24039 class.
24040
24041 @defun Breakpoint.__init__ (spec @r{[}, type @r{[}, wp_class @r{[},internal@r{]]]})
24042 Create a new breakpoint. @var{spec} is a string naming the
24043 location of the breakpoint, or an expression that defines a
24044 watchpoint. The contents can be any location recognized by the
24045 @code{break} command, or in the case of a watchpoint, by the @code{watch}
24046 command. The optional @var{type} denotes the breakpoint to create
24047 from the types defined later in this chapter. This argument can be
24048 either: @code{gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT} or @code{gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT}. @var{type}
24049 defaults to @code{gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT}. The optional @var{internal} argument
24050 allows the breakpoint to become invisible to the user. The breakpoint
24051 will neither be reported when created, nor will it be listed in the
24052 output from @code{info breakpoints} (but will be listed with the
24053 @code{maint info breakpoints} command). The optional @var{wp_class}
24054 argument defines the class of watchpoint to create, if @var{type} is
24055 @code{gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT}. If a watchpoint class is not provided, it is
24056 assumed to be a @code{gdb.WP_WRITE} class.
24057 @end defun
24058
24059 @defun Breakpoint.stop (self)
24060 The @code{gdb.Breakpoint} class can be sub-classed and, in
24061 particular, you may choose to implement the @code{stop} method.
24062 If this method is defined as a sub-class of @code{gdb.Breakpoint},
24063 it will be called when the inferior reaches any location of a
24064 breakpoint which instantiates that sub-class. If the method returns
24065 @code{True}, the inferior will be stopped at the location of the
24066 breakpoint, otherwise the inferior will continue.
24067
24068 If there are multiple breakpoints at the same location with a
24069 @code{stop} method, each one will be called regardless of the
24070 return status of the previous. This ensures that all @code{stop}
24071 methods have a chance to execute at that location. In this scenario
24072 if one of the methods returns @code{True} but the others return
24073 @code{False}, the inferior will still be stopped.
24074
24075 You should not alter the execution state of the inferior (i.e.@:, step,
24076 next, etc.), alter the current frame context (i.e.@:, change the current
24077 active frame), or alter, add or delete any breakpoint. As a general
24078 rule, you should not alter any data within @value{GDBN} or the inferior
24079 at this time.
24080
24081 Example @code{stop} implementation:
24082
24083 @smallexample
24084 class MyBreakpoint (gdb.Breakpoint):
24085 def stop (self):
24086 inf_val = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo")
24087 if inf_val == 3:
24088 return True
24089 return False
24090 @end smallexample
24091 @end defun
24092
24093 The available watchpoint types represented by constants are defined in the
24094 @code{gdb} module:
24095
24096 @table @code
24097 @findex WP_READ
24098 @findex gdb.WP_READ
24099 @item gdb.WP_READ
24100 Read only watchpoint.
24101
24102 @findex WP_WRITE
24103 @findex gdb.WP_WRITE
24104 @item gdb.WP_WRITE
24105 Write only watchpoint.
24106
24107 @findex WP_ACCESS
24108 @findex gdb.WP_ACCESS
24109 @item gdb.WP_ACCESS
24110 Read/Write watchpoint.
24111 @end table
24112
24113 @defun Breakpoint.is_valid ()
24114 Return @code{True} if this @code{Breakpoint} object is valid,
24115 @code{False} otherwise. A @code{Breakpoint} object can become invalid
24116 if the user deletes the breakpoint. In this case, the object still
24117 exists, but the underlying breakpoint does not. In the cases of
24118 watchpoint scope, the watchpoint remains valid even if execution of the
24119 inferior leaves the scope of that watchpoint.
24120 @end defun
24121
24122 @defun Breakpoint.delete
24123 Permanently deletes the @value{GDBN} breakpoint. This also
24124 invalidates the Python @code{Breakpoint} object. Any further access
24125 to this object's attributes or methods will raise an error.
24126 @end defun
24127
24128 @defvar Breakpoint.enabled
24129 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is enabled, and
24130 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
24131 @end defvar
24132
24133 @defvar Breakpoint.silent
24134 This attribute is @code{True} if the breakpoint is silent, and
24135 @code{False} otherwise. This attribute is writable.
24136
24137 Note that a breakpoint can also be silent if it has commands and the
24138 first command is @code{silent}. This is not reported by the
24139 @code{silent} attribute.
24140 @end defvar
24141
24142 @defvar Breakpoint.thread
24143 If the breakpoint is thread-specific, this attribute holds the thread
24144 id. If the breakpoint is not thread-specific, this attribute is
24145 @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
24146 @end defvar
24147
24148 @defvar Breakpoint.task
24149 If the breakpoint is Ada task-specific, this attribute holds the Ada task
24150 id. If the breakpoint is not task-specific (or the underlying
24151 language is not Ada), this attribute is @code{None}. This attribute
24152 is writable.
24153 @end defvar
24154
24155 @defvar Breakpoint.ignore_count
24156 This attribute holds the ignore count for the breakpoint, an integer.
24157 This attribute is writable.
24158 @end defvar
24159
24160 @defvar Breakpoint.number
24161 This attribute holds the breakpoint's number --- the identifier used by
24162 the user to manipulate the breakpoint. This attribute is not writable.
24163 @end defvar
24164
24165 @defvar Breakpoint.type
24166 This attribute holds the breakpoint's type --- the identifier used to
24167 determine the actual breakpoint type or use-case. This attribute is not
24168 writable.
24169 @end defvar
24170
24171 @defvar Breakpoint.visible
24172 This attribute tells whether the breakpoint is visible to the user
24173 when set, or when the @samp{info breakpoints} command is run. This
24174 attribute is not writable.
24175 @end defvar
24176
24177 The available types are represented by constants defined in the @code{gdb}
24178 module:
24179
24180 @table @code
24181 @findex BP_BREAKPOINT
24182 @findex gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT
24183 @item gdb.BP_BREAKPOINT
24184 Normal code breakpoint.
24185
24186 @findex BP_WATCHPOINT
24187 @findex gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT
24188 @item gdb.BP_WATCHPOINT
24189 Watchpoint breakpoint.
24190
24191 @findex BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
24192 @findex gdb.BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
24193 @item gdb.BP_HARDWARE_WATCHPOINT
24194 Hardware assisted watchpoint.
24195
24196 @findex BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
24197 @findex gdb.BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
24198 @item gdb.BP_READ_WATCHPOINT
24199 Hardware assisted read watchpoint.
24200
24201 @findex BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
24202 @findex gdb.BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
24203 @item gdb.BP_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT
24204 Hardware assisted access watchpoint.
24205 @end table
24206
24207 @defvar Breakpoint.hit_count
24208 This attribute holds the hit count for the breakpoint, an integer.
24209 This attribute is writable, but currently it can only be set to zero.
24210 @end defvar
24211
24212 @defvar Breakpoint.location
24213 This attribute holds the location of the breakpoint, as specified by
24214 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have a location
24215 (that is, it is a watchpoint) the attribute's value is @code{None}. This
24216 attribute is not writable.
24217 @end defvar
24218
24219 @defvar Breakpoint.expression
24220 This attribute holds a breakpoint expression, as specified by
24221 the user. It is a string. If the breakpoint does not have an
24222 expression (the breakpoint is not a watchpoint) the attribute's value
24223 is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
24224 @end defvar
24225
24226 @defvar Breakpoint.condition
24227 This attribute holds the condition of the breakpoint, as specified by
24228 the user. It is a string. If there is no condition, this attribute's
24229 value is @code{None}. This attribute is writable.
24230 @end defvar
24231
24232 @defvar Breakpoint.commands
24233 This attribute holds the commands attached to the breakpoint. If
24234 there are commands, this attribute's value is a string holding all the
24235 commands, separated by newlines. If there are no commands, this
24236 attribute is @code{None}. This attribute is not writable.
24237 @end defvar
24238
24239 @node Lazy Strings In Python
24240 @subsubsection Python representation of lazy strings.
24241
24242 @cindex lazy strings in python
24243 @tindex gdb.LazyString
24244
24245 A @dfn{lazy string} is a string whose contents is not retrieved or
24246 encoded until it is needed.
24247
24248 A @code{gdb.LazyString} is represented in @value{GDBN} as an
24249 @code{address} that points to a region of memory, an @code{encoding}
24250 that will be used to encode that region of memory, and a @code{length}
24251 to delimit the region of memory that represents the string. The
24252 difference between a @code{gdb.LazyString} and a string wrapped within
24253 a @code{gdb.Value} is that a @code{gdb.LazyString} will be treated
24254 differently by @value{GDBN} when printing. A @code{gdb.LazyString} is
24255 retrieved and encoded during printing, while a @code{gdb.Value}
24256 wrapping a string is immediately retrieved and encoded on creation.
24257
24258 A @code{gdb.LazyString} object has the following functions:
24259
24260 @defun LazyString.value ()
24261 Convert the @code{gdb.LazyString} to a @code{gdb.Value}. This value
24262 will point to the string in memory, but will lose all the delayed
24263 retrieval, encoding and handling that @value{GDBN} applies to a
24264 @code{gdb.LazyString}.
24265 @end defun
24266
24267 @defvar LazyString.address
24268 This attribute holds the address of the string. This attribute is not
24269 writable.
24270 @end defvar
24271
24272 @defvar LazyString.length
24273 This attribute holds the length of the string in characters. If the
24274 length is -1, then the string will be fetched and encoded up to the
24275 first null of appropriate width. This attribute is not writable.
24276 @end defvar
24277
24278 @defvar LazyString.encoding
24279 This attribute holds the encoding that will be applied to the string
24280 when the string is printed by @value{GDBN}. If the encoding is not
24281 set, or contains an empty string, then @value{GDBN} will select the
24282 most appropriate encoding when the string is printed. This attribute
24283 is not writable.
24284 @end defvar
24285
24286 @defvar LazyString.type
24287 This attribute holds the type that is represented by the lazy string's
24288 type. For a lazy string this will always be a pointer type. To
24289 resolve this to the lazy string's character type, use the type's
24290 @code{target} method. @xref{Types In Python}. This attribute is not
24291 writable.
24292 @end defvar
24293
24294 @node Auto-loading
24295 @subsection Auto-loading
24296 @cindex auto-loading, Python
24297
24298 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24299 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24300 @value{GDBN} will look for Python support scripts in several ways:
24301 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} and @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24302
24303 @menu
24304 * objfile-gdb.py file:: The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
24305 * .debug_gdb_scripts section:: The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24306 * Which flavor to choose?::
24307 @end menu
24308
24309 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24310 debugging commands and scripts.
24311
24312 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24313 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24314
24315 @table @code
24316 @kindex set auto-load-scripts
24317 @item set auto-load-scripts [yes|no]
24318 Enable or disable the auto-loading of Python scripts.
24319
24320 @kindex show auto-load-scripts
24321 @item show auto-load-scripts
24322 Show whether auto-loading of Python scripts is enabled or disabled.
24323
24324 @kindex info auto-load-scripts
24325 @cindex print list of auto-loaded scripts
24326 @item info auto-load-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24327 Print the list of all scripts that @value{GDBN} auto-loaded.
24328
24329 Also printed is the list of scripts that were mentioned in
24330 the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section and were not found
24331 (@pxref{.debug_gdb_scripts section}).
24332 This is useful because their names are not printed when @value{GDBN}
24333 tries to load them and fails. There may be many of them, and printing
24334 an error message for each one is problematic.
24335
24336 If @var{regexp} is supplied only scripts with matching names are printed.
24337
24338 Example:
24339
24340 @smallexample
24341 (gdb) info auto-load-scripts
24342 Loaded Script
24343 Yes py-section-script.py
24344 full name: /tmp/py-section-script.py
24345 Missing my-foo-pretty-printers.py
24346 @end smallexample
24347 @end table
24348
24349 When reading an auto-loaded file, @value{GDBN} sets the
24350 @dfn{current objfile}. This is available via the @code{gdb.current_objfile}
24351 function (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). This can be useful for
24352 registering objfile-specific pretty-printers.
24353
24354 @node objfile-gdb.py file
24355 @subsubsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} file
24356 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24357
24358 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for
24359 a file named @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py},
24360 where @var{objfile} is the object file's real name, formed by ensuring
24361 that the file name is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving
24362 @code{.} and @code{..} components. If this file exists and is
24363 readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a Python script.
24364
24365 If this file does not exist, and if the parameter
24366 @code{debug-file-directory} is set (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}),
24367 then @value{GDBN} will look for @var{real-name} in all of the
24368 directories mentioned in the value of @code{debug-file-directory}.
24369
24370 Finally, if this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24371 a file named @file{@var{data-directory}/python/auto-load/@var{real-name}}, where
24372 @var{data-directory} is @value{GDBN}'s data directory (available via
24373 @code{show data-directory}, @pxref{Data Files}), and @var{real-name}
24374 is the object file's real name, as described above.
24375
24376 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24377 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24378 @var{objfile} is opened.
24379 So your @file{-gdb.py} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24380 is evaluated more than once.
24381
24382 @node .debug_gdb_scripts section
24383 @subsubsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24384 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24385
24386 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24387 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24388 it will look for a special section named @samp{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24389 If this section exists, its contents is a list of names of scripts to load.
24390
24391 @value{GDBN} will look for each specified script file first in the
24392 current directory and then along the source search path
24393 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24394 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24395 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24396
24397 Entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24398 for example, this GCC macro:
24399
24400 @example
24401 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24402 #define DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24403 asm("\
24404 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24405 .byte 1\n\
24406 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24407 .popsection \n\
24408 ");
24409 @end example
24410
24411 @noindent
24412 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24413
24414 @example
24415 DEFINE_GDB_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24416 @end example
24417
24418 The script name may include directories if desired.
24419
24420 If the macro is put in a header, any application or library
24421 using this header will get a reference to the specified script.
24422
24423 @node Which flavor to choose?
24424 @subsubsection Which flavor to choose?
24425
24426 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading Python scripts, it might not always
24427 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24428
24429 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.py} way:
24430
24431 @itemize @bullet
24432 @item
24433 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24434
24435 @item
24436 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24437
24438 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24439 in the source search path.
24440 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24441 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24442
24443 @item
24444 Doesn't require source code additions.
24445 @end itemize
24446
24447 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24448
24449 @itemize @bullet
24450 @item
24451 Works with static linking.
24452
24453 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.py} way require an objfile to
24454 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24455 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24456 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's @file{-gdb.py} script.
24457
24458 @item
24459 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24460
24461 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24462 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.py} script to.
24463
24464 @item
24465 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24466
24467 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24468 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24469 @file{-gdb.py} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24470 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24471 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24472 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24473 @end itemize
24474
24475 @node Python modules
24476 @subsection Python modules
24477 @cindex python modules
24478
24479 @value{GDBN} comes with several modules to assist writing Python code.
24480
24481 @menu
24482 * gdb.printing:: Building and registering pretty-printers.
24483 * gdb.types:: Utilities for working with types.
24484 * gdb.prompt:: Utilities for prompt value substitution.
24485 @end menu
24486
24487 @node gdb.printing
24488 @subsubsection gdb.printing
24489 @cindex gdb.printing
24490
24491 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
24492 pretty-printers.
24493
24494 @table @code
24495 @item PrettyPrinter (@var{name}, @var{subprinters}=None)
24496 This class specifies the API that makes @samp{info pretty-printer},
24497 @samp{enable pretty-printer} and @samp{disable pretty-printer} work.
24498 Pretty-printers should generally inherit from this class.
24499
24500 @item SubPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
24501 For printers that handle multiple types, this class specifies the
24502 corresponding API for the subprinters.
24503
24504 @item RegexpCollectionPrettyPrinter (@var{name})
24505 Utility class for handling multiple printers, all recognized via
24506 regular expressions.
24507 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for an example.
24508
24509 @item register_pretty_printer (@var{obj}, @var{printer}, @var{replace}=False)
24510 Register @var{printer} with the pretty-printer list of @var{obj}.
24511 If @var{replace} is @code{True} then any existing copy of the printer
24512 is replaced. Otherwise a @code{RuntimeError} exception is raised
24513 if a printer with the same name already exists.
24514 @end table
24515
24516 @node gdb.types
24517 @subsubsection gdb.types
24518 @cindex gdb.types
24519
24520 This module provides a collection of utilities for working with
24521 @code{gdb.Types} objects.
24522
24523 @table @code
24524 @item get_basic_type (@var{type})
24525 Return @var{type} with const and volatile qualifiers stripped,
24526 and with typedefs and C@t{++} references converted to the underlying type.
24527
24528 C@t{++} example:
24529
24530 @smallexample
24531 typedef const int const_int;
24532 const_int foo (3);
24533 const_int& foo_ref (foo);
24534 int main () @{ return 0; @}
24535 @end smallexample
24536
24537 Then in gdb:
24538
24539 @smallexample
24540 (gdb) start
24541 (gdb) python import gdb.types
24542 (gdb) python foo_ref = gdb.parse_and_eval("foo_ref")
24543 (gdb) python print gdb.types.get_basic_type(foo_ref.type)
24544 int
24545 @end smallexample
24546
24547 @item has_field (@var{type}, @var{field})
24548 Return @code{True} if @var{type}, assumed to be a type with fields
24549 (e.g., a structure or union), has field @var{field}.
24550
24551 @item make_enum_dict (@var{enum_type})
24552 Return a Python @code{dictionary} type produced from @var{enum_type}.
24553
24554 @item deep_items (@var{type})
24555 Returns a Python iterator similar to the standard
24556 @code{gdb.Type.iteritems} method, except that the iterator returned
24557 by @code{deep_items} will recursively traverse anonymous struct or
24558 union fields. For example:
24559
24560 @smallexample
24561 struct A
24562 @{
24563 int a;
24564 union @{
24565 int b0;
24566 int b1;
24567 @};
24568 @};
24569 @end smallexample
24570
24571 @noindent
24572 Then in @value{GDBN}:
24573 @smallexample
24574 (@value{GDBP}) python import gdb.types
24575 (@value{GDBP}) python struct_a = gdb.lookup_type("struct A")
24576 (@value{GDBP}) python print struct_a.keys ()
24577 @{['a', '']@}
24578 (@value{GDBP}) python print [k for k,v in gdb.types.deep_items(struct_a)]
24579 @{['a', 'b0', 'b1']@}
24580 @end smallexample
24581
24582 @end table
24583
24584 @node gdb.prompt
24585 @subsubsection gdb.prompt
24586 @cindex gdb.prompt
24587
24588 This module provides a method for prompt value-substitution.
24589
24590 @table @code
24591 @item substitute_prompt (@var{string})
24592 Return @var{string} with escape sequences substituted by values. Some
24593 escape sequences take arguments. You can specify arguments inside
24594 ``@{@}'' immediately following the escape sequence.
24595
24596 The escape sequences you can pass to this function are:
24597
24598 @table @code
24599 @item \\
24600 Substitute a backslash.
24601 @item \e
24602 Substitute an ESC character.
24603 @item \f
24604 Substitute the selected frame; an argument names a frame parameter.
24605 @item \n
24606 Substitute a newline.
24607 @item \p
24608 Substitute a parameter's value; the argument names the parameter.
24609 @item \r
24610 Substitute a carriage return.
24611 @item \t
24612 Substitute the selected thread; an argument names a thread parameter.
24613 @item \v
24614 Substitute the version of GDB.
24615 @item \w
24616 Substitute the current working directory.
24617 @item \[
24618 Begin a sequence of non-printing characters. These sequences are
24619 typically used with the ESC character, and are not counted in the string
24620 length. Example: ``\[\e[0;34m\](gdb)\[\e[0m\]'' will return a
24621 blue-colored ``(gdb)'' prompt where the length is five.
24622 @item \]
24623 End a sequence of non-printing characters.
24624 @end table
24625
24626 For example:
24627
24628 @smallexample
24629 substitute_prompt (``frame: \f,
24630 print arguments: \p@{print frame-arguments@}'')
24631 @end smallexample
24632
24633 @exdent will return the string:
24634
24635 @smallexample
24636 "frame: main, print arguments: scalars"
24637 @end smallexample
24638 @end table
24639
24640 @node Aliases
24641 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24642 @cindex aliases for commands
24643
24644 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24645 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24646 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24647 that involves less typing.
24648
24649 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24650 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24651 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24652
24653 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24654 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24655 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24656
24657 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24658
24659 @table @code
24660
24661 @kindex alias
24662 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24663
24664 @end table
24665
24666 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24667 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24668 underscores.
24669
24670 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24671 that is being aliased.
24672
24673 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24674 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24675 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24676
24677 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24678 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24679
24680 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24681 of a command so that there is less to type.
24682 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24683 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24684 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24685 The following will accomplish this.
24686
24687 @smallexample
24688 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24689 @end smallexample
24690
24691 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24692 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24693 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24694 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24695
24696 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24697 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24698 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24699 of a command.
24700
24701 @smallexample
24702 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24703 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24704 (gdb) set p elms 20
24705 (gdb) show p elms
24706 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24707 @end smallexample
24708
24709 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24710 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24711 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24712
24713 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24714 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24715
24716 @smallexample
24717 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24718 @end smallexample
24719
24720 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24721 alias for a more complex command.
24722 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24723
24724 @smallexample
24725 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24726 (gdb) spe 20
24727 @end smallexample
24728
24729 @node Interpreters
24730 @chapter Command Interpreters
24731 @cindex command interpreters
24732
24733 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24734 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24735 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24736
24737 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24738 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24739 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24740 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24741
24742 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24743 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24744 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24745 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24746
24747 @table @code
24748 @item console
24749 @cindex console interpreter
24750 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24751 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24752 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24753
24754 @item mi
24755 @cindex mi interpreter
24756 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24757 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24758 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24759 Interface}.
24760
24761 @item mi2
24762 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24763 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24764
24765 @item mi1
24766 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24767 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24768
24769 @end table
24770
24771 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24772 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
24773 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
24774 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
24775 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
24776 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24777 the IDE inoperable!
24778
24779 @kindex interpreter-exec
24780 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24781 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24782 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24783 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24784
24785 @smallexample
24786 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24787 @end smallexample
24788
24789 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24790 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24791
24792 @node TUI
24793 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24794 @cindex TUI
24795 @cindex Text User Interface
24796
24797 @menu
24798 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24799 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24800 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24801 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24802 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24803 @end menu
24804
24805 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24806 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24807 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24808 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24809 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24810 is available.
24811
24812 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
24813 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24814 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24815 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24816 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
24817 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24818
24819 @node TUI Overview
24820 @section TUI Overview
24821
24822 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24823
24824 @table @emph
24825 @item command
24826 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24827 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24828 managed using readline.
24829
24830 @item source
24831 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24832 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24833
24834 @item assembly
24835 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24836
24837 @item register
24838 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24839 when their values change.
24840 @end table
24841
24842 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24843 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24844 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24845 indicates the breakpoint type:
24846
24847 @table @code
24848 @item B
24849 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24850
24851 @item b
24852 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24853
24854 @item H
24855 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24856
24857 @item h
24858 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24859 @end table
24860
24861 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24862
24863 @table @code
24864 @item +
24865 Breakpoint is enabled.
24866
24867 @item -
24868 Breakpoint is disabled.
24869 @end table
24870
24871 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24872 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24873 changes.
24874
24875 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24876 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24877 layouts:
24878
24879 @itemize @bullet
24880 @item
24881 source only,
24882
24883 @item
24884 assembly only,
24885
24886 @item
24887 source and assembly,
24888
24889 @item
24890 source and registers, or
24891
24892 @item
24893 assembly and registers.
24894 @end itemize
24895
24896 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24897
24898 @table @emph
24899 @item target
24900 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24901 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24902
24903 @item process
24904 Gives the current process or thread number.
24905 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24906
24907 @item function
24908 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24909 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24910 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24911 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24912
24913 @item line
24914 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24915 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24916
24917 @item pc
24918 Indicates the current program counter address.
24919 @end table
24920
24921 @node TUI Keys
24922 @section TUI Key Bindings
24923 @cindex TUI key bindings
24924
24925 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24926 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24927 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24928 @end ifset
24929 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24930 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24931 @end ifclear
24932 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24933 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24934
24935 @table @kbd
24936 @kindex C-x C-a
24937 @item C-x C-a
24938 @kindex C-x a
24939 @itemx C-x a
24940 @kindex C-x A
24941 @itemx C-x A
24942 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24943 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24944 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24945 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24946 The screen is then refreshed.
24947
24948 @kindex C-x 1
24949 @item C-x 1
24950 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24951 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24952 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24953
24954 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24955
24956 @kindex C-x 2
24957 @item C-x 2
24958 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24959 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24960 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24961 previous layout and the new one.
24962
24963 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24964
24965 @kindex C-x o
24966 @item C-x o
24967 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24968 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24969 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24970
24971 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24972
24973 @kindex C-x s
24974 @item C-x s
24975 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24976 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24977 @end table
24978
24979 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24980
24981 @table @asis
24982 @kindex PgUp
24983 @item @key{PgUp}
24984 Scroll the active window one page up.
24985
24986 @kindex PgDn
24987 @item @key{PgDn}
24988 Scroll the active window one page down.
24989
24990 @kindex Up
24991 @item @key{Up}
24992 Scroll the active window one line up.
24993
24994 @kindex Down
24995 @item @key{Down}
24996 Scroll the active window one line down.
24997
24998 @kindex Left
24999 @item @key{Left}
25000 Scroll the active window one column left.
25001
25002 @kindex Right
25003 @item @key{Right}
25004 Scroll the active window one column right.
25005
25006 @kindex C-L
25007 @item @kbd{C-L}
25008 Refresh the screen.
25009 @end table
25010
25011 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
25012 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
25013 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
25014 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
25015 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
25016
25017 @node TUI Single Key Mode
25018 @section TUI Single Key Mode
25019 @cindex TUI single key mode
25020
25021 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
25022 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
25023 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
25024
25025 @table @kbd
25026 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25027 @item c
25028 continue
25029
25030 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25031 @item d
25032 down
25033
25034 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25035 @item f
25036 finish
25037
25038 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25039 @item n
25040 next
25041
25042 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25043 @item q
25044 exit the SingleKey mode.
25045
25046 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25047 @item r
25048 run
25049
25050 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25051 @item s
25052 step
25053
25054 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25055 @item u
25056 up
25057
25058 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25059 @item v
25060 info locals
25061
25062 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
25063 @item w
25064 where
25065 @end table
25066
25067 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
25068 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
25069 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
25070 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
25071 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
25072 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
25073
25074
25075 @node TUI Commands
25076 @section TUI-specific Commands
25077 @cindex TUI commands
25078
25079 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
25080 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
25081 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
25082 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
25083
25084 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
25085 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
25086 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
25087 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
25088 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
25089
25090 @table @code
25091 @item info win
25092 @kindex info win
25093 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25094
25095 @item layout next
25096 @kindex layout
25097 Display the next layout.
25098
25099 @item layout prev
25100 Display the previous layout.
25101
25102 @item layout src
25103 Display the source window only.
25104
25105 @item layout asm
25106 Display the assembly window only.
25107
25108 @item layout split
25109 Display the source and assembly window.
25110
25111 @item layout regs
25112 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
25113
25114 @item focus next
25115 @kindex focus
25116 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25117
25118 @item focus prev
25119 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25120
25121 @item focus src
25122 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25123
25124 @item focus asm
25125 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25126
25127 @item focus regs
25128 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25129
25130 @item focus cmd
25131 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25132
25133 @item refresh
25134 @kindex refresh
25135 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25136
25137 @item tui reg float
25138 @kindex tui reg
25139 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
25140
25141 @item tui reg general
25142 Show the general registers in the register window.
25143
25144 @item tui reg next
25145 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
25146 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
25147 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
25148 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
25149
25150 @item tui reg system
25151 Show the system registers in the register window.
25152
25153 @item update
25154 @kindex update
25155 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25156
25157 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25158 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25159 @kindex winheight
25160 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25161 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25162 decrease it.
25163
25164 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25165 @kindex tabset
25166 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
25167 @end table
25168
25169 @node TUI Configuration
25170 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25171 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25172
25173 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25174
25175 @table @code
25176 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25177 @kindex set tui border-kind
25178 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25179 The possible values are the following:
25180 @table @code
25181 @item space
25182 Use a space character to draw the border.
25183
25184 @item ascii
25185 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25186
25187 @item acs
25188 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25189 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25190 @end table
25191
25192 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25193 @kindex set tui border-mode
25194 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25195 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25196 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25197 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25198 @table @code
25199 @item normal
25200 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25201
25202 @item standout
25203 Use standout mode.
25204
25205 @item reverse
25206 Use reverse video mode.
25207
25208 @item half
25209 Use half bright mode.
25210
25211 @item half-standout
25212 Use half bright and standout mode.
25213
25214 @item bold
25215 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25216
25217 @item bold-standout
25218 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25219 @end table
25220 @end table
25221
25222 @node Emacs
25223 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25224
25225 @cindex Emacs
25226 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25227 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25228 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25229 @value{GDBN}.
25230
25231 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25232 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25233 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25234 created Emacs buffer.
25235 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25236
25237 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25238 things:
25239
25240 @itemize @bullet
25241 @item
25242 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25243 the GUD buffer.
25244
25245 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25246 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25247
25248 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25249 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25250 in this way.
25251
25252 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25253 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25254 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25255 stop.
25256
25257 @item
25258 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25259
25260 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25261 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25262 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25263 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25264 and the source.
25265
25266 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25267 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25268 @end itemize
25269
25270 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25271 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25272 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25273 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25274
25275 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25276 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25277 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25278 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25279 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25280 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25281 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25282 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25283 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25284
25285 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25286 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25287 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25288 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25289
25290 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25291 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25292 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25293 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25294 one you want.
25295
25296 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25297 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25298
25299 @table @kbd
25300 @item C-h m
25301 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25302
25303 @item C-c C-s
25304 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25305 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25306
25307 @item C-c C-n
25308 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25309 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25310 to show the current file and location.
25311
25312 @item C-c C-i
25313 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25314 display window accordingly.
25315
25316 @item C-c C-f
25317 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25318 @code{finish} command.
25319
25320 @item C-c C-r
25321 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25322 command.
25323
25324 @item C-c <
25325 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25326 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25327 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25328
25329 @item C-c >
25330 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25331 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25332 @end table
25333
25334 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25335 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25336
25337 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25338 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25339 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25340 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25341 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25342 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25343 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25344
25345 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25346 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25347 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25348 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25349 frame.
25350
25351 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25352 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25353 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25354 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25355 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25356 to correspond properly with the code.
25357
25358 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25359 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25360 Emacs Manual}).
25361
25362 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
25363 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
25364 @ignore
25365 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
25366 @kindex Epoch
25367 @kindex inspect
25368
25369 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
25370 called the @code{epoch}
25371 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
25372 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
25373 each value is printed in its own window.
25374 @end ignore
25375
25376
25377 @node GDB/MI
25378 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25379
25380 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25381
25382 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25383 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25384 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25385 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25386 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25387 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25388
25389 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25390 in the form of a reference manual.
25391
25392 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25393 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25394 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25395
25396 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25397
25398 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25399 This chapter uses the following notation:
25400
25401 @itemize @bullet
25402 @item
25403 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25404
25405 @item
25406 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25407 it may or may not be given.
25408
25409 @item
25410 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25411 may repeat zero or more times.
25412
25413 @item
25414 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25415 may repeat one or more times.
25416
25417 @item
25418 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25419 @end itemize
25420
25421 @ignore
25422 @heading Dependencies
25423 @end ignore
25424
25425 @menu
25426 * GDB/MI General Design::
25427 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25428 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25429 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25430 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25431 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25432 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25433 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25434 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25435 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25436 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25437 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25438 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25439 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25440 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25441 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25442 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25443 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25444 @ignore
25445 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25446 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25447 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25448 @end ignore
25449 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25450 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25451 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25452 @end menu
25453
25454 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25455 @node GDB/MI General Design
25456 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25457 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25458
25459 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25460 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25461 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25462 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25463 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25464 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25465 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25466 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25467 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25468 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25469
25470 The important examples of notifications are:
25471 @itemize @bullet
25472
25473 @item
25474 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25475 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25476 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25477 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25478 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25479 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25480 command itself was successfully executed.
25481
25482 @item
25483 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25484 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25485 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25486 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25487 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25488 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25489
25490 @item
25491 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25492 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25493 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25494 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25495 orthogonal frontend design.
25496
25497 @end itemize
25498
25499 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25500 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25501 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25502 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25503 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25504 the user interface.
25505
25506
25507 @menu
25508 * Context management::
25509 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25510 * Thread groups::
25511 @end menu
25512
25513 @node Context management
25514 @subsection Context management
25515
25516 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25517 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25518 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25519 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25520 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25521 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25522 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25523 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25524 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25525
25526 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25527 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25528 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25529 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25530 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25531 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25532 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25533 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25534 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25535 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
25536 for thread and frame to operate on.
25537
25538 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25539 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25540 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25541 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
25542 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
25543 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
25544 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
25545 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
25546 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25547 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
25548
25549 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25550 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25551 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25552 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25553 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25554 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25555 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25556 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25557 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25558 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25559 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25560 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25561 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25562 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25563 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25564 @samp{--frame} options.
25565
25566 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25567 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25568
25569 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25570 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25571 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25572 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25573 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25574 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25575 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25576 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25577 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25578
25579 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25580 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25581 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25582 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25583 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25584 are running.
25585
25586 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25587 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25588 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25589 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25590 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25591 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25592 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25593 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25594 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25595 @samp{--thread} option).
25596
25597 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25598 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25599 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25600 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25601
25602 @node Thread groups
25603 @subsection Thread groups
25604 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25605 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25606 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25607 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25608 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25609
25610 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25611 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25612 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25613 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25614 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25615 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25616 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25617 into processes.
25618
25619 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25620 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25621 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25622 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25623 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25624 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25625 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25626 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25627 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25628 the members of specific thread group.
25629
25630 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25631 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25632 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25633 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25634 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25635 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25636 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25637 after attaching to that thread group.
25638
25639 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25640 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25641 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25642 such thread groups.
25643
25644 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25645 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25646 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25647
25648 @menu
25649 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25650 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25651 @end menu
25652
25653 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25654 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25655
25656 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25657 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25658 @table @code
25659 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25660 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25661
25662 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25663 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25664 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25665
25666 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25667 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25668 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25669
25670 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25671 "any sequence of digits"
25672
25673 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25674 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25675
25676 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25677 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25678
25679 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25680 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25681
25682 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25683 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25684 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25685
25686 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25687 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25688
25689 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25690 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25691 @end table
25692
25693 @noindent
25694 Notes:
25695
25696 @itemize @bullet
25697 @item
25698 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
25699 output is described below.
25700
25701 @item
25702 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
25703 finishes.
25704
25705 @item
25706 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
25707 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
25708 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
25709 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
25710 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
25711 @end itemize
25712
25713 Pragmatics:
25714
25715 @itemize @bullet
25716 @item
25717 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
25718
25719 @item
25720 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
25721 @end itemize
25722
25723 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
25724 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
25725
25726 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
25727 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
25728 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
25729 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
25730 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
25731 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
25732
25733 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
25734 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
25735 @var{token}.
25736
25737 @table @code
25738 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
25739 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
25740
25741 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
25742 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25743
25744 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
25745 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
25746
25747 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
25748 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
25749
25750 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25751 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
25752
25753 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25754 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
25755
25756 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25757 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
25758
25759 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25760 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25761
25762 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25763 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25764
25765 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25766 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25767 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25768
25769 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25770 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25771
25772 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25773 @code{ @var{string} }
25774
25775 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
25776 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
25777
25778 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
25779 @code{@var{c-string}}
25780
25781 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
25782 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
25783
25784 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
25785 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
25786 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
25787
25788 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
25789 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
25790
25791 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
25792 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
25793
25794 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
25795 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
25796
25797 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
25798 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
25799
25800 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25801 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25802
25803 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25804 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
25805 @end table
25806
25807 @noindent
25808 Notes:
25809
25810 @itemize @bullet
25811 @item
25812 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
25813
25814 @item
25815 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
25816 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
25817 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
25818 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
25819 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
25820 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
25821 prior command.
25822
25823 @item
25824 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25825 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
25826 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
25827 prefixed by @samp{+}.
25828
25829 @item
25830 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25831 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
25832 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
25833 @samp{*}.
25834
25835 @item
25836 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25837 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25838 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25839 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25840
25841 @item
25842 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25843 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25844 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25845 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25846
25847 @item
25848 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25849 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25850 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25851
25852 @item
25853 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25854 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25855 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25856 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25857
25858 @item
25859 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25860 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25861 @var{values}.
25862
25863
25864 @end itemize
25865
25866 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25867 details about the various output records.
25868
25869 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25870 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25871 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25872
25873 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25874 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25875
25876 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25877 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25878 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25879 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25880 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25881 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25882
25883 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25884 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25885 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25886
25887 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25888 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25889 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25890 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25891
25892 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25893 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25894
25895 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25896 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25897 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25898 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25899 might change.
25900
25901 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25902 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25903 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25904 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25905
25906 @itemize @bullet
25907 @item
25908 New MI commands may be added.
25909
25910 @item
25911 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25912
25913 @item
25914 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
25915 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
25916
25917 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
25918 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
25919
25920 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
25921 @c resolve inconsistencies.
25922 @end itemize
25923
25924 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
25925 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
25926 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
25927 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
25928 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
25929
25930 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
25931 @c version?
25932
25933 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
25934 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
25935 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
25936 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
25937 @cindex mailing lists
25938
25939 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25940 @node GDB/MI Output Records
25941 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
25942
25943 @menu
25944 * GDB/MI Result Records::
25945 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
25946 * GDB/MI Async Records::
25947 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
25948 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
25949 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
25950 @end menu
25951
25952 @node GDB/MI Result Records
25953 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
25954
25955 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25956 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
25957 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
25958 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
25959
25960 @table @code
25961 @findex ^done
25962 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
25963 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
25964 values.
25965
25966 @item "^running"
25967 @findex ^running
25968 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
25969 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
25970 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
25971 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
25972 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
25973 which threads are resumed.
25974
25975 @item "^connected"
25976 @findex ^connected
25977 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
25978
25979 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
25980 @findex ^error
25981 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
25982 error message.
25983
25984 @item "^exit"
25985 @findex ^exit
25986 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
25987
25988 @end table
25989
25990 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
25991 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
25992
25993 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
25994 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25995 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
25996 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
25997 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
25998
25999 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
26000 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
26001 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
26002 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
26003 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
26004
26005 @table @code
26006 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26007 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26008 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26009
26010 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26011 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26012 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26013 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26014
26015 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26016 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26017 internals.
26018 @end table
26019
26020 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26021 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26022
26023 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26024 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26025 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26026 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26027 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26028 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26029
26030 The following is the list of possible async records:
26031
26032 @table @code
26033
26034 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26035 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
26036 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
26037 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
26038 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
26039 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
26040 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
26041 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
26042 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
26043 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
26044
26045 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26046 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26047 following values:
26048
26049 @table @code
26050 @item breakpoint-hit
26051 A breakpoint was reached.
26052 @item watchpoint-trigger
26053 A watchpoint was triggered.
26054 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26055 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26056 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26057 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26058 @item function-finished
26059 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26060 @item location-reached
26061 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26062 @item watchpoint-scope
26063 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26064 @item end-stepping-range
26065 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26066 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26067 @item exited-signalled
26068 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26069 @item exited
26070 The inferior exited.
26071 @item exited-normally
26072 The inferior exited normally.
26073 @item signal-received
26074 A signal was received by the inferior.
26075 @end table
26076
26077 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
26078 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
26079 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26080 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26081 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26082 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26083 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26084 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26085 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26086 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26087 if such information is not available.
26088
26089 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26090 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26091 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26092 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26093 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26094 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26095 cannot be used in any way.
26096
26097 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26098 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26099 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26100 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26101 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26102 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26103
26104 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26105 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26106 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26107 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26108 thread group. @var{code} is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26109 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26110
26111 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26112 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26113 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26114 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26115 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26116
26117 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
26118 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
26119 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
26120 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
26121 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
26122 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
26123 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
26124
26125 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26126 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26127 that thread.
26128
26129 @item =library-loaded,...
26130 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26131 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26132 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26133 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26134 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26135 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26136 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26137 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26138 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26139 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26140 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26141 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26142 thread groups.
26143
26144 @item =library-unloaded,...
26145 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26146 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26147 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26148 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26149 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26150 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26151 thread groups.
26152
26153 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26154 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26155 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,bkpt=@{...@}
26156 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26157 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26158 user.
26159
26160 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26161 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}.
26162
26163 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26164 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26165
26166 @end table
26167
26168 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26169 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26170
26171 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26172 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26173 fields:
26174
26175 @table @code
26176 @item level
26177 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26178 zero. This field is always present.
26179
26180 @item func
26181 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26182 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26183
26184 @item addr
26185 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26186
26187 @item file
26188 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26189 address. This field may be absent.
26190
26191 @item line
26192 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26193 may be absent.
26194
26195 @item from
26196 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26197 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26198
26199 @end table
26200
26201 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26202 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26203
26204 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26205 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26206
26207 @table @code
26208 @item id
26209 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26210 always present.
26211
26212 @item target-id
26213 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26214
26215 @item details
26216 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26217 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26218 frontend. This field is optional.
26219
26220 @item state
26221 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26222 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26223
26224 @item core
26225 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26226 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26227 @end table
26228
26229 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26230 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26231
26232 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26233 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26234 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26235 the @code{exception-name} field.
26236
26237 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26238 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26239 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26240 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26241
26242 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26243 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26244 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26245 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26246
26247 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26248 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26249
26250 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26251
26252 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26253 information of the breakpoint.
26254
26255 @smallexample
26256 -> -break-insert main
26257 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26258 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26259 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
26260 <- (gdb)
26261 @end smallexample
26262
26263 @subheading Program Execution
26264
26265 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26266 reason that execution stopped.
26267
26268 @smallexample
26269 -> -exec-run
26270 <- ^running
26271 <- (gdb)
26272 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26273 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26274 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26275 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26276 <- (gdb)
26277 -> -exec-continue
26278 <- ^running
26279 <- (gdb)
26280 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26281 <- (gdb)
26282 @end smallexample
26283
26284 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26285
26286 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26287
26288 @smallexample
26289 -> (gdb)
26290 <- -gdb-exit
26291 <- ^exit
26292 @end smallexample
26293
26294 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26295 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26296 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26297 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26298 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26299 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26300
26301 @subheading A Bad Command
26302
26303 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26304
26305 @smallexample
26306 -> -rubbish
26307 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26308 <- (gdb)
26309 @end smallexample
26310
26311
26312 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26313 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26314 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26315
26316 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26317 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26318
26319 @subheading Motivation
26320
26321 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26322
26323 @subheading Introduction
26324
26325 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26326
26327 @subheading Commands
26328
26329 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26330
26331 @subsubheading Synopsis
26332
26333 @smallexample
26334 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26335 @end smallexample
26336
26337 @subsubheading Result
26338
26339 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26340
26341 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26342
26343 @subsubheading Example
26344
26345 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26346 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26347
26348
26349 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26350 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26351 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26352
26353 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26354 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26355 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26356 breakpoints.
26357
26358 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26359 @findex -break-after
26360
26361 @subsubheading Synopsis
26362
26363 @smallexample
26364 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26365 @end smallexample
26366
26367 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26368 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26369 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26370 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26371
26372 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26373
26374 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26375
26376 @subsubheading Example
26377
26378 @smallexample
26379 (gdb)
26380 -break-insert main
26381 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26382 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26383 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
26384 (gdb)
26385 -break-after 1 3
26386 ~
26387 ^done
26388 (gdb)
26389 -break-list
26390 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26391 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26392 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26393 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26394 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26395 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26396 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26397 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26398 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26399 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26400 (gdb)
26401 @end smallexample
26402
26403 @ignore
26404 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26405 @findex -break-catch
26406 @end ignore
26407
26408 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26409 @findex -break-commands
26410
26411 @subsubheading Synopsis
26412
26413 @smallexample
26414 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26415 @end smallexample
26416
26417 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26418 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26419 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26420 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26421 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26422 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26423
26424 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26425
26426 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26427
26428 @subsubheading Example
26429
26430 @smallexample
26431 (gdb)
26432 -break-insert main
26433 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26434 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26435 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
26436 (gdb)
26437 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26438 ^done
26439 (gdb)
26440 @end smallexample
26441
26442 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26443 @findex -break-condition
26444
26445 @subsubheading Synopsis
26446
26447 @smallexample
26448 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26449 @end smallexample
26450
26451 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26452 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
26453 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26454 command below).
26455
26456 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26457
26458 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26459
26460 @subsubheading Example
26461
26462 @smallexample
26463 (gdb)
26464 -break-condition 1 1
26465 ^done
26466 (gdb)
26467 -break-list
26468 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26469 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26470 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26471 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26472 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26473 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26474 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26475 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26476 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26477 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26478 (gdb)
26479 @end smallexample
26480
26481 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26482 @findex -break-delete
26483
26484 @subsubheading Synopsis
26485
26486 @smallexample
26487 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26488 @end smallexample
26489
26490 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
26491 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
26492
26493 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26494
26495 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
26496
26497 @subsubheading Example
26498
26499 @smallexample
26500 (gdb)
26501 -break-delete 1
26502 ^done
26503 (gdb)
26504 -break-list
26505 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26506 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26507 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26508 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26509 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26510 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26511 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26512 body=[]@}
26513 (gdb)
26514 @end smallexample
26515
26516 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
26517 @findex -break-disable
26518
26519 @subsubheading Synopsis
26520
26521 @smallexample
26522 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26523 @end smallexample
26524
26525 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
26526 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
26527
26528 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26529
26530 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
26531
26532 @subsubheading Example
26533
26534 @smallexample
26535 (gdb)
26536 -break-disable 2
26537 ^done
26538 (gdb)
26539 -break-list
26540 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26541 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26542 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26543 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26544 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26545 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26546 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26547 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26548 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26549 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
26550 (gdb)
26551 @end smallexample
26552
26553 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26554 @findex -break-enable
26555
26556 @subsubheading Synopsis
26557
26558 @smallexample
26559 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26560 @end smallexample
26561
26562 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26563
26564 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26565
26566 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26567
26568 @subsubheading Example
26569
26570 @smallexample
26571 (gdb)
26572 -break-enable 2
26573 ^done
26574 (gdb)
26575 -break-list
26576 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26577 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26578 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26579 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26580 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26581 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26582 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26583 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26584 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26585 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
26586 (gdb)
26587 @end smallexample
26588
26589 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
26590 @findex -break-info
26591
26592 @subsubheading Synopsis
26593
26594 @smallexample
26595 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
26596 @end smallexample
26597
26598 @c REDUNDANT???
26599 Get information about a single breakpoint.
26600
26601 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26602
26603 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
26604
26605 @subsubheading Example
26606 N.A.
26607
26608 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
26609 @findex -break-insert
26610
26611 @subsubheading Synopsis
26612
26613 @smallexample
26614 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
26615 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26616 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
26617 @end smallexample
26618
26619 @noindent
26620 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26621
26622 @itemize @bullet
26623 @item function
26624 @c @item +offset
26625 @c @item -offset
26626 @c @item linenum
26627 @item filename:linenum
26628 @item filename:function
26629 @item *address
26630 @end itemize
26631
26632 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26633
26634 @table @samp
26635 @item -t
26636 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26637 @item -h
26638 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26639 @item -c @var{condition}
26640 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26641 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26642 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26643 @item -f
26644 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26645 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26646 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26647 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26648 cannot be parsed.
26649 @item -d
26650 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26651 @item -a
26652 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26653 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26654 @end table
26655
26656 @subsubheading Result
26657
26658 The result is in the form:
26659
26660 @smallexample
26661 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
26662 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
26663 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
26664 times="@var{times}"@}
26665 @end smallexample
26666
26667 @noindent
26668 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
26669 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
26670 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
26671 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
26672 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
26673 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
26674 which use the same output).
26675
26676 Note: this format is open to change.
26677 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26678
26679 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26680
26681 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26682 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
26683
26684 @subsubheading Example
26685
26686 @smallexample
26687 (gdb)
26688 -break-insert main
26689 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26690 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
26691 (gdb)
26692 -break-insert -t foo
26693 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26694 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
26695 (gdb)
26696 -break-list
26697 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26698 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26699 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26700 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26701 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26702 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26703 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26704 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26705 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26706 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
26707 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26708 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26709 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
26710 (gdb)
26711 -break-insert -r foo.*
26712 ~int foo(int, int);
26713 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26714 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
26715 (gdb)
26716 @end smallexample
26717
26718 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
26719 @findex -break-list
26720
26721 @subsubheading Synopsis
26722
26723 @smallexample
26724 -break-list
26725 @end smallexample
26726
26727 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
26728
26729 @table @samp
26730 @item Number
26731 number of the breakpoint
26732 @item Type
26733 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
26734 @item Disposition
26735 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
26736 or @samp{nokeep}
26737 @item Enabled
26738 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
26739 @item Address
26740 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
26741 @item What
26742 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
26743 name, line number
26744 @item Times
26745 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
26746 @end table
26747
26748 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
26749 @code{body} field is an empty list.
26750
26751 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26752
26753 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
26754
26755 @subsubheading Example
26756
26757 @smallexample
26758 (gdb)
26759 -break-list
26760 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26761 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26762 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26763 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26764 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26765 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26766 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26767 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26768 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
26769 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26770 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26771 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
26772 (gdb)
26773 @end smallexample
26774
26775 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
26776
26777 @smallexample
26778 (gdb)
26779 -break-list
26780 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26781 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26782 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26783 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26784 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26785 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26786 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26787 body=[]@}
26788 (gdb)
26789 @end smallexample
26790
26791 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
26792 @findex -break-passcount
26793
26794 @subsubheading Synopsis
26795
26796 @smallexample
26797 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
26798 @end smallexample
26799
26800 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
26801 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
26802 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
26803 command @samp{passcount}.
26804
26805 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
26806 @findex -break-watch
26807
26808 @subsubheading Synopsis
26809
26810 @smallexample
26811 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
26812 @end smallexample
26813
26814 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
26815 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
26816 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
26817 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
26818 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
26819 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
26820 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
26821 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
26822
26823 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
26824 breakpoints inserted.
26825
26826 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26827
26828 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
26829 @samp{rwatch}.
26830
26831 @subsubheading Example
26832
26833 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
26834
26835 @smallexample
26836 (gdb)
26837 -break-watch x
26838 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
26839 (gdb)
26840 -exec-continue
26841 ^running
26842 (gdb)
26843 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
26844 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
26845 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26846 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
26847 (gdb)
26848 @end smallexample
26849
26850 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
26851 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
26852 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
26853
26854 @smallexample
26855 (gdb)
26856 -break-watch C
26857 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
26858 (gdb)
26859 -exec-continue
26860 ^running
26861 (gdb)
26862 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
26863 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26864 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26865 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26866 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26867 (gdb)
26868 -exec-continue
26869 ^running
26870 (gdb)
26871 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
26872 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26873 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26874 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26875 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26876 (gdb)
26877 @end smallexample
26878
26879 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
26880 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
26881 deleted.
26882
26883 @smallexample
26884 (gdb)
26885 -break-watch C
26886 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
26887 (gdb)
26888 -break-list
26889 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26890 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26891 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26892 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26893 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26894 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26895 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26896 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26897 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26898 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26899 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
26900 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26901 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
26902 (gdb)
26903 -exec-continue
26904 ^running
26905 (gdb)
26906 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
26907 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26908 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26909 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26910 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26911 (gdb)
26912 -break-list
26913 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26914 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26915 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26916 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26917 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26918 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26919 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26920 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26921 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26922 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26923 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
26924 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
26925 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
26926 (gdb)
26927 -exec-continue
26928 ^running
26929 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
26930 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26931 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26932 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26933 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
26934 (gdb)
26935 -break-list
26936 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26937 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26938 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26939 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26940 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26941 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26942 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26943 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26944 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
26945 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26946 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
26947 times="1"@}]@}
26948 (gdb)
26949 @end smallexample
26950
26951 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26952 @node GDB/MI Program Context
26953 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
26954
26955 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
26956 @findex -exec-arguments
26957
26958
26959 @subsubheading Synopsis
26960
26961 @smallexample
26962 -exec-arguments @var{args}
26963 @end smallexample
26964
26965 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
26966 @samp{-exec-run}.
26967
26968 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26969
26970 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
26971
26972 @subsubheading Example
26973
26974 @smallexample
26975 (gdb)
26976 -exec-arguments -v word
26977 ^done
26978 (gdb)
26979 @end smallexample
26980
26981
26982 @ignore
26983 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
26984 @findex -exec-show-arguments
26985
26986 @subsubheading Synopsis
26987
26988 @smallexample
26989 -exec-show-arguments
26990 @end smallexample
26991
26992 Print the arguments of the program.
26993
26994 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26995
26996 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
26997
26998 @subsubheading Example
26999 N.A.
27000 @end ignore
27001
27002
27003 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27004 @findex -environment-cd
27005
27006 @subsubheading Synopsis
27007
27008 @smallexample
27009 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27010 @end smallexample
27011
27012 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27013
27014 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27015
27016 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27017
27018 @subsubheading Example
27019
27020 @smallexample
27021 (gdb)
27022 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27023 ^done
27024 (gdb)
27025 @end smallexample
27026
27027
27028 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27029 @findex -environment-directory
27030
27031 @subsubheading Synopsis
27032
27033 @smallexample
27034 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27035 @end smallexample
27036
27037 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27038 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27039 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27040 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27041 occurs as normal.
27042 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27043 multiple directories in a single command
27044 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27045 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27046 If blanks are needed as
27047 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27048 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27049 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27050 character must not be used
27051 in any directory name.
27052 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27053
27054 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27055
27056 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27057
27058 @subsubheading Example
27059
27060 @smallexample
27061 (gdb)
27062 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27063 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27064 (gdb)
27065 -environment-directory ""
27066 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27067 (gdb)
27068 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27069 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27070 (gdb)
27071 -environment-directory -r
27072 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27073 (gdb)
27074 @end smallexample
27075
27076
27077 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27078 @findex -environment-path
27079
27080 @subsubheading Synopsis
27081
27082 @smallexample
27083 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27084 @end smallexample
27085
27086 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27087 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27088 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27089 supplied in addition to the
27090 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27091 occurs as normal.
27092 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27093 multiple directories in a single command
27094 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27095 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27096 If blanks are needed as
27097 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27098 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27099 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27100 character must not be used
27101 in any directory name.
27102 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27103
27104
27105 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27106
27107 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27108
27109 @subsubheading Example
27110
27111 @smallexample
27112 (gdb)
27113 -environment-path
27114 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27115 (gdb)
27116 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27117 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27118 (gdb)
27119 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27120 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27121 (gdb)
27122 @end smallexample
27123
27124
27125 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27126 @findex -environment-pwd
27127
27128 @subsubheading Synopsis
27129
27130 @smallexample
27131 -environment-pwd
27132 @end smallexample
27133
27134 Show the current working directory.
27135
27136 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27137
27138 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27139
27140 @subsubheading Example
27141
27142 @smallexample
27143 (gdb)
27144 -environment-pwd
27145 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27146 (gdb)
27147 @end smallexample
27148
27149 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27150 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27151 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27152
27153
27154 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27155 @findex -thread-info
27156
27157 @subsubheading Synopsis
27158
27159 @smallexample
27160 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27161 @end smallexample
27162
27163 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
27164 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
27165 threads. When printing information about all threads,
27166 also reports the current thread.
27167
27168 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27169
27170 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27171 about all threads.
27172
27173 @subsubheading Result
27174
27175 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27176 defined for a given thread:
27177
27178 @table @samp
27179 @item current
27180 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27181
27182 @item id
27183 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27184
27185 @item target-id
27186 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27187
27188 @item details
27189 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27190 field is optional.
27191
27192 @item name
27193 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27194 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27195 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27196 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27197 field is omitted.
27198
27199 @item frame
27200 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27201
27202 @item state
27203 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
27204 values:
27205
27206 @table @code
27207 @item stopped
27208 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
27209 threads.
27210
27211 @item running
27212 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
27213 threads.
27214
27215 @end table
27216
27217 @item core
27218 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
27219 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
27220
27221 @end table
27222
27223 @subsubheading Example
27224
27225 @smallexample
27226 -thread-info
27227 ^done,threads=[
27228 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
27229 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
27230 args=[]@},state="running"@},
27231 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
27232 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
27233 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
27234 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
27235 state="running"@}],
27236 current-thread-id="1"
27237 (gdb)
27238 @end smallexample
27239
27240 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
27241 @findex -thread-list-ids
27242
27243 @subsubheading Synopsis
27244
27245 @smallexample
27246 -thread-list-ids
27247 @end smallexample
27248
27249 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
27250 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
27251
27252 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
27253 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
27254
27255 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27256
27257 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
27258
27259 @subsubheading Example
27260
27261 @smallexample
27262 (gdb)
27263 -thread-list-ids
27264 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27265 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
27266 (gdb)
27267 @end smallexample
27268
27269
27270 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
27271 @findex -thread-select
27272
27273 @subsubheading Synopsis
27274
27275 @smallexample
27276 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
27277 @end smallexample
27278
27279 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
27280 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
27281
27282 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
27283 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
27284
27285 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27286
27287 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
27288
27289 @subsubheading Example
27290
27291 @smallexample
27292 (gdb)
27293 -exec-next
27294 ^running
27295 (gdb)
27296 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
27297 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
27298 (gdb)
27299 -thread-list-ids
27300 ^done,
27301 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27302 number-of-threads="3"
27303 (gdb)
27304 -thread-select 3
27305 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
27306 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27307 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27308 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27309 (gdb)
27310 @end smallexample
27311
27312 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27313 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27314 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
27315
27316 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
27317 @findex -ada-task-info
27318
27319 @subsubheading Synopsis
27320
27321 @smallexample
27322 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
27323 @end smallexample
27324
27325 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
27326 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
27327
27328 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27329
27330 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
27331 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
27332
27333 @subsubheading Result
27334
27335 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
27336 defined for each Ada task:
27337
27338 @table @samp
27339 @item current
27340 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27341
27342 @item id
27343 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
27344
27345 @item task-id
27346 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
27347
27348 @item thread-id
27349 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
27350
27351 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
27352 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
27353 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
27354
27355 @item parent-id
27356 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
27357 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
27358
27359 @item priority
27360 The base priority of the task.
27361
27362 @item state
27363 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
27364 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
27365
27366 @item name
27367 The name of the task.
27368
27369 @end table
27370
27371 @subsubheading Example
27372
27373 @smallexample
27374 -ada-task-info
27375 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
27376 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
27377 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
27378 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
27379 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
27380 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
27381 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
27382 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
27383 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
27384 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
27385 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
27386 (gdb)
27387 @end smallexample
27388
27389 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27390 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
27391 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
27392
27393 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27394 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27395 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27396 other cases.
27397
27398 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27399 @findex -exec-continue
27400
27401 @subsubheading Synopsis
27402
27403 @smallexample
27404 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27405 @end smallexample
27406
27407 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27408 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27409 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27410 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27411 @itemize @bullet
27412 @item
27413 breakpoints or watchpoints
27414 @item
27415 signals or exceptions
27416 @item
27417 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27418 @item
27419 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27420 @end itemize
27421 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27422 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27423 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27424 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27425 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27426 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27427
27428 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27429
27430 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27431
27432 @subsubheading Example
27433
27434 @smallexample
27435 -exec-continue
27436 ^running
27437 (gdb)
27438 @@Hello world
27439 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27440 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27441 line="13"@}
27442 (gdb)
27443 @end smallexample
27444
27445
27446 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27447 @findex -exec-finish
27448
27449 @subsubheading Synopsis
27450
27451 @smallexample
27452 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27453 @end smallexample
27454
27455 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27456 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27457 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27458 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27459 function was called.
27460
27461 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27462
27463 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27464
27465 @subsubheading Example
27466
27467 Function returning @code{void}.
27468
27469 @smallexample
27470 -exec-finish
27471 ^running
27472 (gdb)
27473 @@hello from foo
27474 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27475 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27476 (gdb)
27477 @end smallexample
27478
27479 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27480 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27481 value itself.
27482
27483 @smallexample
27484 -exec-finish
27485 ^running
27486 (gdb)
27487 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27488 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27489 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27490 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27491 (gdb)
27492 @end smallexample
27493
27494
27495 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27496 @findex -exec-interrupt
27497
27498 @subsubheading Synopsis
27499
27500 @smallexample
27501 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27502 @end smallexample
27503
27504 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27505 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27506 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27507 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27508 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27509
27510 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27511 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27512 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27513 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27514
27515 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
27516 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
27517 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
27518 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
27519
27520 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27521
27522 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
27523
27524 @subsubheading Example
27525
27526 @smallexample
27527 (gdb)
27528 111-exec-continue
27529 111^running
27530
27531 (gdb)
27532 222-exec-interrupt
27533 222^done
27534 (gdb)
27535 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
27536 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27537 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
27538 (gdb)
27539
27540 (gdb)
27541 -exec-interrupt
27542 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
27543 (gdb)
27544 @end smallexample
27545
27546 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
27547 @findex -exec-jump
27548
27549 @subsubheading Synopsis
27550
27551 @smallexample
27552 -exec-jump @var{location}
27553 @end smallexample
27554
27555 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
27556 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
27557 different forms of @var{location}.
27558
27559 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27560
27561 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
27562
27563 @subsubheading Example
27564
27565 @smallexample
27566 -exec-jump foo.c:10
27567 *running,thread-id="all"
27568 ^running
27569 @end smallexample
27570
27571
27572 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
27573 @findex -exec-next
27574
27575 @subsubheading Synopsis
27576
27577 @smallexample
27578 -exec-next [--reverse]
27579 @end smallexample
27580
27581 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27582 of the next source line is reached.
27583
27584 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27585 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
27586 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
27587 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
27588 source line where the function was called.
27589
27590
27591 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27592
27593 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
27594
27595 @subsubheading Example
27596
27597 @smallexample
27598 -exec-next
27599 ^running
27600 (gdb)
27601 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
27602 (gdb)
27603 @end smallexample
27604
27605
27606 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
27607 @findex -exec-next-instruction
27608
27609 @subsubheading Synopsis
27610
27611 @smallexample
27612 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
27613 @end smallexample
27614
27615 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
27616 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
27617 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
27618 printed as well.
27619
27620 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27621 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
27622 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
27623 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
27624 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
27625
27626 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27627
27628 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
27629
27630 @subsubheading Example
27631
27632 @smallexample
27633 (gdb)
27634 -exec-next-instruction
27635 ^running
27636
27637 (gdb)
27638 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27639 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
27640 (gdb)
27641 @end smallexample
27642
27643
27644 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
27645 @findex -exec-return
27646
27647 @subsubheading Synopsis
27648
27649 @smallexample
27650 -exec-return
27651 @end smallexample
27652
27653 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
27654 Displays the new current frame.
27655
27656 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27657
27658 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
27659
27660 @subsubheading Example
27661
27662 @smallexample
27663 (gdb)
27664 200-break-insert callee4
27665 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
27666 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27667 (gdb)
27668 000-exec-run
27669 000^running
27670 (gdb)
27671 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27672 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27673 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27674 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27675 (gdb)
27676 205-break-delete
27677 205^done
27678 (gdb)
27679 111-exec-return
27680 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
27681 args=[@{name="strarg",
27682 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27683 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27684 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27685 (gdb)
27686 @end smallexample
27687
27688
27689 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
27690 @findex -exec-run
27691
27692 @subsubheading Synopsis
27693
27694 @smallexample
27695 -exec-run [--all | --thread-group N]
27696 @end smallexample
27697
27698 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
27699 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
27700 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
27701 the program has exited exceptionally.
27702
27703 When no option is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
27704 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
27705 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
27706 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
27707
27708 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27709
27710 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
27711
27712 @subsubheading Examples
27713
27714 @smallexample
27715 (gdb)
27716 -break-insert main
27717 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27718 (gdb)
27719 -exec-run
27720 ^running
27721 (gdb)
27722 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27723 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27724 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
27725 (gdb)
27726 @end smallexample
27727
27728 @noindent
27729 Program exited normally:
27730
27731 @smallexample
27732 (gdb)
27733 -exec-run
27734 ^running
27735 (gdb)
27736 x = 55
27737 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27738 (gdb)
27739 @end smallexample
27740
27741 @noindent
27742 Program exited exceptionally:
27743
27744 @smallexample
27745 (gdb)
27746 -exec-run
27747 ^running
27748 (gdb)
27749 x = 55
27750 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
27751 (gdb)
27752 @end smallexample
27753
27754 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
27755 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
27756
27757 @smallexample
27758 (gdb)
27759 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
27760 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
27761 @end smallexample
27762
27763
27764 @c @subheading -exec-signal
27765
27766
27767 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
27768 @findex -exec-step
27769
27770 @subsubheading Synopsis
27771
27772 @smallexample
27773 -exec-step [--reverse]
27774 @end smallexample
27775
27776 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27777 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
27778 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
27779 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
27780 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
27781 previously executed source line.
27782
27783 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27784
27785 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
27786
27787 @subsubheading Example
27788
27789 Stepping into a function:
27790
27791 @smallexample
27792 -exec-step
27793 ^running
27794 (gdb)
27795 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27796 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
27797 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
27798 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
27799 (gdb)
27800 @end smallexample
27801
27802 Regular stepping:
27803
27804 @smallexample
27805 -exec-step
27806 ^running
27807 (gdb)
27808 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
27809 (gdb)
27810 @end smallexample
27811
27812
27813 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
27814 @findex -exec-step-instruction
27815
27816 @subsubheading Synopsis
27817
27818 @smallexample
27819 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
27820 @end smallexample
27821
27822 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
27823 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
27824 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
27825 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
27826 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
27827 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
27828 as well.
27829
27830 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27831
27832 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
27833
27834 @subsubheading Example
27835
27836 @smallexample
27837 (gdb)
27838 -exec-step-instruction
27839 ^running
27840
27841 (gdb)
27842 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27843 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27844 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27845 (gdb)
27846 -exec-step-instruction
27847 ^running
27848
27849 (gdb)
27850 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27851 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27852 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
27853 (gdb)
27854 @end smallexample
27855
27856
27857 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
27858 @findex -exec-until
27859
27860 @subsubheading Synopsis
27861
27862 @smallexample
27863 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
27864 @end smallexample
27865
27866 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
27867 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
27868 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
27869 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
27870
27871 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27872
27873 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
27874
27875 @subsubheading Example
27876
27877 @smallexample
27878 (gdb)
27879 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
27880 ^running
27881 (gdb)
27882 x = 55
27883 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27884 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
27885 (gdb)
27886 @end smallexample
27887
27888 @ignore
27889 @subheading -file-clear
27890 Is this going away????
27891 @end ignore
27892
27893 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27894 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
27895 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
27896
27897
27898 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
27899 @findex -stack-info-frame
27900
27901 @subsubheading Synopsis
27902
27903 @smallexample
27904 -stack-info-frame
27905 @end smallexample
27906
27907 Get info on the selected frame.
27908
27909 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27910
27911 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
27912 (without arguments).
27913
27914 @subsubheading Example
27915
27916 @smallexample
27917 (gdb)
27918 -stack-info-frame
27919 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
27920 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27921 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
27922 (gdb)
27923 @end smallexample
27924
27925 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
27926 @findex -stack-info-depth
27927
27928 @subsubheading Synopsis
27929
27930 @smallexample
27931 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
27932 @end smallexample
27933
27934 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
27935 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
27936
27937 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27938
27939 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
27940
27941 @subsubheading Example
27942
27943 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
27944
27945 @smallexample
27946 (gdb)
27947 -stack-info-depth
27948 ^done,depth="12"
27949 (gdb)
27950 -stack-info-depth 4
27951 ^done,depth="4"
27952 (gdb)
27953 -stack-info-depth 12
27954 ^done,depth="12"
27955 (gdb)
27956 -stack-info-depth 11
27957 ^done,depth="11"
27958 (gdb)
27959 -stack-info-depth 13
27960 ^done,depth="12"
27961 (gdb)
27962 @end smallexample
27963
27964 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
27965 @findex -stack-list-arguments
27966
27967 @subsubheading Synopsis
27968
27969 @smallexample
27970 -stack-list-arguments @var{print-values}
27971 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
27972 @end smallexample
27973
27974 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
27975 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
27976 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
27977 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
27978 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
27979 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
27980 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
27981 which case only existing frames will be returned.
27982
27983 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
27984 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
27985 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
27986 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
27987 structures and unions.
27988
27989 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
27990 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
27991
27992 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27993
27994 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
27995 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
27996 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
27997
27998 @subsubheading Example
27999
28000 @smallexample
28001 (gdb)
28002 -stack-list-frames
28003 ^done,
28004 stack=[
28005 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28006 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28007 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28008 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28009 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28010 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28011 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28012 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28013 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28014 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28015 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28016 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28017 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28018 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28019 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28020 (gdb)
28021 -stack-list-arguments 0
28022 ^done,
28023 stack-args=[
28024 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28025 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28026 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28027 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28028 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28029 (gdb)
28030 -stack-list-arguments 1
28031 ^done,
28032 stack-args=[
28033 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28034 frame=@{level="1",
28035 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28036 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28037 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28038 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28039 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28040 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28041 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28042 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28043 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28044 (gdb)
28045 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28046 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28047 (gdb)
28048 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28049 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28050 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28051 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28052 (gdb)
28053 @end smallexample
28054
28055 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28056
28057
28058 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28059 @findex -stack-list-frames
28060
28061 @subsubheading Synopsis
28062
28063 @smallexample
28064 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28065 @end smallexample
28066
28067 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28068 following info:
28069
28070 @table @samp
28071 @item @var{level}
28072 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28073 @item @var{addr}
28074 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28075 @item @var{func}
28076 Function name.
28077 @item @var{file}
28078 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28079 @item @var{fullname}
28080 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28081 @item @var{line}
28082 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28083 @item @var{from}
28084 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28085 if the frame's function is not known.
28086 @end table
28087
28088 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28089 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28090 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28091 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28092 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28093 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28094 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
28095
28096 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28097
28098 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28099
28100 @subsubheading Example
28101
28102 Full stack backtrace:
28103
28104 @smallexample
28105 (gdb)
28106 -stack-list-frames
28107 ^done,stack=
28108 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28109 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28110 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28111 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28112 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28113 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28114 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28115 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28116 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28117 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28118 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28119 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28120 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28121 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28122 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28123 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28124 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28125 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28126 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28127 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28128 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28129 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28130 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28131 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28132 (gdb)
28133 @end smallexample
28134
28135 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28136
28137 @smallexample
28138 (gdb)
28139 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28140 ^done,stack=
28141 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28142 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28143 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28144 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28145 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28146 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28147 (gdb)
28148 @end smallexample
28149
28150 Show a single frame:
28151
28152 @smallexample
28153 (gdb)
28154 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28155 ^done,stack=
28156 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28157 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28158 (gdb)
28159 @end smallexample
28160
28161
28162 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28163 @findex -stack-list-locals
28164
28165 @subsubheading Synopsis
28166
28167 @smallexample
28168 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
28169 @end smallexample
28170
28171 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
28172 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28173 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28174 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28175 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28176 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28177 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28178 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28179 more detail.
28180
28181 This command is deprecated in favor of the
28182 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28183
28184 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28185
28186 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
28187
28188 @subsubheading Example
28189
28190 @smallexample
28191 (gdb)
28192 -stack-list-locals 0
28193 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
28194 (gdb)
28195 -stack-list-locals --all-values
28196 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
28197 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
28198 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
28199 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
28200 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
28201 (gdb)
28202 @end smallexample
28203
28204 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
28205 @findex -stack-list-variables
28206
28207 @subsubheading Synopsis
28208
28209 @smallexample
28210 -stack-list-variables @var{print-values}
28211 @end smallexample
28212
28213 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
28214 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28215 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28216 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28217 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28218 structures and unions.
28219
28220 @subsubheading Example
28221
28222 @smallexample
28223 (gdb)
28224 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
28225 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
28226 (gdb)
28227 @end smallexample
28228
28229
28230 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
28231 @findex -stack-select-frame
28232
28233 @subsubheading Synopsis
28234
28235 @smallexample
28236 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
28237 @end smallexample
28238
28239 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
28240 the stack.
28241
28242 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
28243 option to every command.
28244
28245 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28246
28247 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
28248 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
28249
28250 @subsubheading Example
28251
28252 @smallexample
28253 (gdb)
28254 -stack-select-frame 2
28255 ^done
28256 (gdb)
28257 @end smallexample
28258
28259 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28260 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
28261 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
28262
28263 @ignore
28264
28265 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28266
28267 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28268 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28269 used by @code{Insight}.
28270
28271 The two main reasons for that are:
28272
28273 @enumerate 1
28274 @item
28275 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
28276
28277 @item
28278 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
28279 now).
28280 @end enumerate
28281
28282 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
28283 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
28284 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
28285 hints about their use.
28286
28287 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
28288 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
28289 least, the following operations:
28290
28291 @itemize @bullet
28292 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
28293 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
28294 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
28295 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
28296 @end itemize
28297
28298 @end ignore
28299
28300 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
28301
28302 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28303
28304 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
28305 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
28306 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
28307 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
28308 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
28309 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
28310 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
28311 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
28312 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
28313 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
28314 object, or to change display format.
28315
28316 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
28317 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
28318 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
28319 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
28320 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
28321 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
28322 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
28323 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
28324 child will be created.
28325
28326 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
28327 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
28328 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
28329 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
28330 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
28331
28332 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
28333 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
28334 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
28335 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
28336 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
28337 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
28338 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
28339 variables that frontend has created.
28340
28341 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
28342 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
28343 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
28344 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
28345 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
28346 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
28347 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
28348 implicitly updated.
28349
28350 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28351 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28352 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28353 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28354 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28355 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28356 frame. Consider this example:
28357
28358 @smallexample
28359 void do_work(...)
28360 @{
28361 struct work_state state;
28362
28363 if (...)
28364 do_work(...);
28365 @}
28366 @end smallexample
28367
28368 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28369 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28370 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28371 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28372 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28373
28374 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28375 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28376 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28377 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28378 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28379 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28380
28381 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28382 access this functionality:
28383
28384 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28385 @item @strong{Operation}
28386 @tab @strong{Description}
28387
28388 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28389 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28390 @item @code{-var-create}
28391 @tab create a variable object
28392 @item @code{-var-delete}
28393 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28394 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28395 @tab set the display format of this variable
28396 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28397 @tab show the display format of this variable
28398 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28399 @tab tells how many children this object has
28400 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28401 @tab return a list of the object's children
28402 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28403 @tab show the type of this variable object
28404 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28405 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28406 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28407 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28408 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28409 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28410 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28411 @tab get the value of this variable
28412 @item @code{-var-assign}
28413 @tab set the value of this variable
28414 @item @code{-var-update}
28415 @tab update the variable and its children
28416 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28417 @tab set frozeness attribute
28418 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28419 @tab set range of children to display on update
28420 @end multitable
28421
28422 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28423 how it can be used.
28424
28425 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28426
28427 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28428 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28429
28430 @smallexample
28431 -enable-pretty-printing
28432 @end smallexample
28433
28434 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28435 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28436 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28437 request that this functionality be enabled.
28438
28439 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28440
28441 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28442 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28443
28444 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28445 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28446
28447 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28448 @findex -var-create
28449
28450 @subsubheading Synopsis
28451
28452 @smallexample
28453 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28454 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28455 @end smallexample
28456
28457 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28458 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28459 register.
28460
28461 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28462 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28463 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28464 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28465 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28466
28467 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28468 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28469 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28470 object must be created.
28471
28472 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
28473 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
28474
28475 @itemize @bullet
28476 @item
28477 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
28478
28479 @item
28480 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
28481
28482 @item
28483 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
28484 @end itemize
28485
28486 @cindex dynamic varobj
28487 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
28488 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
28489 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
28490 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
28491 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
28492 compatibility for existing clients.
28493
28494 @subsubheading Result
28495
28496 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
28497 are:
28498
28499 @table @samp
28500 @item name
28501 The name of the varobj.
28502
28503 @item numchild
28504 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
28505 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
28506 @samp{has_more} attribute.
28507
28508 @item value
28509 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
28510 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
28511 will not be interesting.
28512
28513 @item type
28514 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
28515 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI.
28516
28517 @item thread-id
28518 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
28519 thread's identifier.
28520
28521 @item has_more
28522 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
28523 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
28524
28525 @item dynamic
28526 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28527 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28528 then this attribute will not be present.
28529
28530 @item displayhint
28531 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28532 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28533 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28534 @end table
28535
28536 Typical output will look like this:
28537
28538 @smallexample
28539 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
28540 has_more="@var{has_more}"
28541 @end smallexample
28542
28543
28544 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
28545 @findex -var-delete
28546
28547 @subsubheading Synopsis
28548
28549 @smallexample
28550 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
28551 @end smallexample
28552
28553 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
28554 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
28555
28556 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
28557
28558
28559 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
28560 @findex -var-set-format
28561
28562 @subsubheading Synopsis
28563
28564 @smallexample
28565 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
28566 @end smallexample
28567
28568 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
28569 @var{format-spec}.
28570
28571 @anchor{-var-set-format}
28572 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
28573
28574 @smallexample
28575 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
28576 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
28577 @end smallexample
28578
28579 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
28580 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
28581 for pointers, etc.).
28582
28583 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
28584 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
28585
28586 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
28587 @findex -var-show-format
28588
28589 @subsubheading Synopsis
28590
28591 @smallexample
28592 -var-show-format @var{name}
28593 @end smallexample
28594
28595 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
28596
28597 @smallexample
28598 @var{format} @expansion{}
28599 @var{format-spec}
28600 @end smallexample
28601
28602
28603 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
28604 @findex -var-info-num-children
28605
28606 @subsubheading Synopsis
28607
28608 @smallexample
28609 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
28610 @end smallexample
28611
28612 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
28613
28614 @smallexample
28615 numchild=@var{n}
28616 @end smallexample
28617
28618 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
28619 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
28620 be available.
28621
28622
28623 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
28624 @findex -var-list-children
28625
28626 @subsubheading Synopsis
28627
28628 @smallexample
28629 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
28630 @end smallexample
28631 @anchor{-var-list-children}
28632
28633 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
28634 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
28635 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
28636 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
28637 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
28638 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
28639 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
28640 and unions.
28641
28642 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
28643 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
28644 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
28645 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
28646 reported.
28647
28648 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
28649 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
28650 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
28651 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
28652 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
28653 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
28654 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
28655 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
28656 the visible items.
28657
28658 For each child the following results are returned:
28659
28660 @table @var
28661
28662 @item name
28663 Name of the variable object created for this child.
28664
28665 @item exp
28666 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
28667 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
28668
28669 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
28670 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
28671
28672 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
28673 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
28674 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
28675 type and value are not present.
28676
28677 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
28678 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
28679 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
28680
28681 @item numchild
28682 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
28683 0.
28684
28685 @item type
28686 The type of the child.
28687
28688 @item value
28689 If values were requested, this is the value.
28690
28691 @item thread-id
28692 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
28693 Otherwise this result is not present.
28694
28695 @item frozen
28696 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
28697 @end table
28698
28699 The result may have its own attributes:
28700
28701 @table @samp
28702 @item displayhint
28703 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28704 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28705 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28706
28707 @item has_more
28708 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
28709 remaining after the end of the selected range.
28710 @end table
28711
28712 @subsubheading Example
28713
28714 @smallexample
28715 (gdb)
28716 -var-list-children n
28717 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28718 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28719 (gdb)
28720 -var-list-children --all-values n
28721 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
28722 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
28723 @end smallexample
28724
28725
28726 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
28727 @findex -var-info-type
28728
28729 @subsubheading Synopsis
28730
28731 @smallexample
28732 -var-info-type @var{name}
28733 @end smallexample
28734
28735 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
28736 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
28737 @value{GDBN} CLI:
28738
28739 @smallexample
28740 type=@var{typename}
28741 @end smallexample
28742
28743
28744 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
28745 @findex -var-info-expression
28746
28747 @subsubheading Synopsis
28748
28749 @smallexample
28750 -var-info-expression @var{name}
28751 @end smallexample
28752
28753 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
28754 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
28755 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
28756
28757 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
28758 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
28759
28760 @smallexample
28761 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
28762 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
28763 @end smallexample
28764
28765 @noindent
28766 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
28767
28768 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
28769 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
28770 is of limited use.
28771
28772 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
28773 @findex -var-info-path-expression
28774
28775 @subsubheading Synopsis
28776
28777 @smallexample
28778 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
28779 @end smallexample
28780
28781 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
28782 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
28783 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
28784 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
28785 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
28786 watchpoint from a variable object.
28787
28788 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
28789 and will give an error when invoked on one.
28790
28791 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
28792 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
28793 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
28794 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
28795 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
28796 @smallexample
28797 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
28798 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
28799 @end smallexample
28800
28801 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
28802 @findex -var-show-attributes
28803
28804 @subsubheading Synopsis
28805
28806 @smallexample
28807 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
28808 @end smallexample
28809
28810 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
28811
28812 @smallexample
28813 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
28814 @end smallexample
28815
28816 @noindent
28817 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
28818
28819 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
28820 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
28821
28822 @subsubheading Synopsis
28823
28824 @smallexample
28825 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
28826 @end smallexample
28827
28828 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
28829 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
28830 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
28831 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
28832 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
28833 the current display format will be used. The current display format
28834 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
28835
28836 @smallexample
28837 value=@var{value}
28838 @end smallexample
28839
28840 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
28841 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
28842
28843 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
28844 @findex -var-assign
28845
28846 @subsubheading Synopsis
28847
28848 @smallexample
28849 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
28850 @end smallexample
28851
28852 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
28853 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
28854 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
28855 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
28856
28857 @subsubheading Example
28858
28859 @smallexample
28860 (gdb)
28861 -var-assign var1 3
28862 ^done,value="3"
28863 (gdb)
28864 -var-update *
28865 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
28866 (gdb)
28867 @end smallexample
28868
28869 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
28870 @findex -var-update
28871
28872 @subsubheading Synopsis
28873
28874 @smallexample
28875 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
28876 @end smallexample
28877
28878 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
28879 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
28880 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
28881 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
28882 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
28883 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
28884 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
28885 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
28886 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
28887 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
28888 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
28889 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
28890 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
28891
28892 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
28893 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
28894 diagnostic.
28895
28896 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
28897 only the selected range of children will be reported.
28898
28899 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
28900 @samp{changelist}.
28901
28902 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
28903
28904 @table @samp
28905 @item name
28906 The name of the varobj.
28907
28908 @item value
28909 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
28910 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
28911
28912 @item in_scope
28913 @anchor{-var-update}
28914 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
28915
28916 @table @code
28917 @item "true"
28918 The variable object's current value is valid.
28919
28920 @item "false"
28921 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
28922 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
28923 scope.
28924
28925 @item "invalid"
28926 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
28927 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
28928 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
28929 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
28930 objects.
28931 @end table
28932
28933 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
28934 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
28935
28936 @item type_changed
28937 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
28938 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
28939 be @samp{false}.
28940
28941 @item new_type
28942 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
28943 hold the new type.
28944
28945 @item new_num_children
28946 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
28947 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
28948
28949 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
28950 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
28951 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
28952 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
28953 children which may be available.
28954
28955 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
28956 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
28957 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
28958 only happen at the end of the update range).
28959
28960 @item displayhint
28961 The display hint, if any.
28962
28963 @item has_more
28964 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
28965 available outside the varobj's update range.
28966
28967 @item dynamic
28968 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28969 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28970 then this attribute will not be present.
28971
28972 @item new_children
28973 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
28974 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
28975 be listed in this attribute.
28976 @end table
28977
28978 @subsubheading Example
28979
28980 @smallexample
28981 (gdb)
28982 -var-assign var1 3
28983 ^done,value="3"
28984 (gdb)
28985 -var-update --all-values var1
28986 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
28987 type_changed="false"@}]
28988 (gdb)
28989 @end smallexample
28990
28991 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
28992 @findex -var-set-frozen
28993 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
28994
28995 @subsubheading Synopsis
28996
28997 @smallexample
28998 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
28999 @end smallexample
29000
29001 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29002 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29003 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29004 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29005 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29006 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29007 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29008 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29009 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29010 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29011 @code{-var-update} does.
29012
29013 @subsubheading Example
29014
29015 @smallexample
29016 (gdb)
29017 -var-set-frozen V 1
29018 ^done
29019 (gdb)
29020 @end smallexample
29021
29022 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29023 @findex -var-set-update-range
29024 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29025
29026 @subsubheading Synopsis
29027
29028 @smallexample
29029 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29030 @end smallexample
29031
29032 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29033 @code{-var-update}.
29034
29035 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29036 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29037 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29038 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29039
29040 @subsubheading Example
29041
29042 @smallexample
29043 (gdb)
29044 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29045 ^done
29046 @end smallexample
29047
29048 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29049 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29050 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29051
29052 @subsubheading Synopsis
29053
29054 @smallexample
29055 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29056 @end smallexample
29057
29058 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29059
29060 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29061 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29062
29063 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29064 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29065 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29066 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29067 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29068 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29069 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29070
29071 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29072 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29073 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29074 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29075
29076 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29077 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands})
29078 can be used to check this.
29079
29080 @subsubheading Example
29081
29082 Resetting the visualizer:
29083
29084 @smallexample
29085 (gdb)
29086 -var-set-visualizer V None
29087 ^done
29088 @end smallexample
29089
29090 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29091
29092 @smallexample
29093 (gdb)
29094 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29095 ^done
29096 @end smallexample
29097
29098 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29099 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29100
29101 @smallexample
29102 (gdb)
29103 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29104 ^done
29105 @end smallexample
29106
29107 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29108 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29109 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29110
29111 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29112 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29113 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29114 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29115
29116 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29117 @c @subheading -data-assign
29118 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29119 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
29120 @c set variable
29121 @c @subsubheading Example
29122 @c N.A.
29123
29124 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29125 @findex -data-disassemble
29126
29127 @subsubheading Synopsis
29128
29129 @smallexample
29130 -data-disassemble
29131 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29132 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29133 -- @var{mode}
29134 @end smallexample
29135
29136 @noindent
29137 Where:
29138
29139 @table @samp
29140 @item @var{start-addr}
29141 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
29142 @item @var{end-addr}
29143 is the end address
29144 @item @var{filename}
29145 is the name of the file to disassemble
29146 @item @var{linenum}
29147 is the line number to disassemble around
29148 @item @var{lines}
29149 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
29150 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
29151 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
29152 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
29153 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
29154 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
29155 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
29156 are displayed.
29157 @item @var{mode}
29158 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
29159 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
29160 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
29161 @end table
29162
29163 @subsubheading Result
29164
29165 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
29166
29167 @itemize @bullet
29168 @item Address
29169 @item Func-name
29170 @item Offset
29171 @item Instruction
29172 @end itemize
29173
29174 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
29175 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
29176
29177 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29178
29179 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
29180
29181 @subsubheading Example
29182
29183 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
29184
29185 @smallexample
29186 (gdb)
29187 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
29188 ^done,
29189 asm_insns=[
29190 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29191 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29192 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29193 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29194 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
29195 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
29196 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
29197 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29198 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
29199 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
29200 (gdb)
29201 @end smallexample
29202
29203 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
29204 @code{main}.
29205
29206 @smallexample
29207 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
29208 ^done,asm_insns=[
29209 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29210 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29211 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29212 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29213 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29214 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29215 [@dots{}]
29216 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
29217 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
29218 (gdb)
29219 @end smallexample
29220
29221 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
29222
29223 @smallexample
29224 (gdb)
29225 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
29226 ^done,asm_insns=[
29227 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29228 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29229 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29230 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29231 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29232 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
29233 (gdb)
29234 @end smallexample
29235
29236 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
29237
29238 @smallexample
29239 (gdb)
29240 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
29241 ^done,asm_insns=[
29242 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
29243 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
29244 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
29245 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29246 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
29247 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
29248 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
29249 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
29250 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29251 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29252 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29253 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
29254 (gdb)
29255 @end smallexample
29256
29257
29258 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
29259 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
29260
29261 @subsubheading Synopsis
29262
29263 @smallexample
29264 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
29265 @end smallexample
29266
29267 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
29268 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
29269 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
29270
29271 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29272
29273 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
29274 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
29275 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
29276
29277 @subsubheading Example
29278
29279 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29280 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29281 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29282 output.
29283
29284 @smallexample
29285 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29286 211^done,value="1"
29287 (gdb)
29288 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29289 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29290 (gdb)
29291 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29292 411^done,value="4"
29293 (gdb)
29294 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29295 511^done,value="4"
29296 (gdb)
29297 @end smallexample
29298
29299
29300 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29301 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29302
29303 @subsubheading Synopsis
29304
29305 @smallexample
29306 -data-list-changed-registers
29307 @end smallexample
29308
29309 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29310
29311 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29312
29313 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29314 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29315
29316 @subsubheading Example
29317
29318 On a PPC MBX board:
29319
29320 @smallexample
29321 (gdb)
29322 -exec-continue
29323 ^running
29324
29325 (gdb)
29326 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29327 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29328 line="5"@}
29329 (gdb)
29330 -data-list-changed-registers
29331 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29332 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29333 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29334 (gdb)
29335 @end smallexample
29336
29337
29338 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29339 @findex -data-list-register-names
29340
29341 @subsubheading Synopsis
29342
29343 @smallexample
29344 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29345 @end smallexample
29346
29347 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29348 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29349 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29350 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29351 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29352 include empty register names.
29353
29354 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29355
29356 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29357 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29358 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29359
29360 @subsubheading Example
29361
29362 For the PPC MBX board:
29363 @smallexample
29364 (gdb)
29365 -data-list-register-names
29366 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29367 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29368 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29369 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29370 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29371 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29372 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29373 (gdb)
29374 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29375 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29376 (gdb)
29377 @end smallexample
29378
29379 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29380 @findex -data-list-register-values
29381
29382 @subsubheading Synopsis
29383
29384 @smallexample
29385 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29386 @end smallexample
29387
29388 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
29389 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
29390 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
29391 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
29392
29393 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
29394
29395 @table @code
29396 @item x
29397 Hexadecimal
29398 @item o
29399 Octal
29400 @item t
29401 Binary
29402 @item d
29403 Decimal
29404 @item r
29405 Raw
29406 @item N
29407 Natural
29408 @end table
29409
29410 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29411
29412 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
29413 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
29414
29415 @subsubheading Example
29416
29417 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
29418 don't appear in the actual output):
29419
29420 @smallexample
29421 (gdb)
29422 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
29423 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29424 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
29425 (gdb)
29426 -data-list-register-values x
29427 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
29428 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29429 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
29430 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
29431 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
29432 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
29433 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
29434 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
29435 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
29436 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29437 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
29438 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
29439 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
29440 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
29441 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
29442 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
29443 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
29444 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
29445 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
29446 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
29447 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
29448 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
29449 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
29450 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
29451 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
29452 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
29453 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
29454 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
29455 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
29456 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
29457 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
29458 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
29459 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29460 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
29461 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
29462 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
29463 (gdb)
29464 @end smallexample
29465
29466
29467 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
29468 @findex -data-read-memory
29469
29470 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
29471
29472 @subsubheading Synopsis
29473
29474 @smallexample
29475 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29476 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
29477 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
29478 @end smallexample
29479
29480 @noindent
29481 where:
29482
29483 @table @samp
29484 @item @var{address}
29485 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29486 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29487 quoted using the C convention.
29488
29489 @item @var{word-format}
29490 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
29491 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
29492 ,Output Formats}).
29493
29494 @item @var{word-size}
29495 The size of each memory word in bytes.
29496
29497 @item @var{nr-rows}
29498 The number of rows in the output table.
29499
29500 @item @var{nr-cols}
29501 The number of columns in the output table.
29502
29503 @item @var{aschar}
29504 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
29505 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
29506 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
29507 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
29508
29509 @item @var{byte-offset}
29510 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
29511 @end table
29512
29513 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
29514 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
29515 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
29516 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
29517 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
29518 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
29519 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
29520 @samp{addr}.
29521
29522 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
29523 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
29524 @samp{prev-page}.
29525
29526 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29527
29528 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
29529 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
29530
29531 @subsubheading Example
29532
29533 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
29534 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
29535 word. Display each word in hex.
29536
29537 @smallexample
29538 (gdb)
29539 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
29540 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
29541 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
29542 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
29543 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
29544 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
29545 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
29546 (gdb)
29547 @end smallexample
29548
29549 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
29550 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
29551
29552 @smallexample
29553 (gdb)
29554 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
29555 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
29556 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
29557 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
29558 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
29559 (gdb)
29560 @end smallexample
29561
29562 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
29563 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
29564 used as the non-printable character.
29565
29566 @smallexample
29567 (gdb)
29568 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
29569 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
29570 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
29571 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
29572 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29573 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29574 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29575 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29576 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
29577 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
29578 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
29579 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
29580 (gdb)
29581 @end smallexample
29582
29583 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
29584 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
29585
29586 @subsubheading Synopsis
29587
29588 @smallexample
29589 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29590 @var{address} @var{count}
29591 @end smallexample
29592
29593 @noindent
29594 where:
29595
29596 @table @samp
29597 @item @var{address}
29598 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29599 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29600 quoted using the C convention.
29601
29602 @item @var{count}
29603 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
29604
29605 @item @var{byte-offset}
29606 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
29607 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
29608 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
29609 perform address arithmetics itself.
29610
29611 @end table
29612
29613 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
29614 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
29615 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
29616 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
29617 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
29618 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
29619
29620 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
29621 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
29622 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
29623 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
29624 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
29625 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
29626 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
29627 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
29628
29629 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
29630 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
29631 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
29632 and has the following fields:
29633
29634 @table @code
29635 @item begin
29636 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29637
29638 @item end
29639 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
29640
29641 @item offset
29642 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
29643 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
29644
29645 @item contents
29646 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
29647
29648 @end table
29649
29650
29651
29652 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29653
29654 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
29655
29656 @subsubheading Example
29657
29658 @smallexample
29659 (gdb)
29660 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
29661 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
29662 end="0xbffff15e",
29663 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
29664 (gdb)
29665 @end smallexample
29666
29667
29668 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
29669 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
29670
29671 @subsubheading Synopsis
29672
29673 @smallexample
29674 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
29675 @end smallexample
29676
29677 @noindent
29678 where:
29679
29680 @table @samp
29681 @item @var{address}
29682 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29683 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29684 quoted using the C convention.
29685
29686 @item @var{contents}
29687 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
29688
29689 @end table
29690
29691 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29692
29693 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
29694
29695 @subsubheading Example
29696
29697 @smallexample
29698 (gdb)
29699 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
29700 ^done
29701 (gdb)
29702 @end smallexample
29703
29704
29705 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29706 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
29707 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
29708
29709 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
29710 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
29711
29712 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
29713 @findex -trace-find
29714
29715 @subsubheading Synopsis
29716
29717 @smallexample
29718 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
29719 @end smallexample
29720
29721 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
29722 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
29723 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
29724
29725 @table @samp
29726
29727 @item none
29728 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
29729
29730 @item frame-number
29731 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
29732 that index.
29733
29734 @item tracepoint-number
29735 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
29736 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
29737
29738 @item pc
29739 An address is required as parameter. Finds
29740 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
29741 address.
29742
29743 @item pc-inside-range
29744 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
29745 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
29746 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29747
29748 @item pc-outside-range
29749 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
29750 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
29751 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
29752
29753 @item line
29754 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
29755 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
29756 the specified location.
29757
29758 @end table
29759
29760 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
29761 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
29762
29763 @table @samp
29764 @item found
29765 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
29766 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
29767
29768 @item traceframe
29769 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
29770 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29771
29772 @item tracepoint
29773 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
29774 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
29775
29776 @item frame
29777 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
29778 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
29779 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
29780
29781 @end table
29782
29783 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29784
29785 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
29786
29787 @subheading -trace-define-variable
29788 @findex -trace-define-variable
29789
29790 @subsubheading Synopsis
29791
29792 @smallexample
29793 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
29794 @end smallexample
29795
29796 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
29797 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
29798 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
29799 with the @samp{$} character.
29800
29801 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29802
29803 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
29804
29805 @subheading -trace-list-variables
29806 @findex -trace-list-variables
29807
29808 @subsubheading Synopsis
29809
29810 @smallexample
29811 -trace-list-variables
29812 @end smallexample
29813
29814 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
29815 table has the following fields:
29816
29817 @table @samp
29818 @item name
29819 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
29820
29821 @item initial
29822 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
29823 field is always present.
29824
29825 @item current
29826 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
29827 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
29828 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
29829 presently running.
29830
29831 @end table
29832
29833 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29834
29835 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
29836
29837 @subsubheading Example
29838
29839 @smallexample
29840 (gdb)
29841 -trace-list-variables
29842 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
29843 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
29844 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
29845 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
29846 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
29847 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
29848 (gdb)
29849 @end smallexample
29850
29851 @subheading -trace-save
29852 @findex -trace-save
29853
29854 @subsubheading Synopsis
29855
29856 @smallexample
29857 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
29858 @end smallexample
29859
29860 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
29861 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
29862 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
29863 to perform the save.
29864
29865 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29866
29867 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
29868
29869
29870 @subheading -trace-start
29871 @findex -trace-start
29872
29873 @subsubheading Synopsis
29874
29875 @smallexample
29876 -trace-start
29877 @end smallexample
29878
29879 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
29880 have any fields.
29881
29882 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29883
29884 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
29885
29886 @subheading -trace-status
29887 @findex -trace-status
29888
29889 @subsubheading Synopsis
29890
29891 @smallexample
29892 -trace-status
29893 @end smallexample
29894
29895 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
29896 the following fields:
29897
29898 @table @samp
29899
29900 @item supported
29901 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
29902 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
29903 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
29904 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
29905 started. This field is always present.
29906
29907 @item running
29908 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
29909 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
29910 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
29911
29912 @item stop-reason
29913 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
29914 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
29915 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
29916 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
29917 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
29918 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
29919 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
29920 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
29921 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
29922
29923 @item stopping-tracepoint
29924 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
29925 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
29926 @samp{passcount}.
29927
29928 @item frames
29929 @itemx frames-created
29930 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
29931 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
29932 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
29933 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
29934
29935 @item buffer-size
29936 @itemx buffer-free
29937 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
29938 remaining space. These fields are optional.
29939
29940 @item circular
29941 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
29942 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
29943 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
29944 and may fill up.
29945
29946 @item disconnected
29947 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
29948 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
29949 that the trace run will stop.
29950
29951 @end table
29952
29953 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29954
29955 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
29956
29957 @subheading -trace-stop
29958 @findex -trace-stop
29959
29960 @subsubheading Synopsis
29961
29962 @smallexample
29963 -trace-stop
29964 @end smallexample
29965
29966 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
29967 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
29968 @samp{running} fields are not output.
29969
29970 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29971
29972 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
29973
29974
29975 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29976 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
29977 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
29978
29979
29980 @ignore
29981 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
29982 @findex -symbol-info-address
29983
29984 @subsubheading Synopsis
29985
29986 @smallexample
29987 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
29988 @end smallexample
29989
29990 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
29991
29992 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29993
29994 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
29995
29996 @subsubheading Example
29997 N.A.
29998
29999
30000 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
30001 @findex -symbol-info-file
30002
30003 @subsubheading Synopsis
30004
30005 @smallexample
30006 -symbol-info-file
30007 @end smallexample
30008
30009 Show the file for the symbol.
30010
30011 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30012
30013 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
30014 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
30015
30016 @subsubheading Example
30017 N.A.
30018
30019
30020 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
30021 @findex -symbol-info-function
30022
30023 @subsubheading Synopsis
30024
30025 @smallexample
30026 -symbol-info-function
30027 @end smallexample
30028
30029 Show which function the symbol lives in.
30030
30031 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30032
30033 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
30034
30035 @subsubheading Example
30036 N.A.
30037
30038
30039 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
30040 @findex -symbol-info-line
30041
30042 @subsubheading Synopsis
30043
30044 @smallexample
30045 -symbol-info-line
30046 @end smallexample
30047
30048 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
30049
30050 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30051
30052 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
30053 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
30054
30055 @subsubheading Example
30056 N.A.
30057
30058
30059 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
30060 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
30061
30062 @subsubheading Synopsis
30063
30064 @smallexample
30065 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
30066 @end smallexample
30067
30068 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
30069
30070 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30071
30072 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
30073
30074 @subsubheading Example
30075 N.A.
30076
30077
30078 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
30079 @findex -symbol-list-functions
30080
30081 @subsubheading Synopsis
30082
30083 @smallexample
30084 -symbol-list-functions
30085 @end smallexample
30086
30087 List the functions in the executable.
30088
30089 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30090
30091 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
30092 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30093
30094 @subsubheading Example
30095 N.A.
30096 @end ignore
30097
30098
30099 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
30100 @findex -symbol-list-lines
30101
30102 @subsubheading Synopsis
30103
30104 @smallexample
30105 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
30106 @end smallexample
30107
30108 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
30109 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
30110 ascending PC order.
30111
30112 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30113
30114 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30115
30116 @subsubheading Example
30117 @smallexample
30118 (gdb)
30119 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
30120 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
30121 (gdb)
30122 @end smallexample
30123
30124
30125 @ignore
30126 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
30127 @findex -symbol-list-types
30128
30129 @subsubheading Synopsis
30130
30131 @smallexample
30132 -symbol-list-types
30133 @end smallexample
30134
30135 List all the type names.
30136
30137 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30138
30139 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
30140 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30141
30142 @subsubheading Example
30143 N.A.
30144
30145
30146 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30147 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30148
30149 @subsubheading Synopsis
30150
30151 @smallexample
30152 -symbol-list-variables
30153 @end smallexample
30154
30155 List all the global and static variable names.
30156
30157 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30158
30159 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30160
30161 @subsubheading Example
30162 N.A.
30163
30164
30165 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30166 @findex -symbol-locate
30167
30168 @subsubheading Synopsis
30169
30170 @smallexample
30171 -symbol-locate
30172 @end smallexample
30173
30174 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30175
30176 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30177
30178 @subsubheading Example
30179 N.A.
30180
30181
30182 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30183 @findex -symbol-type
30184
30185 @subsubheading Synopsis
30186
30187 @smallexample
30188 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30189 @end smallexample
30190
30191 Show type of @var{variable}.
30192
30193 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30194
30195 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30196 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30197
30198 @subsubheading Example
30199 N.A.
30200 @end ignore
30201
30202
30203 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30204 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30205 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30206
30207 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30208 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30209
30210 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30211 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30212
30213 @subsubheading Synopsis
30214
30215 @smallexample
30216 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30217 @end smallexample
30218
30219 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30220 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30221 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30222 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30223 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30224 notification.
30225
30226 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30227
30228 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30229
30230 @subsubheading Example
30231
30232 @smallexample
30233 (gdb)
30234 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30235 ^done
30236 (gdb)
30237 @end smallexample
30238
30239
30240 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30241 @findex -file-exec-file
30242
30243 @subsubheading Synopsis
30244
30245 @smallexample
30246 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30247 @end smallexample
30248
30249 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30250 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30251 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30252 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30253 notification.
30254
30255 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30256
30257 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
30258
30259 @subsubheading Example
30260
30261 @smallexample
30262 (gdb)
30263 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30264 ^done
30265 (gdb)
30266 @end smallexample
30267
30268
30269 @ignore
30270 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
30271 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
30272
30273 @subsubheading Synopsis
30274
30275 @smallexample
30276 -file-list-exec-sections
30277 @end smallexample
30278
30279 List the sections of the current executable file.
30280
30281 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30282
30283 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
30284 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
30285 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
30286
30287 @subsubheading Example
30288 N.A.
30289 @end ignore
30290
30291
30292 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
30293 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
30294
30295 @subsubheading Synopsis
30296
30297 @smallexample
30298 -file-list-exec-source-file
30299 @end smallexample
30300
30301 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
30302 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
30303 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
30304 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
30305
30306 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30307
30308 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
30309
30310 @subsubheading Example
30311
30312 @smallexample
30313 (gdb)
30314 123-file-list-exec-source-file
30315 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
30316 (gdb)
30317 @end smallexample
30318
30319
30320 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
30321 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
30322
30323 @subsubheading Synopsis
30324
30325 @smallexample
30326 -file-list-exec-source-files
30327 @end smallexample
30328
30329 List the source files for the current executable.
30330
30331 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
30332 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
30333
30334 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30335
30336 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
30337 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
30338
30339 @subsubheading Example
30340 @smallexample
30341 (gdb)
30342 -file-list-exec-source-files
30343 ^done,files=[
30344 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
30345 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
30346 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
30347 (gdb)
30348 @end smallexample
30349
30350 @ignore
30351 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
30352 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
30353
30354 @subsubheading Synopsis
30355
30356 @smallexample
30357 -file-list-shared-libraries
30358 @end smallexample
30359
30360 List the shared libraries in the program.
30361
30362 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30363
30364 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
30365
30366 @subsubheading Example
30367 N.A.
30368
30369
30370 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
30371 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
30372
30373 @subsubheading Synopsis
30374
30375 @smallexample
30376 -file-list-symbol-files
30377 @end smallexample
30378
30379 List symbol files.
30380
30381 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30382
30383 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
30384
30385 @subsubheading Example
30386 N.A.
30387 @end ignore
30388
30389
30390 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
30391 @findex -file-symbol-file
30392
30393 @subsubheading Synopsis
30394
30395 @smallexample
30396 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
30397 @end smallexample
30398
30399 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
30400 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
30401 produced, except for a completion notification.
30402
30403 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30404
30405 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
30406
30407 @subsubheading Example
30408
30409 @smallexample
30410 (gdb)
30411 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30412 ^done
30413 (gdb)
30414 @end smallexample
30415
30416 @ignore
30417 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30418 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
30419 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
30420
30421 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
30422
30423 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
30424
30425 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
30426
30427 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
30428
30429 @c @subheading -overlay-map
30430
30431 @c @subheading -overlay-off
30432
30433 @c @subheading -overlay-on
30434
30435 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
30436
30437 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30438 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
30439 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
30440
30441 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
30442
30443 @c @subheading -signal-handle
30444
30445 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
30446
30447 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
30448 @end ignore
30449
30450
30451 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30452 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
30453 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
30454
30455
30456 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
30457 @findex -target-attach
30458
30459 @subsubheading Synopsis
30460
30461 @smallexample
30462 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
30463 @end smallexample
30464
30465 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
30466 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
30467 group, the id previously returned by
30468 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
30469
30470 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30471
30472 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
30473
30474 @subsubheading Example
30475 @smallexample
30476 (gdb)
30477 -target-attach 34
30478 =thread-created,id="1"
30479 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
30480 ^done
30481 (gdb)
30482 @end smallexample
30483
30484 @ignore
30485 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
30486 @findex -target-compare-sections
30487
30488 @subsubheading Synopsis
30489
30490 @smallexample
30491 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
30492 @end smallexample
30493
30494 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
30495 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
30496
30497 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30498
30499 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
30500
30501 @subsubheading Example
30502 N.A.
30503 @end ignore
30504
30505
30506 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
30507 @findex -target-detach
30508
30509 @subsubheading Synopsis
30510
30511 @smallexample
30512 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
30513 @end smallexample
30514
30515 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
30516 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
30517 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
30518
30519 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30520
30521 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
30522
30523 @subsubheading Example
30524
30525 @smallexample
30526 (gdb)
30527 -target-detach
30528 ^done
30529 (gdb)
30530 @end smallexample
30531
30532
30533 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
30534 @findex -target-disconnect
30535
30536 @subsubheading Synopsis
30537
30538 @smallexample
30539 -target-disconnect
30540 @end smallexample
30541
30542 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
30543 generally not resumed.
30544
30545 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30546
30547 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
30548
30549 @subsubheading Example
30550
30551 @smallexample
30552 (gdb)
30553 -target-disconnect
30554 ^done
30555 (gdb)
30556 @end smallexample
30557
30558
30559 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
30560 @findex -target-download
30561
30562 @subsubheading Synopsis
30563
30564 @smallexample
30565 -target-download
30566 @end smallexample
30567
30568 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
30569 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
30570
30571 @table @samp
30572 @item section
30573 The name of the section.
30574 @item section-sent
30575 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
30576 @item section-size
30577 The size of the section.
30578 @item total-sent
30579 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
30580 @item total-size
30581 The size of the overall executable to download.
30582 @end table
30583
30584 @noindent
30585 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
30586 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
30587
30588 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
30589 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
30590
30591 @table @samp
30592 @item section
30593 The name of the section.
30594 @item section-size
30595 The size of the section.
30596 @item total-size
30597 The size of the overall executable to download.
30598 @end table
30599
30600 @noindent
30601 At the end, a summary is printed.
30602
30603 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30604
30605 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
30606
30607 @subsubheading Example
30608
30609 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
30610 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
30611
30612 @smallexample
30613 (gdb)
30614 -target-download
30615 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
30616 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
30617 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
30618 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
30619 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
30620 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
30621 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
30622 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
30623 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
30624 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
30625 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
30626 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
30627 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
30628 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
30629 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
30630 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
30631 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
30632 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
30633 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
30634 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
30635 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
30636 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
30637 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
30638 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
30639 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
30640 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
30641 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
30642 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30643 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
30644 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
30645 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
30646 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
30647 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
30648 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
30649 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
30650 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
30651 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
30652 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
30653 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
30654 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
30655 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
30656 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
30657 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
30658 write-rate="429"
30659 (gdb)
30660 @end smallexample
30661
30662
30663 @ignore
30664 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
30665 @findex -target-exec-status
30666
30667 @subsubheading Synopsis
30668
30669 @smallexample
30670 -target-exec-status
30671 @end smallexample
30672
30673 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
30674 not, for instance).
30675
30676 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30677
30678 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30679
30680 @subsubheading Example
30681 N.A.
30682
30683
30684 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
30685 @findex -target-list-available-targets
30686
30687 @subsubheading Synopsis
30688
30689 @smallexample
30690 -target-list-available-targets
30691 @end smallexample
30692
30693 List the possible targets to connect to.
30694
30695 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30696
30697 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
30698
30699 @subsubheading Example
30700 N.A.
30701
30702
30703 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
30704 @findex -target-list-current-targets
30705
30706 @subsubheading Synopsis
30707
30708 @smallexample
30709 -target-list-current-targets
30710 @end smallexample
30711
30712 Describe the current target.
30713
30714 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30715
30716 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
30717 other things).
30718
30719 @subsubheading Example
30720 N.A.
30721
30722
30723 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
30724 @findex -target-list-parameters
30725
30726 @subsubheading Synopsis
30727
30728 @smallexample
30729 -target-list-parameters
30730 @end smallexample
30731
30732 @c ????
30733 @end ignore
30734
30735 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30736
30737 No equivalent.
30738
30739 @subsubheading Example
30740 N.A.
30741
30742
30743 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
30744 @findex -target-select
30745
30746 @subsubheading Synopsis
30747
30748 @smallexample
30749 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
30750 @end smallexample
30751
30752 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
30753
30754 @table @samp
30755 @item @var{type}
30756 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
30757 @item @var{parameters}
30758 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
30759 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
30760 @end table
30761
30762 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
30763 which the target program is, in the following form:
30764
30765 @smallexample
30766 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
30767 args=[@var{arg list}]
30768 @end smallexample
30769
30770 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30771
30772 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
30773
30774 @subsubheading Example
30775
30776 @smallexample
30777 (gdb)
30778 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
30779 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
30780 (gdb)
30781 @end smallexample
30782
30783 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30784 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
30785 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
30786
30787
30788 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
30789 @findex -target-file-put
30790
30791 @subsubheading Synopsis
30792
30793 @smallexample
30794 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
30795 @end smallexample
30796
30797 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
30798 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
30799
30800 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30801
30802 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
30803
30804 @subsubheading Example
30805
30806 @smallexample
30807 (gdb)
30808 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
30809 ^done
30810 (gdb)
30811 @end smallexample
30812
30813
30814 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
30815 @findex -target-file-get
30816
30817 @subsubheading Synopsis
30818
30819 @smallexample
30820 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
30821 @end smallexample
30822
30823 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
30824 on the host system.
30825
30826 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30827
30828 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
30829
30830 @subsubheading Example
30831
30832 @smallexample
30833 (gdb)
30834 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
30835 ^done
30836 (gdb)
30837 @end smallexample
30838
30839
30840 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
30841 @findex -target-file-delete
30842
30843 @subsubheading Synopsis
30844
30845 @smallexample
30846 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
30847 @end smallexample
30848
30849 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
30850
30851 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30852
30853 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
30854
30855 @subsubheading Example
30856
30857 @smallexample
30858 (gdb)
30859 -target-file-delete remotefile
30860 ^done
30861 (gdb)
30862 @end smallexample
30863
30864
30865 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30866 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
30867 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
30868
30869 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
30870
30871 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
30872 @findex -gdb-exit
30873
30874 @subsubheading Synopsis
30875
30876 @smallexample
30877 -gdb-exit
30878 @end smallexample
30879
30880 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
30881
30882 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30883
30884 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
30885
30886 @subsubheading Example
30887
30888 @smallexample
30889 (gdb)
30890 -gdb-exit
30891 ^exit
30892 @end smallexample
30893
30894
30895 @ignore
30896 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
30897 @findex -exec-abort
30898
30899 @subsubheading Synopsis
30900
30901 @smallexample
30902 -exec-abort
30903 @end smallexample
30904
30905 Kill the inferior running program.
30906
30907 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30908
30909 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
30910
30911 @subsubheading Example
30912 N.A.
30913 @end ignore
30914
30915
30916 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
30917 @findex -gdb-set
30918
30919 @subsubheading Synopsis
30920
30921 @smallexample
30922 -gdb-set
30923 @end smallexample
30924
30925 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
30926 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
30927
30928 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30929
30930 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
30931
30932 @subsubheading Example
30933
30934 @smallexample
30935 (gdb)
30936 -gdb-set $foo=3
30937 ^done
30938 (gdb)
30939 @end smallexample
30940
30941
30942 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
30943 @findex -gdb-show
30944
30945 @subsubheading Synopsis
30946
30947 @smallexample
30948 -gdb-show
30949 @end smallexample
30950
30951 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
30952
30953 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30954
30955 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
30956
30957 @subsubheading Example
30958
30959 @smallexample
30960 (gdb)
30961 -gdb-show annotate
30962 ^done,value="0"
30963 (gdb)
30964 @end smallexample
30965
30966 @c @subheading -gdb-source
30967
30968
30969 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
30970 @findex -gdb-version
30971
30972 @subsubheading Synopsis
30973
30974 @smallexample
30975 -gdb-version
30976 @end smallexample
30977
30978 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
30979
30980 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30981
30982 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
30983 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
30984
30985 @subsubheading Example
30986
30987 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
30988 @c box in TeX.
30989 @smallexample
30990 (gdb)
30991 -gdb-version
30992 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
30993 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
30994 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
30995 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
30996 ~ certain conditions.
30997 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
30998 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
30999 ~ details.
31000 ~This GDB was configured as
31001 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31002 ^done
31003 (gdb)
31004 @end smallexample
31005
31006 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
31007 @findex -list-features
31008
31009 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
31010 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
31011 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
31012 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
31013 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
31014 startup.
31015
31016 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
31017 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
31018 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
31019 is given below.
31020
31021 Example output:
31022
31023 @smallexample
31024 (gdb) -list-features
31025 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
31026 @end smallexample
31027
31028 The current list of features is:
31029
31030 @table @samp
31031 @item frozen-varobjs
31032 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
31033 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
31034 of @code{-varobj-create}.
31035 @item pending-breakpoints
31036 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
31037 command.
31038 @item python
31039 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
31040 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
31041 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
31042 @item thread-info
31043 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
31044 @item data-read-memory-bytes
31045 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
31046 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
31047 @item breakpoint-notifications
31048 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
31049 CLI will be announced via async records.
31050 @item ada-task-info
31051 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
31052 @end table
31053
31054 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
31055 @findex -list-target-features
31056
31057 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
31058 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
31059 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
31060 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
31061 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
31062 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
31063 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
31064 Example output:
31065
31066 @smallexample
31067 (gdb) -list-features
31068 ^done,result=["async"]
31069 @end smallexample
31070
31071 The current list of features is:
31072
31073 @table @samp
31074 @item async
31075 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
31076 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
31077 while the target is running.
31078
31079 @item reverse
31080 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
31081 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31082
31083 @end table
31084
31085 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31086 @findex -list-thread-groups
31087
31088 @subheading Synopsis
31089
31090 @smallexample
31091 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31092 @end smallexample
31093
31094 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31095 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31096 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31097 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31098 top-level thread groups.
31099
31100 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31101 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31102 available on the target.
31103
31104 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31105 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31106 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31107 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31108 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31109 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31110 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31111 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31112
31113 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31114 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31115 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31116 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31117 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31118 @samp{threads} field.
31119
31120 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31121 the following caveats:
31122
31123 @itemize @bullet
31124 @item
31125 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31126 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31127 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31128
31129 @item
31130 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31131 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
31132 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
31133 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
31134 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
31135 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
31136
31137 @end itemize
31138
31139 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
31140 have the following fields:
31141
31142 @table @code
31143 @item id
31144 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
31145 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
31146 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
31147
31148 @item type
31149 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
31150 valid type.
31151
31152 @item pid
31153 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
31154 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
31155
31156 @item num_children
31157 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
31158 absent for an available thread group.
31159
31160 @item threads
31161 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
31162 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
31163 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
31164
31165 @item cores
31166 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
31167 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
31168 such information is not available.
31169
31170 @item executable
31171 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
31172 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
31173 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
31174
31175 @end table
31176
31177 @subheading Example
31178
31179 @smallexample
31180 @value{GDBP}
31181 -list-thread-groups
31182 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
31183 -list-thread-groups 17
31184 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31185 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
31186 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31187 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31188 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
31189 -list-thread-groups --available
31190 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
31191 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
31192 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31193 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31194 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
31195 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
31196 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31197 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31198 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
31199 @end smallexample
31200
31201
31202 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
31203 @findex -add-inferior
31204
31205 @subheading Synopsis
31206
31207 @smallexample
31208 -add-inferior
31209 @end smallexample
31210
31211 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
31212 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
31213 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
31214 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
31215 field, @samp{thread-group}, whose value is the identifier of the
31216 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
31217
31218 @subheading Example
31219
31220 @smallexample
31221 @value{GDBP}
31222 -add-inferior
31223 ^done,thread-group="i3"
31224 @end smallexample
31225
31226 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
31227 @findex -interpreter-exec
31228
31229 @subheading Synopsis
31230
31231 @smallexample
31232 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
31233 @end smallexample
31234 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
31235
31236 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
31237
31238 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31239
31240 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
31241
31242 @subheading Example
31243
31244 @smallexample
31245 (gdb)
31246 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
31247 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
31248 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
31249 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
31250 ^done
31251 (gdb)
31252 @end smallexample
31253
31254 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
31255 @findex -inferior-tty-set
31256
31257 @subheading Synopsis
31258
31259 @smallexample
31260 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31261 @end smallexample
31262
31263 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
31264
31265 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31266
31267 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
31268
31269 @subheading Example
31270
31271 @smallexample
31272 (gdb)
31273 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31274 ^done
31275 (gdb)
31276 @end smallexample
31277
31278 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
31279 @findex -inferior-tty-show
31280
31281 @subheading Synopsis
31282
31283 @smallexample
31284 -inferior-tty-show
31285 @end smallexample
31286
31287 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
31288
31289 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31290
31291 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
31292
31293 @subheading Example
31294
31295 @smallexample
31296 (gdb)
31297 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
31298 ^done
31299 (gdb)
31300 -inferior-tty-show
31301 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
31302 (gdb)
31303 @end smallexample
31304
31305 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
31306 @findex -enable-timings
31307
31308 @subheading Synopsis
31309
31310 @smallexample
31311 -enable-timings [yes | no]
31312 @end smallexample
31313
31314 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
31315 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
31316 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
31317 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
31318
31319 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31320
31321 No equivalent.
31322
31323 @subheading Example
31324
31325 @smallexample
31326 (gdb)
31327 -enable-timings
31328 ^done
31329 (gdb)
31330 -break-insert main
31331 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
31332 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
31333 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
31334 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
31335 (gdb)
31336 -enable-timings no
31337 ^done
31338 (gdb)
31339 -exec-run
31340 ^running
31341 (gdb)
31342 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
31343 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
31344 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
31345 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
31346 (gdb)
31347 @end smallexample
31348
31349 @node Annotations
31350 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
31351
31352 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
31353 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
31354 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
31355 relatively high level.
31356
31357 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
31358 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
31359
31360 @ignore
31361 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
31362 @end ignore
31363
31364 @menu
31365 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
31366 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
31367 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
31368 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
31369 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
31370 * Annotations for Running::
31371 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
31372 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
31373 @end menu
31374
31375 @node Annotations Overview
31376 @section What is an Annotation?
31377 @cindex annotations
31378
31379 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
31380 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
31381 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
31382 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
31383 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
31384 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
31385 cannot contain newline characters.
31386
31387 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
31388 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
31389 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
31390 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
31391 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
31392 means those three characters as output.
31393
31394 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
31395 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
31396 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
31397 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
31398 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
31399 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
31400 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
31401 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
31402 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
31403
31404 @table @code
31405 @kindex set annotate
31406 @item set annotate @var{level}
31407 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
31408 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
31409
31410 @item show annotate
31411 @kindex show annotate
31412 Show the current annotation level.
31413 @end table
31414
31415 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
31416
31417 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
31418
31419 @smallexample
31420 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
31421 GNU gdb 6.0
31422 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31423 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
31424 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
31425 under certain conditions.
31426 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31427 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
31428 for details.
31429 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
31430
31431 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31432 (@value{GDBP})
31433 ^Z^Zprompt
31434 @kbd{quit}
31435
31436 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31437 $
31438 @end smallexample
31439
31440 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
31441 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
31442 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
31443 output from @value{GDBN}.
31444
31445 @node Server Prefix
31446 @section The Server Prefix
31447 @cindex server prefix
31448
31449 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
31450 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
31451 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
31452 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
31453 a transparent manner.
31454
31455 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
31456 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
31457 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
31458 @code{print} command.
31459
31460 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
31461 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
31462
31463 @node Prompting
31464 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
31465
31466 @cindex annotations for prompts
31467 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
31468 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
31469 over, etc.
31470
31471 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
31472 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
31473 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
31474 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
31475 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
31476 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
31477 features the following annotations:
31478
31479 @smallexample
31480 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
31481 ^Z^Zprompt
31482 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
31483 @end smallexample
31484
31485 The input types are
31486
31487 @table @code
31488 @findex pre-prompt annotation
31489 @findex prompt annotation
31490 @findex post-prompt annotation
31491 @item prompt
31492 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
31493
31494 @findex pre-commands annotation
31495 @findex commands annotation
31496 @findex post-commands annotation
31497 @item commands
31498 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
31499 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
31500
31501 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
31502 @findex overload-choice annotation
31503 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
31504 @item overload-choice
31505 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
31506
31507 @findex pre-query annotation
31508 @findex query annotation
31509 @findex post-query annotation
31510 @item query
31511 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
31512
31513 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
31514 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
31515 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
31516 @item prompt-for-continue
31517 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
31518 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
31519 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
31520 presence of annotations.
31521 @end table
31522
31523 @node Errors
31524 @section Errors
31525 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
31526
31527 @findex quit annotation
31528 @smallexample
31529 ^Z^Zquit
31530 @end smallexample
31531
31532 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
31533
31534 @findex error annotation
31535 @smallexample
31536 ^Z^Zerror
31537 @end smallexample
31538
31539 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
31540
31541 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
31542 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
31543 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
31544 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
31545 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
31546 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
31547 to the top level.
31548
31549 @findex error-begin annotation
31550 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
31551
31552 @smallexample
31553 ^Z^Zerror-begin
31554 @end smallexample
31555
31556 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
31557 message.
31558
31559 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
31560 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
31561 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
31562
31563 @node Invalidation
31564 @section Invalidation Notices
31565
31566 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
31567 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
31568 changed.
31569
31570 @table @code
31571 @findex frames-invalid annotation
31572 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
31573
31574 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
31575 have changed.
31576
31577 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
31578 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
31579
31580 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
31581 deleted a breakpoint.
31582 @end table
31583
31584 @node Annotations for Running
31585 @section Running the Program
31586 @cindex annotations for running programs
31587
31588 @findex starting annotation
31589 @findex stopping annotation
31590 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
31591 @code{step} or @code{continue},
31592
31593 @smallexample
31594 ^Z^Zstarting
31595 @end smallexample
31596
31597 is output. When the program stops,
31598
31599 @smallexample
31600 ^Z^Zstopped
31601 @end smallexample
31602
31603 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
31604 annotations describe how the program stopped.
31605
31606 @table @code
31607 @findex exited annotation
31608 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
31609 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
31610 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
31611
31612 @findex signalled annotation
31613 @findex signal-name annotation
31614 @findex signal-name-end annotation
31615 @findex signal-string annotation
31616 @findex signal-string-end annotation
31617 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
31618 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
31619 annotation continues:
31620
31621 @smallexample
31622 @var{intro-text}
31623 ^Z^Zsignal-name
31624 @var{name}
31625 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
31626 @var{middle-text}
31627 ^Z^Zsignal-string
31628 @var{string}
31629 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
31630 @var{end-text}
31631 @end smallexample
31632
31633 @noindent
31634 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
31635 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
31636 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
31637 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
31638 user's benefit and have no particular format.
31639
31640 @findex signal annotation
31641 @item ^Z^Zsignal
31642 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
31643 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
31644 terminated with it.
31645
31646 @findex breakpoint annotation
31647 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
31648 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
31649
31650 @findex watchpoint annotation
31651 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
31652 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
31653 @end table
31654
31655 @node Source Annotations
31656 @section Displaying Source
31657 @cindex annotations for source display
31658
31659 @findex source annotation
31660 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
31661
31662 @smallexample
31663 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
31664 @end smallexample
31665
31666 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
31667 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
31668 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
31669 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
31670 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
31671 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
31672 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
31673 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
31674 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
31675 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
31676 depend on the language).
31677
31678 @node JIT Interface
31679 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
31680 @cindex just-in-time compilation
31681 @cindex JIT compilation interface
31682
31683 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
31684 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
31685 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
31686 performance while maintaining platform independence.
31687
31688 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
31689 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
31690 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
31691 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
31692 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
31693 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
31694
31695 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
31696 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
31697 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
31698 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
31699 LLVM JIT.
31700
31701 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
31702 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
31703 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
31704 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
31705 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
31706 out about additional code.
31707
31708 @menu
31709 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
31710 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
31711 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
31712 @end menu
31713
31714 @node Declarations
31715 @section JIT Declarations
31716
31717 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
31718 implement the interface:
31719
31720 @smallexample
31721 typedef enum
31722 @{
31723 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
31724 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
31725 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
31726 @} jit_actions_t;
31727
31728 struct jit_code_entry
31729 @{
31730 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
31731 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
31732 const char *symfile_addr;
31733 uint64_t symfile_size;
31734 @};
31735
31736 struct jit_descriptor
31737 @{
31738 uint32_t version;
31739 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
31740 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
31741 uint32_t action_flag;
31742 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
31743 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
31744 @};
31745
31746 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
31747 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
31748
31749 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
31750 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
31751 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
31752 @end smallexample
31753
31754 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
31755 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
31756 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
31757
31758 @node Registering Code
31759 @section Registering Code
31760
31761 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
31762
31763 @itemize @bullet
31764 @item
31765 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
31766 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
31767
31768 @item
31769 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
31770 file.
31771
31772 @item
31773 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
31774
31775 @item
31776 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
31777
31778 @item
31779 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
31780 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
31781 @end itemize
31782
31783 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
31784 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
31785 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
31786 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
31787
31788 @node Unregistering Code
31789 @section Unregistering Code
31790
31791 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
31792
31793 @itemize @bullet
31794 @item
31795 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
31796
31797 @item
31798 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
31799
31800 @item
31801 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
31802 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
31803 @end itemize
31804
31805 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
31806 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
31807
31808 @node GDB Bugs
31809 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
31810 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
31811 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
31812
31813 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
31814
31815 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
31816 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
31817 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
31818 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
31819
31820 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
31821 information that enables us to fix the bug.
31822
31823 @menu
31824 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
31825 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
31826 @end menu
31827
31828 @node Bug Criteria
31829 @section Have You Found a Bug?
31830 @cindex bug criteria
31831
31832 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
31833
31834 @itemize @bullet
31835 @cindex fatal signal
31836 @cindex debugger crash
31837 @cindex crash of debugger
31838 @item
31839 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
31840 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
31841
31842 @cindex error on valid input
31843 @item
31844 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
31845 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
31846 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
31847
31848 @cindex invalid input
31849 @item
31850 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
31851 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
31852 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
31853 for traditional practice''.
31854
31855 @item
31856 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
31857 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
31858 @end itemize
31859
31860 @node Bug Reporting
31861 @section How to Report Bugs
31862 @cindex bug reports
31863 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
31864
31865 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
31866 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
31867 contact that organization first.
31868
31869 You can find contact information for many support companies and
31870 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
31871 distribution.
31872 @c should add a web page ref...
31873
31874 @ifset BUGURL
31875 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
31876 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
31877 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
31878 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
31879 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
31880 be used.
31881
31882 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
31883 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
31884 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
31885 @samp{bug-gdb}.
31886
31887 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
31888 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
31889 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
31890 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
31891 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
31892 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
31893 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
31894 bug reports to the mailing list.
31895 @end ifset
31896 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
31897 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
31898 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
31899 @end ifclear
31900 @end ifset
31901
31902 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
31903 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
31904 fact or leave it out, state it!
31905
31906 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
31907 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
31908 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
31909 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
31910 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
31911 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
31912 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
31913 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
31914 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
31915
31916 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
31917 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
31918 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
31919 self-contained.
31920
31921 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
31922 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
31923 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
31924 bugs properly.
31925
31926 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
31927
31928 @itemize @bullet
31929 @item
31930 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
31931 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
31932 version}.
31933
31934 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
31935 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
31936
31937 @item
31938 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
31939 version number.
31940
31941 @item
31942 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
31943 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
31944
31945 @item
31946 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
31947 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
31948 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
31949 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
31950 those compilers.
31951
31952 @item
31953 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
31954 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
31955 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
31956 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
31957
31958 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
31959 and then we might not encounter the bug.
31960
31961 @item
31962 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
31963 reproduce the bug.
31964
31965 @item
31966 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
31967 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
31968
31969 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
31970 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
31971 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
31972 a chance to make a mistake.
31973
31974 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
31975 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
31976 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
31977 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
31978 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
31979 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
31980 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
31981 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
31982
31983 @pindex script
31984 @cindex recording a session script
31985 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
31986 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
31987 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
31988 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
31989
31990 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
31991 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
31992
31993 @item
31994 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
31995 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
31996 it by context, not by line number.
31997
31998 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
31999 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
32000
32001 @end itemize
32002
32003 Here are some things that are not necessary:
32004
32005 @itemize @bullet
32006 @item
32007 A description of the envelope of the bug.
32008
32009 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
32010 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
32011 changes will not affect it.
32012
32013 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
32014 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
32015 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
32016 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
32017
32018 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
32019 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
32020 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
32021 less time, and so on.
32022
32023 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
32024 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
32025
32026 @item
32027 A patch for the bug.
32028
32029 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
32030 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
32031 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
32032 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
32033
32034 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
32035 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
32036 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
32037 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
32038
32039 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
32040 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
32041 help us to understand.
32042
32043 @item
32044 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
32045
32046 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
32047 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
32048 @end itemize
32049
32050 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
32051 @c and consists of the two following files:
32052 @c rluser.texi
32053 @c hsuser.texi
32054 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
32055 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
32056 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
32057 @include rluser.texi
32058 @include hsuser.texi
32059 @end ifclear
32060
32061 @node In Memoriam
32062 @appendix In Memoriam
32063
32064 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
32065 contributors:
32066
32067 @table @code
32068 @item Fred Fish
32069 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
32070 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
32071 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
32072
32073 @item Michael Snyder
32074 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
32075 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
32076 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
32077 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
32078 @end table
32079
32080 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
32081 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
32082
32083 @node Formatting Documentation
32084 @appendix Formatting Documentation
32085
32086 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
32087 @cindex reference card
32088 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
32089 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
32090 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
32091 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
32092 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
32093 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
32094
32095 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
32096 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
32097
32098 @smallexample
32099 make refcard.dvi
32100 @end smallexample
32101
32102 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
32103 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
32104 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
32105 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
32106 your @sc{dvi} output program.
32107
32108 @cindex documentation
32109
32110 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
32111 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
32112 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
32113 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
32114 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
32115 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
32116
32117 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
32118 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
32119 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
32120 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
32121 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
32122 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
32123 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
32124 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
32125
32126 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
32127 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
32128 @code{makeinfo}.
32129
32130 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
32131 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
32132 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
32133
32134 @smallexample
32135 cd gdb
32136 make gdb.info
32137 @end smallexample
32138
32139 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
32140 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
32141 Texinfo definitions file.
32142
32143 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
32144 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
32145 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
32146 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
32147 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
32148 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
32149 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
32150
32151 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
32152 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
32153 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
32154 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
32155 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
32156 directory.
32157
32158 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
32159 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
32160 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
32161 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
32162
32163 @smallexample
32164 make gdb.dvi
32165 @end smallexample
32166
32167 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
32168
32169 @node Installing GDB
32170 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
32171 @cindex installation
32172
32173 @menu
32174 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
32175 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
32176 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
32177 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
32178 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
32179 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
32180 @end menu
32181
32182 @node Requirements
32183 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
32184 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
32185
32186 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
32187 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
32188
32189 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
32190 @table @asis
32191 @item ISO C90 compiler
32192 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
32193 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
32194
32195 @end table
32196
32197 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
32198 @table @asis
32199 @item Expat
32200 @anchor{Expat}
32201 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
32202 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
32203 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
32204 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
32205 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
32206 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
32207
32208 Expat is used for:
32209
32210 @itemize @bullet
32211 @item
32212 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
32213 @item
32214 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
32215 @item
32216 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
32217 @item
32218 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
32219 @item
32220 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
32221 @end itemize
32222
32223 @item zlib
32224 @cindex compressed debug sections
32225 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
32226 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
32227 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
32228 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
32229 information in such binaries.
32230
32231 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
32232 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
32233 @url{http://zlib.net}.
32234
32235 @item iconv
32236 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
32237 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
32238 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
32239 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
32240
32241 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
32242 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
32243 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
32244 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
32245
32246 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
32247 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
32248 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
32249
32250 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
32251 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
32252 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
32253 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
32254 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
32255 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
32256 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
32257 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
32258 @end table
32259
32260 @node Running Configure
32261 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
32262 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
32263 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
32264 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
32265 build the @code{gdb} program.
32266 @iftex
32267 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
32268 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
32269 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
32270 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
32271 @end iftex
32272
32273 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
32274 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
32275 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
32276
32277 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
32278 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
32279
32280 @table @code
32281 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
32282 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
32283
32284 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
32285 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
32286
32287 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
32288 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
32289
32290 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
32291 @sc{gnu} include files
32292
32293 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
32294 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
32295
32296 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
32297 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
32298
32299 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
32300 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
32301
32302 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
32303 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
32304
32305 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
32306 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
32307 @end table
32308
32309 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
32310 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
32311 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
32312
32313 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
32314 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
32315 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
32316 argument.
32317
32318 For example:
32319
32320 @smallexample
32321 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32322 ./configure @var{host}
32323 make
32324 @end smallexample
32325
32326 @noindent
32327 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
32328 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
32329 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
32330 correct value by examining your system.)
32331
32332 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
32333 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
32334 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
32335 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
32336
32337 @need 750
32338 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
32339 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
32340 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
32341
32342 @smallexample
32343 sh configure @var{host}
32344 @end smallexample
32345
32346 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
32347 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
32348 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
32349 @file{configure}
32350 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
32351 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
32352
32353 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
32354 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
32355 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
32356 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
32357 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
32358 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
32359 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
32360 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
32361 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32362
32363 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
32364 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
32365 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
32366 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
32367 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
32368
32369 @node Separate Objdir
32370 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
32371
32372 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
32373 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
32374 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
32375 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
32376 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
32377 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
32378 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
32379 program specified there.
32380
32381 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
32382 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
32383 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
32384 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
32385 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
32386 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
32387
32388 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
32389 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
32390
32391 @smallexample
32392 @group
32393 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
32394 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
32395 cd ../gdb-sun4
32396 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
32397 make
32398 @end group
32399 @end smallexample
32400
32401 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
32402 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
32403 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
32404 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
32405 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
32406 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
32407
32408 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
32409 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
32410 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
32411 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
32412 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
32413
32414 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
32415 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
32416 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
32417 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
32418 You specify a cross-debugging target by
32419 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
32420
32421 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
32422 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
32423 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
32424
32425 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
32426 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
32427 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
32428 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
32429 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
32430
32431 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
32432 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
32433 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
32434 with each other.
32435
32436 @node Config Names
32437 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
32438
32439 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
32440 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
32441 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
32442 of information in the following pattern:
32443
32444 @smallexample
32445 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
32446 @end smallexample
32447
32448 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
32449 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
32450 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
32451
32452 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
32453 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
32454 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
32455 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
32456 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
32457 abbreviations---for example:
32458
32459 @smallexample
32460 % sh config.sub i386-linux
32461 i386-pc-linux-gnu
32462 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
32463 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
32464 % sh config.sub hp9k700
32465 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
32466 % sh config.sub sun4
32467 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
32468 % sh config.sub sun3
32469 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
32470 % sh config.sub i986v
32471 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
32472 @end smallexample
32473
32474 @noindent
32475 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
32476 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
32477
32478 @node Configure Options
32479 @section @file{configure} Options
32480
32481 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
32482 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
32483 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
32484 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
32485
32486 @smallexample
32487 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
32488 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
32489 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
32490 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
32491 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
32492 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
32493 @var{host}
32494 @end smallexample
32495
32496 @noindent
32497 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
32498 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
32499 @samp{--}.
32500
32501 @table @code
32502 @item --help
32503 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
32504
32505 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
32506 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
32507 @file{@var{dir}}.
32508
32509 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
32510 Configure the source to install programs under directory
32511 @file{@var{dir}}.
32512
32513 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
32514 @need 2000
32515 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
32516 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
32517 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
32518 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
32519 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
32520 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
32521 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
32522 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
32523 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
32524 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
32525 @var{dirname}.
32526
32527 @item --norecursion
32528 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
32529 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
32530
32531 @item --target=@var{target}
32532 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
32533 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
32534 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
32535
32536 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
32537
32538 @item @var{host} @dots{}
32539 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
32540
32541 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
32542 @end table
32543
32544 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
32545 needed for special purposes only.
32546
32547 @node System-wide configuration
32548 @section System-wide configuration and settings
32549 @cindex system-wide init file
32550
32551 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
32552 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
32553 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
32554
32555 Here is the corresponding configure option:
32556
32557 @table @code
32558 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
32559 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
32560 @var{file}.
32561 @end table
32562
32563 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
32564 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
32565
32566 @itemize @bullet
32567 @item
32568 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
32569 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
32570 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
32571 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
32572 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
32573 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
32574
32575 @item
32576 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
32577 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
32578 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
32579 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
32580 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
32581 @end itemize
32582
32583 @node Maintenance Commands
32584 @appendix Maintenance Commands
32585 @cindex maintenance commands
32586 @cindex internal commands
32587
32588 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
32589 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
32590 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
32591 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
32592 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
32593
32594 @table @code
32595 @kindex maint agent
32596 @kindex maint agent-eval
32597 @item maint agent @var{expression}
32598 @itemx maint agent-eval @var{expression}
32599 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
32600 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
32601 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
32602 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
32603 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
32604 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
32605 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
32606 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
32607 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
32608 addition and return the sum.
32609
32610 @kindex maint info breakpoints
32611 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
32612 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
32613 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
32614 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
32615 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
32616 is shown:
32617
32618 @table @code
32619 @item breakpoint
32620 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
32621
32622 @item watchpoint
32623 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
32624
32625 @item longjmp
32626 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
32627 @code{longjmp} calls.
32628
32629 @item longjmp resume
32630 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
32631
32632 @item until
32633 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
32634
32635 @item finish
32636 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
32637
32638 @item shlib events
32639 Shared library events.
32640
32641 @end table
32642
32643 @kindex set displaced-stepping
32644 @kindex show displaced-stepping
32645 @cindex displaced stepping support
32646 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
32647 @item set displaced-stepping
32648 @itemx show displaced-stepping
32649 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
32650 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
32651 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
32652 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
32653 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
32654
32655 @table @code
32656 @item set displaced-stepping on
32657 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
32658 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
32659
32660 @item set displaced-stepping off
32661 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
32662 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
32663
32664 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
32665 @item set displaced-stepping auto
32666 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
32667 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
32668 architecture supports displaced stepping.
32669 @end table
32670
32671 @kindex maint check-symtabs
32672 @item maint check-symtabs
32673 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
32674
32675 @kindex maint cplus first_component
32676 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
32677 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
32678
32679 @kindex maint cplus namespace
32680 @item maint cplus namespace
32681 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
32682
32683 @kindex maint demangle
32684 @item maint demangle @var{name}
32685 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
32686
32687 @kindex maint deprecate
32688 @kindex maint undeprecate
32689 @cindex deprecated commands
32690 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
32691 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
32692 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
32693 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
32694 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
32695 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
32696 the replacement as part of the warning.
32697
32698 @kindex maint dump-me
32699 @item maint dump-me
32700 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
32701 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
32702 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
32703 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
32704
32705 @kindex maint internal-error
32706 @kindex maint internal-warning
32707 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
32708 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
32709 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
32710 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
32711 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
32712 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
32713 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
32714 @value{GDBN} session.
32715
32716 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
32717 used as the text of the error or warning message.
32718
32719 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
32720
32721 @smallexample
32722 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
32723 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
32724 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
32725 debugging may prove unreliable.
32726 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
32727 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
32728 (@value{GDBP})
32729 @end smallexample
32730
32731 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
32732 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
32733
32734 @kindex maint set internal-error
32735 @kindex maint show internal-error
32736 @kindex maint set internal-warning
32737 @kindex maint show internal-warning
32738 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
32739 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
32740 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
32741 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
32742 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
32743 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
32744 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
32745 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
32746 described in the table below.
32747
32748 @table @samp
32749 @item quit
32750 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
32751 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
32752
32753 @item corefile
32754 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
32755 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
32756 @end table
32757
32758 @kindex maint packet
32759 @item maint packet @var{text}
32760 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
32761 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
32762 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
32763 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
32764 checksum.
32765
32766 @kindex maint print architecture
32767 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
32768 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
32769 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
32770
32771 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
32772 @item maint print c-tdesc
32773 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
32774 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
32775 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
32776
32777 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
32778 @item maint print dummy-frames
32779 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
32780
32781 @smallexample
32782 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
32783 @dots{}
32784 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
32785 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
32786 58 return (a + b);
32787 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
32788 @dots{}
32789 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
32790 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
32791 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
32792 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
32793 (@value{GDBP})
32794 @end smallexample
32795
32796 Takes an optional file parameter.
32797
32798 @kindex maint print registers
32799 @kindex maint print raw-registers
32800 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
32801 @kindex maint print register-groups
32802 @kindex maint print remote-registers
32803 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
32804 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
32805 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
32806 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
32807 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
32808 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
32809
32810 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
32811 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
32812 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
32813 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
32814 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
32815 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
32816 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
32817 and offsets in the `G' packets. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
32818 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
32819
32820 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
32821 write the information.
32822
32823 @kindex maint print reggroups
32824 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
32825 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
32826 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
32827 information.
32828
32829 The register groups info looks like this:
32830
32831 @smallexample
32832 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
32833 Group Type
32834 general user
32835 float user
32836 all user
32837 vector user
32838 system user
32839 save internal
32840 restore internal
32841 @end smallexample
32842
32843 @kindex flushregs
32844 @item flushregs
32845 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
32846
32847 @kindex maint print objfiles
32848 @cindex info for known object files
32849 @item maint print objfiles
32850 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
32851 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
32852 and symtabs.
32853
32854 @kindex maint print section-scripts
32855 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
32856 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
32857 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
32858 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
32859 matching @var{regexp}.
32860 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
32861 and the full path if known.
32862 @xref{.debug_gdb_scripts section}.
32863
32864 @kindex maint print statistics
32865 @cindex bcache statistics
32866 @item maint print statistics
32867 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
32868 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
32869 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
32870 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
32871 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
32872 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
32873 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
32874 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
32875 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
32876 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
32877 lengths.
32878
32879 @kindex maint print target-stack
32880 @cindex target stack description
32881 @item maint print target-stack
32882 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
32883 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
32884 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
32885 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
32886 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
32887 address.
32888
32889 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
32890 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
32891
32892 @kindex maint print type
32893 @cindex type chain of a data type
32894 @item maint print type @var{expr}
32895 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
32896 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
32897 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
32898 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
32899 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
32900
32901 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
32902 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
32903 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
32904 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
32905 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
32906 information.
32907
32908 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
32909 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
32910 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
32911 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
32912 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
32913 always see the disassembly form.
32914
32915 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
32916
32917 @smallexample
32918 (gdb) info addr argc
32919 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
32920 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
32921 @end smallexample
32922
32923 For more information on these expressions, see
32924 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
32925
32926 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
32927 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
32928 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
32929 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
32930 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
32931
32932 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
32933 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
32934 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
32935 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
32936 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
32937 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
32938 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
32939 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
32940 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
32941
32942 @kindex maint set profile
32943 @kindex maint show profile
32944 @cindex profiling GDB
32945 @item maint set profile
32946 @itemx maint show profile
32947 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
32948
32949 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
32950 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
32951 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
32952 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
32953 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
32954 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
32955 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
32956
32957 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
32958 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
32959
32960 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
32961 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
32962 @cindex hardware debug registers
32963 @item maint set show-debug-regs
32964 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
32965 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
32966 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
32967 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
32968 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
32969 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
32970
32971 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
32972 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
32973 @item maint set show-all-tib
32974 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
32975 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
32976 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
32977 command.
32978
32979 @kindex maint space
32980 @cindex memory used by commands
32981 @item maint space
32982 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
32983 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
32984 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
32985 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
32986 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
32987
32988 @kindex maint time
32989 @cindex time of command execution
32990 @item maint time
32991 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
32992 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
32993 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
32994 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
32995 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
32996 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
32997 it's not possibly currently
32998 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
32999 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
33000
33001 @kindex maint translate-address
33002 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
33003 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
33004 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
33005 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
33006 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
33007 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
33008 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
33009
33010 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
33011 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
33012 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
33013
33014 @end table
33015
33016 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
33017 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
33018
33019 @table @code
33020 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
33021 @kindex set watchdog
33022 @cindex watchdog timer
33023 @cindex timeout for commands
33024 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
33025 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
33026 reports and error and the command is aborted.
33027
33028 @item show watchdog
33029 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
33030 @end table
33031
33032 @node Remote Protocol
33033 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
33034
33035 @menu
33036 * Overview::
33037 * Packets::
33038 * Stop Reply Packets::
33039 * General Query Packets::
33040 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
33041 * Tracepoint Packets::
33042 * Host I/O Packets::
33043 * Interrupts::
33044 * Notification Packets::
33045 * Remote Non-Stop::
33046 * Packet Acknowledgment::
33047 * Examples::
33048 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
33049 * Library List Format::
33050 * Memory Map Format::
33051 * Thread List Format::
33052 * Traceframe Info Format::
33053 @end menu
33054
33055 @node Overview
33056 @section Overview
33057
33058 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
33059 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
33060 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
33061 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
33062
33063 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
33064 transmitted and received data, respectively.
33065
33066 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
33067 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
33068 @cindex remote serial protocol
33069 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
33070 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
33071 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
33072 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
33073 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
33074
33075 @smallexample
33076 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33077 @end smallexample
33078 @noindent
33079
33080 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
33081 @noindent
33082 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
33083 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
33084 eight bit unsigned checksum).
33085
33086 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
33087 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
33088
33089 @smallexample
33090 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33091 @end smallexample
33092
33093 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
33094 @noindent
33095 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
33096 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
33097 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
33098
33099 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
33100 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
33101 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
33102 retransmission):
33103
33104 @smallexample
33105 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
33106 <- @code{+}
33107 @end smallexample
33108 @noindent
33109
33110 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
33111 once a connection is established.
33112 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
33113
33114 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
33115 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
33116 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
33117 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
33118 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
33119 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
33120 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
33121
33122 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
33123 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
33124 exceptions).
33125
33126 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
33127 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
33128 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
33129 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
33130
33131 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
33132 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
33133 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
33134
33135 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
33136 @anchor{Binary Data}
33137 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
33138 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
33139 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
33140 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
33141 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
33142 binary data.
33143
33144 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
33145 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
33146 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
33147 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
33148 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
33149 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
33150 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
33151 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
33152 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
33153 (described next).
33154
33155 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
33156 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
33157 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
33158 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
33159 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
33160 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
33161 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
33162 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
33163 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
33164 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
33165 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
33166 3}} more times.
33167
33168 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
33169 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
33170 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
33171 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
33172 @samp{0*"00}.
33173
33174 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
33175 error number. That number is not well defined.
33176
33177 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
33178 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
33179 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
33180 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
33181 on that response.
33182
33183 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
33184 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
33185 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
33186 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
33187 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
33188 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
33189
33190 @node Packets
33191 @section Packets
33192
33193 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
33194 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
33195 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
33196 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
33197
33198 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
33199 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
33200 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
33201 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
33202 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
33203 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
33204 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
33205 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
33206 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
33207 @var{baz}.
33208
33209 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
33210 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
33211 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
33212 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
33213 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
33214 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
33215 pick any thread.
33216
33217 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
33218 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
33219 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
33220 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
33221 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
33222 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
33223 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
33224 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
33225 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
33226 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
33227 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
33228 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
33229 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
33230
33231 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
33232 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
33233 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
33234 more information.
33235
33236 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
33237 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
33238
33239 Here are the packet descriptions.
33240
33241 @table @samp
33242
33243 @item !
33244 @cindex @samp{!} packet
33245 @anchor{extended mode}
33246 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
33247 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
33248 debugged.
33249
33250 Reply:
33251 @table @samp
33252 @item OK
33253 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
33254 @end table
33255
33256 @item ?
33257 @cindex @samp{?} packet
33258 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
33259 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
33260 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
33261
33262 Reply:
33263 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33264
33265 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
33266 @cindex @samp{A} packet
33267 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
33268 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
33269 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
33270
33271 Reply:
33272 @table @samp
33273 @item OK
33274 The arguments were set.
33275 @item E @var{NN}
33276 An error occurred.
33277 @end table
33278
33279 @item b @var{baud}
33280 @cindex @samp{b} packet
33281 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
33282 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
33283
33284 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
33285 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
33286 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
33287
33288 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
33289 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
33290 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
33291 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
33292 of view, nothing actually happened.}
33293
33294 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
33295 @cindex @samp{B} packet
33296 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
33297 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
33298
33299 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
33300 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
33301
33302 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
33303 @anchor{bc}
33304 @item bc
33305 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
33306 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33307
33308 Reply:
33309 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33310
33311 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
33312 @anchor{bs}
33313 @item bs
33314 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
33315 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33316
33317 Reply:
33318 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33319
33320 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
33321 @cindex @samp{c} packet
33322 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
33323 resume at current address.
33324
33325 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33326 packet}.
33327
33328 Reply:
33329 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33330
33331 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
33332 @cindex @samp{C} packet
33333 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
33334 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
33335
33336 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33337 packet}.
33338
33339 Reply:
33340 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33341
33342 @item d
33343 @cindex @samp{d} packet
33344 Toggle debug flag.
33345
33346 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
33347 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
33348
33349 @item D
33350 @itemx D;@var{pid}
33351 @cindex @samp{D} packet
33352 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
33353 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
33354 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
33355
33356 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
33357 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
33358 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
33359 big-endian hex string.
33360
33361 Reply:
33362 @table @samp
33363 @item OK
33364 for success
33365 @item E @var{NN}
33366 for an error
33367 @end table
33368
33369 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
33370 @cindex @samp{F} packet
33371 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
33372 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
33373 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
33374
33375 @item g
33376 @anchor{read registers packet}
33377 @cindex @samp{g} packet
33378 Read general registers.
33379
33380 Reply:
33381 @table @samp
33382 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
33383 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
33384 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
33385 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
33386 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
33387 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
33388 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
33389
33390 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
33391 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
33392 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
33393 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
33394 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
33395 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
33396 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
33397 have been collected, and both have zero value:
33398
33399 @smallexample
33400 -> @code{g}
33401 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
33402 @end smallexample
33403
33404 @item E @var{NN}
33405 for an error.
33406 @end table
33407
33408 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
33409 @cindex @samp{G} packet
33410 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
33411 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
33412
33413 Reply:
33414 @table @samp
33415 @item OK
33416 for success
33417 @item E @var{NN}
33418 for an error
33419 @end table
33420
33421 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
33422 @cindex @samp{H} packet
33423 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
33424 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{op} depends on the operation to be performed:
33425 it should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
33426 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
33427 option), @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
33428 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
33429 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
33430
33431 Reply:
33432 @table @samp
33433 @item OK
33434 for success
33435 @item E @var{NN}
33436 for an error
33437 @end table
33438
33439 @c FIXME: JTC:
33440 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
33441 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
33442 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
33443 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
33444 @c described. For example:
33445 @c
33446 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
33447 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
33448 @c otherwise returns current registers.
33449 @c
33450 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
33451 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
33452 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
33453
33454 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
33455 @anchor{cycle step packet}
33456 @cindex @samp{i} packet
33457 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
33458 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
33459 step starting at that address.
33460
33461 @item I
33462 @cindex @samp{I} packet
33463 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
33464 step packet}.
33465
33466 @item k
33467 @cindex @samp{k} packet
33468 Kill request.
33469
33470 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
33471 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
33472 thread?)}.
33473
33474 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
33475 @cindex @samp{m} packet
33476 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
33477 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
33478
33479 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
33480 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
33481 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
33482 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
33483 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
33484 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
33485 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
33486 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
33487
33488 Reply:
33489 @table @samp
33490 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
33491 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
33492 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
33493 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
33494 @item E @var{NN}
33495 @var{NN} is errno
33496 @end table
33497
33498 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
33499 @cindex @samp{M} packet
33500 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
33501 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
33502 hexadecimal number.
33503
33504 Reply:
33505 @table @samp
33506 @item OK
33507 for success
33508 @item E @var{NN}
33509 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
33510 written).
33511 @end table
33512
33513 @item p @var{n}
33514 @cindex @samp{p} packet
33515 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
33516 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
33517 register value is encoded.
33518
33519 Reply:
33520 @table @samp
33521 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
33522 the register's value
33523 @item E @var{NN}
33524 for an error
33525 @item
33526 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
33527 @end table
33528
33529 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
33530 @anchor{write register packet}
33531 @cindex @samp{P} packet
33532 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
33533 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
33534 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
33535
33536 Reply:
33537 @table @samp
33538 @item OK
33539 for success
33540 @item E @var{NN}
33541 for an error
33542 @end table
33543
33544 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
33545 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
33546 @cindex @samp{q} packet
33547 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
33548 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
33549 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
33550
33551 @item r
33552 @cindex @samp{r} packet
33553 Reset the entire system.
33554
33555 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
33556
33557 @item R @var{XX}
33558 @cindex @samp{R} packet
33559 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
33560 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
33561
33562 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
33563
33564 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
33565 @cindex @samp{s} packet
33566 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
33567 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
33568
33569 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33570 packet}.
33571
33572 Reply:
33573 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33574
33575 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
33576 @anchor{step with signal packet}
33577 @cindex @samp{S} packet
33578 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
33579 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
33580
33581 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
33582 packet}.
33583
33584 Reply:
33585 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33586
33587 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
33588 @cindex @samp{t} packet
33589 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
33590 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
33591 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
33592
33593 @item T @var{thread-id}
33594 @cindex @samp{T} packet
33595 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
33596
33597 Reply:
33598 @table @samp
33599 @item OK
33600 thread is still alive
33601 @item E @var{NN}
33602 thread is dead
33603 @end table
33604
33605 @item v
33606 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
33607 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
33608
33609 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
33610 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
33611 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
33612 The process ID is a
33613 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
33614 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
33615 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
33616
33617 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
33618 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
33619 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
33620 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
33621 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
33622 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
33623 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
33624 @c stopping or restarting threads.
33625
33626 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
33627
33628 Reply:
33629 @table @samp
33630 @item E @var{nn}
33631 for an error
33632 @item @r{Any stop packet}
33633 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
33634 @item OK
33635 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
33636 @end table
33637
33638 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
33639 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
33640 @anchor{vCont packet}
33641 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
33642 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
33643 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
33644 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
33645 in their current state in non-stop mode.
33646 Specifying multiple
33647 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
33648 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
33649
33650 Currently supported actions are:
33651
33652 @table @samp
33653 @item c
33654 Continue.
33655 @item C @var{sig}
33656 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
33657 @item s
33658 Step.
33659 @item S @var{sig}
33660 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
33661 @item t
33662 Stop.
33663 @end table
33664
33665 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
33666 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
33667 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
33668
33669 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
33670 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
33671 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
33672 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
33673 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
33674 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
33675 as an implementation detail.
33676
33677 Reply:
33678 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
33679
33680 @item vCont?
33681 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
33682 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
33683
33684 Reply:
33685 @table @samp
33686 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
33687 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
33688 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
33689 @item
33690 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
33691 @end table
33692
33693 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
33694 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
33695 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
33696 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
33697
33698 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
33699 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
33700 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
33701 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
33702 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
33703 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
33704 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
33705 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
33706 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
33707 packet is received.
33708
33709 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
33710 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
33711 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
33712 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
33713 @var{thread-id}.
33714
33715 Reply:
33716 @table @samp
33717 @item OK
33718 for success
33719 @item E @var{NN}
33720 for an error
33721 @end table
33722
33723 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
33724 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
33725 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
33726 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
33727 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
33728 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
33729 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
33730 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
33731 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
33732 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
33733 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
33734 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
33735
33736
33737 Reply:
33738 @table @samp
33739 @item OK
33740 for success
33741 @item E.memtype
33742 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
33743 @item E @var{NN}
33744 for an error
33745 @end table
33746
33747 @item vFlashDone
33748 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
33749 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
33750 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
33751 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
33752 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
33753 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
33754 request is completed.
33755
33756 @item vKill;@var{pid}
33757 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
33758 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
33759 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
33760 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
33761 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
33762
33763 Reply:
33764 @table @samp
33765 @item E @var{nn}
33766 for an error
33767 @item OK
33768 for success
33769 @end table
33770
33771 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
33772 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
33773 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
33774 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
33775 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
33776 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
33777 state.
33778
33779 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
33780
33781 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
33782
33783 Reply:
33784 @table @samp
33785 @item E @var{nn}
33786 for an error
33787 @item @r{Any stop packet}
33788 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
33789 @end table
33790
33791 @item vStopped
33792 @anchor{vStopped packet}
33793 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
33794
33795 In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
33796 reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
33797
33798 Reply:
33799 @table @samp
33800 @item @r{Any stop packet}
33801 if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
33802 @item OK
33803 if there are no unreported stop events
33804 @end table
33805
33806 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
33807 @anchor{X packet}
33808 @cindex @samp{X} packet
33809 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
33810 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
33811 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
33812
33813 Reply:
33814 @table @samp
33815 @item OK
33816 for success
33817 @item E @var{NN}
33818 for an error
33819 @end table
33820
33821 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
33822 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
33823 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
33824 @cindex @samp{z} packet
33825 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
33826 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
33827 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
33828
33829 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
33830 separately.
33831
33832 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
33833 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
33834 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
33835 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
33836 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
33837 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
33838
33839 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
33840 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
33841 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
33842 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
33843 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
33844 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
33845
33846 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
33847 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
33848 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
33849 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
33850 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
33851 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
33852 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
33853
33854 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
33855 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
33856 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
33857 target, is not defined.}
33858
33859 Reply:
33860 @table @samp
33861 @item OK
33862 success
33863 @item
33864 not supported
33865 @item E @var{NN}
33866 for an error
33867 @end table
33868
33869 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
33870 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
33871 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
33872 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
33873 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
33874 address @var{addr}.
33875
33876 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
33877 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. @var{kind}
33878 has the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
33879
33880 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
33881 movement.}
33882
33883 Reply:
33884 @table @samp
33885 @item OK
33886 success
33887 @item
33888 not supported
33889 @item E @var{NN}
33890 for an error
33891 @end table
33892
33893 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
33894 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
33895 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
33896 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
33897 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
33898 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
33899
33900 Reply:
33901 @table @samp
33902 @item OK
33903 success
33904 @item
33905 not supported
33906 @item E @var{NN}
33907 for an error
33908 @end table
33909
33910 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
33911 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
33912 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
33913 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
33914 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
33915 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
33916
33917 Reply:
33918 @table @samp
33919 @item OK
33920 success
33921 @item
33922 not supported
33923 @item E @var{NN}
33924 for an error
33925 @end table
33926
33927 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
33928 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
33929 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
33930 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
33931 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
33932 @var{kind} is interpreted as the number of bytes to watch.
33933
33934 Reply:
33935 @table @samp
33936 @item OK
33937 success
33938 @item
33939 not supported
33940 @item E @var{NN}
33941 for an error
33942 @end table
33943
33944 @end table
33945
33946 @node Stop Reply Packets
33947 @section Stop Reply Packets
33948 @cindex stop reply packets
33949
33950 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
33951 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
33952 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
33953 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
33954 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
33955 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
33956 @value{GDBN} source code.
33957
33958 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
33959 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
33960 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
33961 components.
33962
33963 @table @samp
33964
33965 @item S @var{AA}
33966 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
33967 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
33968 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
33969
33970 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
33971 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
33972 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
33973 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
33974 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
33975 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
33976 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
33977 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
33978
33979 @itemize @bullet
33980 @item
33981 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
33982 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
33983 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
33984 two-digit hex number.
33985
33986 @item
33987 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
33988 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
33989
33990 @item
33991 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
33992 the core on which the stop event was detected.
33993
33994 @item
33995 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
33996 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
33997 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
33998 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
33999
34000 @item
34001 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
34002 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
34003 future.
34004 @end itemize
34005
34006 The currently defined stop reasons are:
34007
34008 @table @samp
34009 @item watch
34010 @itemx rwatch
34011 @itemx awatch
34012 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
34013 hex.
34014
34015 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
34016 @item library
34017 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
34018 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
34019 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
34020
34021 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
34022 @item replaylog
34023 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
34024 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
34025 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
34026 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
34027 for more information.
34028 @end table
34029
34030 @item W @var{AA}
34031 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34032 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
34033 applicable to certain targets.
34034
34035 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
34036 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
34037 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
34038 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34039
34040 @item X @var{AA}
34041 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
34042 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
34043
34044 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
34045 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
34046 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
34047 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
34048
34049 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
34050 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
34051 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
34052 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
34053 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
34054
34055 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
34056 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
34057 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
34058 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
34059 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
34060 system calls.
34061
34062 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
34063 this very system call.
34064
34065 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
34066 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
34067 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
34068 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
34069 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
34070 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
34071
34072 @end table
34073
34074 @node General Query Packets
34075 @section General Query Packets
34076 @cindex remote query requests
34077
34078 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
34079 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
34080 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
34081 sending information to and from the stub.
34082
34083 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
34084 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
34085 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
34086 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
34087 conventions:
34088
34089 @itemize @bullet
34090 @item
34091 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
34092 @item
34093 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
34094 letter.
34095 @item
34096 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
34097 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
34098 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
34099 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
34100 @end itemize
34101
34102 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
34103 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
34104 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
34105 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
34106 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
34107 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
34108 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
34109 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
34110 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
34111 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
34112 packet.}.
34113
34114 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
34115 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
34116 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
34117 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
34118 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
34119
34120 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
34121
34122 @table @samp
34123
34124 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
34125 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
34126 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
34127 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
34128 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
34129 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
34130 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
34131 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
34132 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
34133 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
34134 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
34135
34136 @item qC
34137 @cindex current thread, remote request
34138 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
34139 Return the current thread ID.
34140
34141 Reply:
34142 @table @samp
34143 @item QC @var{thread-id}
34144 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
34145 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34146 @item @r{(anything else)}
34147 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
34148 @end table
34149
34150 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
34151 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
34152 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
34153 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
34154 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
34155 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
34156 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
34157
34158 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
34159 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
34160 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
34161 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
34162 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
34163 detect trailing zeros.
34164
34165 Reply:
34166 @table @samp
34167 @item E @var{NN}
34168 An error (such as memory fault)
34169 @item C @var{crc32}
34170 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
34171 @end table
34172
34173 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
34174 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
34175 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
34176 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
34177 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
34178 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
34179 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
34180 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
34181 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
34182 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
34183 randomization.
34184
34185 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34186
34187 Reply:
34188 @table @samp
34189 @item OK
34190 The request succeeded.
34191
34192 @item E @var{nn}
34193 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34194
34195 @item
34196 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
34197 by the stub.
34198 @end table
34199
34200 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34201 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34202 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
34203 address space randomization.
34204
34205 @item qfThreadInfo
34206 @itemx qsThreadInfo
34207 @cindex list active threads, remote request
34208 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
34209 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
34210 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
34211 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
34212 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
34213 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
34214 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
34215 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
34216
34217 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
34218
34219 Reply:
34220 @table @samp
34221 @item m @var{thread-id}
34222 A single thread ID
34223 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
34224 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
34225 @item l
34226 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
34227 @end table
34228
34229 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
34230 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
34231 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
34232 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
34233 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
34234 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
34235 fields.
34236
34237 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
34238 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
34239 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
34240 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
34241 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
34242
34243 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
34244 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34245
34246 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
34247 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
34248 information associated with the variable.)
34249
34250 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
34251 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
34252 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
34253 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
34254 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
34255 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
34256
34257 Reply:
34258 @table @samp
34259 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34260 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
34261 local storage requested.
34262
34263 @item E @var{nn}
34264 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34265
34266 @item
34267 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
34268 @end table
34269
34270 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
34271 @cindex get thread information block address
34272 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
34273 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
34274
34275 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
34276
34277 Reply:
34278 @table @samp
34279 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34280 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
34281 thread information block.
34282
34283 @item E @var{nn}
34284 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
34285 address could not be retrieved.
34286
34287 @item
34288 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
34289 @end table
34290
34291 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
34292 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
34293 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
34294 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
34295 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
34296 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
34297 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
34298
34299 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
34300
34301 Reply:
34302 @table @samp
34303 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
34304 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
34305 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
34306 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
34307 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
34308 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
34309 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
34310 @end table
34311
34312 @item qOffsets
34313 @cindex section offsets, remote request
34314 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
34315 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
34316 image.
34317
34318 Reply:
34319 @table @samp
34320 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
34321 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
34322 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
34323 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
34324 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
34325 segments by the supplied offsets.
34326
34327 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
34328 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
34329 to the @code{Bss} section.}
34330
34331 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
34332 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
34333 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
34334 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
34335 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
34336 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
34337 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
34338 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
34339 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
34340 @end table
34341
34342 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
34343 @cindex thread information, remote request
34344 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
34345 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
34346 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
34347 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
34348
34349 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
34350 (see below).
34351
34352 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
34353
34354 @item QNonStop:1
34355 @item QNonStop:0
34356 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
34357 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
34358 @anchor{QNonStop}
34359 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
34360 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
34361
34362 Reply:
34363 @table @samp
34364 @item OK
34365 The request succeeded.
34366
34367 @item E @var{nn}
34368 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34369
34370 @item
34371 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
34372 the stub.
34373 @end table
34374
34375 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34376 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34377 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
34378 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
34379
34380 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
34381 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
34382 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
34383 @anchor{QPassSignals}
34384 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
34385 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
34386 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
34387 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
34388 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
34389 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
34390 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
34391 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
34392 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
34393
34394 Reply:
34395 @table @samp
34396 @item OK
34397 The request succeeded.
34398
34399 @item E @var{nn}
34400 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
34401
34402 @item
34403 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
34404 the stub.
34405 @end table
34406
34407 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
34408 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
34409 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34410 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34411
34412 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
34413 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
34414 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
34415 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
34416 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
34417 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
34418 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
34419 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
34420 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
34421
34422 Reply:
34423 @table @samp
34424 @item OK
34425 A command response with no output.
34426 @item @var{OUTPUT}
34427 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
34428 @item E @var{NN}
34429 Indicate a badly formed request.
34430 @item
34431 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
34432 @end table
34433
34434 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
34435 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
34436 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
34437 packets.)
34438
34439 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
34440 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
34441 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
34442 @anchor{qSearch memory}
34443 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
34444 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
34445 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
34446
34447 Reply:
34448 @table @samp
34449 @item 0
34450 The pattern was not found.
34451 @item 1,address
34452 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
34453 @item E @var{NN}
34454 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
34455 @item
34456 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
34457 @end table
34458
34459 @item QStartNoAckMode
34460 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
34461 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
34462 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
34463 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
34464
34465 Reply:
34466 @table @samp
34467 @item OK
34468 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
34469 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
34470 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
34471 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
34472 @item
34473 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
34474 @end table
34475
34476 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
34477 @cindex supported packets, remote query
34478 @cindex features of the remote protocol
34479 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
34480 @anchor{qSupported}
34481 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
34482 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
34483 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
34484 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
34485 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
34486 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
34487 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
34488 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
34489 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
34490 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
34491 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
34492 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
34493 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
34494 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
34495
34496 Reply:
34497 @table @samp
34498 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
34499 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
34500 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
34501 possible forms).
34502 @item
34503 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
34504 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
34505 @end table
34506
34507 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
34508 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
34509 are:
34510
34511 @table @samp
34512 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
34513 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
34514 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
34515 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
34516 @item @var{name}+
34517 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
34518 need an associated value.
34519 @item @var{name}-
34520 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
34521 @item @var{name}?
34522 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
34523 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
34524 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
34525 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
34526 @end table
34527
34528 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
34529 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
34530 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
34531 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
34532 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
34533
34534 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
34535 are defined:
34536
34537 @table @samp
34538 @item multiprocess
34539 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
34540 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
34541 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
34542 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
34543 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
34544
34545 @item xmlRegisters
34546 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
34547 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
34548 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
34549 description.
34550
34551 @item qRelocInsn
34552 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
34553 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
34554 instruction reply packet}).
34555 @end table
34556
34557 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
34558 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
34559 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
34560 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
34561 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
34562 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
34563 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
34564 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
34565 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
34566 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
34567 all the features it supports.
34568
34569 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
34570 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
34571
34572 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
34573 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
34574 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
34575 form response.
34576
34577 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
34578 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
34579 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
34580 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
34581
34582 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
34583 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
34584 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
34585 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
34586 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
34587
34588 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
34589
34590 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
34591 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
34592 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
34593 @item Feature Name
34594 @tab Value Required
34595 @tab Default
34596 @tab Probe Allowed
34597
34598 @item @samp{PacketSize}
34599 @tab Yes
34600 @tab @samp{-}
34601 @tab No
34602
34603 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
34604 @tab No
34605 @tab @samp{-}
34606 @tab Yes
34607
34608 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
34609 @tab No
34610 @tab @samp{-}
34611 @tab Yes
34612
34613 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
34614 @tab No
34615 @tab @samp{-}
34616 @tab Yes
34617
34618 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
34619 @tab No
34620 @tab @samp{-}
34621 @tab Yes
34622
34623 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
34624 @tab No
34625 @tab @samp{-}
34626 @tab Yes
34627
34628 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
34629 @tab No
34630 @tab @samp{-}
34631 @tab Yes
34632
34633 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
34634 @tab No
34635 @tab @samp{-}
34636 @tab Yes
34637
34638 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
34639 @tab No
34640 @tab @samp{-}
34641 @tab Yes
34642
34643 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
34644 @tab No
34645 @tab @samp{-}
34646 @tab Yes
34647
34648 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
34649 @tab No
34650 @tab @samp{-}
34651 @tab Yes
34652
34653 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
34654 @tab No
34655 @tab @samp{-}
34656 @tab Yes
34657
34658 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
34659 @tab No
34660 @tab @samp{-}
34661 @tab Yes
34662
34663 @item @samp{QNonStop}
34664 @tab No
34665 @tab @samp{-}
34666 @tab Yes
34667
34668 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
34669 @tab No
34670 @tab @samp{-}
34671 @tab Yes
34672
34673 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
34674 @tab No
34675 @tab @samp{-}
34676 @tab Yes
34677
34678 @item @samp{multiprocess}
34679 @tab No
34680 @tab @samp{-}
34681 @tab No
34682
34683 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
34684 @tab No
34685 @tab @samp{-}
34686 @tab No
34687
34688 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
34689 @tab No
34690 @tab @samp{-}
34691 @tab No
34692
34693 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
34694 @tab No
34695 @tab @samp{-}
34696 @tab No
34697
34698 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
34699 @tab No
34700 @tab @samp{-}
34701 @tab No
34702
34703 @item @samp{QAllow}
34704 @tab No
34705 @tab @samp{-}
34706 @tab No
34707
34708 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
34709 @tab No
34710 @tab @samp{-}
34711 @tab No
34712
34713 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
34714 @tab No
34715 @tab @samp{-}
34716 @tab No
34717
34718 @item @samp{tracenz}
34719 @tab No
34720 @tab @samp{-}
34721 @tab No
34722
34723 @end multitable
34724
34725 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
34726
34727 @table @samp
34728 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
34729 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
34730 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
34731 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
34732 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
34733 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
34734 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
34735 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
34736 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
34737 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
34738
34739 @item qXfer:auxv:read
34740 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
34741 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
34742
34743 @item qXfer:features:read
34744 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
34745 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
34746
34747 @item qXfer:libraries:read
34748 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
34749 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
34750
34751 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
34752 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
34753 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
34754
34755 @item qXfer:sdata:read
34756 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
34757 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
34758
34759 @item qXfer:spu:read
34760 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
34761 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
34762
34763 @item qXfer:spu:write
34764 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
34765 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
34766
34767 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
34768 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
34769 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
34770
34771 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
34772 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
34773 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
34774
34775 @item qXfer:threads:read
34776 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
34777 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
34778
34779 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
34780 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
34781 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
34782
34783 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
34784 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
34785 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
34786
34787 @item QNonStop
34788 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
34789 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
34790
34791 @item QPassSignals
34792 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
34793 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
34794
34795 @item QStartNoAckMode
34796 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
34797 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
34798
34799 @item multiprocess
34800 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
34801 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
34802 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
34803 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
34804 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
34805 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
34806 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
34807 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
34808 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
34809 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
34810 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
34811
34812 @item qXfer:osdata:read
34813 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
34814 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
34815
34816 @item ConditionalTracepoints
34817 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
34818 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
34819
34820 @item ReverseContinue
34821 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
34822 (@pxref{bc}).
34823
34824 @item ReverseStep
34825 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
34826 (@pxref{bs}).
34827
34828 @item TracepointSource
34829 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
34830 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
34831
34832 @item QAllow
34833 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
34834
34835 @item QDisableRandomization
34836 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
34837
34838 @item StaticTracepoint
34839 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
34840 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
34841
34842 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
34843 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
34844 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
34845 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
34846
34847 @item tracenz
34848 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
34849 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
34850 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
34851
34852 @end table
34853
34854 @item qSymbol::
34855 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
34856 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
34857 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
34858 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
34859
34860 Reply:
34861 @table @samp
34862 @item OK
34863 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
34864 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
34865 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
34866 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
34867 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
34868 below.
34869 @end table
34870
34871 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
34872 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
34873
34874 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
34875 target has previously requested.
34876
34877 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
34878 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
34879 will be empty.
34880
34881 Reply:
34882 @table @samp
34883 @item OK
34884 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
34885 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
34886 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
34887 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
34888 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
34889 @end table
34890
34891 @item qTBuffer
34892 @item QTBuffer
34893 @item QTDisconnected
34894 @itemx QTDP
34895 @itemx QTDPsrc
34896 @itemx QTDV
34897 @itemx qTfP
34898 @itemx qTfV
34899 @itemx QTFrame
34900 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
34901
34902 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
34903 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
34904 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
34905 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
34906 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
34907 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
34908 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
34909 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
34910 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
34911 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
34912 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
34913
34914 Reply:
34915 @table @samp
34916 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
34917 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
34918 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
34919 the thread's attributes.
34920 @end table
34921
34922 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
34923 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
34924 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
34925 packets.)
34926
34927 @item QTSave
34928 @item qTsP
34929 @item qTsV
34930 @itemx QTStart
34931 @itemx QTStop
34932 @itemx QTEnable
34933 @itemx QTDisable
34934 @itemx QTinit
34935 @itemx QTro
34936 @itemx qTStatus
34937 @itemx qTV
34938 @itemx qTfSTM
34939 @itemx qTsSTM
34940 @itemx qTSTMat
34941 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
34942
34943 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
34944 @cindex read special object, remote request
34945 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
34946 @anchor{qXfer read}
34947 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
34948 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
34949 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
34950 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
34951 additional details about what data to access.
34952
34953 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
34954 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
34955 formats, listed below.
34956
34957 @table @samp
34958 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
34959 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
34960 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
34961 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
34962
34963 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34964 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34965
34966 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
34967 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
34968 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
34969 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
34970 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
34971
34972 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34973 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34974
34975 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
34976 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
34977 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
34978 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
34979 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
34980
34981 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
34982 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
34983 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
34984
34985 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34986 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34987
34988 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
34989 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
34990 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
34991 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
34992 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
34993
34994 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
34995 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
34996
34997 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
34998 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
34999
35000 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
35001 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
35002 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
35003 Action Lists}.
35004
35005 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35006 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35007 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35008
35009 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35010 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
35011 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
35012 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
35013 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35014
35015 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35016 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35017 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35018
35019 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35020 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
35021 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
35022 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
35023 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
35024 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
35025 in that context to be accessed.
35026
35027 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35028 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35029 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35030
35031 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35032 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
35033 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
35034 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
35035 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35036
35037 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35038 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35039
35040 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35041 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
35042
35043 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
35044 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
35045 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
35046
35047 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35048 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35049
35050 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
35051 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
35052 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
35053 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
35054 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
35055
35056 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35057 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35058
35059 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
35060 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
35061 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
35062 @xref{Operating System Information}.
35063
35064 @end table
35065
35066 Reply:
35067 @table @samp
35068 @item m @var{data}
35069 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
35070 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
35071 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
35072 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
35073 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
35074 request.
35075
35076 @item l @var{data}
35077 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
35078 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
35079 than the @var{length} in the request.
35080
35081 @item l
35082 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
35083 There is no more data to be read.
35084
35085 @item E00
35086 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
35087
35088 @item E @var{nn}
35089 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
35090 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
35091
35092 @item
35093 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
35094 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
35095 @end table
35096
35097 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35098 @cindex write data into object, remote request
35099 @anchor{qXfer write}
35100 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
35101 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
35102 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
35103 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
35104 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
35105 to access.
35106
35107 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
35108 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
35109 formats, listed below.
35110
35111 @table @samp
35112 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35113 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
35114 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
35115 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
35116 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
35117
35118 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35119 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
35120 (@pxref{qSupported}).
35121
35122 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
35123 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
35124 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
35125 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
35126 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
35127 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
35128 in that context to be accessed.
35129
35130 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35131 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35132 @end table
35133
35134 Reply:
35135 @table @samp
35136 @item @var{nn}
35137 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
35138 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
35139
35140 @item E00
35141 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
35142
35143 @item E @var{nn}
35144 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
35145 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
35146
35147 @item
35148 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
35149 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
35150 @end table
35151
35152 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
35153 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
35154 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
35155 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
35156 must respond with an empty packet.
35157
35158 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
35159 @cindex query attached, remote request
35160 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
35161 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
35162 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
35163 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
35164 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
35165 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
35166 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
35167
35168 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
35169 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
35170 the @code{quit} command.
35171
35172 Reply:
35173 @table @samp
35174 @item 1
35175 The remote server attached to an existing process.
35176 @item 0
35177 The remote server created a new process.
35178 @item E @var{NN}
35179 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
35180 @end table
35181
35182 @end table
35183
35184 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
35185 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
35186
35187 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
35188 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
35189 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
35190
35191 @subsection ARM
35192
35193 @subsubsection Breakpoint Kinds
35194
35195 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
35196
35197 @table @r
35198
35199 @item 2
35200 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
35201
35202 @item 3
35203 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
35204
35205 @item 4
35206 32-bit ARM mode breakpoint.
35207
35208 @end table
35209
35210 @subsection MIPS
35211
35212 @subsubsection Register Packet Format
35213
35214 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
35215 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
35216 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
35217 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
35218 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
35219 most-significant - least-significant.
35220
35221 @table @r
35222
35223 @item MIPS32
35224
35225 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
35226 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
35227 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
35228
35229 @item MIPS64
35230
35231 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
35232 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
35233 as @code{MIPS32}.
35234
35235 @end table
35236
35237 @node Tracepoint Packets
35238 @section Tracepoint Packets
35239 @cindex tracepoint packets
35240 @cindex packets, tracepoint
35241
35242 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
35243 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
35244
35245 @table @samp
35246
35247 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
35248 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
35249 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
35250 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
35251 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
35252 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
35253 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
35254 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
35255 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
35256 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
35257 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
35258 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
35259 actions.
35260
35261 Replies:
35262 @table @samp
35263 @item OK
35264 The packet was understood and carried out.
35265 @item qRelocInsn
35266 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
35267 @item
35268 The packet was not recognized.
35269 @end table
35270
35271 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
35272 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
35273 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
35274 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
35275 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
35276 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
35277 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
35278
35279 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
35280 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
35281 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
35282 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
35283 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
35284 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
35285 tracepoint actions.
35286
35287 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
35288 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
35289 following forms:
35290
35291 @table @samp
35292
35293 @item R @var{mask}
35294 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
35295 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
35296 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
35297 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
35298 not fit in a 32-bit word.
35299
35300 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
35301 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
35302 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
35303 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
35304 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
35305 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
35306 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
35307
35308 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35309 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
35310 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
35311 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
35312 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
35313 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
35314 packet).
35315
35316 @end table
35317
35318 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
35319 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
35320 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
35321 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
35322 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
35323 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
35324 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
35325 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
35326
35327 Replies:
35328 @table @samp
35329 @item OK
35330 The packet was understood and carried out.
35331 @item qRelocInsn
35332 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
35333 @item
35334 The packet was not recognized.
35335 @end table
35336
35337 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
35338 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
35339 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
35340 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
35341 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. @var{type}
35342 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
35343 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
35344 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
35345
35346 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
35347 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
35348 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
35349 fit in a single packet.
35350 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
35351 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
35352
35353 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
35354 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
35355 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
35356 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
35357
35358 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
35359 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
35360 query packets.
35361
35362 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
35363 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
35364 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
35365 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
35366 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
35367 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
35368 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
35369 be found.
35370
35371 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}
35372 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
35373 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
35374 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
35375 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
35376 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
35377 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
35378 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
35379 mentioned in expressions.
35380
35381 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
35382 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
35383 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
35384 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
35385
35386 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
35387 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
35388 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
35389 one of the following forms:
35390
35391 @table @samp
35392 @item F @var{f}
35393 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
35394 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
35395 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
35396
35397 @item T @var{t}
35398 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
35399 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
35400
35401 @end table
35402
35403 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
35404 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
35405 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
35406 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
35407
35408 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
35409 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
35410 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
35411 is a hexadecimal number.
35412
35413 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
35414 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
35415 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
35416 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
35417 numbers.
35418
35419 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
35420 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
35421 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
35422
35423 @item QTStart
35424 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
35425 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
35426 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
35427 instruction reply packet}).
35428
35429 @item QTStop
35430 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
35431
35432 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
35433 @anchor{QTEnable}
35434 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
35435 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
35436 of data from it will resume.
35437
35438 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
35439 @anchor{QTDisable}
35440 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
35441 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
35442 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
35443
35444 @item QTinit
35445 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
35446
35447 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
35448 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
35449 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
35450 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
35451
35452 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
35453 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
35454 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
35455 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
35456
35457 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
35458 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
35459 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
35460 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
35461 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
35462
35463 @item qTStatus
35464 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
35465
35466 The reply has the form:
35467
35468 @table @samp
35469
35470 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
35471 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
35472 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
35473 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
35474
35475 @end table
35476
35477 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
35478 explanations as one of the optional fields:
35479
35480 @table @samp
35481
35482 @item tnotrun:0
35483 No trace has been run yet.
35484
35485 @item tstop:0
35486 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command.
35487
35488 @item tfull:0
35489 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
35490
35491 @item tdisconnected:0
35492 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
35493
35494 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
35495 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
35496
35497 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
35498 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
35499 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
35500 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression).
35501 @var{text} is hex encoded.
35502
35503 @item tunknown:0
35504 The trace stopped for some other reason.
35505
35506 @end table
35507
35508 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
35509 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
35510 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
35511 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
35512 trace.
35513
35514 @table @samp
35515
35516 @item tframes:@var{n}
35517 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
35518
35519 @item tcreated:@var{n}
35520 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
35521 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
35522
35523 @item tsize:@var{n}
35524 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
35525
35526 @item tfree:@var{n}
35527 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
35528
35529 @item circular:@var{n}
35530 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
35531 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
35532 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
35533 and may fill up.
35534
35535 @item disconn:@var{n}
35536 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
35537 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
35538 that the trace run will stop.
35539
35540 @end table
35541
35542 @item qTV:@var{var}
35543 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
35544 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
35545 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
35546
35547 Replies:
35548 @table @samp
35549 @item V@var{value}
35550 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
35551 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
35552 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
35553 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
35554 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
35555 program is running.
35556
35557 @item U
35558 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
35559 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
35560 was not collected.
35561 @end table
35562
35563 @item qTfP
35564 @itemx qTsP
35565 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
35566 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
35567 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
35568 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
35569 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
35570
35571 @item qTfV
35572 @itemx qTsV
35573 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
35574 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
35575 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
35576 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
35577 trace state variables.
35578
35579 @item qTfSTM
35580 @itemx qTsSTM
35581 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
35582 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
35583 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
35584 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
35585
35586 Reply:
35587 @table @samp
35588 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
35589 A single marker
35590 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
35591 a comma-separated list of markers
35592 @item l
35593 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
35594 @item E @var{nn}
35595 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
35596 @item
35597 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
35598 stub.
35599 @end table
35600
35601 @var{address} is encoded in hex.
35602 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
35603
35604 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
35605 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
35606 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
35607 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
35608 @dfn{last}).
35609
35610 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
35611 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
35612 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
35613 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
35614 tracepoint markers.
35615
35616 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
35617 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
35618 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. @var{filename} is encoded
35619 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
35620 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
35621
35622 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
35623 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
35624 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
35625 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
35626 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
35627 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
35628 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
35629 available.
35630
35631 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
35632 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
35633 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
35634
35635 @end table
35636
35637 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
35638 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
35639 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
35640 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
35641 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
35642 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
35643 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
35644 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
35645 it had executed in the original location.
35646
35647 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
35648 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
35649 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
35650 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
35651 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
35652 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
35653 format of the request is:
35654
35655 @table @samp
35656 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
35657
35658 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
35659 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
35660 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
35661 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
35662 memory starting at @var{to}.
35663 @end table
35664
35665 Replies:
35666 @table @samp
35667 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
35668 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. @var{adjusted_size} is
35669 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
35670 @item E @var{NN}
35671 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
35672 relocating the instruction.
35673 @end table
35674
35675 @node Host I/O Packets
35676 @section Host I/O Packets
35677 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
35678 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
35679
35680 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
35681 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
35682 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
35683 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
35684 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
35685 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
35686 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
35687 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
35688 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
35689 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
35690
35691 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
35692 its arguments. They have this format:
35693
35694 @table @samp
35695
35696 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
35697 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
35698 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
35699 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
35700 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
35701 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
35702 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
35703 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
35704 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35705
35706 @end table
35707
35708 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
35709
35710 @table @samp
35711
35712 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
35713 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
35714 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
35715 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
35716 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
35717 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
35718 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
35719 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
35720 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
35721 @var{attachment}.
35722
35723 @item
35724 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
35725
35726 @end table
35727
35728 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
35729
35730 @table @samp
35731 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
35732 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
35733 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
35734 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
35735 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
35736 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
35737 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
35738
35739 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
35740 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
35741 -1 if an error occurs.
35742
35743 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
35744 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
35745 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
35746 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
35747 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
35748 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
35749 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
35750 @var{count} was zero.
35751
35752 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
35753 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
35754 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
35755 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
35756 some characters were escaped.
35757
35758 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
35759 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
35760 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
35761 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
35762 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
35763 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
35764 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
35765 error occurred.
35766
35767 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
35768 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
35769 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
35770
35771 @end table
35772
35773 @node Interrupts
35774 @section Interrupts
35775 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
35776
35777 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
35778 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
35779 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
35780 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
35781
35782 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
35783 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
35784 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
35785 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
35786 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
35787
35788 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
35789 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
35790 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
35791 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
35792 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
35793 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
35794 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
35795 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
35796
35797 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
35798 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
35799 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
35800
35801 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
35802 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
35803 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
35804 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
35805 currently-executing threads and processes.
35806 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
35807 running program, it should send one of the stop
35808 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
35809 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
35810 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
35811 Interrupts received while the
35812 program is stopped are discarded.
35813
35814 @node Notification Packets
35815 @section Notification Packets
35816 @cindex notification packets
35817 @cindex packets, notification
35818
35819 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
35820 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
35821 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
35822 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
35823 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
35824 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
35825 is not a problem.
35826
35827 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
35828 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
35829 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
35830 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
35831 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
35832 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
35833 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
35834
35835 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
35836 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
35837
35838 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
35839 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
35840 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
35841 not they understand it.
35842
35843 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
35844 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
35845 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
35846 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
35847 recipients.
35848
35849 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
35850 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
35851 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
35852 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
35853 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
35854
35855 The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
35856 defined:
35857
35858 @table @samp
35859 @item Stop: @var{reply}
35860 Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
35861 The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
35862 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
35863 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
35864 @value{GDBN}.
35865 @end table
35866
35867 @node Remote Non-Stop
35868 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
35869
35870 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
35871 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
35872 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
35873 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35874
35875 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
35876 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
35877 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
35878 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
35879 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
35880 probe the target state after a mode change.
35881
35882 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
35883 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
35884 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
35885 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
35886 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
35887 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
35888 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
35889 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
35890 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
35891 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
35892 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
35893
35894 Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
35895 additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
35896 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
35897 synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
35898 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
35899 the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
35900 if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
35901 ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
35902 finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
35903 sending any queued stop events.
35904
35905 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
35906 notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
35907 @value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
35908 @value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
35909 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
35910 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
35911 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
35912
35913 After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
35914 acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
35915 as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
35916 is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
35917 send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
35918 process normally.
35919
35920 Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
35921 stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
35922 normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
35923 @samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
35924 permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
35925 should process normally.
35926
35927 If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
35928 additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
35929 response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
35930 send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
35931 notification, and the process shall be repeated.
35932
35933 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
35934 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
35935 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
35936 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
35937 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
35938 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
35939 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
35940 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
35941 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
35942 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
35943 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
35944 @samp{OK}.
35945
35946 @node Packet Acknowledgment
35947 @section Packet Acknowledgment
35948
35949 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
35950 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
35951 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
35952 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
35953 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
35954 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
35955 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
35956
35957 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
35958 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
35959 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
35960 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
35961 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
35962
35963 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
35964 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
35965 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
35966 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
35967
35968 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
35969 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
35970 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
35971 @pxref{qSupported}.
35972 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
35973 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
35974 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
35975 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
35976 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
35977 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
35978 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
35979
35980 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
35981 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
35982 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
35983 connection.
35984 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
35985 new connection is established,
35986 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
35987 for the current connection, once disabled.
35988
35989 @node Examples
35990 @section Examples
35991
35992 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
35993 does not get any direct output:
35994
35995 @smallexample
35996 -> @code{R00}
35997 <- @code{+}
35998 @emph{target restarts}
35999 -> @code{?}
36000 <- @code{+}
36001 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
36002 -> @code{+}
36003 @end smallexample
36004
36005 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
36006
36007 @smallexample
36008 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
36009 <- @code{+}
36010 -> @code{s}
36011 <- @code{+}
36012 @emph{time passes}
36013 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
36014 -> @code{+}
36015 -> @code{g}
36016 <- @code{+}
36017 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
36018 -> @code{+}
36019 @end smallexample
36020
36021 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
36022 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
36023 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
36024
36025 @menu
36026 * File-I/O Overview::
36027 * Protocol Basics::
36028 * The F Request Packet::
36029 * The F Reply Packet::
36030 * The Ctrl-C Message::
36031 * Console I/O::
36032 * List of Supported Calls::
36033 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
36034 * Constants::
36035 * File-I/O Examples::
36036 @end menu
36037
36038 @node File-I/O Overview
36039 @subsection File-I/O Overview
36040 @cindex file-i/o overview
36041
36042 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
36043 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
36044 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
36045 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
36046 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
36047 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
36048
36049 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
36050 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
36051 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
36052 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
36053 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
36054
36055 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
36056 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
36057 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
36058 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
36059 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
36060 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
36061 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
36062
36063 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
36064 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
36065 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
36066 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
36067 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
36068
36069 @smallexample
36070 (@value{GDBP}) continue
36071 <- target requests 'system call X'
36072 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
36073 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
36074 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
36075 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
36076 @end smallexample
36077
36078 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
36079 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
36080 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
36081 system are not supported by this protocol.
36082
36083 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
36084
36085 @node Protocol Basics
36086 @subsection Protocol Basics
36087 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
36088
36089 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
36090 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
36091 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
36092 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
36093 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
36094 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
36095 to call the appropriate host system call:
36096
36097 @itemize @bullet
36098 @item
36099 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
36100
36101 @item
36102 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
36103 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
36104 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
36105 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
36106
36107 @end itemize
36108
36109 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
36110
36111 @itemize @bullet
36112 @item
36113 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
36114 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
36115 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
36116 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
36117 packet.
36118
36119 @item
36120 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
36121 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
36122
36123 @item
36124 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
36125
36126 @item
36127 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
36128
36129 @item
36130 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
36131 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
36132 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
36133 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
36134 packet.
36135
36136 @end itemize
36137
36138 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
36139 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
36140
36141 @itemize @bullet
36142 @item
36143 Return value.
36144
36145 @item
36146 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
36147
36148 @item
36149 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
36150
36151 @end itemize
36152
36153 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
36154 the latest continue or step action.
36155
36156 @node The F Request Packet
36157 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
36158 @cindex file-i/o request packet
36159 @cindex @code{F} request packet
36160
36161 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
36162
36163 @table @samp
36164 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
36165
36166 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
36167 This is just the name of the function.
36168
36169 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
36170 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
36171 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
36172 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
36173 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
36174 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
36175 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
36176
36177 @end table
36178
36179
36180
36181 @node The F Reply Packet
36182 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
36183 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
36184 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
36185
36186 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
36187
36188 @table @samp
36189
36190 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
36191
36192 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
36193
36194 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
36195 representation.
36196 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
36197
36198 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
36199 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
36200 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
36201
36202 @smallexample
36203 F0,0,C
36204 @end smallexample
36205
36206 @noindent
36207 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
36208
36209 @smallexample
36210 F-1,4,C
36211 @end smallexample
36212
36213 @noindent
36214 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
36215
36216 @end table
36217
36218
36219 @node The Ctrl-C Message
36220 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
36221 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
36222
36223 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
36224 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
36225 the target should behave as if it had
36226 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
36227 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
36228 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
36229 packet.
36230
36231 It's important for the target to know in which
36232 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
36233
36234 @itemize @bullet
36235 @item
36236 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
36237
36238 @item
36239 The system call on the host has been finished.
36240
36241 @end itemize
36242
36243 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
36244 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
36245 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
36246 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
36247 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
36248 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
36249
36250 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
36251 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
36252 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
36253 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
36254 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
36255 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
36256 or the full action has been completed.
36257
36258 @node Console I/O
36259 @subsection Console I/O
36260 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
36261
36262 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
36263 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
36264 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
36265 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
36266 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
36267 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
36268 conditions is met:
36269
36270 @itemize @bullet
36271 @item
36272 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
36273 @code{read}
36274 system call is treated as finished.
36275
36276 @item
36277 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
36278 newline.
36279
36280 @item
36281 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
36282 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
36283
36284 @end itemize
36285
36286 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
36287 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
36288 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
36289 is stopped at the user's request.
36290
36291
36292 @node List of Supported Calls
36293 @subsection List of Supported Calls
36294 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
36295
36296 @menu
36297 * open::
36298 * close::
36299 * read::
36300 * write::
36301 * lseek::
36302 * rename::
36303 * unlink::
36304 * stat/fstat::
36305 * gettimeofday::
36306 * isatty::
36307 * system::
36308 @end menu
36309
36310 @node open
36311 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
36312 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
36313
36314 @table @asis
36315 @item Synopsis:
36316 @smallexample
36317 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
36318 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
36319 @end smallexample
36320
36321 @item Request:
36322 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
36323
36324 @noindent
36325 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
36326
36327 @table @code
36328 @item O_CREAT
36329 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
36330 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
36331 are concerned.
36332
36333 @item O_EXCL
36334 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
36335 an error and open() fails.
36336
36337 @item O_TRUNC
36338 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
36339 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
36340 truncated to zero length.
36341
36342 @item O_APPEND
36343 The file is opened in append mode.
36344
36345 @item O_RDONLY
36346 The file is opened for reading only.
36347
36348 @item O_WRONLY
36349 The file is opened for writing only.
36350
36351 @item O_RDWR
36352 The file is opened for reading and writing.
36353 @end table
36354
36355 @noindent
36356 Other bits are silently ignored.
36357
36358
36359 @noindent
36360 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
36361
36362 @table @code
36363 @item S_IRUSR
36364 User has read permission.
36365
36366 @item S_IWUSR
36367 User has write permission.
36368
36369 @item S_IRGRP
36370 Group has read permission.
36371
36372 @item S_IWGRP
36373 Group has write permission.
36374
36375 @item S_IROTH
36376 Others have read permission.
36377
36378 @item S_IWOTH
36379 Others have write permission.
36380 @end table
36381
36382 @noindent
36383 Other bits are silently ignored.
36384
36385
36386 @item Return value:
36387 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
36388 occurred.
36389
36390 @item Errors:
36391
36392 @table @code
36393 @item EEXIST
36394 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
36395
36396 @item EISDIR
36397 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
36398
36399 @item EACCES
36400 The requested access is not allowed.
36401
36402 @item ENAMETOOLONG
36403 @var{pathname} was too long.
36404
36405 @item ENOENT
36406 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
36407
36408 @item ENODEV
36409 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
36410
36411 @item EROFS
36412 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
36413 write access was requested.
36414
36415 @item EFAULT
36416 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
36417
36418 @item ENOSPC
36419 No space on device to create the file.
36420
36421 @item EMFILE
36422 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
36423
36424 @item ENFILE
36425 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
36426 has been reached.
36427
36428 @item EINTR
36429 The call was interrupted by the user.
36430 @end table
36431
36432 @end table
36433
36434 @node close
36435 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
36436 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
36437
36438 @table @asis
36439 @item Synopsis:
36440 @smallexample
36441 int close(int fd);
36442 @end smallexample
36443
36444 @item Request:
36445 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
36446
36447 @item Return value:
36448 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
36449
36450 @item Errors:
36451
36452 @table @code
36453 @item EBADF
36454 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
36455
36456 @item EINTR
36457 The call was interrupted by the user.
36458 @end table
36459
36460 @end table
36461
36462 @node read
36463 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
36464 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
36465
36466 @table @asis
36467 @item Synopsis:
36468 @smallexample
36469 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
36470 @end smallexample
36471
36472 @item Request:
36473 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
36474
36475 @item Return value:
36476 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
36477 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
36478 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
36479
36480 @item Errors:
36481
36482 @table @code
36483 @item EBADF
36484 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
36485 reading.
36486
36487 @item EFAULT
36488 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
36489
36490 @item EINTR
36491 The call was interrupted by the user.
36492 @end table
36493
36494 @end table
36495
36496 @node write
36497 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
36498 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
36499
36500 @table @asis
36501 @item Synopsis:
36502 @smallexample
36503 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
36504 @end smallexample
36505
36506 @item Request:
36507 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
36508
36509 @item Return value:
36510 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
36511 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
36512 is returned.
36513
36514 @item Errors:
36515
36516 @table @code
36517 @item EBADF
36518 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
36519 writing.
36520
36521 @item EFAULT
36522 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
36523
36524 @item EFBIG
36525 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
36526 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
36527
36528 @item ENOSPC
36529 No space on device to write the data.
36530
36531 @item EINTR
36532 The call was interrupted by the user.
36533 @end table
36534
36535 @end table
36536
36537 @node lseek
36538 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
36539 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
36540
36541 @table @asis
36542 @item Synopsis:
36543 @smallexample
36544 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
36545 @end smallexample
36546
36547 @item Request:
36548 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
36549
36550 @var{flag} is one of:
36551
36552 @table @code
36553 @item SEEK_SET
36554 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
36555
36556 @item SEEK_CUR
36557 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
36558 bytes.
36559
36560 @item SEEK_END
36561 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
36562 bytes.
36563 @end table
36564
36565 @item Return value:
36566 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
36567 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
36568 value of -1 is returned.
36569
36570 @item Errors:
36571
36572 @table @code
36573 @item EBADF
36574 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
36575
36576 @item ESPIPE
36577 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
36578
36579 @item EINVAL
36580 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
36581
36582 @item EINTR
36583 The call was interrupted by the user.
36584 @end table
36585
36586 @end table
36587
36588 @node rename
36589 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
36590 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
36591
36592 @table @asis
36593 @item Synopsis:
36594 @smallexample
36595 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
36596 @end smallexample
36597
36598 @item Request:
36599 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
36600
36601 @item Return value:
36602 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
36603
36604 @item Errors:
36605
36606 @table @code
36607 @item EISDIR
36608 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
36609 directory.
36610
36611 @item EEXIST
36612 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
36613
36614 @item EBUSY
36615 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
36616 process.
36617
36618 @item EINVAL
36619 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
36620 of itself.
36621
36622 @item ENOTDIR
36623 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
36624 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
36625 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
36626
36627 @item EFAULT
36628 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
36629
36630 @item EACCES
36631 No access to the file or the path of the file.
36632
36633 @item ENAMETOOLONG
36634
36635 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
36636
36637 @item ENOENT
36638 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
36639
36640 @item EROFS
36641 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
36642
36643 @item ENOSPC
36644 The device containing the file has no room for the new
36645 directory entry.
36646
36647 @item EINTR
36648 The call was interrupted by the user.
36649 @end table
36650
36651 @end table
36652
36653 @node unlink
36654 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
36655 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
36656
36657 @table @asis
36658 @item Synopsis:
36659 @smallexample
36660 int unlink(const char *pathname);
36661 @end smallexample
36662
36663 @item Request:
36664 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
36665
36666 @item Return value:
36667 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
36668
36669 @item Errors:
36670
36671 @table @code
36672 @item EACCES
36673 No access to the file or the path of the file.
36674
36675 @item EPERM
36676 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
36677
36678 @item EBUSY
36679 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
36680 being used by another process.
36681
36682 @item EFAULT
36683 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
36684
36685 @item ENAMETOOLONG
36686 @var{pathname} was too long.
36687
36688 @item ENOENT
36689 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
36690
36691 @item ENOTDIR
36692 A component of the path is not a directory.
36693
36694 @item EROFS
36695 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
36696
36697 @item EINTR
36698 The call was interrupted by the user.
36699 @end table
36700
36701 @end table
36702
36703 @node stat/fstat
36704 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
36705 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
36706 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
36707
36708 @table @asis
36709 @item Synopsis:
36710 @smallexample
36711 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
36712 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
36713 @end smallexample
36714
36715 @item Request:
36716 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
36717 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
36718
36719 @item Return value:
36720 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
36721
36722 @item Errors:
36723
36724 @table @code
36725 @item EBADF
36726 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
36727
36728 @item ENOENT
36729 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
36730 path is an empty string.
36731
36732 @item ENOTDIR
36733 A component of the path is not a directory.
36734
36735 @item EFAULT
36736 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
36737
36738 @item EACCES
36739 No access to the file or the path of the file.
36740
36741 @item ENAMETOOLONG
36742 @var{pathname} was too long.
36743
36744 @item EINTR
36745 The call was interrupted by the user.
36746 @end table
36747
36748 @end table
36749
36750 @node gettimeofday
36751 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
36752 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
36753
36754 @table @asis
36755 @item Synopsis:
36756 @smallexample
36757 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
36758 @end smallexample
36759
36760 @item Request:
36761 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
36762
36763 @item Return value:
36764 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
36765
36766 @item Errors:
36767
36768 @table @code
36769 @item EINVAL
36770 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
36771
36772 @item EFAULT
36773 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
36774 @end table
36775
36776 @end table
36777
36778 @node isatty
36779 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
36780 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
36781
36782 @table @asis
36783 @item Synopsis:
36784 @smallexample
36785 int isatty(int fd);
36786 @end smallexample
36787
36788 @item Request:
36789 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
36790
36791 @item Return value:
36792 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
36793
36794 @item Errors:
36795
36796 @table @code
36797 @item EINTR
36798 The call was interrupted by the user.
36799 @end table
36800
36801 @end table
36802
36803 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
36804 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
36805 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
36806 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
36807 needed.
36808
36809
36810 @node system
36811 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
36812 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
36813
36814 @table @asis
36815 @item Synopsis:
36816 @smallexample
36817 int system(const char *command);
36818 @end smallexample
36819
36820 @item Request:
36821 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
36822
36823 @item Return value:
36824 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
36825 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
36826 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
36827 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
36828 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
36829 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
36830 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
36831
36832 @item Errors:
36833
36834 @table @code
36835 @item EINTR
36836 The call was interrupted by the user.
36837 @end table
36838
36839 @end table
36840
36841 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
36842 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
36843 the host is simplified before it's returned
36844 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
36845 is discarded, and the return value consists
36846 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
36847
36848 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
36849 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
36850 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
36851
36852 @table @code
36853 @item set remote system-call-allowed
36854 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
36855 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
36856 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
36857
36858 @item show remote system-call-allowed
36859 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
36860 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
36861 protocol.
36862 @end table
36863
36864 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
36865 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
36866 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
36867
36868 @menu
36869 * Integral Datatypes::
36870 * Pointer Values::
36871 * Memory Transfer::
36872 * struct stat::
36873 * struct timeval::
36874 @end menu
36875
36876 @node Integral Datatypes
36877 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
36878 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
36879
36880 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
36881 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
36882 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
36883
36884 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
36885 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
36886
36887 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
36888
36889 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
36890 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
36891
36892 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
36893
36894 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
36895 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
36896 byte order.
36897
36898 @node Pointer Values
36899 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
36900 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
36901
36902 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
36903 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
36904 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
36905 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
36906
36907 @smallexample
36908 @code{1aaf/12}
36909 @end smallexample
36910
36911 @noindent
36912 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
36913 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
36914 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
36915 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
36916
36917 @smallexample
36918 @code{123456/d}
36919 @end smallexample
36920
36921 @node Memory Transfer
36922 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
36923 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
36924
36925 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
36926 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
36927 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
36928 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
36929 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
36930 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
36931 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
36932
36933
36934 @node struct stat
36935 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
36936 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
36937
36938 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
36939 is defined as follows:
36940
36941 @smallexample
36942 struct stat @{
36943 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
36944 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
36945 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
36946 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
36947 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
36948 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
36949 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
36950 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
36951 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
36952 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
36953 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
36954 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
36955 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
36956 @};
36957 @end smallexample
36958
36959 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
36960 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
36961 structure is of size 64 bytes.
36962
36963 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
36964 range of values.
36965
36966 @table @code
36967
36968 @item st_dev
36969 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
36970
36971 @item st_ino
36972 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
36973
36974 @item st_mode
36975 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
36976 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
36977
36978 @item st_uid
36979 @itemx st_gid
36980 @itemx st_rdev
36981 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
36982
36983 @item st_atime
36984 @itemx st_mtime
36985 @itemx st_ctime
36986 These values have a host and file system dependent
36987 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
36988 support exact timing values.
36989 @end table
36990
36991 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
36992 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
36993 continuing.
36994
36995 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
36996 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
36997 get truncated on the target.
36998
36999 @node struct timeval
37000 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
37001 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
37002
37003 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
37004 is defined as follows:
37005
37006 @smallexample
37007 struct timeval @{
37008 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
37009 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
37010 @};
37011 @end smallexample
37012
37013 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
37014 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
37015 structure is of size 8 bytes.
37016
37017 @node Constants
37018 @subsection Constants
37019 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
37020
37021 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
37022 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
37023 values before and after the call as needed.
37024
37025 @menu
37026 * Open Flags::
37027 * mode_t Values::
37028 * Errno Values::
37029 * Lseek Flags::
37030 * Limits::
37031 @end menu
37032
37033 @node Open Flags
37034 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
37035 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
37036
37037 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
37038
37039 @smallexample
37040 O_RDONLY 0x0
37041 O_WRONLY 0x1
37042 O_RDWR 0x2
37043 O_APPEND 0x8
37044 O_CREAT 0x200
37045 O_TRUNC 0x400
37046 O_EXCL 0x800
37047 @end smallexample
37048
37049 @node mode_t Values
37050 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
37051 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
37052
37053 All values are given in octal representation.
37054
37055 @smallexample
37056 S_IFREG 0100000
37057 S_IFDIR 040000
37058 S_IRUSR 0400
37059 S_IWUSR 0200
37060 S_IXUSR 0100
37061 S_IRGRP 040
37062 S_IWGRP 020
37063 S_IXGRP 010
37064 S_IROTH 04
37065 S_IWOTH 02
37066 S_IXOTH 01
37067 @end smallexample
37068
37069 @node Errno Values
37070 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
37071 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
37072
37073 All values are given in decimal representation.
37074
37075 @smallexample
37076 EPERM 1
37077 ENOENT 2
37078 EINTR 4
37079 EBADF 9
37080 EACCES 13
37081 EFAULT 14
37082 EBUSY 16
37083 EEXIST 17
37084 ENODEV 19
37085 ENOTDIR 20
37086 EISDIR 21
37087 EINVAL 22
37088 ENFILE 23
37089 EMFILE 24
37090 EFBIG 27
37091 ENOSPC 28
37092 ESPIPE 29
37093 EROFS 30
37094 ENAMETOOLONG 91
37095 EUNKNOWN 9999
37096 @end smallexample
37097
37098 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
37099 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
37100
37101 @node Lseek Flags
37102 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
37103 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
37104
37105 @smallexample
37106 SEEK_SET 0
37107 SEEK_CUR 1
37108 SEEK_END 2
37109 @end smallexample
37110
37111 @node Limits
37112 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
37113 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
37114
37115 All values are given in decimal representation.
37116
37117 @smallexample
37118 INT_MIN -2147483648
37119 INT_MAX 2147483647
37120 UINT_MAX 4294967295
37121 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
37122 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
37123 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
37124 @end smallexample
37125
37126 @node File-I/O Examples
37127 @subsection File-I/O Examples
37128 @cindex file-i/o examples
37129
37130 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
37131 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
37132
37133 @smallexample
37134 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
37135 @emph{request memory read from target}
37136 -> @code{m1234,6}
37137 <- XXXXXX
37138 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
37139 -> @code{F6}
37140 @end smallexample
37141
37142 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
37143 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
37144
37145 @smallexample
37146 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
37147 @emph{request memory write to target}
37148 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
37149 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
37150 -> @code{F6}
37151 @end smallexample
37152
37153 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
37154 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
37155
37156 @smallexample
37157 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
37158 -> @code{F-1,9}
37159 @end smallexample
37160
37161 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
37162 host is called:
37163
37164 @smallexample
37165 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
37166 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
37167 <- @code{T02}
37168 @end smallexample
37169
37170 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
37171 host is called:
37172
37173 @smallexample
37174 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
37175 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
37176 <- @code{T02}
37177 @end smallexample
37178
37179 @node Library List Format
37180 @section Library List Format
37181 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
37182
37183 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
37184 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
37185 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
37186 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
37187 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
37188 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
37189 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
37190 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
37191 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
37192 are loaded.
37193
37194 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
37195 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
37196 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
37197 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
37198
37199 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
37200 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
37201 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
37202 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
37203 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
37204 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
37205
37206 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
37207 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
37208
37209 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
37210 offset, looks like this:
37211
37212 @smallexample
37213 <library-list>
37214 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
37215 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
37216 </library>
37217 </library-list>
37218 @end smallexample
37219
37220 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
37221 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
37222
37223 @smallexample
37224 <library-list>
37225 <library name="sharedlib.o">
37226 <section address="0x10000000"/>
37227 <section address="0x20000000"/>
37228 <section address="0x30000000"/>
37229 </library>
37230 </library-list>
37231 @end smallexample
37232
37233 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
37234
37235 @smallexample
37236 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
37237 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
37238 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
37239 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
37240 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
37241 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
37242 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
37243 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
37244 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
37245 @end smallexample
37246
37247 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
37248 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
37249 section for each library.
37250
37251 @node Memory Map Format
37252 @section Memory Map Format
37253 @cindex memory map format
37254
37255 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
37256 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
37257 memory map.
37258
37259 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
37260 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
37261 lists memory regions.
37262
37263 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
37264 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
37265
37266 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
37267
37268 @smallexample
37269 <?xml version="1.0"?>
37270 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
37271 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
37272 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
37273 <memory-map>
37274 region...
37275 </memory-map>
37276 @end smallexample
37277
37278 Each region can be either:
37279
37280 @itemize
37281
37282 @item
37283 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
37284 bytes from there:
37285
37286 @smallexample
37287 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
37288 @end smallexample
37289
37290
37291 @item
37292 A region of read-only memory:
37293
37294 @smallexample
37295 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
37296 @end smallexample
37297
37298
37299 @item
37300 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
37301 bytes in length:
37302
37303 @smallexample
37304 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
37305 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
37306 </memory>
37307 @end smallexample
37308
37309 @end itemize
37310
37311 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
37312 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
37313 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
37314
37315 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
37316
37317 @smallexample
37318 <!-- ................................................... -->
37319 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
37320 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
37321 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
37322 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
37323 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
37324 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
37325 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
37326 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
37327 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
37328 and its type, or device. -->
37329 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
37330 start CDATA #REQUIRED
37331 length CDATA #REQUIRED
37332 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
37333 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
37334 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
37335 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
37336 @end smallexample
37337
37338 @node Thread List Format
37339 @section Thread List Format
37340 @cindex thread list format
37341
37342 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
37343 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
37344 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
37345 the following structure:
37346
37347 @smallexample
37348 <?xml version="1.0"?>
37349 <threads>
37350 <thread id="id" core="0">
37351 ... description ...
37352 </thread>
37353 </threads>
37354 @end smallexample
37355
37356 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
37357 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
37358 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
37359 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
37360 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
37361
37362 @node Traceframe Info Format
37363 @section Traceframe Info Format
37364 @cindex traceframe info format
37365
37366 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
37367 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
37368 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
37369 collected in a traceframe.
37370
37371 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37372 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
37373
37374 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
37375 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
37376
37377 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
37378
37379 @smallexample
37380 <?xml version="1.0"?>
37381 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
37382 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
37383 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
37384 <traceframe-info>
37385 block...
37386 </traceframe-info>
37387 @end smallexample
37388
37389 Each traceframe block can be either:
37390
37391 @itemize
37392
37393 @item
37394 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
37395 @var{length} bytes from there:
37396
37397 @smallexample
37398 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
37399 @end smallexample
37400
37401 @end itemize
37402
37403 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
37404
37405 @smallexample
37406 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory)* >
37407 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
37408
37409 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
37410 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
37411 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
37412 @end smallexample
37413
37414 @include agentexpr.texi
37415
37416 @node Target Descriptions
37417 @appendix Target Descriptions
37418 @cindex target descriptions
37419
37420 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
37421 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
37422 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
37423 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
37424 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
37425 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
37426 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
37427
37428 @itemize @bullet
37429 @item
37430 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
37431 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
37432 @item
37433 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
37434 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
37435 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
37436 @item
37437 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
37438 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
37439 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
37440 @end itemize
37441
37442 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
37443 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
37444 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
37445 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
37446 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
37447
37448 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
37449 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
37450
37451 @menu
37452 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
37453 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
37454 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
37455 descriptions.
37456 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
37457 @end menu
37458
37459 @node Retrieving Descriptions
37460 @section Retrieving Descriptions
37461
37462 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
37463 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
37464 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
37465 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
37466 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
37467 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
37468 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
37469 Format}.
37470
37471 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
37472 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
37473 specify a file are:
37474
37475 @table @code
37476 @cindex set tdesc filename
37477 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
37478 Read the target description from @var{path}.
37479
37480 @cindex unset tdesc filename
37481 @item unset tdesc filename
37482 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
37483 will use the description supplied by the current target.
37484
37485 @cindex show tdesc filename
37486 @item show tdesc filename
37487 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
37488 @end table
37489
37490
37491 @node Target Description Format
37492 @section Target Description Format
37493 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
37494
37495 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
37496 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
37497 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
37498 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
37499 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
37500 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
37501 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
37502
37503 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
37504 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
37505 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
37506 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
37507 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
37508
37509 Here is a simple target description:
37510
37511 @smallexample
37512 <target version="1.0">
37513 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
37514 </target>
37515 @end smallexample
37516
37517 @noindent
37518 This minimal description only says that the target uses
37519 the x86-64 architecture.
37520
37521 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
37522 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
37523 are explained further below.
37524
37525 @smallexample
37526 <?xml version="1.0"?>
37527 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
37528 <target version="1.0">
37529 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
37530 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
37531 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
37532 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
37533 </target>
37534 @end smallexample
37535
37536 @noindent
37537 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
37538 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
37539 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
37540 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
37541 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
37542 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
37543 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
37544 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
37545 the version mismatch.
37546
37547 @subsection Inclusion
37548 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
37549 @cindex XInclude
37550 @ifnotinfo
37551 @cindex <xi:include>
37552 @end ifnotinfo
37553
37554 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
37555 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
37556 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
37557 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
37558 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
37559
37560 @smallexample
37561 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
37562 @end smallexample
37563
37564 @noindent
37565 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
37566 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
37567 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
37568 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
37569 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
37570 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
37571 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
37572 original description.
37573
37574 @subsection Architecture
37575 @cindex <architecture>
37576
37577 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
37578
37579 @smallexample
37580 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
37581 @end smallexample
37582
37583 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
37584 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
37585
37586 @subsection OS ABI
37587 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
37588
37589 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
37590 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
37591
37592 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
37593
37594 @smallexample
37595 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
37596 @end smallexample
37597
37598 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
37599 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
37600
37601 @subsection Compatible Architecture
37602 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
37603
37604 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
37605 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
37606
37607 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
37608
37609 @smallexample
37610 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
37611 @end smallexample
37612
37613 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
37614 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
37615
37616 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
37617 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
37618 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
37619 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
37620 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
37621 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
37622 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
37623
37624 @smallexample
37625 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
37626 <compatible>spu</compatible>
37627 @end smallexample
37628
37629 @subsection Features
37630 @cindex <feature>
37631
37632 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
37633 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
37634 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
37635 has this form:
37636
37637 @smallexample
37638 <feature name="@var{name}">
37639 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
37640 @var{reg}@dots{}
37641 </feature>
37642 @end smallexample
37643
37644 @noindent
37645 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
37646 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
37647 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
37648 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
37649
37650 @subsection Types
37651
37652 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
37653 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
37654 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
37655 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
37656 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
37657
37658 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
37659 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
37660 Types must be defined before they are used.
37661
37662 @cindex <vector>
37663 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
37664 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
37665 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
37666 @var{count}:
37667
37668 @smallexample
37669 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
37670 @end smallexample
37671
37672 @cindex <union>
37673 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
37674 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
37675 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
37676 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
37677
37678 @smallexample
37679 <union id="@var{id}">
37680 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
37681 @dots{}
37682 </union>
37683 @end smallexample
37684
37685 @cindex <struct>
37686 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
37687 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
37688 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
37689 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
37690 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
37691 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
37692 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
37693 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
37694
37695 @smallexample
37696 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
37697 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
37698 @dots{}
37699 </struct>
37700 @end smallexample
37701
37702 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
37703 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
37704
37705 @smallexample
37706 <struct id="@var{id}">
37707 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
37708 @dots{}
37709 </struct>
37710 @end smallexample
37711
37712 @cindex <flags>
37713 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
37714 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
37715 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
37716 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
37717 are supported.
37718
37719 @smallexample
37720 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
37721 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
37722 @dots{}
37723 </flags>
37724 @end smallexample
37725
37726 @subsection Registers
37727 @cindex <reg>
37728
37729 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
37730
37731 @smallexample
37732 <reg name="@var{name}"
37733 bitsize="@var{size}"
37734 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
37735 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
37736 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
37737 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
37738 @end smallexample
37739
37740 @noindent
37741 The components are as follows:
37742
37743 @table @var
37744
37745 @item name
37746 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
37747
37748 @item bitsize
37749 The register's size, in bits.
37750
37751 @item regnum
37752 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
37753 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
37754 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
37755 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
37756 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
37757 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
37758 in order of increasing register number.
37759
37760 @item save-restore
37761 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
37762 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
37763 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
37764 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
37765 ABI.
37766
37767 @item type
37768 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
37769 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
37770 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
37771 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
37772 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
37773 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
37774
37775 @item group
37776 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
37777 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
37778 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
37779 in @code{info registers}.
37780
37781 @end table
37782
37783 @node Predefined Target Types
37784 @section Predefined Target Types
37785 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
37786
37787 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
37788 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
37789 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
37790 types. The currently supported types are:
37791
37792 @table @code
37793
37794 @item int8
37795 @itemx int16
37796 @itemx int32
37797 @itemx int64
37798 @itemx int128
37799 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
37800
37801 @item uint8
37802 @itemx uint16
37803 @itemx uint32
37804 @itemx uint64
37805 @itemx uint128
37806 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
37807
37808 @item code_ptr
37809 @itemx data_ptr
37810 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
37811 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
37812 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
37813 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
37814 may be marked as data pointers.
37815
37816 @item ieee_single
37817 Single precision IEEE floating point.
37818
37819 @item ieee_double
37820 Double precision IEEE floating point.
37821
37822 @item arm_fpa_ext
37823 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
37824
37825 @item i387_ext
37826 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
37827
37828 @item i386_eflags
37829 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
37830
37831 @item i386_mxcsr
37832 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
37833
37834 @end table
37835
37836 @node Standard Target Features
37837 @section Standard Target Features
37838 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
37839
37840 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
37841 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
37842 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
37843 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
37844 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
37845 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
37846 can recognize them.
37847
37848 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
37849 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
37850 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
37851 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
37852 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
37853 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
37854 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
37855 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
37856
37857 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
37858 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
37859 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
37860
37861 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
37862 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
37863 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
37864 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
37865
37866 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
37867 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
37868 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
37869
37870 @menu
37871 * ARM Features::
37872 * i386 Features::
37873 * MIPS Features::
37874 * M68K Features::
37875 * PowerPC Features::
37876 * TIC6x Features::
37877 @end menu
37878
37879
37880 @node ARM Features
37881 @subsection ARM Features
37882 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
37883
37884 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
37885 ARM targets.
37886 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
37887 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
37888
37889 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
37890 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
37891 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
37892 and @samp{xpsr}.
37893
37894 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
37895 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
37896
37897 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
37898 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
37899 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
37900 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
37901
37902 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
37903 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
37904 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
37905 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
37906 halves of the double-precision registers.
37907
37908 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
37909 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
37910 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
37911 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
37912 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
37913 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
37914
37915 @node i386 Features
37916 @subsection i386 Features
37917 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
37918
37919 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
37920 targets. It should describe the following registers:
37921
37922 @itemize @minus
37923 @item
37924 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
37925 @item
37926 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
37927 @item
37928 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
37929 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
37930 @item
37931 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
37932 @item
37933 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
37934 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
37935 @end itemize
37936
37937 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
37938
37939 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
37940 describe registers:
37941
37942 @itemize @minus
37943 @item
37944 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
37945 @item
37946 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
37947 @item
37948 @samp{mxcsr}
37949 @end itemize
37950
37951 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
37952 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
37953 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
37954
37955 @itemize @minus
37956 @item
37957 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
37958 @item
37959 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
37960 @end itemize
37961
37962 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
37963 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
37964
37965 @node MIPS Features
37966 @subsection MIPS Features
37967 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
37968
37969 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
37970 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
37971 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
37972 on the target.
37973
37974 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
37975 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
37976 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
37977
37978 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
37979 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
37980 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
37981 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
37982
37983 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
37984 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
37985 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
37986
37987 @node M68K Features
37988 @subsection M68K Features
37989 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
37990
37991 @table @code
37992 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
37993 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
37994 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
37995 One of those features must be always present.
37996 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
37997 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
37998 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
37999 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
38000
38001 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
38002 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
38003 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
38004 @samp{fpiaddr}.
38005 @end table
38006
38007 @node PowerPC Features
38008 @subsection PowerPC Features
38009 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
38010
38011 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
38012 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
38013 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
38014 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
38015
38016 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
38017 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
38018
38019 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
38020 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
38021 and @samp{vrsave}.
38022
38023 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
38024 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
38025 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
38026 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
38027 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
38028 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
38029
38030 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
38031 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
38032 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
38033 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
38034 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
38035 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
38036 user.
38037
38038 @node TIC6x Features
38039 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
38040 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
38041 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
38042 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
38043 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
38044 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
38045
38046 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
38047 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
38048 through @samp{B31}.
38049
38050 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
38051 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
38052
38053 @node Operating System Information
38054 @appendix Operating System Information
38055 @cindex operating system information
38056
38057 @menu
38058 * Process list::
38059 @end menu
38060
38061 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
38062 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
38063 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
38064 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
38065 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
38066 on a different aspect of target.
38067
38068 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
38069 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
38070 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
38071 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
38072
38073 @node Process list
38074 @appendixsection Process list
38075 @cindex operating system information, process list
38076
38077 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
38078 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
38079 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
38080 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
38081
38082 An example document is:
38083
38084 @smallexample
38085 <?xml version="1.0"?>
38086 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
38087 <osdata type="processes">
38088 <item>
38089 <column name="pid">1</column>
38090 <column name="user">root</column>
38091 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
38092 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
38093 </item>
38094 </osdata>
38095 @end smallexample
38096
38097 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
38098 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
38099 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
38100 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
38101 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
38102 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
38103 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
38104
38105 @node Trace File Format
38106 @appendix Trace File Format
38107 @cindex trace file format
38108
38109 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
38110 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
38111
38112 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
38113 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
38114 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
38115 in the future.
38116
38117 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
38118 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
38119 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
38120 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
38121 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
38122 of this section.
38123
38124 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
38125
38126 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
38127 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
38128 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
38129 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
38130 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
38131 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
38132 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
38133 endianness.
38134
38135 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
38136
38137 @table @code
38138 @item R @var{bytes}
38139 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
38140 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
38141 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
38142 hexadecimal encoding.
38143
38144 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
38145 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
38146 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
38147 @var{length} bytes.
38148
38149 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
38150 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
38151 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
38152
38153 @end table
38154
38155 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
38156 of blocks.
38157
38158 @node Index Section Format
38159 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
38160 @cindex .gdb_index section format
38161 @cindex index section format
38162
38163 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
38164 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
38165 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
38166 description.
38167
38168 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
38169 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
38170 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
38171 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
38172 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
38173 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
38174
38175 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
38176
38177 @enumerate
38178 @item
38179 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
38180 unless otherwise noted:
38181
38182 @enumerate
38183 @item
38184 The version number, currently 5. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
38185 Version 4 differs by its hashing function.
38186
38187 @item
38188 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
38189
38190 @item
38191 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
38192 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
38193 to the next offset.
38194
38195 @item
38196 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
38197
38198 @item
38199 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
38200
38201 @item
38202 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
38203 @end enumerate
38204
38205 @item
38206 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
38207 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
38208 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
38209 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
38210 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
38211 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
38212 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
38213 CU indices.
38214
38215 @item
38216 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
38217 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
38218 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
38219 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
38220
38221 @item
38222 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
38223 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
38224
38225 @enumerate
38226 @item
38227 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
38228
38229 @item
38230 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
38231 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
38232
38233 @item
38234 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
38235 @end enumerate
38236
38237 @item
38238 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
38239 the hash table is always a power of 2.
38240
38241 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
38242 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
38243 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
38244 constant pool.
38245
38246 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
38247 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
38248 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
38249
38250 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
38251 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
38252 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
38253 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
38254 index version:
38255
38256 @table @asis
38257 @item Version 4
38258 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
38259
38260 @item Version 5
38261 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
38262 @end table
38263
38264 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
38265
38266 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
38267 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
38268 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
38269 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
38270 collision.
38271
38272 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
38273 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
38274 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
38275 the code.
38276
38277 @item
38278 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
38279 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
38280 strings.
38281
38282 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
38283 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
38284 Each subsequent value is the index of a CU in the CU list. This
38285 element in the hash table is used to indicate which CUs define the
38286 symbol.
38287
38288 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
38289 @end enumerate
38290
38291 @include gpl.texi
38292
38293 @node GNU Free Documentation License
38294 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
38295 @include fdl.texi
38296
38297 @node Index
38298 @unnumbered Index
38299
38300 @printindex cp
38301
38302 @tex
38303 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
38304 % meantime:
38305 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
38306 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
38307 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
38308 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
38309 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
38310 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
38311 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
38312 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
38313 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
38314 \page\colophon
38315 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
38316 @end tex
38317
38318 @bye
This page took 0.85562 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.